Collections.java (UnmodifiableMap.toArray): Imported changes from Classpath.
[gcc.git] / gcc / dwarf2out.c
1 /* Output Dwarf2 format symbol table information from GCC.
2 Copyright (C) 1992, 1993, 1995, 1996, 1997, 1998, 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002,
3 2003, 2004, 2005, 2006, 2007 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
4 Contributed by Gary Funck (gary@intrepid.com).
5 Derived from DWARF 1 implementation of Ron Guilmette (rfg@monkeys.com).
6 Extensively modified by Jason Merrill (jason@cygnus.com).
7
8 This file is part of GCC.
9
10 GCC is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it under
11 the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by the Free
12 Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option) any later
13 version.
14
15 GCC is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, but WITHOUT ANY
16 WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of MERCHANTABILITY or
17 FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU General Public License
18 for more details.
19
20 You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
21 along with GCC; see the file COPYING. If not, write to the Free
22 Software Foundation, 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor, Boston, MA
23 02110-1301, USA. */
24
25 /* TODO: Emit .debug_line header even when there are no functions, since
26 the file numbers are used by .debug_info. Alternately, leave
27 out locations for types and decls.
28 Avoid talking about ctors and op= for PODs.
29 Factor out common prologue sequences into multiple CIEs. */
30
31 /* The first part of this file deals with the DWARF 2 frame unwind
32 information, which is also used by the GCC efficient exception handling
33 mechanism. The second part, controlled only by an #ifdef
34 DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO, deals with the other DWARF 2 debugging
35 information. */
36
37 #include "config.h"
38 #include "system.h"
39 #include "coretypes.h"
40 #include "tm.h"
41 #include "tree.h"
42 #include "version.h"
43 #include "flags.h"
44 #include "real.h"
45 #include "rtl.h"
46 #include "hard-reg-set.h"
47 #include "regs.h"
48 #include "insn-config.h"
49 #include "reload.h"
50 #include "function.h"
51 #include "output.h"
52 #include "expr.h"
53 #include "libfuncs.h"
54 #include "except.h"
55 #include "dwarf2.h"
56 #include "dwarf2out.h"
57 #include "dwarf2asm.h"
58 #include "toplev.h"
59 #include "varray.h"
60 #include "ggc.h"
61 #include "md5.h"
62 #include "tm_p.h"
63 #include "diagnostic.h"
64 #include "debug.h"
65 #include "target.h"
66 #include "langhooks.h"
67 #include "hashtab.h"
68 #include "cgraph.h"
69 #include "input.h"
70
71 #ifdef DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO
72 static void dwarf2out_source_line (unsigned int, const char *);
73 #endif
74
75 /* DWARF2 Abbreviation Glossary:
76 CFA = Canonical Frame Address
77 a fixed address on the stack which identifies a call frame.
78 We define it to be the value of SP just before the call insn.
79 The CFA register and offset, which may change during the course
80 of the function, are used to calculate its value at runtime.
81 CFI = Call Frame Instruction
82 an instruction for the DWARF2 abstract machine
83 CIE = Common Information Entry
84 information describing information common to one or more FDEs
85 DIE = Debugging Information Entry
86 FDE = Frame Description Entry
87 information describing the stack call frame, in particular,
88 how to restore registers
89
90 DW_CFA_... = DWARF2 CFA call frame instruction
91 DW_TAG_... = DWARF2 DIE tag */
92
93 #ifndef DWARF2_FRAME_INFO
94 # ifdef DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO
95 # define DWARF2_FRAME_INFO \
96 (write_symbols == DWARF2_DEBUG || write_symbols == VMS_AND_DWARF2_DEBUG)
97 # else
98 # define DWARF2_FRAME_INFO 0
99 # endif
100 #endif
101
102 /* Map register numbers held in the call frame info that gcc has
103 collected using DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM to those that should be output in
104 .debug_frame and .eh_frame. */
105 #ifndef DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT
106 #define DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT(REGNO, FOR_EH) (REGNO)
107 #endif
108
109 /* Decide whether we want to emit frame unwind information for the current
110 translation unit. */
111
112 int
113 dwarf2out_do_frame (void)
114 {
115 /* We want to emit correct CFA location expressions or lists, so we
116 have to return true if we're going to output debug info, even if
117 we're not going to output frame or unwind info. */
118 return (write_symbols == DWARF2_DEBUG
119 || write_symbols == VMS_AND_DWARF2_DEBUG
120 || DWARF2_FRAME_INFO
121 #ifdef DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO
122 || (DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO
123 && (flag_unwind_tables
124 || (flag_exceptions && ! USING_SJLJ_EXCEPTIONS)))
125 #endif
126 );
127 }
128
129 /* The size of the target's pointer type. */
130 #ifndef PTR_SIZE
131 #define PTR_SIZE (POINTER_SIZE / BITS_PER_UNIT)
132 #endif
133
134 /* Array of RTXes referenced by the debugging information, which therefore
135 must be kept around forever. */
136 static GTY(()) VEC(rtx,gc) *used_rtx_array;
137
138 /* A pointer to the base of a list of incomplete types which might be
139 completed at some later time. incomplete_types_list needs to be a
140 VEC(tree,gc) because we want to tell the garbage collector about
141 it. */
142 static GTY(()) VEC(tree,gc) *incomplete_types;
143
144 /* A pointer to the base of a table of references to declaration
145 scopes. This table is a display which tracks the nesting
146 of declaration scopes at the current scope and containing
147 scopes. This table is used to find the proper place to
148 define type declaration DIE's. */
149 static GTY(()) VEC(tree,gc) *decl_scope_table;
150
151 /* Pointers to various DWARF2 sections. */
152 static GTY(()) section *debug_info_section;
153 static GTY(()) section *debug_abbrev_section;
154 static GTY(()) section *debug_aranges_section;
155 static GTY(()) section *debug_macinfo_section;
156 static GTY(()) section *debug_line_section;
157 static GTY(()) section *debug_loc_section;
158 static GTY(()) section *debug_pubnames_section;
159 static GTY(()) section *debug_pubtypes_section;
160 static GTY(()) section *debug_str_section;
161 static GTY(()) section *debug_ranges_section;
162 static GTY(()) section *debug_frame_section;
163
164 /* How to start an assembler comment. */
165 #ifndef ASM_COMMENT_START
166 #define ASM_COMMENT_START ";#"
167 #endif
168
169 typedef struct dw_cfi_struct *dw_cfi_ref;
170 typedef struct dw_fde_struct *dw_fde_ref;
171 typedef union dw_cfi_oprnd_struct *dw_cfi_oprnd_ref;
172
173 /* Call frames are described using a sequence of Call Frame
174 Information instructions. The register number, offset
175 and address fields are provided as possible operands;
176 their use is selected by the opcode field. */
177
178 enum dw_cfi_oprnd_type {
179 dw_cfi_oprnd_unused,
180 dw_cfi_oprnd_reg_num,
181 dw_cfi_oprnd_offset,
182 dw_cfi_oprnd_addr,
183 dw_cfi_oprnd_loc
184 };
185
186 typedef union dw_cfi_oprnd_struct GTY(())
187 {
188 unsigned int GTY ((tag ("dw_cfi_oprnd_reg_num"))) dw_cfi_reg_num;
189 HOST_WIDE_INT GTY ((tag ("dw_cfi_oprnd_offset"))) dw_cfi_offset;
190 const char * GTY ((tag ("dw_cfi_oprnd_addr"))) dw_cfi_addr;
191 struct dw_loc_descr_struct * GTY ((tag ("dw_cfi_oprnd_loc"))) dw_cfi_loc;
192 }
193 dw_cfi_oprnd;
194
195 typedef struct dw_cfi_struct GTY(())
196 {
197 dw_cfi_ref dw_cfi_next;
198 enum dwarf_call_frame_info dw_cfi_opc;
199 dw_cfi_oprnd GTY ((desc ("dw_cfi_oprnd1_desc (%1.dw_cfi_opc)")))
200 dw_cfi_oprnd1;
201 dw_cfi_oprnd GTY ((desc ("dw_cfi_oprnd2_desc (%1.dw_cfi_opc)")))
202 dw_cfi_oprnd2;
203 }
204 dw_cfi_node;
205
206 /* This is how we define the location of the CFA. We use to handle it
207 as REG + OFFSET all the time, but now it can be more complex.
208 It can now be either REG + CFA_OFFSET or *(REG + BASE_OFFSET) + CFA_OFFSET.
209 Instead of passing around REG and OFFSET, we pass a copy
210 of this structure. */
211 typedef struct cfa_loc GTY(())
212 {
213 HOST_WIDE_INT offset;
214 HOST_WIDE_INT base_offset;
215 unsigned int reg;
216 int indirect; /* 1 if CFA is accessed via a dereference. */
217 } dw_cfa_location;
218
219 /* All call frame descriptions (FDE's) in the GCC generated DWARF
220 refer to a single Common Information Entry (CIE), defined at
221 the beginning of the .debug_frame section. This use of a single
222 CIE obviates the need to keep track of multiple CIE's
223 in the DWARF generation routines below. */
224
225 typedef struct dw_fde_struct GTY(())
226 {
227 tree decl;
228 const char *dw_fde_begin;
229 const char *dw_fde_current_label;
230 const char *dw_fde_end;
231 const char *dw_fde_hot_section_label;
232 const char *dw_fde_hot_section_end_label;
233 const char *dw_fde_unlikely_section_label;
234 const char *dw_fde_unlikely_section_end_label;
235 bool dw_fde_switched_sections;
236 dw_cfi_ref dw_fde_cfi;
237 unsigned funcdef_number;
238 unsigned all_throwers_are_sibcalls : 1;
239 unsigned nothrow : 1;
240 unsigned uses_eh_lsda : 1;
241 }
242 dw_fde_node;
243
244 /* Maximum size (in bytes) of an artificially generated label. */
245 #define MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES 30
246
247 /* The size of addresses as they appear in the Dwarf 2 data.
248 Some architectures use word addresses to refer to code locations,
249 but Dwarf 2 info always uses byte addresses. On such machines,
250 Dwarf 2 addresses need to be larger than the architecture's
251 pointers. */
252 #ifndef DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE
253 #define DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE (POINTER_SIZE / BITS_PER_UNIT)
254 #endif
255
256 /* The size in bytes of a DWARF field indicating an offset or length
257 relative to a debug info section, specified to be 4 bytes in the
258 DWARF-2 specification. The SGI/MIPS ABI defines it to be the same
259 as PTR_SIZE. */
260
261 #ifndef DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE
262 #define DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE 4
263 #endif
264
265 /* According to the (draft) DWARF 3 specification, the initial length
266 should either be 4 or 12 bytes. When it's 12 bytes, the first 4
267 bytes are 0xffffffff, followed by the length stored in the next 8
268 bytes.
269
270 However, the SGI/MIPS ABI uses an initial length which is equal to
271 DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE. It is defined (elsewhere) accordingly. */
272
273 #ifndef DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE
274 #define DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE == 4 ? 4 : 12)
275 #endif
276
277 #define DWARF_VERSION 2
278
279 /* Round SIZE up to the nearest BOUNDARY. */
280 #define DWARF_ROUND(SIZE,BOUNDARY) \
281 ((((SIZE) + (BOUNDARY) - 1) / (BOUNDARY)) * (BOUNDARY))
282
283 /* Offsets recorded in opcodes are a multiple of this alignment factor. */
284 #ifndef DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT
285 #ifdef STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD
286 #define DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT (-((int) UNITS_PER_WORD))
287 #else
288 #define DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT ((int) UNITS_PER_WORD)
289 #endif
290 #endif
291
292 /* CIE identifier. */
293 #if HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT >= 64
294 #define DWARF_CIE_ID \
295 (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE == 4 ? DW_CIE_ID : DW64_CIE_ID)
296 #else
297 #define DWARF_CIE_ID DW_CIE_ID
298 #endif
299
300 /* A pointer to the base of a table that contains frame description
301 information for each routine. */
302 static GTY((length ("fde_table_allocated"))) dw_fde_ref fde_table;
303
304 /* Number of elements currently allocated for fde_table. */
305 static GTY(()) unsigned fde_table_allocated;
306
307 /* Number of elements in fde_table currently in use. */
308 static GTY(()) unsigned fde_table_in_use;
309
310 /* Size (in elements) of increments by which we may expand the
311 fde_table. */
312 #define FDE_TABLE_INCREMENT 256
313
314 /* A list of call frame insns for the CIE. */
315 static GTY(()) dw_cfi_ref cie_cfi_head;
316
317 #if defined (DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO) || defined (DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO)
318 /* Some DWARF extensions (e.g., MIPS/SGI) implement a subprogram
319 attribute that accelerates the lookup of the FDE associated
320 with the subprogram. This variable holds the table index of the FDE
321 associated with the current function (body) definition. */
322 static unsigned current_funcdef_fde;
323 #endif
324
325 struct indirect_string_node GTY(())
326 {
327 const char *str;
328 unsigned int refcount;
329 unsigned int form;
330 char *label;
331 };
332
333 static GTY ((param_is (struct indirect_string_node))) htab_t debug_str_hash;
334
335 static GTY(()) int dw2_string_counter;
336 static GTY(()) unsigned long dwarf2out_cfi_label_num;
337
338 #if defined (DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO) || defined (DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO)
339
340 /* Forward declarations for functions defined in this file. */
341
342 static char *stripattributes (const char *);
343 static const char *dwarf_cfi_name (unsigned);
344 static dw_cfi_ref new_cfi (void);
345 static void add_cfi (dw_cfi_ref *, dw_cfi_ref);
346 static void add_fde_cfi (const char *, dw_cfi_ref);
347 static void lookup_cfa_1 (dw_cfi_ref, dw_cfa_location *);
348 static void lookup_cfa (dw_cfa_location *);
349 static void reg_save (const char *, unsigned, unsigned, HOST_WIDE_INT);
350 static void initial_return_save (rtx);
351 static HOST_WIDE_INT stack_adjust_offset (rtx);
352 static void output_cfi (dw_cfi_ref, dw_fde_ref, int);
353 static void output_call_frame_info (int);
354 static void dwarf2out_stack_adjust (rtx, bool);
355 static void flush_queued_reg_saves (void);
356 static bool clobbers_queued_reg_save (rtx);
357 static void dwarf2out_frame_debug_expr (rtx, const char *);
358
359 /* Support for complex CFA locations. */
360 static void output_cfa_loc (dw_cfi_ref);
361 static void get_cfa_from_loc_descr (dw_cfa_location *,
362 struct dw_loc_descr_struct *);
363 static struct dw_loc_descr_struct *build_cfa_loc
364 (dw_cfa_location *, HOST_WIDE_INT);
365 static void def_cfa_1 (const char *, dw_cfa_location *);
366
367 /* How to start an assembler comment. */
368 #ifndef ASM_COMMENT_START
369 #define ASM_COMMENT_START ";#"
370 #endif
371
372 /* Data and reference forms for relocatable data. */
373 #define DW_FORM_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE == 8 ? DW_FORM_data8 : DW_FORM_data4)
374 #define DW_FORM_ref (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE == 8 ? DW_FORM_ref8 : DW_FORM_ref4)
375
376 #ifndef DEBUG_FRAME_SECTION
377 #define DEBUG_FRAME_SECTION ".debug_frame"
378 #endif
379
380 #ifndef FUNC_BEGIN_LABEL
381 #define FUNC_BEGIN_LABEL "LFB"
382 #endif
383
384 #ifndef FUNC_END_LABEL
385 #define FUNC_END_LABEL "LFE"
386 #endif
387
388 #ifndef FRAME_BEGIN_LABEL
389 #define FRAME_BEGIN_LABEL "Lframe"
390 #endif
391 #define CIE_AFTER_SIZE_LABEL "LSCIE"
392 #define CIE_END_LABEL "LECIE"
393 #define FDE_LABEL "LSFDE"
394 #define FDE_AFTER_SIZE_LABEL "LASFDE"
395 #define FDE_END_LABEL "LEFDE"
396 #define LINE_NUMBER_BEGIN_LABEL "LSLT"
397 #define LINE_NUMBER_END_LABEL "LELT"
398 #define LN_PROLOG_AS_LABEL "LASLTP"
399 #define LN_PROLOG_END_LABEL "LELTP"
400 #define DIE_LABEL_PREFIX "DW"
401
402 /* The DWARF 2 CFA column which tracks the return address. Normally this
403 is the column for PC, or the first column after all of the hard
404 registers. */
405 #ifndef DWARF_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN
406 #ifdef PC_REGNUM
407 #define DWARF_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (PC_REGNUM)
408 #else
409 #define DWARF_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN DWARF_FRAME_REGISTERS
410 #endif
411 #endif
412
413 /* The mapping from gcc register number to DWARF 2 CFA column number. By
414 default, we just provide columns for all registers. */
415 #ifndef DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM
416 #define DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM(REG) DBX_REGISTER_NUMBER (REG)
417 #endif
418 \f
419 /* Hook used by __throw. */
420
421 rtx
422 expand_builtin_dwarf_sp_column (void)
423 {
424 unsigned int dwarf_regnum = DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (STACK_POINTER_REGNUM);
425 return GEN_INT (DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (dwarf_regnum, 1));
426 }
427
428 /* Return a pointer to a copy of the section string name S with all
429 attributes stripped off, and an asterisk prepended (for assemble_name). */
430
431 static inline char *
432 stripattributes (const char *s)
433 {
434 char *stripped = XNEWVEC (char, strlen (s) + 2);
435 char *p = stripped;
436
437 *p++ = '*';
438
439 while (*s && *s != ',')
440 *p++ = *s++;
441
442 *p = '\0';
443 return stripped;
444 }
445
446 /* MEM is a memory reference for the register size table, each element of
447 which has mode MODE. Initialize column C as a return address column. */
448
449 static void
450 init_return_column_size (enum machine_mode mode, rtx mem, unsigned int c)
451 {
452 HOST_WIDE_INT offset = c * GET_MODE_SIZE (mode);
453 HOST_WIDE_INT size = GET_MODE_SIZE (Pmode);
454 emit_move_insn (adjust_address (mem, mode, offset), GEN_INT (size));
455 }
456
457 /* Generate code to initialize the register size table. */
458
459 void
460 expand_builtin_init_dwarf_reg_sizes (tree address)
461 {
462 unsigned int i;
463 enum machine_mode mode = TYPE_MODE (char_type_node);
464 rtx addr = expand_normal (address);
465 rtx mem = gen_rtx_MEM (BLKmode, addr);
466 bool wrote_return_column = false;
467
468 for (i = 0; i < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER; i++)
469 {
470 int rnum = DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (i), 1);
471
472 if (rnum < DWARF_FRAME_REGISTERS)
473 {
474 HOST_WIDE_INT offset = rnum * GET_MODE_SIZE (mode);
475 enum machine_mode save_mode = reg_raw_mode[i];
476 HOST_WIDE_INT size;
477
478 if (HARD_REGNO_CALL_PART_CLOBBERED (i, save_mode))
479 save_mode = choose_hard_reg_mode (i, 1, true);
480 if (DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (i) == DWARF_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN)
481 {
482 if (save_mode == VOIDmode)
483 continue;
484 wrote_return_column = true;
485 }
486 size = GET_MODE_SIZE (save_mode);
487 if (offset < 0)
488 continue;
489
490 emit_move_insn (adjust_address (mem, mode, offset),
491 gen_int_mode (size, mode));
492 }
493 }
494
495 if (!wrote_return_column)
496 init_return_column_size (mode, mem, DWARF_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN);
497
498 #ifdef DWARF_ALT_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN
499 init_return_column_size (mode, mem, DWARF_ALT_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN);
500 #endif
501 }
502
503 /* Convert a DWARF call frame info. operation to its string name */
504
505 static const char *
506 dwarf_cfi_name (unsigned int cfi_opc)
507 {
508 switch (cfi_opc)
509 {
510 case DW_CFA_advance_loc:
511 return "DW_CFA_advance_loc";
512 case DW_CFA_offset:
513 return "DW_CFA_offset";
514 case DW_CFA_restore:
515 return "DW_CFA_restore";
516 case DW_CFA_nop:
517 return "DW_CFA_nop";
518 case DW_CFA_set_loc:
519 return "DW_CFA_set_loc";
520 case DW_CFA_advance_loc1:
521 return "DW_CFA_advance_loc1";
522 case DW_CFA_advance_loc2:
523 return "DW_CFA_advance_loc2";
524 case DW_CFA_advance_loc4:
525 return "DW_CFA_advance_loc4";
526 case DW_CFA_offset_extended:
527 return "DW_CFA_offset_extended";
528 case DW_CFA_restore_extended:
529 return "DW_CFA_restore_extended";
530 case DW_CFA_undefined:
531 return "DW_CFA_undefined";
532 case DW_CFA_same_value:
533 return "DW_CFA_same_value";
534 case DW_CFA_register:
535 return "DW_CFA_register";
536 case DW_CFA_remember_state:
537 return "DW_CFA_remember_state";
538 case DW_CFA_restore_state:
539 return "DW_CFA_restore_state";
540 case DW_CFA_def_cfa:
541 return "DW_CFA_def_cfa";
542 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_register:
543 return "DW_CFA_def_cfa_register";
544 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset:
545 return "DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset";
546
547 /* DWARF 3 */
548 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_expression:
549 return "DW_CFA_def_cfa_expression";
550 case DW_CFA_expression:
551 return "DW_CFA_expression";
552 case DW_CFA_offset_extended_sf:
553 return "DW_CFA_offset_extended_sf";
554 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_sf:
555 return "DW_CFA_def_cfa_sf";
556 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset_sf:
557 return "DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset_sf";
558
559 /* SGI/MIPS specific */
560 case DW_CFA_MIPS_advance_loc8:
561 return "DW_CFA_MIPS_advance_loc8";
562
563 /* GNU extensions */
564 case DW_CFA_GNU_window_save:
565 return "DW_CFA_GNU_window_save";
566 case DW_CFA_GNU_args_size:
567 return "DW_CFA_GNU_args_size";
568 case DW_CFA_GNU_negative_offset_extended:
569 return "DW_CFA_GNU_negative_offset_extended";
570
571 default:
572 return "DW_CFA_<unknown>";
573 }
574 }
575
576 /* Return a pointer to a newly allocated Call Frame Instruction. */
577
578 static inline dw_cfi_ref
579 new_cfi (void)
580 {
581 dw_cfi_ref cfi = ggc_alloc (sizeof (dw_cfi_node));
582
583 cfi->dw_cfi_next = NULL;
584 cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num = 0;
585 cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd2.dw_cfi_reg_num = 0;
586
587 return cfi;
588 }
589
590 /* Add a Call Frame Instruction to list of instructions. */
591
592 static inline void
593 add_cfi (dw_cfi_ref *list_head, dw_cfi_ref cfi)
594 {
595 dw_cfi_ref *p;
596
597 /* Find the end of the chain. */
598 for (p = list_head; (*p) != NULL; p = &(*p)->dw_cfi_next)
599 ;
600
601 *p = cfi;
602 }
603
604 /* Generate a new label for the CFI info to refer to. */
605
606 char *
607 dwarf2out_cfi_label (void)
608 {
609 static char label[20];
610
611 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label, "LCFI", dwarf2out_cfi_label_num++);
612 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, label);
613 return label;
614 }
615
616 /* Add CFI to the current fde at the PC value indicated by LABEL if specified,
617 or to the CIE if LABEL is NULL. */
618
619 static void
620 add_fde_cfi (const char *label, dw_cfi_ref cfi)
621 {
622 if (label)
623 {
624 dw_fde_ref fde = &fde_table[fde_table_in_use - 1];
625
626 if (*label == 0)
627 label = dwarf2out_cfi_label ();
628
629 if (fde->dw_fde_current_label == NULL
630 || strcmp (label, fde->dw_fde_current_label) != 0)
631 {
632 dw_cfi_ref xcfi;
633
634 label = xstrdup (label);
635
636 /* Set the location counter to the new label. */
637 xcfi = new_cfi ();
638 /* If we have a current label, advance from there, otherwise
639 set the location directly using set_loc. */
640 xcfi->dw_cfi_opc = fde->dw_fde_current_label
641 ? DW_CFA_advance_loc4
642 : DW_CFA_set_loc;
643 xcfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_addr = label;
644 add_cfi (&fde->dw_fde_cfi, xcfi);
645
646 fde->dw_fde_current_label = label;
647 }
648
649 add_cfi (&fde->dw_fde_cfi, cfi);
650 }
651
652 else
653 add_cfi (&cie_cfi_head, cfi);
654 }
655
656 /* Subroutine of lookup_cfa. */
657
658 static void
659 lookup_cfa_1 (dw_cfi_ref cfi, dw_cfa_location *loc)
660 {
661 switch (cfi->dw_cfi_opc)
662 {
663 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset:
664 loc->offset = cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_offset;
665 break;
666 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset_sf:
667 loc->offset
668 = cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_offset * DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT;
669 break;
670 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_register:
671 loc->reg = cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num;
672 break;
673 case DW_CFA_def_cfa:
674 loc->reg = cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num;
675 loc->offset = cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd2.dw_cfi_offset;
676 break;
677 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_sf:
678 loc->reg = cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num;
679 loc->offset
680 = cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd2.dw_cfi_offset * DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT;
681 break;
682 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_expression:
683 get_cfa_from_loc_descr (loc, cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_loc);
684 break;
685 default:
686 break;
687 }
688 }
689
690 /* Find the previous value for the CFA. */
691
692 static void
693 lookup_cfa (dw_cfa_location *loc)
694 {
695 dw_cfi_ref cfi;
696
697 loc->reg = INVALID_REGNUM;
698 loc->offset = 0;
699 loc->indirect = 0;
700 loc->base_offset = 0;
701
702 for (cfi = cie_cfi_head; cfi; cfi = cfi->dw_cfi_next)
703 lookup_cfa_1 (cfi, loc);
704
705 if (fde_table_in_use)
706 {
707 dw_fde_ref fde = &fde_table[fde_table_in_use - 1];
708 for (cfi = fde->dw_fde_cfi; cfi; cfi = cfi->dw_cfi_next)
709 lookup_cfa_1 (cfi, loc);
710 }
711 }
712
713 /* The current rule for calculating the DWARF2 canonical frame address. */
714 static dw_cfa_location cfa;
715
716 /* The register used for saving registers to the stack, and its offset
717 from the CFA. */
718 static dw_cfa_location cfa_store;
719
720 /* The running total of the size of arguments pushed onto the stack. */
721 static HOST_WIDE_INT args_size;
722
723 /* The last args_size we actually output. */
724 static HOST_WIDE_INT old_args_size;
725
726 /* Entry point to update the canonical frame address (CFA).
727 LABEL is passed to add_fde_cfi. The value of CFA is now to be
728 calculated from REG+OFFSET. */
729
730 void
731 dwarf2out_def_cfa (const char *label, unsigned int reg, HOST_WIDE_INT offset)
732 {
733 dw_cfa_location loc;
734 loc.indirect = 0;
735 loc.base_offset = 0;
736 loc.reg = reg;
737 loc.offset = offset;
738 def_cfa_1 (label, &loc);
739 }
740
741 /* Determine if two dw_cfa_location structures define the same data. */
742
743 static bool
744 cfa_equal_p (const dw_cfa_location *loc1, const dw_cfa_location *loc2)
745 {
746 return (loc1->reg == loc2->reg
747 && loc1->offset == loc2->offset
748 && loc1->indirect == loc2->indirect
749 && (loc1->indirect == 0
750 || loc1->base_offset == loc2->base_offset));
751 }
752
753 /* This routine does the actual work. The CFA is now calculated from
754 the dw_cfa_location structure. */
755
756 static void
757 def_cfa_1 (const char *label, dw_cfa_location *loc_p)
758 {
759 dw_cfi_ref cfi;
760 dw_cfa_location old_cfa, loc;
761
762 cfa = *loc_p;
763 loc = *loc_p;
764
765 if (cfa_store.reg == loc.reg && loc.indirect == 0)
766 cfa_store.offset = loc.offset;
767
768 loc.reg = DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (loc.reg);
769 lookup_cfa (&old_cfa);
770
771 /* If nothing changed, no need to issue any call frame instructions. */
772 if (cfa_equal_p (&loc, &old_cfa))
773 return;
774
775 cfi = new_cfi ();
776
777 if (loc.reg == old_cfa.reg && !loc.indirect)
778 {
779 /* Construct a "DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset <offset>" instruction, indicating
780 the CFA register did not change but the offset did. */
781 if (loc.offset < 0)
782 {
783 HOST_WIDE_INT f_offset = loc.offset / DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT;
784 gcc_assert (f_offset * DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT == loc.offset);
785
786 cfi->dw_cfi_opc = DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset_sf;
787 cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_offset = f_offset;
788 }
789 else
790 {
791 cfi->dw_cfi_opc = DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset;
792 cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_offset = loc.offset;
793 }
794 }
795
796 #ifndef MIPS_DEBUGGING_INFO /* SGI dbx thinks this means no offset. */
797 else if (loc.offset == old_cfa.offset
798 && old_cfa.reg != INVALID_REGNUM
799 && !loc.indirect)
800 {
801 /* Construct a "DW_CFA_def_cfa_register <register>" instruction,
802 indicating the CFA register has changed to <register> but the
803 offset has not changed. */
804 cfi->dw_cfi_opc = DW_CFA_def_cfa_register;
805 cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num = loc.reg;
806 }
807 #endif
808
809 else if (loc.indirect == 0)
810 {
811 /* Construct a "DW_CFA_def_cfa <register> <offset>" instruction,
812 indicating the CFA register has changed to <register> with
813 the specified offset. */
814 if (loc.offset < 0)
815 {
816 HOST_WIDE_INT f_offset = loc.offset / DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT;
817 gcc_assert (f_offset * DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT == loc.offset);
818
819 cfi->dw_cfi_opc = DW_CFA_def_cfa_sf;
820 cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num = loc.reg;
821 cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd2.dw_cfi_offset = f_offset;
822 }
823 else
824 {
825 cfi->dw_cfi_opc = DW_CFA_def_cfa;
826 cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num = loc.reg;
827 cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd2.dw_cfi_offset = loc.offset;
828 }
829 }
830 else
831 {
832 /* Construct a DW_CFA_def_cfa_expression instruction to
833 calculate the CFA using a full location expression since no
834 register-offset pair is available. */
835 struct dw_loc_descr_struct *loc_list;
836
837 cfi->dw_cfi_opc = DW_CFA_def_cfa_expression;
838 loc_list = build_cfa_loc (&loc, 0);
839 cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_loc = loc_list;
840 }
841
842 add_fde_cfi (label, cfi);
843 }
844
845 /* Add the CFI for saving a register. REG is the CFA column number.
846 LABEL is passed to add_fde_cfi.
847 If SREG is -1, the register is saved at OFFSET from the CFA;
848 otherwise it is saved in SREG. */
849
850 static void
851 reg_save (const char *label, unsigned int reg, unsigned int sreg, HOST_WIDE_INT offset)
852 {
853 dw_cfi_ref cfi = new_cfi ();
854
855 cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num = reg;
856
857 if (sreg == INVALID_REGNUM)
858 {
859 if (reg & ~0x3f)
860 /* The register number won't fit in 6 bits, so we have to use
861 the long form. */
862 cfi->dw_cfi_opc = DW_CFA_offset_extended;
863 else
864 cfi->dw_cfi_opc = DW_CFA_offset;
865
866 #ifdef ENABLE_CHECKING
867 {
868 /* If we get an offset that is not a multiple of
869 DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT, there is either a bug in the
870 definition of DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT, or a bug in the machine
871 description. */
872 HOST_WIDE_INT check_offset = offset / DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT;
873
874 gcc_assert (check_offset * DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT == offset);
875 }
876 #endif
877 offset /= DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT;
878 if (offset < 0)
879 cfi->dw_cfi_opc = DW_CFA_offset_extended_sf;
880
881 cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd2.dw_cfi_offset = offset;
882 }
883 else if (sreg == reg)
884 cfi->dw_cfi_opc = DW_CFA_same_value;
885 else
886 {
887 cfi->dw_cfi_opc = DW_CFA_register;
888 cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd2.dw_cfi_reg_num = sreg;
889 }
890
891 add_fde_cfi (label, cfi);
892 }
893
894 /* Add the CFI for saving a register window. LABEL is passed to reg_save.
895 This CFI tells the unwinder that it needs to restore the window registers
896 from the previous frame's window save area.
897
898 ??? Perhaps we should note in the CIE where windows are saved (instead of
899 assuming 0(cfa)) and what registers are in the window. */
900
901 void
902 dwarf2out_window_save (const char *label)
903 {
904 dw_cfi_ref cfi = new_cfi ();
905
906 cfi->dw_cfi_opc = DW_CFA_GNU_window_save;
907 add_fde_cfi (label, cfi);
908 }
909
910 /* Add a CFI to update the running total of the size of arguments
911 pushed onto the stack. */
912
913 void
914 dwarf2out_args_size (const char *label, HOST_WIDE_INT size)
915 {
916 dw_cfi_ref cfi;
917
918 if (size == old_args_size)
919 return;
920
921 old_args_size = size;
922
923 cfi = new_cfi ();
924 cfi->dw_cfi_opc = DW_CFA_GNU_args_size;
925 cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_offset = size;
926 add_fde_cfi (label, cfi);
927 }
928
929 /* Entry point for saving a register to the stack. REG is the GCC register
930 number. LABEL and OFFSET are passed to reg_save. */
931
932 void
933 dwarf2out_reg_save (const char *label, unsigned int reg, HOST_WIDE_INT offset)
934 {
935 reg_save (label, DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (reg), INVALID_REGNUM, offset);
936 }
937
938 /* Entry point for saving the return address in the stack.
939 LABEL and OFFSET are passed to reg_save. */
940
941 void
942 dwarf2out_return_save (const char *label, HOST_WIDE_INT offset)
943 {
944 reg_save (label, DWARF_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN, INVALID_REGNUM, offset);
945 }
946
947 /* Entry point for saving the return address in a register.
948 LABEL and SREG are passed to reg_save. */
949
950 void
951 dwarf2out_return_reg (const char *label, unsigned int sreg)
952 {
953 reg_save (label, DWARF_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN, DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (sreg), 0);
954 }
955
956 /* Record the initial position of the return address. RTL is
957 INCOMING_RETURN_ADDR_RTX. */
958
959 static void
960 initial_return_save (rtx rtl)
961 {
962 unsigned int reg = INVALID_REGNUM;
963 HOST_WIDE_INT offset = 0;
964
965 switch (GET_CODE (rtl))
966 {
967 case REG:
968 /* RA is in a register. */
969 reg = DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (REGNO (rtl));
970 break;
971
972 case MEM:
973 /* RA is on the stack. */
974 rtl = XEXP (rtl, 0);
975 switch (GET_CODE (rtl))
976 {
977 case REG:
978 gcc_assert (REGNO (rtl) == STACK_POINTER_REGNUM);
979 offset = 0;
980 break;
981
982 case PLUS:
983 gcc_assert (REGNO (XEXP (rtl, 0)) == STACK_POINTER_REGNUM);
984 offset = INTVAL (XEXP (rtl, 1));
985 break;
986
987 case MINUS:
988 gcc_assert (REGNO (XEXP (rtl, 0)) == STACK_POINTER_REGNUM);
989 offset = -INTVAL (XEXP (rtl, 1));
990 break;
991
992 default:
993 gcc_unreachable ();
994 }
995
996 break;
997
998 case PLUS:
999 /* The return address is at some offset from any value we can
1000 actually load. For instance, on the SPARC it is in %i7+8. Just
1001 ignore the offset for now; it doesn't matter for unwinding frames. */
1002 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (XEXP (rtl, 1)) == CONST_INT);
1003 initial_return_save (XEXP (rtl, 0));
1004 return;
1005
1006 default:
1007 gcc_unreachable ();
1008 }
1009
1010 if (reg != DWARF_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN)
1011 reg_save (NULL, DWARF_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN, reg, offset - cfa.offset);
1012 }
1013
1014 /* Given a SET, calculate the amount of stack adjustment it
1015 contains. */
1016
1017 static HOST_WIDE_INT
1018 stack_adjust_offset (rtx pattern)
1019 {
1020 rtx src = SET_SRC (pattern);
1021 rtx dest = SET_DEST (pattern);
1022 HOST_WIDE_INT offset = 0;
1023 enum rtx_code code;
1024
1025 if (dest == stack_pointer_rtx)
1026 {
1027 /* (set (reg sp) (plus (reg sp) (const_int))) */
1028 code = GET_CODE (src);
1029 if (! (code == PLUS || code == MINUS)
1030 || XEXP (src, 0) != stack_pointer_rtx
1031 || GET_CODE (XEXP (src, 1)) != CONST_INT)
1032 return 0;
1033
1034 offset = INTVAL (XEXP (src, 1));
1035 if (code == PLUS)
1036 offset = -offset;
1037 }
1038 else if (MEM_P (dest))
1039 {
1040 /* (set (mem (pre_dec (reg sp))) (foo)) */
1041 src = XEXP (dest, 0);
1042 code = GET_CODE (src);
1043
1044 switch (code)
1045 {
1046 case PRE_MODIFY:
1047 case POST_MODIFY:
1048 if (XEXP (src, 0) == stack_pointer_rtx)
1049 {
1050 rtx val = XEXP (XEXP (src, 1), 1);
1051 /* We handle only adjustments by constant amount. */
1052 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (XEXP (src, 1)) == PLUS
1053 && GET_CODE (val) == CONST_INT);
1054 offset = -INTVAL (val);
1055 break;
1056 }
1057 return 0;
1058
1059 case PRE_DEC:
1060 case POST_DEC:
1061 if (XEXP (src, 0) == stack_pointer_rtx)
1062 {
1063 offset = GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (dest));
1064 break;
1065 }
1066 return 0;
1067
1068 case PRE_INC:
1069 case POST_INC:
1070 if (XEXP (src, 0) == stack_pointer_rtx)
1071 {
1072 offset = -GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (dest));
1073 break;
1074 }
1075 return 0;
1076
1077 default:
1078 return 0;
1079 }
1080 }
1081 else
1082 return 0;
1083
1084 return offset;
1085 }
1086
1087 /* Check INSN to see if it looks like a push or a stack adjustment, and
1088 make a note of it if it does. EH uses this information to find out how
1089 much extra space it needs to pop off the stack. */
1090
1091 static void
1092 dwarf2out_stack_adjust (rtx insn, bool after_p)
1093 {
1094 HOST_WIDE_INT offset;
1095 const char *label;
1096 int i;
1097
1098 /* Don't handle epilogues at all. Certainly it would be wrong to do so
1099 with this function. Proper support would require all frame-related
1100 insns to be marked, and to be able to handle saving state around
1101 epilogues textually in the middle of the function. */
1102 if (prologue_epilogue_contains (insn) || sibcall_epilogue_contains (insn))
1103 return;
1104
1105 /* If only calls can throw, and we have a frame pointer,
1106 save up adjustments until we see the CALL_INSN. */
1107 if (!flag_asynchronous_unwind_tables && cfa.reg != STACK_POINTER_REGNUM)
1108 {
1109 if (CALL_P (insn) && !after_p)
1110 {
1111 /* Extract the size of the args from the CALL rtx itself. */
1112 insn = PATTERN (insn);
1113 if (GET_CODE (insn) == PARALLEL)
1114 insn = XVECEXP (insn, 0, 0);
1115 if (GET_CODE (insn) == SET)
1116 insn = SET_SRC (insn);
1117 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (insn) == CALL);
1118 dwarf2out_args_size ("", INTVAL (XEXP (insn, 1)));
1119 }
1120 return;
1121 }
1122
1123 if (CALL_P (insn) && !after_p)
1124 {
1125 if (!flag_asynchronous_unwind_tables)
1126 dwarf2out_args_size ("", args_size);
1127 return;
1128 }
1129 else if (BARRIER_P (insn))
1130 {
1131 /* When we see a BARRIER, we know to reset args_size to 0. Usually
1132 the compiler will have already emitted a stack adjustment, but
1133 doesn't bother for calls to noreturn functions. */
1134 #ifdef STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD
1135 offset = -args_size;
1136 #else
1137 offset = args_size;
1138 #endif
1139 }
1140 else if (GET_CODE (PATTERN (insn)) == SET)
1141 offset = stack_adjust_offset (PATTERN (insn));
1142 else if (GET_CODE (PATTERN (insn)) == PARALLEL
1143 || GET_CODE (PATTERN (insn)) == SEQUENCE)
1144 {
1145 /* There may be stack adjustments inside compound insns. Search
1146 for them. */
1147 for (offset = 0, i = XVECLEN (PATTERN (insn), 0) - 1; i >= 0; i--)
1148 if (GET_CODE (XVECEXP (PATTERN (insn), 0, i)) == SET)
1149 offset += stack_adjust_offset (XVECEXP (PATTERN (insn), 0, i));
1150 }
1151 else
1152 return;
1153
1154 if (offset == 0)
1155 return;
1156
1157 if (cfa.reg == STACK_POINTER_REGNUM)
1158 cfa.offset += offset;
1159
1160 #ifndef STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD
1161 offset = -offset;
1162 #endif
1163
1164 args_size += offset;
1165 if (args_size < 0)
1166 args_size = 0;
1167
1168 label = dwarf2out_cfi_label ();
1169 def_cfa_1 (label, &cfa);
1170 if (flag_asynchronous_unwind_tables)
1171 dwarf2out_args_size (label, args_size);
1172 }
1173
1174 #endif
1175
1176 /* We delay emitting a register save until either (a) we reach the end
1177 of the prologue or (b) the register is clobbered. This clusters
1178 register saves so that there are fewer pc advances. */
1179
1180 struct queued_reg_save GTY(())
1181 {
1182 struct queued_reg_save *next;
1183 rtx reg;
1184 HOST_WIDE_INT cfa_offset;
1185 rtx saved_reg;
1186 };
1187
1188 static GTY(()) struct queued_reg_save *queued_reg_saves;
1189
1190 /* The caller's ORIG_REG is saved in SAVED_IN_REG. */
1191 struct reg_saved_in_data GTY(()) {
1192 rtx orig_reg;
1193 rtx saved_in_reg;
1194 };
1195
1196 /* A list of registers saved in other registers.
1197 The list intentionally has a small maximum capacity of 4; if your
1198 port needs more than that, you might consider implementing a
1199 more efficient data structure. */
1200 static GTY(()) struct reg_saved_in_data regs_saved_in_regs[4];
1201 static GTY(()) size_t num_regs_saved_in_regs;
1202
1203 #if defined (DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO) || defined (DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO)
1204 static const char *last_reg_save_label;
1205
1206 /* Add an entry to QUEUED_REG_SAVES saying that REG is now saved at
1207 SREG, or if SREG is NULL then it is saved at OFFSET to the CFA. */
1208
1209 static void
1210 queue_reg_save (const char *label, rtx reg, rtx sreg, HOST_WIDE_INT offset)
1211 {
1212 struct queued_reg_save *q;
1213
1214 /* Duplicates waste space, but it's also necessary to remove them
1215 for correctness, since the queue gets output in reverse
1216 order. */
1217 for (q = queued_reg_saves; q != NULL; q = q->next)
1218 if (REGNO (q->reg) == REGNO (reg))
1219 break;
1220
1221 if (q == NULL)
1222 {
1223 q = ggc_alloc (sizeof (*q));
1224 q->next = queued_reg_saves;
1225 queued_reg_saves = q;
1226 }
1227
1228 q->reg = reg;
1229 q->cfa_offset = offset;
1230 q->saved_reg = sreg;
1231
1232 last_reg_save_label = label;
1233 }
1234
1235 /* Output all the entries in QUEUED_REG_SAVES. */
1236
1237 static void
1238 flush_queued_reg_saves (void)
1239 {
1240 struct queued_reg_save *q;
1241
1242 for (q = queued_reg_saves; q; q = q->next)
1243 {
1244 size_t i;
1245 unsigned int reg, sreg;
1246
1247 for (i = 0; i < num_regs_saved_in_regs; i++)
1248 if (REGNO (regs_saved_in_regs[i].orig_reg) == REGNO (q->reg))
1249 break;
1250 if (q->saved_reg && i == num_regs_saved_in_regs)
1251 {
1252 gcc_assert (i != ARRAY_SIZE (regs_saved_in_regs));
1253 num_regs_saved_in_regs++;
1254 }
1255 if (i != num_regs_saved_in_regs)
1256 {
1257 regs_saved_in_regs[i].orig_reg = q->reg;
1258 regs_saved_in_regs[i].saved_in_reg = q->saved_reg;
1259 }
1260
1261 reg = DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (REGNO (q->reg));
1262 if (q->saved_reg)
1263 sreg = DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (REGNO (q->saved_reg));
1264 else
1265 sreg = INVALID_REGNUM;
1266 reg_save (last_reg_save_label, reg, sreg, q->cfa_offset);
1267 }
1268
1269 queued_reg_saves = NULL;
1270 last_reg_save_label = NULL;
1271 }
1272
1273 /* Does INSN clobber any register which QUEUED_REG_SAVES lists a saved
1274 location for? Or, does it clobber a register which we've previously
1275 said that some other register is saved in, and for which we now
1276 have a new location for? */
1277
1278 static bool
1279 clobbers_queued_reg_save (rtx insn)
1280 {
1281 struct queued_reg_save *q;
1282
1283 for (q = queued_reg_saves; q; q = q->next)
1284 {
1285 size_t i;
1286 if (modified_in_p (q->reg, insn))
1287 return true;
1288 for (i = 0; i < num_regs_saved_in_regs; i++)
1289 if (REGNO (q->reg) == REGNO (regs_saved_in_regs[i].orig_reg)
1290 && modified_in_p (regs_saved_in_regs[i].saved_in_reg, insn))
1291 return true;
1292 }
1293
1294 return false;
1295 }
1296
1297 /* Entry point for saving the first register into the second. */
1298
1299 void
1300 dwarf2out_reg_save_reg (const char *label, rtx reg, rtx sreg)
1301 {
1302 size_t i;
1303 unsigned int regno, sregno;
1304
1305 for (i = 0; i < num_regs_saved_in_regs; i++)
1306 if (REGNO (regs_saved_in_regs[i].orig_reg) == REGNO (reg))
1307 break;
1308 if (i == num_regs_saved_in_regs)
1309 {
1310 gcc_assert (i != ARRAY_SIZE (regs_saved_in_regs));
1311 num_regs_saved_in_regs++;
1312 }
1313 regs_saved_in_regs[i].orig_reg = reg;
1314 regs_saved_in_regs[i].saved_in_reg = sreg;
1315
1316 regno = DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (REGNO (reg));
1317 sregno = DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (REGNO (sreg));
1318 reg_save (label, regno, sregno, 0);
1319 }
1320
1321 /* What register, if any, is currently saved in REG? */
1322
1323 static rtx
1324 reg_saved_in (rtx reg)
1325 {
1326 unsigned int regn = REGNO (reg);
1327 size_t i;
1328 struct queued_reg_save *q;
1329
1330 for (q = queued_reg_saves; q; q = q->next)
1331 if (q->saved_reg && regn == REGNO (q->saved_reg))
1332 return q->reg;
1333
1334 for (i = 0; i < num_regs_saved_in_regs; i++)
1335 if (regs_saved_in_regs[i].saved_in_reg
1336 && regn == REGNO (regs_saved_in_regs[i].saved_in_reg))
1337 return regs_saved_in_regs[i].orig_reg;
1338
1339 return NULL_RTX;
1340 }
1341
1342
1343 /* A temporary register holding an integral value used in adjusting SP
1344 or setting up the store_reg. The "offset" field holds the integer
1345 value, not an offset. */
1346 static dw_cfa_location cfa_temp;
1347
1348 /* Record call frame debugging information for an expression EXPR,
1349 which either sets SP or FP (adjusting how we calculate the frame
1350 address) or saves a register to the stack or another register.
1351 LABEL indicates the address of EXPR.
1352
1353 This function encodes a state machine mapping rtxes to actions on
1354 cfa, cfa_store, and cfa_temp.reg. We describe these rules so
1355 users need not read the source code.
1356
1357 The High-Level Picture
1358
1359 Changes in the register we use to calculate the CFA: Currently we
1360 assume that if you copy the CFA register into another register, we
1361 should take the other one as the new CFA register; this seems to
1362 work pretty well. If it's wrong for some target, it's simple
1363 enough not to set RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P on the insn in question.
1364
1365 Changes in the register we use for saving registers to the stack:
1366 This is usually SP, but not always. Again, we deduce that if you
1367 copy SP into another register (and SP is not the CFA register),
1368 then the new register is the one we will be using for register
1369 saves. This also seems to work.
1370
1371 Register saves: There's not much guesswork about this one; if
1372 RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P is set on an insn which modifies memory, it's a
1373 register save, and the register used to calculate the destination
1374 had better be the one we think we're using for this purpose.
1375 It's also assumed that a copy from a call-saved register to another
1376 register is saving that register if RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P is set on
1377 that instruction. If the copy is from a call-saved register to
1378 the *same* register, that means that the register is now the same
1379 value as in the caller.
1380
1381 Except: If the register being saved is the CFA register, and the
1382 offset is nonzero, we are saving the CFA, so we assume we have to
1383 use DW_CFA_def_cfa_expression. If the offset is 0, we assume that
1384 the intent is to save the value of SP from the previous frame.
1385
1386 In addition, if a register has previously been saved to a different
1387 register,
1388
1389 Invariants / Summaries of Rules
1390
1391 cfa current rule for calculating the CFA. It usually
1392 consists of a register and an offset.
1393 cfa_store register used by prologue code to save things to the stack
1394 cfa_store.offset is the offset from the value of
1395 cfa_store.reg to the actual CFA
1396 cfa_temp register holding an integral value. cfa_temp.offset
1397 stores the value, which will be used to adjust the
1398 stack pointer. cfa_temp is also used like cfa_store,
1399 to track stores to the stack via fp or a temp reg.
1400
1401 Rules 1- 4: Setting a register's value to cfa.reg or an expression
1402 with cfa.reg as the first operand changes the cfa.reg and its
1403 cfa.offset. Rule 1 and 4 also set cfa_temp.reg and
1404 cfa_temp.offset.
1405
1406 Rules 6- 9: Set a non-cfa.reg register value to a constant or an
1407 expression yielding a constant. This sets cfa_temp.reg
1408 and cfa_temp.offset.
1409
1410 Rule 5: Create a new register cfa_store used to save items to the
1411 stack.
1412
1413 Rules 10-14: Save a register to the stack. Define offset as the
1414 difference of the original location and cfa_store's
1415 location (or cfa_temp's location if cfa_temp is used).
1416
1417 The Rules
1418
1419 "{a,b}" indicates a choice of a xor b.
1420 "<reg>:cfa.reg" indicates that <reg> must equal cfa.reg.
1421
1422 Rule 1:
1423 (set <reg1> <reg2>:cfa.reg)
1424 effects: cfa.reg = <reg1>
1425 cfa.offset unchanged
1426 cfa_temp.reg = <reg1>
1427 cfa_temp.offset = cfa.offset
1428
1429 Rule 2:
1430 (set sp ({minus,plus,losum} {sp,fp}:cfa.reg
1431 {<const_int>,<reg>:cfa_temp.reg}))
1432 effects: cfa.reg = sp if fp used
1433 cfa.offset += {+/- <const_int>, cfa_temp.offset} if cfa.reg==sp
1434 cfa_store.offset += {+/- <const_int>, cfa_temp.offset}
1435 if cfa_store.reg==sp
1436
1437 Rule 3:
1438 (set fp ({minus,plus,losum} <reg>:cfa.reg <const_int>))
1439 effects: cfa.reg = fp
1440 cfa_offset += +/- <const_int>
1441
1442 Rule 4:
1443 (set <reg1> ({plus,losum} <reg2>:cfa.reg <const_int>))
1444 constraints: <reg1> != fp
1445 <reg1> != sp
1446 effects: cfa.reg = <reg1>
1447 cfa_temp.reg = <reg1>
1448 cfa_temp.offset = cfa.offset
1449
1450 Rule 5:
1451 (set <reg1> (plus <reg2>:cfa_temp.reg sp:cfa.reg))
1452 constraints: <reg1> != fp
1453 <reg1> != sp
1454 effects: cfa_store.reg = <reg1>
1455 cfa_store.offset = cfa.offset - cfa_temp.offset
1456
1457 Rule 6:
1458 (set <reg> <const_int>)
1459 effects: cfa_temp.reg = <reg>
1460 cfa_temp.offset = <const_int>
1461
1462 Rule 7:
1463 (set <reg1>:cfa_temp.reg (ior <reg2>:cfa_temp.reg <const_int>))
1464 effects: cfa_temp.reg = <reg1>
1465 cfa_temp.offset |= <const_int>
1466
1467 Rule 8:
1468 (set <reg> (high <exp>))
1469 effects: none
1470
1471 Rule 9:
1472 (set <reg> (lo_sum <exp> <const_int>))
1473 effects: cfa_temp.reg = <reg>
1474 cfa_temp.offset = <const_int>
1475
1476 Rule 10:
1477 (set (mem (pre_modify sp:cfa_store (???? <reg1> <const_int>))) <reg2>)
1478 effects: cfa_store.offset -= <const_int>
1479 cfa.offset = cfa_store.offset if cfa.reg == sp
1480 cfa.reg = sp
1481 cfa.base_offset = -cfa_store.offset
1482
1483 Rule 11:
1484 (set (mem ({pre_inc,pre_dec} sp:cfa_store.reg)) <reg>)
1485 effects: cfa_store.offset += -/+ mode_size(mem)
1486 cfa.offset = cfa_store.offset if cfa.reg == sp
1487 cfa.reg = sp
1488 cfa.base_offset = -cfa_store.offset
1489
1490 Rule 12:
1491 (set (mem ({minus,plus,losum} <reg1>:{cfa_store,cfa_temp} <const_int>))
1492
1493 <reg2>)
1494 effects: cfa.reg = <reg1>
1495 cfa.base_offset = -/+ <const_int> - {cfa_store,cfa_temp}.offset
1496
1497 Rule 13:
1498 (set (mem <reg1>:{cfa_store,cfa_temp}) <reg2>)
1499 effects: cfa.reg = <reg1>
1500 cfa.base_offset = -{cfa_store,cfa_temp}.offset
1501
1502 Rule 14:
1503 (set (mem (postinc <reg1>:cfa_temp <const_int>)) <reg2>)
1504 effects: cfa.reg = <reg1>
1505 cfa.base_offset = -cfa_temp.offset
1506 cfa_temp.offset -= mode_size(mem)
1507
1508 Rule 15:
1509 (set <reg> {unspec, unspec_volatile})
1510 effects: target-dependent */
1511
1512 static void
1513 dwarf2out_frame_debug_expr (rtx expr, const char *label)
1514 {
1515 rtx src, dest;
1516 HOST_WIDE_INT offset;
1517
1518 /* If RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P is set on a PARALLEL, process each member of
1519 the PARALLEL independently. The first element is always processed if
1520 it is a SET. This is for backward compatibility. Other elements
1521 are processed only if they are SETs and the RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P
1522 flag is set in them. */
1523 if (GET_CODE (expr) == PARALLEL || GET_CODE (expr) == SEQUENCE)
1524 {
1525 int par_index;
1526 int limit = XVECLEN (expr, 0);
1527 rtx elem;
1528
1529 /* PARALLELs have strict read-modify-write semantics, so we
1530 ought to evaluate every rvalue before changing any lvalue.
1531 It's cumbersome to do that in general, but there's an
1532 easy approximation that is enough for all current users:
1533 handle register saves before register assignments. */
1534 if (GET_CODE (expr) == PARALLEL)
1535 for (par_index = 0; par_index < limit; par_index++)
1536 {
1537 elem = XVECEXP (expr, 0, par_index);
1538 if (GET_CODE (elem) == SET
1539 && MEM_P (SET_DEST (elem))
1540 && (RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P (elem) || par_index == 0))
1541 dwarf2out_frame_debug_expr (elem, label);
1542 }
1543
1544 for (par_index = 0; par_index < limit; par_index++)
1545 {
1546 elem = XVECEXP (expr, 0, par_index);
1547 if (GET_CODE (elem) == SET
1548 && (!MEM_P (SET_DEST (elem)) || GET_CODE (expr) == SEQUENCE)
1549 && (RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P (elem) || par_index == 0))
1550 dwarf2out_frame_debug_expr (elem, label);
1551 }
1552 return;
1553 }
1554
1555 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (expr) == SET);
1556
1557 src = SET_SRC (expr);
1558 dest = SET_DEST (expr);
1559
1560 if (REG_P (src))
1561 {
1562 rtx rsi = reg_saved_in (src);
1563 if (rsi)
1564 src = rsi;
1565 }
1566
1567 switch (GET_CODE (dest))
1568 {
1569 case REG:
1570 switch (GET_CODE (src))
1571 {
1572 /* Setting FP from SP. */
1573 case REG:
1574 if (cfa.reg == (unsigned) REGNO (src))
1575 {
1576 /* Rule 1 */
1577 /* Update the CFA rule wrt SP or FP. Make sure src is
1578 relative to the current CFA register.
1579
1580 We used to require that dest be either SP or FP, but the
1581 ARM copies SP to a temporary register, and from there to
1582 FP. So we just rely on the backends to only set
1583 RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P on appropriate insns. */
1584 cfa.reg = REGNO (dest);
1585 cfa_temp.reg = cfa.reg;
1586 cfa_temp.offset = cfa.offset;
1587 }
1588 else
1589 {
1590 /* Saving a register in a register. */
1591 gcc_assert (!fixed_regs [REGNO (dest)]
1592 /* For the SPARC and its register window. */
1593 || (DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (REGNO (src))
1594 == DWARF_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN));
1595 queue_reg_save (label, src, dest, 0);
1596 }
1597 break;
1598
1599 case PLUS:
1600 case MINUS:
1601 case LO_SUM:
1602 if (dest == stack_pointer_rtx)
1603 {
1604 /* Rule 2 */
1605 /* Adjusting SP. */
1606 switch (GET_CODE (XEXP (src, 1)))
1607 {
1608 case CONST_INT:
1609 offset = INTVAL (XEXP (src, 1));
1610 break;
1611 case REG:
1612 gcc_assert ((unsigned) REGNO (XEXP (src, 1))
1613 == cfa_temp.reg);
1614 offset = cfa_temp.offset;
1615 break;
1616 default:
1617 gcc_unreachable ();
1618 }
1619
1620 if (XEXP (src, 0) == hard_frame_pointer_rtx)
1621 {
1622 /* Restoring SP from FP in the epilogue. */
1623 gcc_assert (cfa.reg == (unsigned) HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM);
1624 cfa.reg = STACK_POINTER_REGNUM;
1625 }
1626 else if (GET_CODE (src) == LO_SUM)
1627 /* Assume we've set the source reg of the LO_SUM from sp. */
1628 ;
1629 else
1630 gcc_assert (XEXP (src, 0) == stack_pointer_rtx);
1631
1632 if (GET_CODE (src) != MINUS)
1633 offset = -offset;
1634 if (cfa.reg == STACK_POINTER_REGNUM)
1635 cfa.offset += offset;
1636 if (cfa_store.reg == STACK_POINTER_REGNUM)
1637 cfa_store.offset += offset;
1638 }
1639 else if (dest == hard_frame_pointer_rtx)
1640 {
1641 /* Rule 3 */
1642 /* Either setting the FP from an offset of the SP,
1643 or adjusting the FP */
1644 gcc_assert (frame_pointer_needed);
1645
1646 gcc_assert (REG_P (XEXP (src, 0))
1647 && (unsigned) REGNO (XEXP (src, 0)) == cfa.reg
1648 && GET_CODE (XEXP (src, 1)) == CONST_INT);
1649 offset = INTVAL (XEXP (src, 1));
1650 if (GET_CODE (src) != MINUS)
1651 offset = -offset;
1652 cfa.offset += offset;
1653 cfa.reg = HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM;
1654 }
1655 else
1656 {
1657 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (src) != MINUS);
1658
1659 /* Rule 4 */
1660 if (REG_P (XEXP (src, 0))
1661 && REGNO (XEXP (src, 0)) == cfa.reg
1662 && GET_CODE (XEXP (src, 1)) == CONST_INT)
1663 {
1664 /* Setting a temporary CFA register that will be copied
1665 into the FP later on. */
1666 offset = - INTVAL (XEXP (src, 1));
1667 cfa.offset += offset;
1668 cfa.reg = REGNO (dest);
1669 /* Or used to save regs to the stack. */
1670 cfa_temp.reg = cfa.reg;
1671 cfa_temp.offset = cfa.offset;
1672 }
1673
1674 /* Rule 5 */
1675 else if (REG_P (XEXP (src, 0))
1676 && REGNO (XEXP (src, 0)) == cfa_temp.reg
1677 && XEXP (src, 1) == stack_pointer_rtx)
1678 {
1679 /* Setting a scratch register that we will use instead
1680 of SP for saving registers to the stack. */
1681 gcc_assert (cfa.reg == STACK_POINTER_REGNUM);
1682 cfa_store.reg = REGNO (dest);
1683 cfa_store.offset = cfa.offset - cfa_temp.offset;
1684 }
1685
1686 /* Rule 9 */
1687 else if (GET_CODE (src) == LO_SUM
1688 && GET_CODE (XEXP (src, 1)) == CONST_INT)
1689 {
1690 cfa_temp.reg = REGNO (dest);
1691 cfa_temp.offset = INTVAL (XEXP (src, 1));
1692 }
1693 else
1694 gcc_unreachable ();
1695 }
1696 break;
1697
1698 /* Rule 6 */
1699 case CONST_INT:
1700 cfa_temp.reg = REGNO (dest);
1701 cfa_temp.offset = INTVAL (src);
1702 break;
1703
1704 /* Rule 7 */
1705 case IOR:
1706 gcc_assert (REG_P (XEXP (src, 0))
1707 && (unsigned) REGNO (XEXP (src, 0)) == cfa_temp.reg
1708 && GET_CODE (XEXP (src, 1)) == CONST_INT);
1709
1710 if ((unsigned) REGNO (dest) != cfa_temp.reg)
1711 cfa_temp.reg = REGNO (dest);
1712 cfa_temp.offset |= INTVAL (XEXP (src, 1));
1713 break;
1714
1715 /* Skip over HIGH, assuming it will be followed by a LO_SUM,
1716 which will fill in all of the bits. */
1717 /* Rule 8 */
1718 case HIGH:
1719 break;
1720
1721 /* Rule 15 */
1722 case UNSPEC:
1723 case UNSPEC_VOLATILE:
1724 gcc_assert (targetm.dwarf_handle_frame_unspec);
1725 targetm.dwarf_handle_frame_unspec (label, expr, XINT (src, 1));
1726 return;
1727
1728 default:
1729 gcc_unreachable ();
1730 }
1731
1732 def_cfa_1 (label, &cfa);
1733 break;
1734
1735 case MEM:
1736 gcc_assert (REG_P (src));
1737
1738 /* Saving a register to the stack. Make sure dest is relative to the
1739 CFA register. */
1740 switch (GET_CODE (XEXP (dest, 0)))
1741 {
1742 /* Rule 10 */
1743 /* With a push. */
1744 case PRE_MODIFY:
1745 /* We can't handle variable size modifications. */
1746 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (XEXP (XEXP (XEXP (dest, 0), 1), 1))
1747 == CONST_INT);
1748 offset = -INTVAL (XEXP (XEXP (XEXP (dest, 0), 1), 1));
1749
1750 gcc_assert (REGNO (XEXP (XEXP (dest, 0), 0)) == STACK_POINTER_REGNUM
1751 && cfa_store.reg == STACK_POINTER_REGNUM);
1752
1753 cfa_store.offset += offset;
1754 if (cfa.reg == STACK_POINTER_REGNUM)
1755 cfa.offset = cfa_store.offset;
1756
1757 offset = -cfa_store.offset;
1758 break;
1759
1760 /* Rule 11 */
1761 case PRE_INC:
1762 case PRE_DEC:
1763 offset = GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (dest));
1764 if (GET_CODE (XEXP (dest, 0)) == PRE_INC)
1765 offset = -offset;
1766
1767 gcc_assert (REGNO (XEXP (XEXP (dest, 0), 0)) == STACK_POINTER_REGNUM
1768 && cfa_store.reg == STACK_POINTER_REGNUM);
1769
1770 cfa_store.offset += offset;
1771 if (cfa.reg == STACK_POINTER_REGNUM)
1772 cfa.offset = cfa_store.offset;
1773
1774 offset = -cfa_store.offset;
1775 break;
1776
1777 /* Rule 12 */
1778 /* With an offset. */
1779 case PLUS:
1780 case MINUS:
1781 case LO_SUM:
1782 {
1783 int regno;
1784
1785 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (XEXP (XEXP (dest, 0), 1)) == CONST_INT
1786 && REG_P (XEXP (XEXP (dest, 0), 0)));
1787 offset = INTVAL (XEXP (XEXP (dest, 0), 1));
1788 if (GET_CODE (XEXP (dest, 0)) == MINUS)
1789 offset = -offset;
1790
1791 regno = REGNO (XEXP (XEXP (dest, 0), 0));
1792
1793 if (cfa_store.reg == (unsigned) regno)
1794 offset -= cfa_store.offset;
1795 else
1796 {
1797 gcc_assert (cfa_temp.reg == (unsigned) regno);
1798 offset -= cfa_temp.offset;
1799 }
1800 }
1801 break;
1802
1803 /* Rule 13 */
1804 /* Without an offset. */
1805 case REG:
1806 {
1807 int regno = REGNO (XEXP (dest, 0));
1808
1809 if (cfa_store.reg == (unsigned) regno)
1810 offset = -cfa_store.offset;
1811 else
1812 {
1813 gcc_assert (cfa_temp.reg == (unsigned) regno);
1814 offset = -cfa_temp.offset;
1815 }
1816 }
1817 break;
1818
1819 /* Rule 14 */
1820 case POST_INC:
1821 gcc_assert (cfa_temp.reg
1822 == (unsigned) REGNO (XEXP (XEXP (dest, 0), 0)));
1823 offset = -cfa_temp.offset;
1824 cfa_temp.offset -= GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (dest));
1825 break;
1826
1827 default:
1828 gcc_unreachable ();
1829 }
1830
1831 if (REGNO (src) != STACK_POINTER_REGNUM
1832 && REGNO (src) != HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
1833 && (unsigned) REGNO (src) == cfa.reg)
1834 {
1835 /* We're storing the current CFA reg into the stack. */
1836
1837 if (cfa.offset == 0)
1838 {
1839 /* If the source register is exactly the CFA, assume
1840 we're saving SP like any other register; this happens
1841 on the ARM. */
1842 def_cfa_1 (label, &cfa);
1843 queue_reg_save (label, stack_pointer_rtx, NULL_RTX, offset);
1844 break;
1845 }
1846 else
1847 {
1848 /* Otherwise, we'll need to look in the stack to
1849 calculate the CFA. */
1850 rtx x = XEXP (dest, 0);
1851
1852 if (!REG_P (x))
1853 x = XEXP (x, 0);
1854 gcc_assert (REG_P (x));
1855
1856 cfa.reg = REGNO (x);
1857 cfa.base_offset = offset;
1858 cfa.indirect = 1;
1859 def_cfa_1 (label, &cfa);
1860 break;
1861 }
1862 }
1863
1864 def_cfa_1 (label, &cfa);
1865 queue_reg_save (label, src, NULL_RTX, offset);
1866 break;
1867
1868 default:
1869 gcc_unreachable ();
1870 }
1871 }
1872
1873 /* Record call frame debugging information for INSN, which either
1874 sets SP or FP (adjusting how we calculate the frame address) or saves a
1875 register to the stack. If INSN is NULL_RTX, initialize our state.
1876
1877 If AFTER_P is false, we're being called before the insn is emitted,
1878 otherwise after. Call instructions get invoked twice. */
1879
1880 void
1881 dwarf2out_frame_debug (rtx insn, bool after_p)
1882 {
1883 const char *label;
1884 rtx src;
1885
1886 if (insn == NULL_RTX)
1887 {
1888 size_t i;
1889
1890 /* Flush any queued register saves. */
1891 flush_queued_reg_saves ();
1892
1893 /* Set up state for generating call frame debug info. */
1894 lookup_cfa (&cfa);
1895 gcc_assert (cfa.reg
1896 == (unsigned long)DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (STACK_POINTER_REGNUM));
1897
1898 cfa.reg = STACK_POINTER_REGNUM;
1899 cfa_store = cfa;
1900 cfa_temp.reg = -1;
1901 cfa_temp.offset = 0;
1902
1903 for (i = 0; i < num_regs_saved_in_regs; i++)
1904 {
1905 regs_saved_in_regs[i].orig_reg = NULL_RTX;
1906 regs_saved_in_regs[i].saved_in_reg = NULL_RTX;
1907 }
1908 num_regs_saved_in_regs = 0;
1909 return;
1910 }
1911
1912 if (!NONJUMP_INSN_P (insn) || clobbers_queued_reg_save (insn))
1913 flush_queued_reg_saves ();
1914
1915 if (! RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P (insn))
1916 {
1917 if (!ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS)
1918 dwarf2out_stack_adjust (insn, after_p);
1919 return;
1920 }
1921
1922 label = dwarf2out_cfi_label ();
1923 src = find_reg_note (insn, REG_FRAME_RELATED_EXPR, NULL_RTX);
1924 if (src)
1925 insn = XEXP (src, 0);
1926 else
1927 insn = PATTERN (insn);
1928
1929 dwarf2out_frame_debug_expr (insn, label);
1930 }
1931
1932 #endif
1933
1934 /* Describe for the GTY machinery what parts of dw_cfi_oprnd1 are used. */
1935 static enum dw_cfi_oprnd_type dw_cfi_oprnd1_desc
1936 (enum dwarf_call_frame_info cfi);
1937
1938 static enum dw_cfi_oprnd_type
1939 dw_cfi_oprnd1_desc (enum dwarf_call_frame_info cfi)
1940 {
1941 switch (cfi)
1942 {
1943 case DW_CFA_nop:
1944 case DW_CFA_GNU_window_save:
1945 return dw_cfi_oprnd_unused;
1946
1947 case DW_CFA_set_loc:
1948 case DW_CFA_advance_loc1:
1949 case DW_CFA_advance_loc2:
1950 case DW_CFA_advance_loc4:
1951 case DW_CFA_MIPS_advance_loc8:
1952 return dw_cfi_oprnd_addr;
1953
1954 case DW_CFA_offset:
1955 case DW_CFA_offset_extended:
1956 case DW_CFA_def_cfa:
1957 case DW_CFA_offset_extended_sf:
1958 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_sf:
1959 case DW_CFA_restore_extended:
1960 case DW_CFA_undefined:
1961 case DW_CFA_same_value:
1962 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_register:
1963 case DW_CFA_register:
1964 return dw_cfi_oprnd_reg_num;
1965
1966 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset:
1967 case DW_CFA_GNU_args_size:
1968 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset_sf:
1969 return dw_cfi_oprnd_offset;
1970
1971 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_expression:
1972 case DW_CFA_expression:
1973 return dw_cfi_oprnd_loc;
1974
1975 default:
1976 gcc_unreachable ();
1977 }
1978 }
1979
1980 /* Describe for the GTY machinery what parts of dw_cfi_oprnd2 are used. */
1981 static enum dw_cfi_oprnd_type dw_cfi_oprnd2_desc
1982 (enum dwarf_call_frame_info cfi);
1983
1984 static enum dw_cfi_oprnd_type
1985 dw_cfi_oprnd2_desc (enum dwarf_call_frame_info cfi)
1986 {
1987 switch (cfi)
1988 {
1989 case DW_CFA_def_cfa:
1990 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_sf:
1991 case DW_CFA_offset:
1992 case DW_CFA_offset_extended_sf:
1993 case DW_CFA_offset_extended:
1994 return dw_cfi_oprnd_offset;
1995
1996 case DW_CFA_register:
1997 return dw_cfi_oprnd_reg_num;
1998
1999 default:
2000 return dw_cfi_oprnd_unused;
2001 }
2002 }
2003
2004 #if defined (DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO) || defined (DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO)
2005
2006 /* Switch to eh_frame_section. If we don't have an eh_frame_section,
2007 switch to the data section instead, and write out a synthetic label
2008 for collect2. */
2009
2010 static void
2011 switch_to_eh_frame_section (void)
2012 {
2013 tree label;
2014
2015 #ifdef EH_FRAME_SECTION_NAME
2016 if (eh_frame_section == 0)
2017 {
2018 int flags;
2019
2020 if (EH_TABLES_CAN_BE_READ_ONLY)
2021 {
2022 int fde_encoding;
2023 int per_encoding;
2024 int lsda_encoding;
2025
2026 fde_encoding = ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT (/*code=*/1,
2027 /*global=*/0);
2028 per_encoding = ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT (/*code=*/2,
2029 /*global=*/1);
2030 lsda_encoding = ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT (/*code=*/0,
2031 /*global=*/0);
2032 flags = ((! flag_pic
2033 || ((fde_encoding & 0x70) != DW_EH_PE_absptr
2034 && (fde_encoding & 0x70) != DW_EH_PE_aligned
2035 && (per_encoding & 0x70) != DW_EH_PE_absptr
2036 && (per_encoding & 0x70) != DW_EH_PE_aligned
2037 && (lsda_encoding & 0x70) != DW_EH_PE_absptr
2038 && (lsda_encoding & 0x70) != DW_EH_PE_aligned))
2039 ? 0 : SECTION_WRITE);
2040 }
2041 else
2042 flags = SECTION_WRITE;
2043 eh_frame_section = get_section (EH_FRAME_SECTION_NAME, flags, NULL);
2044 }
2045 #endif
2046
2047 if (eh_frame_section)
2048 switch_to_section (eh_frame_section);
2049 else
2050 {
2051 /* We have no special eh_frame section. Put the information in
2052 the data section and emit special labels to guide collect2. */
2053 switch_to_section (data_section);
2054 label = get_file_function_name ("F");
2055 ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGN (asm_out_file, floor_log2 (PTR_SIZE));
2056 targetm.asm_out.globalize_label (asm_out_file,
2057 IDENTIFIER_POINTER (label));
2058 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, IDENTIFIER_POINTER (label));
2059 }
2060 }
2061
2062 /* Output a Call Frame Information opcode and its operand(s). */
2063
2064 static void
2065 output_cfi (dw_cfi_ref cfi, dw_fde_ref fde, int for_eh)
2066 {
2067 unsigned long r;
2068 if (cfi->dw_cfi_opc == DW_CFA_advance_loc)
2069 dw2_asm_output_data (1, (cfi->dw_cfi_opc
2070 | (cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_offset & 0x3f)),
2071 "DW_CFA_advance_loc " HOST_WIDE_INT_PRINT_HEX,
2072 cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_offset);
2073 else if (cfi->dw_cfi_opc == DW_CFA_offset)
2074 {
2075 r = DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num, for_eh);
2076 dw2_asm_output_data (1, (cfi->dw_cfi_opc | (r & 0x3f)),
2077 "DW_CFA_offset, column 0x%lx", r);
2078 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd2.dw_cfi_offset, NULL);
2079 }
2080 else if (cfi->dw_cfi_opc == DW_CFA_restore)
2081 {
2082 r = DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num, for_eh);
2083 dw2_asm_output_data (1, (cfi->dw_cfi_opc | (r & 0x3f)),
2084 "DW_CFA_restore, column 0x%lx", r);
2085 }
2086 else
2087 {
2088 dw2_asm_output_data (1, cfi->dw_cfi_opc,
2089 "%s", dwarf_cfi_name (cfi->dw_cfi_opc));
2090
2091 switch (cfi->dw_cfi_opc)
2092 {
2093 case DW_CFA_set_loc:
2094 if (for_eh)
2095 dw2_asm_output_encoded_addr_rtx (
2096 ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT (/*code=*/1, /*global=*/0),
2097 gen_rtx_SYMBOL_REF (Pmode, cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_addr),
2098 false, NULL);
2099 else
2100 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE,
2101 cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_addr, NULL);
2102 fde->dw_fde_current_label = cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_addr;
2103 break;
2104
2105 case DW_CFA_advance_loc1:
2106 dw2_asm_output_delta (1, cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_addr,
2107 fde->dw_fde_current_label, NULL);
2108 fde->dw_fde_current_label = cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_addr;
2109 break;
2110
2111 case DW_CFA_advance_loc2:
2112 dw2_asm_output_delta (2, cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_addr,
2113 fde->dw_fde_current_label, NULL);
2114 fde->dw_fde_current_label = cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_addr;
2115 break;
2116
2117 case DW_CFA_advance_loc4:
2118 dw2_asm_output_delta (4, cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_addr,
2119 fde->dw_fde_current_label, NULL);
2120 fde->dw_fde_current_label = cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_addr;
2121 break;
2122
2123 case DW_CFA_MIPS_advance_loc8:
2124 dw2_asm_output_delta (8, cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_addr,
2125 fde->dw_fde_current_label, NULL);
2126 fde->dw_fde_current_label = cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_addr;
2127 break;
2128
2129 case DW_CFA_offset_extended:
2130 case DW_CFA_def_cfa:
2131 r = DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num, for_eh);
2132 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (r, NULL);
2133 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd2.dw_cfi_offset, NULL);
2134 break;
2135
2136 case DW_CFA_offset_extended_sf:
2137 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_sf:
2138 r = DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num, for_eh);
2139 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (r, NULL);
2140 dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128 (cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd2.dw_cfi_offset, NULL);
2141 break;
2142
2143 case DW_CFA_restore_extended:
2144 case DW_CFA_undefined:
2145 case DW_CFA_same_value:
2146 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_register:
2147 r = DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num, for_eh);
2148 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (r, NULL);
2149 break;
2150
2151 case DW_CFA_register:
2152 r = DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num, for_eh);
2153 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (r, NULL);
2154 r = DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd2.dw_cfi_reg_num, for_eh);
2155 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (r, NULL);
2156 break;
2157
2158 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset:
2159 case DW_CFA_GNU_args_size:
2160 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_offset, NULL);
2161 break;
2162
2163 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset_sf:
2164 dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128 (cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_offset, NULL);
2165 break;
2166
2167 case DW_CFA_GNU_window_save:
2168 break;
2169
2170 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_expression:
2171 case DW_CFA_expression:
2172 output_cfa_loc (cfi);
2173 break;
2174
2175 case DW_CFA_GNU_negative_offset_extended:
2176 /* Obsoleted by DW_CFA_offset_extended_sf. */
2177 gcc_unreachable ();
2178
2179 default:
2180 break;
2181 }
2182 }
2183 }
2184
2185 /* Output the call frame information used to record information
2186 that relates to calculating the frame pointer, and records the
2187 location of saved registers. */
2188
2189 static void
2190 output_call_frame_info (int for_eh)
2191 {
2192 unsigned int i;
2193 dw_fde_ref fde;
2194 dw_cfi_ref cfi;
2195 char l1[20], l2[20], section_start_label[20];
2196 bool any_lsda_needed = false;
2197 char augmentation[6];
2198 int augmentation_size;
2199 int fde_encoding = DW_EH_PE_absptr;
2200 int per_encoding = DW_EH_PE_absptr;
2201 int lsda_encoding = DW_EH_PE_absptr;
2202 int return_reg;
2203
2204 /* Don't emit a CIE if there won't be any FDEs. */
2205 if (fde_table_in_use == 0)
2206 return;
2207
2208 /* If we make FDEs linkonce, we may have to emit an empty label for
2209 an FDE that wouldn't otherwise be emitted. We want to avoid
2210 having an FDE kept around when the function it refers to is
2211 discarded. Example where this matters: a primary function
2212 template in C++ requires EH information, but an explicit
2213 specialization doesn't. */
2214 if (TARGET_USES_WEAK_UNWIND_INFO
2215 && ! flag_asynchronous_unwind_tables
2216 && for_eh)
2217 for (i = 0; i < fde_table_in_use; i++)
2218 if ((fde_table[i].nothrow || fde_table[i].all_throwers_are_sibcalls)
2219 && !fde_table[i].uses_eh_lsda
2220 && ! DECL_WEAK (fde_table[i].decl))
2221 targetm.asm_out.unwind_label (asm_out_file, fde_table[i].decl,
2222 for_eh, /* empty */ 1);
2223
2224 /* If we don't have any functions we'll want to unwind out of, don't
2225 emit any EH unwind information. Note that if exceptions aren't
2226 enabled, we won't have collected nothrow information, and if we
2227 asked for asynchronous tables, we always want this info. */
2228 if (for_eh)
2229 {
2230 bool any_eh_needed = !flag_exceptions || flag_asynchronous_unwind_tables;
2231
2232 for (i = 0; i < fde_table_in_use; i++)
2233 if (fde_table[i].uses_eh_lsda)
2234 any_eh_needed = any_lsda_needed = true;
2235 else if (TARGET_USES_WEAK_UNWIND_INFO && DECL_WEAK (fde_table[i].decl))
2236 any_eh_needed = true;
2237 else if (! fde_table[i].nothrow
2238 && ! fde_table[i].all_throwers_are_sibcalls)
2239 any_eh_needed = true;
2240
2241 if (! any_eh_needed)
2242 return;
2243 }
2244
2245 /* We're going to be generating comments, so turn on app. */
2246 if (flag_debug_asm)
2247 app_enable ();
2248
2249 if (for_eh)
2250 switch_to_eh_frame_section ();
2251 else
2252 {
2253 if (!debug_frame_section)
2254 debug_frame_section = get_section (DEBUG_FRAME_SECTION,
2255 SECTION_DEBUG, NULL);
2256 switch_to_section (debug_frame_section);
2257 }
2258
2259 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (section_start_label, FRAME_BEGIN_LABEL, for_eh);
2260 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, section_start_label);
2261
2262 /* Output the CIE. */
2263 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (l1, CIE_AFTER_SIZE_LABEL, for_eh);
2264 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (l2, CIE_END_LABEL, for_eh);
2265 if (DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE - DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE == 4 && !for_eh)
2266 dw2_asm_output_data (4, 0xffffffff,
2267 "Initial length escape value indicating 64-bit DWARF extension");
2268 dw2_asm_output_delta (for_eh ? 4 : DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, l2, l1,
2269 "Length of Common Information Entry");
2270 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, l1);
2271
2272 /* Now that the CIE pointer is PC-relative for EH,
2273 use 0 to identify the CIE. */
2274 dw2_asm_output_data ((for_eh ? 4 : DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE),
2275 (for_eh ? 0 : DWARF_CIE_ID),
2276 "CIE Identifier Tag");
2277
2278 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_CIE_VERSION, "CIE Version");
2279
2280 augmentation[0] = 0;
2281 augmentation_size = 0;
2282 if (for_eh)
2283 {
2284 char *p;
2285
2286 /* Augmentation:
2287 z Indicates that a uleb128 is present to size the
2288 augmentation section.
2289 L Indicates the encoding (and thus presence) of
2290 an LSDA pointer in the FDE augmentation.
2291 R Indicates a non-default pointer encoding for
2292 FDE code pointers.
2293 P Indicates the presence of an encoding + language
2294 personality routine in the CIE augmentation. */
2295
2296 fde_encoding = ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT (/*code=*/1, /*global=*/0);
2297 per_encoding = ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT (/*code=*/2, /*global=*/1);
2298 lsda_encoding = ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT (/*code=*/0, /*global=*/0);
2299
2300 p = augmentation + 1;
2301 if (eh_personality_libfunc)
2302 {
2303 *p++ = 'P';
2304 augmentation_size += 1 + size_of_encoded_value (per_encoding);
2305 }
2306 if (any_lsda_needed)
2307 {
2308 *p++ = 'L';
2309 augmentation_size += 1;
2310 }
2311 if (fde_encoding != DW_EH_PE_absptr)
2312 {
2313 *p++ = 'R';
2314 augmentation_size += 1;
2315 }
2316 if (p > augmentation + 1)
2317 {
2318 augmentation[0] = 'z';
2319 *p = '\0';
2320 }
2321
2322 /* Ug. Some platforms can't do unaligned dynamic relocations at all. */
2323 if (eh_personality_libfunc && per_encoding == DW_EH_PE_aligned)
2324 {
2325 int offset = ( 4 /* Length */
2326 + 4 /* CIE Id */
2327 + 1 /* CIE version */
2328 + strlen (augmentation) + 1 /* Augmentation */
2329 + size_of_uleb128 (1) /* Code alignment */
2330 + size_of_sleb128 (DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT)
2331 + 1 /* RA column */
2332 + 1 /* Augmentation size */
2333 + 1 /* Personality encoding */ );
2334 int pad = -offset & (PTR_SIZE - 1);
2335
2336 augmentation_size += pad;
2337
2338 /* Augmentations should be small, so there's scarce need to
2339 iterate for a solution. Die if we exceed one uleb128 byte. */
2340 gcc_assert (size_of_uleb128 (augmentation_size) == 1);
2341 }
2342 }
2343
2344 dw2_asm_output_nstring (augmentation, -1, "CIE Augmentation");
2345 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (1, "CIE Code Alignment Factor");
2346 dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128 (DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT,
2347 "CIE Data Alignment Factor");
2348
2349 return_reg = DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (DWARF_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN, for_eh);
2350 if (DW_CIE_VERSION == 1)
2351 dw2_asm_output_data (1, return_reg, "CIE RA Column");
2352 else
2353 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (return_reg, "CIE RA Column");
2354
2355 if (augmentation[0])
2356 {
2357 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (augmentation_size, "Augmentation size");
2358 if (eh_personality_libfunc)
2359 {
2360 dw2_asm_output_data (1, per_encoding, "Personality (%s)",
2361 eh_data_format_name (per_encoding));
2362 dw2_asm_output_encoded_addr_rtx (per_encoding,
2363 eh_personality_libfunc,
2364 true, NULL);
2365 }
2366
2367 if (any_lsda_needed)
2368 dw2_asm_output_data (1, lsda_encoding, "LSDA Encoding (%s)",
2369 eh_data_format_name (lsda_encoding));
2370
2371 if (fde_encoding != DW_EH_PE_absptr)
2372 dw2_asm_output_data (1, fde_encoding, "FDE Encoding (%s)",
2373 eh_data_format_name (fde_encoding));
2374 }
2375
2376 for (cfi = cie_cfi_head; cfi != NULL; cfi = cfi->dw_cfi_next)
2377 output_cfi (cfi, NULL, for_eh);
2378
2379 /* Pad the CIE out to an address sized boundary. */
2380 ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGN (asm_out_file,
2381 floor_log2 (for_eh ? PTR_SIZE : DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE));
2382 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, l2);
2383
2384 /* Loop through all of the FDE's. */
2385 for (i = 0; i < fde_table_in_use; i++)
2386 {
2387 fde = &fde_table[i];
2388
2389 /* Don't emit EH unwind info for leaf functions that don't need it. */
2390 if (for_eh && !flag_asynchronous_unwind_tables && flag_exceptions
2391 && (fde->nothrow || fde->all_throwers_are_sibcalls)
2392 && ! (TARGET_USES_WEAK_UNWIND_INFO && DECL_WEAK (fde_table[i].decl))
2393 && !fde->uses_eh_lsda)
2394 continue;
2395
2396 targetm.asm_out.unwind_label (asm_out_file, fde->decl, for_eh, /* empty */ 0);
2397 targetm.asm_out.internal_label (asm_out_file, FDE_LABEL, for_eh + i * 2);
2398 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (l1, FDE_AFTER_SIZE_LABEL, for_eh + i * 2);
2399 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (l2, FDE_END_LABEL, for_eh + i * 2);
2400 if (DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE - DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE == 4 && !for_eh)
2401 dw2_asm_output_data (4, 0xffffffff,
2402 "Initial length escape value indicating 64-bit DWARF extension");
2403 dw2_asm_output_delta (for_eh ? 4 : DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, l2, l1,
2404 "FDE Length");
2405 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, l1);
2406
2407 if (for_eh)
2408 dw2_asm_output_delta (4, l1, section_start_label, "FDE CIE offset");
2409 else
2410 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, section_start_label,
2411 debug_frame_section, "FDE CIE offset");
2412
2413 if (for_eh)
2414 {
2415 rtx sym_ref = gen_rtx_SYMBOL_REF (Pmode, fde->dw_fde_begin);
2416 SYMBOL_REF_FLAGS (sym_ref) |= SYMBOL_FLAG_LOCAL;
2417 dw2_asm_output_encoded_addr_rtx (fde_encoding,
2418 sym_ref,
2419 false,
2420 "FDE initial location");
2421 if (fde->dw_fde_switched_sections)
2422 {
2423 rtx sym_ref2 = gen_rtx_SYMBOL_REF (Pmode,
2424 fde->dw_fde_unlikely_section_label);
2425 rtx sym_ref3= gen_rtx_SYMBOL_REF (Pmode,
2426 fde->dw_fde_hot_section_label);
2427 SYMBOL_REF_FLAGS (sym_ref2) |= SYMBOL_FLAG_LOCAL;
2428 SYMBOL_REF_FLAGS (sym_ref3) |= SYMBOL_FLAG_LOCAL;
2429 dw2_asm_output_encoded_addr_rtx (fde_encoding, sym_ref3, false,
2430 "FDE initial location");
2431 dw2_asm_output_delta (size_of_encoded_value (fde_encoding),
2432 fde->dw_fde_hot_section_end_label,
2433 fde->dw_fde_hot_section_label,
2434 "FDE address range");
2435 dw2_asm_output_encoded_addr_rtx (fde_encoding, sym_ref2, false,
2436 "FDE initial location");
2437 dw2_asm_output_delta (size_of_encoded_value (fde_encoding),
2438 fde->dw_fde_unlikely_section_end_label,
2439 fde->dw_fde_unlikely_section_label,
2440 "FDE address range");
2441 }
2442 else
2443 dw2_asm_output_delta (size_of_encoded_value (fde_encoding),
2444 fde->dw_fde_end, fde->dw_fde_begin,
2445 "FDE address range");
2446 }
2447 else
2448 {
2449 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, fde->dw_fde_begin,
2450 "FDE initial location");
2451 if (fde->dw_fde_switched_sections)
2452 {
2453 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE,
2454 fde->dw_fde_hot_section_label,
2455 "FDE initial location");
2456 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE,
2457 fde->dw_fde_hot_section_end_label,
2458 fde->dw_fde_hot_section_label,
2459 "FDE address range");
2460 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE,
2461 fde->dw_fde_unlikely_section_label,
2462 "FDE initial location");
2463 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE,
2464 fde->dw_fde_unlikely_section_end_label,
2465 fde->dw_fde_unlikely_section_label,
2466 "FDE address range");
2467 }
2468 else
2469 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE,
2470 fde->dw_fde_end, fde->dw_fde_begin,
2471 "FDE address range");
2472 }
2473
2474 if (augmentation[0])
2475 {
2476 if (any_lsda_needed)
2477 {
2478 int size = size_of_encoded_value (lsda_encoding);
2479
2480 if (lsda_encoding == DW_EH_PE_aligned)
2481 {
2482 int offset = ( 4 /* Length */
2483 + 4 /* CIE offset */
2484 + 2 * size_of_encoded_value (fde_encoding)
2485 + 1 /* Augmentation size */ );
2486 int pad = -offset & (PTR_SIZE - 1);
2487
2488 size += pad;
2489 gcc_assert (size_of_uleb128 (size) == 1);
2490 }
2491
2492 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (size, "Augmentation size");
2493
2494 if (fde->uses_eh_lsda)
2495 {
2496 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (l1, "LLSDA",
2497 fde->funcdef_number);
2498 dw2_asm_output_encoded_addr_rtx (
2499 lsda_encoding, gen_rtx_SYMBOL_REF (Pmode, l1),
2500 false, "Language Specific Data Area");
2501 }
2502 else
2503 {
2504 if (lsda_encoding == DW_EH_PE_aligned)
2505 ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGN (asm_out_file, floor_log2 (PTR_SIZE));
2506 dw2_asm_output_data
2507 (size_of_encoded_value (lsda_encoding), 0,
2508 "Language Specific Data Area (none)");
2509 }
2510 }
2511 else
2512 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (0, "Augmentation size");
2513 }
2514
2515 /* Loop through the Call Frame Instructions associated with
2516 this FDE. */
2517 fde->dw_fde_current_label = fde->dw_fde_begin;
2518 for (cfi = fde->dw_fde_cfi; cfi != NULL; cfi = cfi->dw_cfi_next)
2519 output_cfi (cfi, fde, for_eh);
2520
2521 /* Pad the FDE out to an address sized boundary. */
2522 ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGN (asm_out_file,
2523 floor_log2 ((for_eh ? PTR_SIZE : DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)));
2524 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, l2);
2525 }
2526
2527 if (for_eh && targetm.terminate_dw2_eh_frame_info)
2528 dw2_asm_output_data (4, 0, "End of Table");
2529 #ifdef MIPS_DEBUGGING_INFO
2530 /* Work around Irix 6 assembler bug whereby labels at the end of a section
2531 get a value of 0. Putting .align 0 after the label fixes it. */
2532 ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGN (asm_out_file, 0);
2533 #endif
2534
2535 /* Turn off app to make assembly quicker. */
2536 if (flag_debug_asm)
2537 app_disable ();
2538 }
2539
2540 /* Output a marker (i.e. a label) for the beginning of a function, before
2541 the prologue. */
2542
2543 void
2544 dwarf2out_begin_prologue (unsigned int line ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
2545 const char *file ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
2546 {
2547 char label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
2548 char * dup_label;
2549 dw_fde_ref fde;
2550
2551 current_function_func_begin_label = NULL;
2552
2553 #ifdef TARGET_UNWIND_INFO
2554 /* ??? current_function_func_begin_label is also used by except.c
2555 for call-site information. We must emit this label if it might
2556 be used. */
2557 if ((! flag_exceptions || USING_SJLJ_EXCEPTIONS)
2558 && ! dwarf2out_do_frame ())
2559 return;
2560 #else
2561 if (! dwarf2out_do_frame ())
2562 return;
2563 #endif
2564
2565 switch_to_section (function_section (current_function_decl));
2566 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label, FUNC_BEGIN_LABEL,
2567 current_function_funcdef_no);
2568 ASM_OUTPUT_DEBUG_LABEL (asm_out_file, FUNC_BEGIN_LABEL,
2569 current_function_funcdef_no);
2570 dup_label = xstrdup (label);
2571 current_function_func_begin_label = dup_label;
2572
2573 #ifdef TARGET_UNWIND_INFO
2574 /* We can elide the fde allocation if we're not emitting debug info. */
2575 if (! dwarf2out_do_frame ())
2576 return;
2577 #endif
2578
2579 /* Expand the fde table if necessary. */
2580 if (fde_table_in_use == fde_table_allocated)
2581 {
2582 fde_table_allocated += FDE_TABLE_INCREMENT;
2583 fde_table = ggc_realloc (fde_table,
2584 fde_table_allocated * sizeof (dw_fde_node));
2585 memset (fde_table + fde_table_in_use, 0,
2586 FDE_TABLE_INCREMENT * sizeof (dw_fde_node));
2587 }
2588
2589 /* Record the FDE associated with this function. */
2590 current_funcdef_fde = fde_table_in_use;
2591
2592 /* Add the new FDE at the end of the fde_table. */
2593 fde = &fde_table[fde_table_in_use++];
2594 fde->decl = current_function_decl;
2595 fde->dw_fde_begin = dup_label;
2596 fde->dw_fde_current_label = dup_label;
2597 fde->dw_fde_hot_section_label = NULL;
2598 fde->dw_fde_hot_section_end_label = NULL;
2599 fde->dw_fde_unlikely_section_label = NULL;
2600 fde->dw_fde_unlikely_section_end_label = NULL;
2601 fde->dw_fde_switched_sections = false;
2602 fde->dw_fde_end = NULL;
2603 fde->dw_fde_cfi = NULL;
2604 fde->funcdef_number = current_function_funcdef_no;
2605 fde->nothrow = TREE_NOTHROW (current_function_decl);
2606 fde->uses_eh_lsda = cfun->uses_eh_lsda;
2607 fde->all_throwers_are_sibcalls = cfun->all_throwers_are_sibcalls;
2608
2609 args_size = old_args_size = 0;
2610
2611 /* We only want to output line number information for the genuine dwarf2
2612 prologue case, not the eh frame case. */
2613 #ifdef DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO
2614 if (file)
2615 dwarf2out_source_line (line, file);
2616 #endif
2617 }
2618
2619 /* Output a marker (i.e. a label) for the absolute end of the generated code
2620 for a function definition. This gets called *after* the epilogue code has
2621 been generated. */
2622
2623 void
2624 dwarf2out_end_epilogue (unsigned int line ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
2625 const char *file ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
2626 {
2627 dw_fde_ref fde;
2628 char label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
2629
2630 /* Output a label to mark the endpoint of the code generated for this
2631 function. */
2632 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label, FUNC_END_LABEL,
2633 current_function_funcdef_no);
2634 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, label);
2635 fde = &fde_table[fde_table_in_use - 1];
2636 fde->dw_fde_end = xstrdup (label);
2637 }
2638
2639 void
2640 dwarf2out_frame_init (void)
2641 {
2642 /* Allocate the initial hunk of the fde_table. */
2643 fde_table = ggc_alloc_cleared (FDE_TABLE_INCREMENT * sizeof (dw_fde_node));
2644 fde_table_allocated = FDE_TABLE_INCREMENT;
2645 fde_table_in_use = 0;
2646
2647 /* Generate the CFA instructions common to all FDE's. Do it now for the
2648 sake of lookup_cfa. */
2649
2650 /* On entry, the Canonical Frame Address is at SP. */
2651 dwarf2out_def_cfa (NULL, STACK_POINTER_REGNUM, INCOMING_FRAME_SP_OFFSET);
2652
2653 #ifdef DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO
2654 if (DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO)
2655 initial_return_save (INCOMING_RETURN_ADDR_RTX);
2656 #endif
2657 }
2658
2659 void
2660 dwarf2out_frame_finish (void)
2661 {
2662 /* Output call frame information. */
2663 if (DWARF2_FRAME_INFO)
2664 output_call_frame_info (0);
2665
2666 #ifndef TARGET_UNWIND_INFO
2667 /* Output another copy for the unwinder. */
2668 if (! USING_SJLJ_EXCEPTIONS && (flag_unwind_tables || flag_exceptions))
2669 output_call_frame_info (1);
2670 #endif
2671 }
2672 #endif
2673 \f
2674 /* And now, the subset of the debugging information support code necessary
2675 for emitting location expressions. */
2676
2677 /* Data about a single source file. */
2678 struct dwarf_file_data GTY(())
2679 {
2680 const char * filename;
2681 int emitted_number;
2682 };
2683
2684 /* We need some way to distinguish DW_OP_addr with a direct symbol
2685 relocation from DW_OP_addr with a dtp-relative symbol relocation. */
2686 #define INTERNAL_DW_OP_tls_addr (0x100 + DW_OP_addr)
2687
2688
2689 typedef struct dw_val_struct *dw_val_ref;
2690 typedef struct die_struct *dw_die_ref;
2691 typedef struct dw_loc_descr_struct *dw_loc_descr_ref;
2692 typedef struct dw_loc_list_struct *dw_loc_list_ref;
2693
2694 /* Each DIE may have a series of attribute/value pairs. Values
2695 can take on several forms. The forms that are used in this
2696 implementation are listed below. */
2697
2698 enum dw_val_class
2699 {
2700 dw_val_class_addr,
2701 dw_val_class_offset,
2702 dw_val_class_loc,
2703 dw_val_class_loc_list,
2704 dw_val_class_range_list,
2705 dw_val_class_const,
2706 dw_val_class_unsigned_const,
2707 dw_val_class_long_long,
2708 dw_val_class_vec,
2709 dw_val_class_flag,
2710 dw_val_class_die_ref,
2711 dw_val_class_fde_ref,
2712 dw_val_class_lbl_id,
2713 dw_val_class_lineptr,
2714 dw_val_class_str,
2715 dw_val_class_macptr,
2716 dw_val_class_file
2717 };
2718
2719 /* Describe a double word constant value. */
2720 /* ??? Every instance of long_long in the code really means CONST_DOUBLE. */
2721
2722 typedef struct dw_long_long_struct GTY(())
2723 {
2724 unsigned long hi;
2725 unsigned long low;
2726 }
2727 dw_long_long_const;
2728
2729 /* Describe a floating point constant value, or a vector constant value. */
2730
2731 typedef struct dw_vec_struct GTY(())
2732 {
2733 unsigned char * GTY((length ("%h.length"))) array;
2734 unsigned length;
2735 unsigned elt_size;
2736 }
2737 dw_vec_const;
2738
2739 /* The dw_val_node describes an attribute's value, as it is
2740 represented internally. */
2741
2742 typedef struct dw_val_struct GTY(())
2743 {
2744 enum dw_val_class val_class;
2745 union dw_val_struct_union
2746 {
2747 rtx GTY ((tag ("dw_val_class_addr"))) val_addr;
2748 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT GTY ((tag ("dw_val_class_offset"))) val_offset;
2749 dw_loc_list_ref GTY ((tag ("dw_val_class_loc_list"))) val_loc_list;
2750 dw_loc_descr_ref GTY ((tag ("dw_val_class_loc"))) val_loc;
2751 HOST_WIDE_INT GTY ((default)) val_int;
2752 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT GTY ((tag ("dw_val_class_unsigned_const"))) val_unsigned;
2753 dw_long_long_const GTY ((tag ("dw_val_class_long_long"))) val_long_long;
2754 dw_vec_const GTY ((tag ("dw_val_class_vec"))) val_vec;
2755 struct dw_val_die_union
2756 {
2757 dw_die_ref die;
2758 int external;
2759 } GTY ((tag ("dw_val_class_die_ref"))) val_die_ref;
2760 unsigned GTY ((tag ("dw_val_class_fde_ref"))) val_fde_index;
2761 struct indirect_string_node * GTY ((tag ("dw_val_class_str"))) val_str;
2762 char * GTY ((tag ("dw_val_class_lbl_id"))) val_lbl_id;
2763 unsigned char GTY ((tag ("dw_val_class_flag"))) val_flag;
2764 struct dwarf_file_data * GTY ((tag ("dw_val_class_file"))) val_file;
2765 }
2766 GTY ((desc ("%1.val_class"))) v;
2767 }
2768 dw_val_node;
2769
2770 /* Locations in memory are described using a sequence of stack machine
2771 operations. */
2772
2773 typedef struct dw_loc_descr_struct GTY(())
2774 {
2775 dw_loc_descr_ref dw_loc_next;
2776 enum dwarf_location_atom dw_loc_opc;
2777 dw_val_node dw_loc_oprnd1;
2778 dw_val_node dw_loc_oprnd2;
2779 int dw_loc_addr;
2780 }
2781 dw_loc_descr_node;
2782
2783 /* Location lists are ranges + location descriptions for that range,
2784 so you can track variables that are in different places over
2785 their entire life. */
2786 typedef struct dw_loc_list_struct GTY(())
2787 {
2788 dw_loc_list_ref dw_loc_next;
2789 const char *begin; /* Label for begin address of range */
2790 const char *end; /* Label for end address of range */
2791 char *ll_symbol; /* Label for beginning of location list.
2792 Only on head of list */
2793 const char *section; /* Section this loclist is relative to */
2794 dw_loc_descr_ref expr;
2795 } dw_loc_list_node;
2796
2797 #if defined (DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO) || defined (DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO)
2798
2799 static const char *dwarf_stack_op_name (unsigned);
2800 static dw_loc_descr_ref new_loc_descr (enum dwarf_location_atom,
2801 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT, unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT);
2802 static void add_loc_descr (dw_loc_descr_ref *, dw_loc_descr_ref);
2803 static unsigned long size_of_loc_descr (dw_loc_descr_ref);
2804 static unsigned long size_of_locs (dw_loc_descr_ref);
2805 static void output_loc_operands (dw_loc_descr_ref);
2806 static void output_loc_sequence (dw_loc_descr_ref);
2807
2808 /* Convert a DWARF stack opcode into its string name. */
2809
2810 static const char *
2811 dwarf_stack_op_name (unsigned int op)
2812 {
2813 switch (op)
2814 {
2815 case DW_OP_addr:
2816 case INTERNAL_DW_OP_tls_addr:
2817 return "DW_OP_addr";
2818 case DW_OP_deref:
2819 return "DW_OP_deref";
2820 case DW_OP_const1u:
2821 return "DW_OP_const1u";
2822 case DW_OP_const1s:
2823 return "DW_OP_const1s";
2824 case DW_OP_const2u:
2825 return "DW_OP_const2u";
2826 case DW_OP_const2s:
2827 return "DW_OP_const2s";
2828 case DW_OP_const4u:
2829 return "DW_OP_const4u";
2830 case DW_OP_const4s:
2831 return "DW_OP_const4s";
2832 case DW_OP_const8u:
2833 return "DW_OP_const8u";
2834 case DW_OP_const8s:
2835 return "DW_OP_const8s";
2836 case DW_OP_constu:
2837 return "DW_OP_constu";
2838 case DW_OP_consts:
2839 return "DW_OP_consts";
2840 case DW_OP_dup:
2841 return "DW_OP_dup";
2842 case DW_OP_drop:
2843 return "DW_OP_drop";
2844 case DW_OP_over:
2845 return "DW_OP_over";
2846 case DW_OP_pick:
2847 return "DW_OP_pick";
2848 case DW_OP_swap:
2849 return "DW_OP_swap";
2850 case DW_OP_rot:
2851 return "DW_OP_rot";
2852 case DW_OP_xderef:
2853 return "DW_OP_xderef";
2854 case DW_OP_abs:
2855 return "DW_OP_abs";
2856 case DW_OP_and:
2857 return "DW_OP_and";
2858 case DW_OP_div:
2859 return "DW_OP_div";
2860 case DW_OP_minus:
2861 return "DW_OP_minus";
2862 case DW_OP_mod:
2863 return "DW_OP_mod";
2864 case DW_OP_mul:
2865 return "DW_OP_mul";
2866 case DW_OP_neg:
2867 return "DW_OP_neg";
2868 case DW_OP_not:
2869 return "DW_OP_not";
2870 case DW_OP_or:
2871 return "DW_OP_or";
2872 case DW_OP_plus:
2873 return "DW_OP_plus";
2874 case DW_OP_plus_uconst:
2875 return "DW_OP_plus_uconst";
2876 case DW_OP_shl:
2877 return "DW_OP_shl";
2878 case DW_OP_shr:
2879 return "DW_OP_shr";
2880 case DW_OP_shra:
2881 return "DW_OP_shra";
2882 case DW_OP_xor:
2883 return "DW_OP_xor";
2884 case DW_OP_bra:
2885 return "DW_OP_bra";
2886 case DW_OP_eq:
2887 return "DW_OP_eq";
2888 case DW_OP_ge:
2889 return "DW_OP_ge";
2890 case DW_OP_gt:
2891 return "DW_OP_gt";
2892 case DW_OP_le:
2893 return "DW_OP_le";
2894 case DW_OP_lt:
2895 return "DW_OP_lt";
2896 case DW_OP_ne:
2897 return "DW_OP_ne";
2898 case DW_OP_skip:
2899 return "DW_OP_skip";
2900 case DW_OP_lit0:
2901 return "DW_OP_lit0";
2902 case DW_OP_lit1:
2903 return "DW_OP_lit1";
2904 case DW_OP_lit2:
2905 return "DW_OP_lit2";
2906 case DW_OP_lit3:
2907 return "DW_OP_lit3";
2908 case DW_OP_lit4:
2909 return "DW_OP_lit4";
2910 case DW_OP_lit5:
2911 return "DW_OP_lit5";
2912 case DW_OP_lit6:
2913 return "DW_OP_lit6";
2914 case DW_OP_lit7:
2915 return "DW_OP_lit7";
2916 case DW_OP_lit8:
2917 return "DW_OP_lit8";
2918 case DW_OP_lit9:
2919 return "DW_OP_lit9";
2920 case DW_OP_lit10:
2921 return "DW_OP_lit10";
2922 case DW_OP_lit11:
2923 return "DW_OP_lit11";
2924 case DW_OP_lit12:
2925 return "DW_OP_lit12";
2926 case DW_OP_lit13:
2927 return "DW_OP_lit13";
2928 case DW_OP_lit14:
2929 return "DW_OP_lit14";
2930 case DW_OP_lit15:
2931 return "DW_OP_lit15";
2932 case DW_OP_lit16:
2933 return "DW_OP_lit16";
2934 case DW_OP_lit17:
2935 return "DW_OP_lit17";
2936 case DW_OP_lit18:
2937 return "DW_OP_lit18";
2938 case DW_OP_lit19:
2939 return "DW_OP_lit19";
2940 case DW_OP_lit20:
2941 return "DW_OP_lit20";
2942 case DW_OP_lit21:
2943 return "DW_OP_lit21";
2944 case DW_OP_lit22:
2945 return "DW_OP_lit22";
2946 case DW_OP_lit23:
2947 return "DW_OP_lit23";
2948 case DW_OP_lit24:
2949 return "DW_OP_lit24";
2950 case DW_OP_lit25:
2951 return "DW_OP_lit25";
2952 case DW_OP_lit26:
2953 return "DW_OP_lit26";
2954 case DW_OP_lit27:
2955 return "DW_OP_lit27";
2956 case DW_OP_lit28:
2957 return "DW_OP_lit28";
2958 case DW_OP_lit29:
2959 return "DW_OP_lit29";
2960 case DW_OP_lit30:
2961 return "DW_OP_lit30";
2962 case DW_OP_lit31:
2963 return "DW_OP_lit31";
2964 case DW_OP_reg0:
2965 return "DW_OP_reg0";
2966 case DW_OP_reg1:
2967 return "DW_OP_reg1";
2968 case DW_OP_reg2:
2969 return "DW_OP_reg2";
2970 case DW_OP_reg3:
2971 return "DW_OP_reg3";
2972 case DW_OP_reg4:
2973 return "DW_OP_reg4";
2974 case DW_OP_reg5:
2975 return "DW_OP_reg5";
2976 case DW_OP_reg6:
2977 return "DW_OP_reg6";
2978 case DW_OP_reg7:
2979 return "DW_OP_reg7";
2980 case DW_OP_reg8:
2981 return "DW_OP_reg8";
2982 case DW_OP_reg9:
2983 return "DW_OP_reg9";
2984 case DW_OP_reg10:
2985 return "DW_OP_reg10";
2986 case DW_OP_reg11:
2987 return "DW_OP_reg11";
2988 case DW_OP_reg12:
2989 return "DW_OP_reg12";
2990 case DW_OP_reg13:
2991 return "DW_OP_reg13";
2992 case DW_OP_reg14:
2993 return "DW_OP_reg14";
2994 case DW_OP_reg15:
2995 return "DW_OP_reg15";
2996 case DW_OP_reg16:
2997 return "DW_OP_reg16";
2998 case DW_OP_reg17:
2999 return "DW_OP_reg17";
3000 case DW_OP_reg18:
3001 return "DW_OP_reg18";
3002 case DW_OP_reg19:
3003 return "DW_OP_reg19";
3004 case DW_OP_reg20:
3005 return "DW_OP_reg20";
3006 case DW_OP_reg21:
3007 return "DW_OP_reg21";
3008 case DW_OP_reg22:
3009 return "DW_OP_reg22";
3010 case DW_OP_reg23:
3011 return "DW_OP_reg23";
3012 case DW_OP_reg24:
3013 return "DW_OP_reg24";
3014 case DW_OP_reg25:
3015 return "DW_OP_reg25";
3016 case DW_OP_reg26:
3017 return "DW_OP_reg26";
3018 case DW_OP_reg27:
3019 return "DW_OP_reg27";
3020 case DW_OP_reg28:
3021 return "DW_OP_reg28";
3022 case DW_OP_reg29:
3023 return "DW_OP_reg29";
3024 case DW_OP_reg30:
3025 return "DW_OP_reg30";
3026 case DW_OP_reg31:
3027 return "DW_OP_reg31";
3028 case DW_OP_breg0:
3029 return "DW_OP_breg0";
3030 case DW_OP_breg1:
3031 return "DW_OP_breg1";
3032 case DW_OP_breg2:
3033 return "DW_OP_breg2";
3034 case DW_OP_breg3:
3035 return "DW_OP_breg3";
3036 case DW_OP_breg4:
3037 return "DW_OP_breg4";
3038 case DW_OP_breg5:
3039 return "DW_OP_breg5";
3040 case DW_OP_breg6:
3041 return "DW_OP_breg6";
3042 case DW_OP_breg7:
3043 return "DW_OP_breg7";
3044 case DW_OP_breg8:
3045 return "DW_OP_breg8";
3046 case DW_OP_breg9:
3047 return "DW_OP_breg9";
3048 case DW_OP_breg10:
3049 return "DW_OP_breg10";
3050 case DW_OP_breg11:
3051 return "DW_OP_breg11";
3052 case DW_OP_breg12:
3053 return "DW_OP_breg12";
3054 case DW_OP_breg13:
3055 return "DW_OP_breg13";
3056 case DW_OP_breg14:
3057 return "DW_OP_breg14";
3058 case DW_OP_breg15:
3059 return "DW_OP_breg15";
3060 case DW_OP_breg16:
3061 return "DW_OP_breg16";
3062 case DW_OP_breg17:
3063 return "DW_OP_breg17";
3064 case DW_OP_breg18:
3065 return "DW_OP_breg18";
3066 case DW_OP_breg19:
3067 return "DW_OP_breg19";
3068 case DW_OP_breg20:
3069 return "DW_OP_breg20";
3070 case DW_OP_breg21:
3071 return "DW_OP_breg21";
3072 case DW_OP_breg22:
3073 return "DW_OP_breg22";
3074 case DW_OP_breg23:
3075 return "DW_OP_breg23";
3076 case DW_OP_breg24:
3077 return "DW_OP_breg24";
3078 case DW_OP_breg25:
3079 return "DW_OP_breg25";
3080 case DW_OP_breg26:
3081 return "DW_OP_breg26";
3082 case DW_OP_breg27:
3083 return "DW_OP_breg27";
3084 case DW_OP_breg28:
3085 return "DW_OP_breg28";
3086 case DW_OP_breg29:
3087 return "DW_OP_breg29";
3088 case DW_OP_breg30:
3089 return "DW_OP_breg30";
3090 case DW_OP_breg31:
3091 return "DW_OP_breg31";
3092 case DW_OP_regx:
3093 return "DW_OP_regx";
3094 case DW_OP_fbreg:
3095 return "DW_OP_fbreg";
3096 case DW_OP_bregx:
3097 return "DW_OP_bregx";
3098 case DW_OP_piece:
3099 return "DW_OP_piece";
3100 case DW_OP_deref_size:
3101 return "DW_OP_deref_size";
3102 case DW_OP_xderef_size:
3103 return "DW_OP_xderef_size";
3104 case DW_OP_nop:
3105 return "DW_OP_nop";
3106 case DW_OP_push_object_address:
3107 return "DW_OP_push_object_address";
3108 case DW_OP_call2:
3109 return "DW_OP_call2";
3110 case DW_OP_call4:
3111 return "DW_OP_call4";
3112 case DW_OP_call_ref:
3113 return "DW_OP_call_ref";
3114 case DW_OP_GNU_push_tls_address:
3115 return "DW_OP_GNU_push_tls_address";
3116 default:
3117 return "OP_<unknown>";
3118 }
3119 }
3120
3121 /* Return a pointer to a newly allocated location description. Location
3122 descriptions are simple expression terms that can be strung
3123 together to form more complicated location (address) descriptions. */
3124
3125 static inline dw_loc_descr_ref
3126 new_loc_descr (enum dwarf_location_atom op, unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT oprnd1,
3127 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT oprnd2)
3128 {
3129 dw_loc_descr_ref descr = ggc_alloc_cleared (sizeof (dw_loc_descr_node));
3130
3131 descr->dw_loc_opc = op;
3132 descr->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_unsigned_const;
3133 descr->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned = oprnd1;
3134 descr->dw_loc_oprnd2.val_class = dw_val_class_unsigned_const;
3135 descr->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_unsigned = oprnd2;
3136
3137 return descr;
3138 }
3139
3140 /* Add a location description term to a location description expression. */
3141
3142 static inline void
3143 add_loc_descr (dw_loc_descr_ref *list_head, dw_loc_descr_ref descr)
3144 {
3145 dw_loc_descr_ref *d;
3146
3147 /* Find the end of the chain. */
3148 for (d = list_head; (*d) != NULL; d = &(*d)->dw_loc_next)
3149 ;
3150
3151 *d = descr;
3152 }
3153
3154 /* Return the size of a location descriptor. */
3155
3156 static unsigned long
3157 size_of_loc_descr (dw_loc_descr_ref loc)
3158 {
3159 unsigned long size = 1;
3160
3161 switch (loc->dw_loc_opc)
3162 {
3163 case DW_OP_addr:
3164 case INTERNAL_DW_OP_tls_addr:
3165 size += DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE;
3166 break;
3167 case DW_OP_const1u:
3168 case DW_OP_const1s:
3169 size += 1;
3170 break;
3171 case DW_OP_const2u:
3172 case DW_OP_const2s:
3173 size += 2;
3174 break;
3175 case DW_OP_const4u:
3176 case DW_OP_const4s:
3177 size += 4;
3178 break;
3179 case DW_OP_const8u:
3180 case DW_OP_const8s:
3181 size += 8;
3182 break;
3183 case DW_OP_constu:
3184 size += size_of_uleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned);
3185 break;
3186 case DW_OP_consts:
3187 size += size_of_sleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_int);
3188 break;
3189 case DW_OP_pick:
3190 size += 1;
3191 break;
3192 case DW_OP_plus_uconst:
3193 size += size_of_uleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned);
3194 break;
3195 case DW_OP_skip:
3196 case DW_OP_bra:
3197 size += 2;
3198 break;
3199 case DW_OP_breg0:
3200 case DW_OP_breg1:
3201 case DW_OP_breg2:
3202 case DW_OP_breg3:
3203 case DW_OP_breg4:
3204 case DW_OP_breg5:
3205 case DW_OP_breg6:
3206 case DW_OP_breg7:
3207 case DW_OP_breg8:
3208 case DW_OP_breg9:
3209 case DW_OP_breg10:
3210 case DW_OP_breg11:
3211 case DW_OP_breg12:
3212 case DW_OP_breg13:
3213 case DW_OP_breg14:
3214 case DW_OP_breg15:
3215 case DW_OP_breg16:
3216 case DW_OP_breg17:
3217 case DW_OP_breg18:
3218 case DW_OP_breg19:
3219 case DW_OP_breg20:
3220 case DW_OP_breg21:
3221 case DW_OP_breg22:
3222 case DW_OP_breg23:
3223 case DW_OP_breg24:
3224 case DW_OP_breg25:
3225 case DW_OP_breg26:
3226 case DW_OP_breg27:
3227 case DW_OP_breg28:
3228 case DW_OP_breg29:
3229 case DW_OP_breg30:
3230 case DW_OP_breg31:
3231 size += size_of_sleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_int);
3232 break;
3233 case DW_OP_regx:
3234 size += size_of_uleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned);
3235 break;
3236 case DW_OP_fbreg:
3237 size += size_of_sleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_int);
3238 break;
3239 case DW_OP_bregx:
3240 size += size_of_uleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned);
3241 size += size_of_sleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_int);
3242 break;
3243 case DW_OP_piece:
3244 size += size_of_uleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned);
3245 break;
3246 case DW_OP_deref_size:
3247 case DW_OP_xderef_size:
3248 size += 1;
3249 break;
3250 case DW_OP_call2:
3251 size += 2;
3252 break;
3253 case DW_OP_call4:
3254 size += 4;
3255 break;
3256 case DW_OP_call_ref:
3257 size += DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE;
3258 break;
3259 default:
3260 break;
3261 }
3262
3263 return size;
3264 }
3265
3266 /* Return the size of a series of location descriptors. */
3267
3268 static unsigned long
3269 size_of_locs (dw_loc_descr_ref loc)
3270 {
3271 dw_loc_descr_ref l;
3272 unsigned long size;
3273
3274 /* If there are no skip or bra opcodes, don't fill in the dw_loc_addr
3275 field, to avoid writing to a PCH file. */
3276 for (size = 0, l = loc; l != NULL; l = l->dw_loc_next)
3277 {
3278 if (l->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_skip || l->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_bra)
3279 break;
3280 size += size_of_loc_descr (l);
3281 }
3282 if (! l)
3283 return size;
3284
3285 for (size = 0, l = loc; l != NULL; l = l->dw_loc_next)
3286 {
3287 l->dw_loc_addr = size;
3288 size += size_of_loc_descr (l);
3289 }
3290
3291 return size;
3292 }
3293
3294 /* Output location description stack opcode's operands (if any). */
3295
3296 static void
3297 output_loc_operands (dw_loc_descr_ref loc)
3298 {
3299 dw_val_ref val1 = &loc->dw_loc_oprnd1;
3300 dw_val_ref val2 = &loc->dw_loc_oprnd2;
3301
3302 switch (loc->dw_loc_opc)
3303 {
3304 #ifdef DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO
3305 case DW_OP_addr:
3306 dw2_asm_output_addr_rtx (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, val1->v.val_addr, NULL);
3307 break;
3308 case DW_OP_const2u:
3309 case DW_OP_const2s:
3310 dw2_asm_output_data (2, val1->v.val_int, NULL);
3311 break;
3312 case DW_OP_const4u:
3313 case DW_OP_const4s:
3314 dw2_asm_output_data (4, val1->v.val_int, NULL);
3315 break;
3316 case DW_OP_const8u:
3317 case DW_OP_const8s:
3318 gcc_assert (HOST_BITS_PER_LONG >= 64);
3319 dw2_asm_output_data (8, val1->v.val_int, NULL);
3320 break;
3321 case DW_OP_skip:
3322 case DW_OP_bra:
3323 {
3324 int offset;
3325
3326 gcc_assert (val1->val_class == dw_val_class_loc);
3327 offset = val1->v.val_loc->dw_loc_addr - (loc->dw_loc_addr + 3);
3328
3329 dw2_asm_output_data (2, offset, NULL);
3330 }
3331 break;
3332 #else
3333 case DW_OP_addr:
3334 case DW_OP_const2u:
3335 case DW_OP_const2s:
3336 case DW_OP_const4u:
3337 case DW_OP_const4s:
3338 case DW_OP_const8u:
3339 case DW_OP_const8s:
3340 case DW_OP_skip:
3341 case DW_OP_bra:
3342 /* We currently don't make any attempt to make sure these are
3343 aligned properly like we do for the main unwind info, so
3344 don't support emitting things larger than a byte if we're
3345 only doing unwinding. */
3346 gcc_unreachable ();
3347 #endif
3348 case DW_OP_const1u:
3349 case DW_OP_const1s:
3350 dw2_asm_output_data (1, val1->v.val_int, NULL);
3351 break;
3352 case DW_OP_constu:
3353 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (val1->v.val_unsigned, NULL);
3354 break;
3355 case DW_OP_consts:
3356 dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128 (val1->v.val_int, NULL);
3357 break;
3358 case DW_OP_pick:
3359 dw2_asm_output_data (1, val1->v.val_int, NULL);
3360 break;
3361 case DW_OP_plus_uconst:
3362 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (val1->v.val_unsigned, NULL);
3363 break;
3364 case DW_OP_breg0:
3365 case DW_OP_breg1:
3366 case DW_OP_breg2:
3367 case DW_OP_breg3:
3368 case DW_OP_breg4:
3369 case DW_OP_breg5:
3370 case DW_OP_breg6:
3371 case DW_OP_breg7:
3372 case DW_OP_breg8:
3373 case DW_OP_breg9:
3374 case DW_OP_breg10:
3375 case DW_OP_breg11:
3376 case DW_OP_breg12:
3377 case DW_OP_breg13:
3378 case DW_OP_breg14:
3379 case DW_OP_breg15:
3380 case DW_OP_breg16:
3381 case DW_OP_breg17:
3382 case DW_OP_breg18:
3383 case DW_OP_breg19:
3384 case DW_OP_breg20:
3385 case DW_OP_breg21:
3386 case DW_OP_breg22:
3387 case DW_OP_breg23:
3388 case DW_OP_breg24:
3389 case DW_OP_breg25:
3390 case DW_OP_breg26:
3391 case DW_OP_breg27:
3392 case DW_OP_breg28:
3393 case DW_OP_breg29:
3394 case DW_OP_breg30:
3395 case DW_OP_breg31:
3396 dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128 (val1->v.val_int, NULL);
3397 break;
3398 case DW_OP_regx:
3399 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (val1->v.val_unsigned, NULL);
3400 break;
3401 case DW_OP_fbreg:
3402 dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128 (val1->v.val_int, NULL);
3403 break;
3404 case DW_OP_bregx:
3405 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (val1->v.val_unsigned, NULL);
3406 dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128 (val2->v.val_int, NULL);
3407 break;
3408 case DW_OP_piece:
3409 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (val1->v.val_unsigned, NULL);
3410 break;
3411 case DW_OP_deref_size:
3412 case DW_OP_xderef_size:
3413 dw2_asm_output_data (1, val1->v.val_int, NULL);
3414 break;
3415
3416 case INTERNAL_DW_OP_tls_addr:
3417 if (targetm.asm_out.output_dwarf_dtprel)
3418 {
3419 targetm.asm_out.output_dwarf_dtprel (asm_out_file,
3420 DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE,
3421 val1->v.val_addr);
3422 fputc ('\n', asm_out_file);
3423 }
3424 else
3425 gcc_unreachable ();
3426 break;
3427
3428 default:
3429 /* Other codes have no operands. */
3430 break;
3431 }
3432 }
3433
3434 /* Output a sequence of location operations. */
3435
3436 static void
3437 output_loc_sequence (dw_loc_descr_ref loc)
3438 {
3439 for (; loc != NULL; loc = loc->dw_loc_next)
3440 {
3441 /* Output the opcode. */
3442 dw2_asm_output_data (1, loc->dw_loc_opc,
3443 "%s", dwarf_stack_op_name (loc->dw_loc_opc));
3444
3445 /* Output the operand(s) (if any). */
3446 output_loc_operands (loc);
3447 }
3448 }
3449
3450 /* This routine will generate the correct assembly data for a location
3451 description based on a cfi entry with a complex address. */
3452
3453 static void
3454 output_cfa_loc (dw_cfi_ref cfi)
3455 {
3456 dw_loc_descr_ref loc;
3457 unsigned long size;
3458
3459 /* Output the size of the block. */
3460 loc = cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_loc;
3461 size = size_of_locs (loc);
3462 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (size, NULL);
3463
3464 /* Now output the operations themselves. */
3465 output_loc_sequence (loc);
3466 }
3467
3468 /* This function builds a dwarf location descriptor sequence from a
3469 dw_cfa_location, adding the given OFFSET to the result of the
3470 expression. */
3471
3472 static struct dw_loc_descr_struct *
3473 build_cfa_loc (dw_cfa_location *cfa, HOST_WIDE_INT offset)
3474 {
3475 struct dw_loc_descr_struct *head, *tmp;
3476
3477 offset += cfa->offset;
3478
3479 if (cfa->indirect)
3480 {
3481 if (cfa->base_offset)
3482 {
3483 if (cfa->reg <= 31)
3484 head = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_breg0 + cfa->reg, cfa->base_offset, 0);
3485 else
3486 head = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_bregx, cfa->reg, cfa->base_offset);
3487 }
3488 else if (cfa->reg <= 31)
3489 head = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_reg0 + cfa->reg, 0, 0);
3490 else
3491 head = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_regx, cfa->reg, 0);
3492
3493 head->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_const;
3494 tmp = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_deref, 0, 0);
3495 add_loc_descr (&head, tmp);
3496 if (offset != 0)
3497 {
3498 tmp = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus_uconst, offset, 0);
3499 add_loc_descr (&head, tmp);
3500 }
3501 }
3502 else
3503 {
3504 if (offset == 0)
3505 if (cfa->reg <= 31)
3506 head = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_reg0 + cfa->reg, 0, 0);
3507 else
3508 head = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_regx, cfa->reg, 0);
3509 else if (cfa->reg <= 31)
3510 head = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_breg0 + cfa->reg, offset, 0);
3511 else
3512 head = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_bregx, cfa->reg, offset);
3513 }
3514
3515 return head;
3516 }
3517
3518 /* This function fills in aa dw_cfa_location structure from a dwarf location
3519 descriptor sequence. */
3520
3521 static void
3522 get_cfa_from_loc_descr (dw_cfa_location *cfa, struct dw_loc_descr_struct *loc)
3523 {
3524 struct dw_loc_descr_struct *ptr;
3525 cfa->offset = 0;
3526 cfa->base_offset = 0;
3527 cfa->indirect = 0;
3528 cfa->reg = -1;
3529
3530 for (ptr = loc; ptr != NULL; ptr = ptr->dw_loc_next)
3531 {
3532 enum dwarf_location_atom op = ptr->dw_loc_opc;
3533
3534 switch (op)
3535 {
3536 case DW_OP_reg0:
3537 case DW_OP_reg1:
3538 case DW_OP_reg2:
3539 case DW_OP_reg3:
3540 case DW_OP_reg4:
3541 case DW_OP_reg5:
3542 case DW_OP_reg6:
3543 case DW_OP_reg7:
3544 case DW_OP_reg8:
3545 case DW_OP_reg9:
3546 case DW_OP_reg10:
3547 case DW_OP_reg11:
3548 case DW_OP_reg12:
3549 case DW_OP_reg13:
3550 case DW_OP_reg14:
3551 case DW_OP_reg15:
3552 case DW_OP_reg16:
3553 case DW_OP_reg17:
3554 case DW_OP_reg18:
3555 case DW_OP_reg19:
3556 case DW_OP_reg20:
3557 case DW_OP_reg21:
3558 case DW_OP_reg22:
3559 case DW_OP_reg23:
3560 case DW_OP_reg24:
3561 case DW_OP_reg25:
3562 case DW_OP_reg26:
3563 case DW_OP_reg27:
3564 case DW_OP_reg28:
3565 case DW_OP_reg29:
3566 case DW_OP_reg30:
3567 case DW_OP_reg31:
3568 cfa->reg = op - DW_OP_reg0;
3569 break;
3570 case DW_OP_regx:
3571 cfa->reg = ptr->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_int;
3572 break;
3573 case DW_OP_breg0:
3574 case DW_OP_breg1:
3575 case DW_OP_breg2:
3576 case DW_OP_breg3:
3577 case DW_OP_breg4:
3578 case DW_OP_breg5:
3579 case DW_OP_breg6:
3580 case DW_OP_breg7:
3581 case DW_OP_breg8:
3582 case DW_OP_breg9:
3583 case DW_OP_breg10:
3584 case DW_OP_breg11:
3585 case DW_OP_breg12:
3586 case DW_OP_breg13:
3587 case DW_OP_breg14:
3588 case DW_OP_breg15:
3589 case DW_OP_breg16:
3590 case DW_OP_breg17:
3591 case DW_OP_breg18:
3592 case DW_OP_breg19:
3593 case DW_OP_breg20:
3594 case DW_OP_breg21:
3595 case DW_OP_breg22:
3596 case DW_OP_breg23:
3597 case DW_OP_breg24:
3598 case DW_OP_breg25:
3599 case DW_OP_breg26:
3600 case DW_OP_breg27:
3601 case DW_OP_breg28:
3602 case DW_OP_breg29:
3603 case DW_OP_breg30:
3604 case DW_OP_breg31:
3605 cfa->reg = op - DW_OP_breg0;
3606 cfa->base_offset = ptr->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_int;
3607 break;
3608 case DW_OP_bregx:
3609 cfa->reg = ptr->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_int;
3610 cfa->base_offset = ptr->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_int;
3611 break;
3612 case DW_OP_deref:
3613 cfa->indirect = 1;
3614 break;
3615 case DW_OP_plus_uconst:
3616 cfa->offset = ptr->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned;
3617 break;
3618 default:
3619 internal_error ("DW_LOC_OP %s not implemented",
3620 dwarf_stack_op_name (ptr->dw_loc_opc));
3621 }
3622 }
3623 }
3624 #endif /* .debug_frame support */
3625 \f
3626 /* And now, the support for symbolic debugging information. */
3627 #ifdef DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO
3628
3629 /* .debug_str support. */
3630 static int output_indirect_string (void **, void *);
3631
3632 static void dwarf2out_init (const char *);
3633 static void dwarf2out_finish (const char *);
3634 static void dwarf2out_define (unsigned int, const char *);
3635 static void dwarf2out_undef (unsigned int, const char *);
3636 static void dwarf2out_start_source_file (unsigned, const char *);
3637 static void dwarf2out_end_source_file (unsigned);
3638 static void dwarf2out_begin_block (unsigned, unsigned);
3639 static void dwarf2out_end_block (unsigned, unsigned);
3640 static bool dwarf2out_ignore_block (tree);
3641 static void dwarf2out_global_decl (tree);
3642 static void dwarf2out_type_decl (tree, int);
3643 static void dwarf2out_imported_module_or_decl (tree, tree);
3644 static void dwarf2out_abstract_function (tree);
3645 static void dwarf2out_var_location (rtx);
3646 static void dwarf2out_begin_function (tree);
3647 static void dwarf2out_switch_text_section (void);
3648
3649 /* The debug hooks structure. */
3650
3651 const struct gcc_debug_hooks dwarf2_debug_hooks =
3652 {
3653 dwarf2out_init,
3654 dwarf2out_finish,
3655 dwarf2out_define,
3656 dwarf2out_undef,
3657 dwarf2out_start_source_file,
3658 dwarf2out_end_source_file,
3659 dwarf2out_begin_block,
3660 dwarf2out_end_block,
3661 dwarf2out_ignore_block,
3662 dwarf2out_source_line,
3663 dwarf2out_begin_prologue,
3664 debug_nothing_int_charstar, /* end_prologue */
3665 dwarf2out_end_epilogue,
3666 dwarf2out_begin_function,
3667 debug_nothing_int, /* end_function */
3668 dwarf2out_decl, /* function_decl */
3669 dwarf2out_global_decl,
3670 dwarf2out_type_decl, /* type_decl */
3671 dwarf2out_imported_module_or_decl,
3672 debug_nothing_tree, /* deferred_inline_function */
3673 /* The DWARF 2 backend tries to reduce debugging bloat by not
3674 emitting the abstract description of inline functions until
3675 something tries to reference them. */
3676 dwarf2out_abstract_function, /* outlining_inline_function */
3677 debug_nothing_rtx, /* label */
3678 debug_nothing_int, /* handle_pch */
3679 dwarf2out_var_location,
3680 dwarf2out_switch_text_section,
3681 1 /* start_end_main_source_file */
3682 };
3683 #endif
3684 \f
3685 /* NOTE: In the comments in this file, many references are made to
3686 "Debugging Information Entries". This term is abbreviated as `DIE'
3687 throughout the remainder of this file. */
3688
3689 /* An internal representation of the DWARF output is built, and then
3690 walked to generate the DWARF debugging info. The walk of the internal
3691 representation is done after the entire program has been compiled.
3692 The types below are used to describe the internal representation. */
3693
3694 /* Various DIE's use offsets relative to the beginning of the
3695 .debug_info section to refer to each other. */
3696
3697 typedef long int dw_offset;
3698
3699 /* Define typedefs here to avoid circular dependencies. */
3700
3701 typedef struct dw_attr_struct *dw_attr_ref;
3702 typedef struct dw_line_info_struct *dw_line_info_ref;
3703 typedef struct dw_separate_line_info_struct *dw_separate_line_info_ref;
3704 typedef struct pubname_struct *pubname_ref;
3705 typedef struct dw_ranges_struct *dw_ranges_ref;
3706
3707 /* Each entry in the line_info_table maintains the file and
3708 line number associated with the label generated for that
3709 entry. The label gives the PC value associated with
3710 the line number entry. */
3711
3712 typedef struct dw_line_info_struct GTY(())
3713 {
3714 unsigned long dw_file_num;
3715 unsigned long dw_line_num;
3716 }
3717 dw_line_info_entry;
3718
3719 /* Line information for functions in separate sections; each one gets its
3720 own sequence. */
3721 typedef struct dw_separate_line_info_struct GTY(())
3722 {
3723 unsigned long dw_file_num;
3724 unsigned long dw_line_num;
3725 unsigned long function;
3726 }
3727 dw_separate_line_info_entry;
3728
3729 /* Each DIE attribute has a field specifying the attribute kind,
3730 a link to the next attribute in the chain, and an attribute value.
3731 Attributes are typically linked below the DIE they modify. */
3732
3733 typedef struct dw_attr_struct GTY(())
3734 {
3735 enum dwarf_attribute dw_attr;
3736 dw_val_node dw_attr_val;
3737 }
3738 dw_attr_node;
3739
3740 DEF_VEC_O(dw_attr_node);
3741 DEF_VEC_ALLOC_O(dw_attr_node,gc);
3742
3743 /* The Debugging Information Entry (DIE) structure. DIEs form a tree.
3744 The children of each node form a circular list linked by
3745 die_sib. die_child points to the node *before* the "first" child node. */
3746
3747 typedef struct die_struct GTY(())
3748 {
3749 enum dwarf_tag die_tag;
3750 char *die_symbol;
3751 VEC(dw_attr_node,gc) * die_attr;
3752 dw_die_ref die_parent;
3753 dw_die_ref die_child;
3754 dw_die_ref die_sib;
3755 dw_die_ref die_definition; /* ref from a specification to its definition */
3756 dw_offset die_offset;
3757 unsigned long die_abbrev;
3758 int die_mark;
3759 /* Die is used and must not be pruned as unused. */
3760 int die_perennial_p;
3761 unsigned int decl_id;
3762 }
3763 die_node;
3764
3765 /* Evaluate 'expr' while 'c' is set to each child of DIE in order. */
3766 #define FOR_EACH_CHILD(die, c, expr) do { \
3767 c = die->die_child; \
3768 if (c) do { \
3769 c = c->die_sib; \
3770 expr; \
3771 } while (c != die->die_child); \
3772 } while (0)
3773
3774 /* The pubname structure */
3775
3776 typedef struct pubname_struct GTY(())
3777 {
3778 dw_die_ref die;
3779 const char *name;
3780 }
3781 pubname_entry;
3782
3783 DEF_VEC_O(pubname_entry);
3784 DEF_VEC_ALLOC_O(pubname_entry, gc);
3785
3786 struct dw_ranges_struct GTY(())
3787 {
3788 int block_num;
3789 };
3790
3791 /* The limbo die list structure. */
3792 typedef struct limbo_die_struct GTY(())
3793 {
3794 dw_die_ref die;
3795 tree created_for;
3796 struct limbo_die_struct *next;
3797 }
3798 limbo_die_node;
3799
3800 /* How to start an assembler comment. */
3801 #ifndef ASM_COMMENT_START
3802 #define ASM_COMMENT_START ";#"
3803 #endif
3804
3805 /* Define a macro which returns nonzero for a TYPE_DECL which was
3806 implicitly generated for a tagged type.
3807
3808 Note that unlike the gcc front end (which generates a NULL named
3809 TYPE_DECL node for each complete tagged type, each array type, and
3810 each function type node created) the g++ front end generates a
3811 _named_ TYPE_DECL node for each tagged type node created.
3812 These TYPE_DECLs have DECL_ARTIFICIAL set, so we know not to
3813 generate a DW_TAG_typedef DIE for them. */
3814
3815 #define TYPE_DECL_IS_STUB(decl) \
3816 (DECL_NAME (decl) == NULL_TREE \
3817 || (DECL_ARTIFICIAL (decl) \
3818 && is_tagged_type (TREE_TYPE (decl)) \
3819 && ((decl == TYPE_STUB_DECL (TREE_TYPE (decl))) \
3820 /* This is necessary for stub decls that \
3821 appear in nested inline functions. */ \
3822 || (DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN (decl) != NULL_TREE \
3823 && (decl_ultimate_origin (decl) \
3824 == TYPE_STUB_DECL (TREE_TYPE (decl)))))))
3825
3826 /* Information concerning the compilation unit's programming
3827 language, and compiler version. */
3828
3829 /* Fixed size portion of the DWARF compilation unit header. */
3830 #define DWARF_COMPILE_UNIT_HEADER_SIZE \
3831 (DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE + DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE + 3)
3832
3833 /* Fixed size portion of public names info. */
3834 #define DWARF_PUBNAMES_HEADER_SIZE (2 * DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE + 2)
3835
3836 /* Fixed size portion of the address range info. */
3837 #define DWARF_ARANGES_HEADER_SIZE \
3838 (DWARF_ROUND (DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE + DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE + 4, \
3839 DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE * 2) \
3840 - DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE)
3841
3842 /* Size of padding portion in the address range info. It must be
3843 aligned to twice the pointer size. */
3844 #define DWARF_ARANGES_PAD_SIZE \
3845 (DWARF_ROUND (DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE + DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE + 4, \
3846 DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE * 2) \
3847 - (DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE + DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE + 4))
3848
3849 /* Use assembler line directives if available. */
3850 #ifndef DWARF2_ASM_LINE_DEBUG_INFO
3851 #ifdef HAVE_AS_DWARF2_DEBUG_LINE
3852 #define DWARF2_ASM_LINE_DEBUG_INFO 1
3853 #else
3854 #define DWARF2_ASM_LINE_DEBUG_INFO 0
3855 #endif
3856 #endif
3857
3858 /* Minimum line offset in a special line info. opcode.
3859 This value was chosen to give a reasonable range of values. */
3860 #define DWARF_LINE_BASE -10
3861
3862 /* First special line opcode - leave room for the standard opcodes. */
3863 #define DWARF_LINE_OPCODE_BASE 10
3864
3865 /* Range of line offsets in a special line info. opcode. */
3866 #define DWARF_LINE_RANGE (254-DWARF_LINE_OPCODE_BASE+1)
3867
3868 /* Flag that indicates the initial value of the is_stmt_start flag.
3869 In the present implementation, we do not mark any lines as
3870 the beginning of a source statement, because that information
3871 is not made available by the GCC front-end. */
3872 #define DWARF_LINE_DEFAULT_IS_STMT_START 1
3873
3874 #ifdef DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO
3875 /* This location is used by calc_die_sizes() to keep track
3876 the offset of each DIE within the .debug_info section. */
3877 static unsigned long next_die_offset;
3878 #endif
3879
3880 /* Record the root of the DIE's built for the current compilation unit. */
3881 static GTY(()) dw_die_ref comp_unit_die;
3882
3883 /* A list of DIEs with a NULL parent waiting to be relocated. */
3884 static GTY(()) limbo_die_node *limbo_die_list;
3885
3886 /* Filenames referenced by this compilation unit. */
3887 static GTY((param_is (struct dwarf_file_data))) htab_t file_table;
3888
3889 /* A hash table of references to DIE's that describe declarations.
3890 The key is a DECL_UID() which is a unique number identifying each decl. */
3891 static GTY ((param_is (struct die_struct))) htab_t decl_die_table;
3892
3893 /* Node of the variable location list. */
3894 struct var_loc_node GTY ((chain_next ("%h.next")))
3895 {
3896 rtx GTY (()) var_loc_note;
3897 const char * GTY (()) label;
3898 const char * GTY (()) section_label;
3899 struct var_loc_node * GTY (()) next;
3900 };
3901
3902 /* Variable location list. */
3903 struct var_loc_list_def GTY (())
3904 {
3905 struct var_loc_node * GTY (()) first;
3906
3907 /* Do not mark the last element of the chained list because
3908 it is marked through the chain. */
3909 struct var_loc_node * GTY ((skip ("%h"))) last;
3910
3911 /* DECL_UID of the variable decl. */
3912 unsigned int decl_id;
3913 };
3914 typedef struct var_loc_list_def var_loc_list;
3915
3916
3917 /* Table of decl location linked lists. */
3918 static GTY ((param_is (var_loc_list))) htab_t decl_loc_table;
3919
3920 /* A pointer to the base of a list of references to DIE's that
3921 are uniquely identified by their tag, presence/absence of
3922 children DIE's, and list of attribute/value pairs. */
3923 static GTY((length ("abbrev_die_table_allocated")))
3924 dw_die_ref *abbrev_die_table;
3925
3926 /* Number of elements currently allocated for abbrev_die_table. */
3927 static GTY(()) unsigned abbrev_die_table_allocated;
3928
3929 /* Number of elements in type_die_table currently in use. */
3930 static GTY(()) unsigned abbrev_die_table_in_use;
3931
3932 /* Size (in elements) of increments by which we may expand the
3933 abbrev_die_table. */
3934 #define ABBREV_DIE_TABLE_INCREMENT 256
3935
3936 /* A pointer to the base of a table that contains line information
3937 for each source code line in .text in the compilation unit. */
3938 static GTY((length ("line_info_table_allocated")))
3939 dw_line_info_ref line_info_table;
3940
3941 /* Number of elements currently allocated for line_info_table. */
3942 static GTY(()) unsigned line_info_table_allocated;
3943
3944 /* Number of elements in line_info_table currently in use. */
3945 static GTY(()) unsigned line_info_table_in_use;
3946
3947 /* True if the compilation unit places functions in more than one section. */
3948 static GTY(()) bool have_multiple_function_sections = false;
3949
3950 /* A pointer to the base of a table that contains line information
3951 for each source code line outside of .text in the compilation unit. */
3952 static GTY ((length ("separate_line_info_table_allocated")))
3953 dw_separate_line_info_ref separate_line_info_table;
3954
3955 /* Number of elements currently allocated for separate_line_info_table. */
3956 static GTY(()) unsigned separate_line_info_table_allocated;
3957
3958 /* Number of elements in separate_line_info_table currently in use. */
3959 static GTY(()) unsigned separate_line_info_table_in_use;
3960
3961 /* Size (in elements) of increments by which we may expand the
3962 line_info_table. */
3963 #define LINE_INFO_TABLE_INCREMENT 1024
3964
3965 /* A pointer to the base of a table that contains a list of publicly
3966 accessible names. */
3967 static GTY (()) VEC (pubname_entry, gc) * pubname_table;
3968
3969 /* A pointer to the base of a table that contains a list of publicly
3970 accessible types. */
3971 static GTY (()) VEC (pubname_entry, gc) * pubtype_table;
3972
3973 /* Array of dies for which we should generate .debug_arange info. */
3974 static GTY((length ("arange_table_allocated"))) dw_die_ref *arange_table;
3975
3976 /* Number of elements currently allocated for arange_table. */
3977 static GTY(()) unsigned arange_table_allocated;
3978
3979 /* Number of elements in arange_table currently in use. */
3980 static GTY(()) unsigned arange_table_in_use;
3981
3982 /* Size (in elements) of increments by which we may expand the
3983 arange_table. */
3984 #define ARANGE_TABLE_INCREMENT 64
3985
3986 /* Array of dies for which we should generate .debug_ranges info. */
3987 static GTY ((length ("ranges_table_allocated"))) dw_ranges_ref ranges_table;
3988
3989 /* Number of elements currently allocated for ranges_table. */
3990 static GTY(()) unsigned ranges_table_allocated;
3991
3992 /* Number of elements in ranges_table currently in use. */
3993 static GTY(()) unsigned ranges_table_in_use;
3994
3995 /* Size (in elements) of increments by which we may expand the
3996 ranges_table. */
3997 #define RANGES_TABLE_INCREMENT 64
3998
3999 /* Whether we have location lists that need outputting */
4000 static GTY(()) bool have_location_lists;
4001
4002 /* Unique label counter. */
4003 static GTY(()) unsigned int loclabel_num;
4004
4005 #ifdef DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO
4006 /* Record whether the function being analyzed contains inlined functions. */
4007 static int current_function_has_inlines;
4008 #endif
4009 #if 0 && defined (MIPS_DEBUGGING_INFO)
4010 static int comp_unit_has_inlines;
4011 #endif
4012
4013 /* The last file entry emitted by maybe_emit_file(). */
4014 static GTY(()) struct dwarf_file_data * last_emitted_file;
4015
4016 /* Number of internal labels generated by gen_internal_sym(). */
4017 static GTY(()) int label_num;
4018
4019 /* Cached result of previous call to lookup_filename. */
4020 static GTY(()) struct dwarf_file_data * file_table_last_lookup;
4021
4022 #ifdef DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO
4023
4024 /* Offset from the "steady-state frame pointer" to the frame base,
4025 within the current function. */
4026 static HOST_WIDE_INT frame_pointer_fb_offset;
4027
4028 /* Forward declarations for functions defined in this file. */
4029
4030 static int is_pseudo_reg (rtx);
4031 static tree type_main_variant (tree);
4032 static int is_tagged_type (tree);
4033 static const char *dwarf_tag_name (unsigned);
4034 static const char *dwarf_attr_name (unsigned);
4035 static const char *dwarf_form_name (unsigned);
4036 static tree decl_ultimate_origin (tree);
4037 static tree block_ultimate_origin (tree);
4038 static tree decl_class_context (tree);
4039 static void add_dwarf_attr (dw_die_ref, dw_attr_ref);
4040 static inline enum dw_val_class AT_class (dw_attr_ref);
4041 static void add_AT_flag (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, unsigned);
4042 static inline unsigned AT_flag (dw_attr_ref);
4043 static void add_AT_int (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, HOST_WIDE_INT);
4044 static inline HOST_WIDE_INT AT_int (dw_attr_ref);
4045 static void add_AT_unsigned (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT);
4046 static inline unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT AT_unsigned (dw_attr_ref);
4047 static void add_AT_long_long (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, unsigned long,
4048 unsigned long);
4049 static inline void add_AT_vec (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, unsigned int,
4050 unsigned int, unsigned char *);
4051 static hashval_t debug_str_do_hash (const void *);
4052 static int debug_str_eq (const void *, const void *);
4053 static void add_AT_string (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, const char *);
4054 static inline const char *AT_string (dw_attr_ref);
4055 static int AT_string_form (dw_attr_ref);
4056 static void add_AT_die_ref (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, dw_die_ref);
4057 static void add_AT_specification (dw_die_ref, dw_die_ref);
4058 static inline dw_die_ref AT_ref (dw_attr_ref);
4059 static inline int AT_ref_external (dw_attr_ref);
4060 static inline void set_AT_ref_external (dw_attr_ref, int);
4061 static void add_AT_fde_ref (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, unsigned);
4062 static void add_AT_loc (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, dw_loc_descr_ref);
4063 static inline dw_loc_descr_ref AT_loc (dw_attr_ref);
4064 static void add_AT_loc_list (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute,
4065 dw_loc_list_ref);
4066 static inline dw_loc_list_ref AT_loc_list (dw_attr_ref);
4067 static void add_AT_addr (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, rtx);
4068 static inline rtx AT_addr (dw_attr_ref);
4069 static void add_AT_lbl_id (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, const char *);
4070 static void add_AT_lineptr (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, const char *);
4071 static void add_AT_macptr (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, const char *);
4072 static void add_AT_offset (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute,
4073 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT);
4074 static void add_AT_range_list (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute,
4075 unsigned long);
4076 static inline const char *AT_lbl (dw_attr_ref);
4077 static dw_attr_ref get_AT (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute);
4078 static const char *get_AT_low_pc (dw_die_ref);
4079 static const char *get_AT_hi_pc (dw_die_ref);
4080 static const char *get_AT_string (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute);
4081 static int get_AT_flag (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute);
4082 static unsigned get_AT_unsigned (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute);
4083 static inline dw_die_ref get_AT_ref (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute);
4084 static bool is_c_family (void);
4085 static bool is_cxx (void);
4086 static bool is_java (void);
4087 static bool is_fortran (void);
4088 static bool is_ada (void);
4089 static void remove_AT (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute);
4090 static void remove_child_TAG (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_tag);
4091 static void add_child_die (dw_die_ref, dw_die_ref);
4092 static dw_die_ref new_die (enum dwarf_tag, dw_die_ref, tree);
4093 static dw_die_ref lookup_type_die (tree);
4094 static void equate_type_number_to_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
4095 static hashval_t decl_die_table_hash (const void *);
4096 static int decl_die_table_eq (const void *, const void *);
4097 static dw_die_ref lookup_decl_die (tree);
4098 static hashval_t decl_loc_table_hash (const void *);
4099 static int decl_loc_table_eq (const void *, const void *);
4100 static var_loc_list *lookup_decl_loc (tree);
4101 static void equate_decl_number_to_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
4102 static void add_var_loc_to_decl (tree, struct var_loc_node *);
4103 static void print_spaces (FILE *);
4104 static void print_die (dw_die_ref, FILE *);
4105 static void print_dwarf_line_table (FILE *);
4106 static dw_die_ref push_new_compile_unit (dw_die_ref, dw_die_ref);
4107 static dw_die_ref pop_compile_unit (dw_die_ref);
4108 static void loc_checksum (dw_loc_descr_ref, struct md5_ctx *);
4109 static void attr_checksum (dw_attr_ref, struct md5_ctx *, int *);
4110 static void die_checksum (dw_die_ref, struct md5_ctx *, int *);
4111 static int same_loc_p (dw_loc_descr_ref, dw_loc_descr_ref, int *);
4112 static int same_dw_val_p (dw_val_node *, dw_val_node *, int *);
4113 static int same_attr_p (dw_attr_ref, dw_attr_ref, int *);
4114 static int same_die_p (dw_die_ref, dw_die_ref, int *);
4115 static int same_die_p_wrap (dw_die_ref, dw_die_ref);
4116 static void compute_section_prefix (dw_die_ref);
4117 static int is_type_die (dw_die_ref);
4118 static int is_comdat_die (dw_die_ref);
4119 static int is_symbol_die (dw_die_ref);
4120 static void assign_symbol_names (dw_die_ref);
4121 static void break_out_includes (dw_die_ref);
4122 static hashval_t htab_cu_hash (const void *);
4123 static int htab_cu_eq (const void *, const void *);
4124 static void htab_cu_del (void *);
4125 static int check_duplicate_cu (dw_die_ref, htab_t, unsigned *);
4126 static void record_comdat_symbol_number (dw_die_ref, htab_t, unsigned);
4127 static void add_sibling_attributes (dw_die_ref);
4128 static void build_abbrev_table (dw_die_ref);
4129 static void output_location_lists (dw_die_ref);
4130 static int constant_size (long unsigned);
4131 static unsigned long size_of_die (dw_die_ref);
4132 static void calc_die_sizes (dw_die_ref);
4133 static void mark_dies (dw_die_ref);
4134 static void unmark_dies (dw_die_ref);
4135 static void unmark_all_dies (dw_die_ref);
4136 static unsigned long size_of_pubnames (VEC (pubname_entry,gc) *);
4137 static unsigned long size_of_aranges (void);
4138 static enum dwarf_form value_format (dw_attr_ref);
4139 static void output_value_format (dw_attr_ref);
4140 static void output_abbrev_section (void);
4141 static void output_die_symbol (dw_die_ref);
4142 static void output_die (dw_die_ref);
4143 static void output_compilation_unit_header (void);
4144 static void output_comp_unit (dw_die_ref, int);
4145 static const char *dwarf2_name (tree, int);
4146 static void add_pubname (tree, dw_die_ref);
4147 static void add_pubtype (tree, dw_die_ref);
4148 static void output_pubnames (VEC (pubname_entry,gc) *);
4149 static void add_arange (tree, dw_die_ref);
4150 static void output_aranges (void);
4151 static unsigned int add_ranges (tree);
4152 static void output_ranges (void);
4153 static void output_line_info (void);
4154 static void output_file_names (void);
4155 static dw_die_ref base_type_die (tree);
4156 static int is_base_type (tree);
4157 static bool is_subrange_type (tree);
4158 static dw_die_ref subrange_type_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
4159 static dw_die_ref modified_type_die (tree, int, int, dw_die_ref);
4160 static int type_is_enum (tree);
4161 static unsigned int dbx_reg_number (rtx);
4162 static void add_loc_descr_op_piece (dw_loc_descr_ref *, int);
4163 static dw_loc_descr_ref reg_loc_descriptor (rtx);
4164 static dw_loc_descr_ref one_reg_loc_descriptor (unsigned int);
4165 static dw_loc_descr_ref multiple_reg_loc_descriptor (rtx, rtx);
4166 static dw_loc_descr_ref int_loc_descriptor (HOST_WIDE_INT);
4167 static dw_loc_descr_ref based_loc_descr (rtx, HOST_WIDE_INT);
4168 static int is_based_loc (rtx);
4169 static dw_loc_descr_ref mem_loc_descriptor (rtx, enum machine_mode mode);
4170 static dw_loc_descr_ref concat_loc_descriptor (rtx, rtx);
4171 static dw_loc_descr_ref loc_descriptor (rtx);
4172 static dw_loc_descr_ref loc_descriptor_from_tree_1 (tree, int);
4173 static dw_loc_descr_ref loc_descriptor_from_tree (tree);
4174 static HOST_WIDE_INT ceiling (HOST_WIDE_INT, unsigned int);
4175 static tree field_type (tree);
4176 static unsigned int simple_type_align_in_bits (tree);
4177 static unsigned int simple_decl_align_in_bits (tree);
4178 static unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT simple_type_size_in_bits (tree);
4179 static HOST_WIDE_INT field_byte_offset (tree);
4180 static void add_AT_location_description (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute,
4181 dw_loc_descr_ref);
4182 static void add_data_member_location_attribute (dw_die_ref, tree);
4183 static void add_const_value_attribute (dw_die_ref, rtx);
4184 static void insert_int (HOST_WIDE_INT, unsigned, unsigned char *);
4185 static HOST_WIDE_INT extract_int (const unsigned char *, unsigned);
4186 static void insert_float (rtx, unsigned char *);
4187 static rtx rtl_for_decl_location (tree);
4188 static void add_location_or_const_value_attribute (dw_die_ref, tree,
4189 enum dwarf_attribute);
4190 static void tree_add_const_value_attribute (dw_die_ref, tree);
4191 static void add_name_attribute (dw_die_ref, const char *);
4192 static void add_comp_dir_attribute (dw_die_ref);
4193 static void add_bound_info (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, tree);
4194 static void add_subscript_info (dw_die_ref, tree);
4195 static void add_byte_size_attribute (dw_die_ref, tree);
4196 static void add_bit_offset_attribute (dw_die_ref, tree);
4197 static void add_bit_size_attribute (dw_die_ref, tree);
4198 static void add_prototyped_attribute (dw_die_ref, tree);
4199 static void add_abstract_origin_attribute (dw_die_ref, tree);
4200 static void add_pure_or_virtual_attribute (dw_die_ref, tree);
4201 static void add_src_coords_attributes (dw_die_ref, tree);
4202 static void add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (dw_die_ref, tree);
4203 static void push_decl_scope (tree);
4204 static void pop_decl_scope (void);
4205 static dw_die_ref scope_die_for (tree, dw_die_ref);
4206 static inline int local_scope_p (dw_die_ref);
4207 static inline int class_or_namespace_scope_p (dw_die_ref);
4208 static void add_type_attribute (dw_die_ref, tree, int, int, dw_die_ref);
4209 static void add_calling_convention_attribute (dw_die_ref, tree);
4210 static const char *type_tag (tree);
4211 static tree member_declared_type (tree);
4212 #if 0
4213 static const char *decl_start_label (tree);
4214 #endif
4215 static void gen_array_type_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
4216 #if 0
4217 static void gen_entry_point_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
4218 #endif
4219 static void gen_inlined_enumeration_type_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
4220 static void gen_inlined_structure_type_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
4221 static void gen_inlined_union_type_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
4222 static dw_die_ref gen_enumeration_type_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
4223 static dw_die_ref gen_formal_parameter_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
4224 static void gen_unspecified_parameters_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
4225 static void gen_formal_types_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
4226 static void gen_subprogram_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
4227 static void gen_variable_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
4228 static void gen_label_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
4229 static void gen_lexical_block_die (tree, dw_die_ref, int);
4230 static void gen_inlined_subroutine_die (tree, dw_die_ref, int);
4231 static void gen_field_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
4232 static void gen_ptr_to_mbr_type_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
4233 static dw_die_ref gen_compile_unit_die (const char *);
4234 static void gen_inheritance_die (tree, tree, dw_die_ref);
4235 static void gen_member_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
4236 static void gen_struct_or_union_type_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
4237 static void gen_subroutine_type_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
4238 static void gen_typedef_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
4239 static void gen_type_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
4240 static void gen_tagged_type_instantiation_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
4241 static void gen_block_die (tree, dw_die_ref, int);
4242 static void decls_for_scope (tree, dw_die_ref, int);
4243 static int is_redundant_typedef (tree);
4244 static void gen_namespace_die (tree);
4245 static void gen_decl_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
4246 static dw_die_ref force_decl_die (tree);
4247 static dw_die_ref force_type_die (tree);
4248 static dw_die_ref setup_namespace_context (tree, dw_die_ref);
4249 static void declare_in_namespace (tree, dw_die_ref);
4250 static struct dwarf_file_data * lookup_filename (const char *);
4251 static void retry_incomplete_types (void);
4252 static void gen_type_die_for_member (tree, tree, dw_die_ref);
4253 static void splice_child_die (dw_die_ref, dw_die_ref);
4254 static int file_info_cmp (const void *, const void *);
4255 static dw_loc_list_ref new_loc_list (dw_loc_descr_ref, const char *,
4256 const char *, const char *, unsigned);
4257 static void add_loc_descr_to_loc_list (dw_loc_list_ref *, dw_loc_descr_ref,
4258 const char *, const char *,
4259 const char *);
4260 static void output_loc_list (dw_loc_list_ref);
4261 static char *gen_internal_sym (const char *);
4262
4263 static void prune_unmark_dies (dw_die_ref);
4264 static void prune_unused_types_mark (dw_die_ref, int);
4265 static void prune_unused_types_walk (dw_die_ref);
4266 static void prune_unused_types_walk_attribs (dw_die_ref);
4267 static void prune_unused_types_prune (dw_die_ref);
4268 static void prune_unused_types (void);
4269 static int maybe_emit_file (struct dwarf_file_data *fd);
4270
4271 /* Section names used to hold DWARF debugging information. */
4272 #ifndef DEBUG_INFO_SECTION
4273 #define DEBUG_INFO_SECTION ".debug_info"
4274 #endif
4275 #ifndef DEBUG_ABBREV_SECTION
4276 #define DEBUG_ABBREV_SECTION ".debug_abbrev"
4277 #endif
4278 #ifndef DEBUG_ARANGES_SECTION
4279 #define DEBUG_ARANGES_SECTION ".debug_aranges"
4280 #endif
4281 #ifndef DEBUG_MACINFO_SECTION
4282 #define DEBUG_MACINFO_SECTION ".debug_macinfo"
4283 #endif
4284 #ifndef DEBUG_LINE_SECTION
4285 #define DEBUG_LINE_SECTION ".debug_line"
4286 #endif
4287 #ifndef DEBUG_LOC_SECTION
4288 #define DEBUG_LOC_SECTION ".debug_loc"
4289 #endif
4290 #ifndef DEBUG_PUBNAMES_SECTION
4291 #define DEBUG_PUBNAMES_SECTION ".debug_pubnames"
4292 #endif
4293 #ifndef DEBUG_STR_SECTION
4294 #define DEBUG_STR_SECTION ".debug_str"
4295 #endif
4296 #ifndef DEBUG_RANGES_SECTION
4297 #define DEBUG_RANGES_SECTION ".debug_ranges"
4298 #endif
4299
4300 /* Standard ELF section names for compiled code and data. */
4301 #ifndef TEXT_SECTION_NAME
4302 #define TEXT_SECTION_NAME ".text"
4303 #endif
4304
4305 /* Section flags for .debug_str section. */
4306 #define DEBUG_STR_SECTION_FLAGS \
4307 (HAVE_GAS_SHF_MERGE && flag_merge_constants \
4308 ? SECTION_DEBUG | SECTION_MERGE | SECTION_STRINGS | 1 \
4309 : SECTION_DEBUG)
4310
4311 /* Labels we insert at beginning sections we can reference instead of
4312 the section names themselves. */
4313
4314 #ifndef TEXT_SECTION_LABEL
4315 #define TEXT_SECTION_LABEL "Ltext"
4316 #endif
4317 #ifndef COLD_TEXT_SECTION_LABEL
4318 #define COLD_TEXT_SECTION_LABEL "Ltext_cold"
4319 #endif
4320 #ifndef DEBUG_LINE_SECTION_LABEL
4321 #define DEBUG_LINE_SECTION_LABEL "Ldebug_line"
4322 #endif
4323 #ifndef DEBUG_INFO_SECTION_LABEL
4324 #define DEBUG_INFO_SECTION_LABEL "Ldebug_info"
4325 #endif
4326 #ifndef DEBUG_ABBREV_SECTION_LABEL
4327 #define DEBUG_ABBREV_SECTION_LABEL "Ldebug_abbrev"
4328 #endif
4329 #ifndef DEBUG_LOC_SECTION_LABEL
4330 #define DEBUG_LOC_SECTION_LABEL "Ldebug_loc"
4331 #endif
4332 #ifndef DEBUG_RANGES_SECTION_LABEL
4333 #define DEBUG_RANGES_SECTION_LABEL "Ldebug_ranges"
4334 #endif
4335 #ifndef DEBUG_MACINFO_SECTION_LABEL
4336 #define DEBUG_MACINFO_SECTION_LABEL "Ldebug_macinfo"
4337 #endif
4338
4339 /* Definitions of defaults for formats and names of various special
4340 (artificial) labels which may be generated within this file (when the -g
4341 options is used and DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO is in effect.
4342 If necessary, these may be overridden from within the tm.h file, but
4343 typically, overriding these defaults is unnecessary. */
4344
4345 static char text_end_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
4346 static char text_section_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
4347 static char cold_text_section_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
4348 static char cold_end_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
4349 static char abbrev_section_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
4350 static char debug_info_section_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
4351 static char debug_line_section_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
4352 static char macinfo_section_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
4353 static char loc_section_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
4354 static char ranges_section_label[2 * MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
4355
4356 #ifndef TEXT_END_LABEL
4357 #define TEXT_END_LABEL "Letext"
4358 #endif
4359 #ifndef COLD_END_LABEL
4360 #define COLD_END_LABEL "Letext_cold"
4361 #endif
4362 #ifndef BLOCK_BEGIN_LABEL
4363 #define BLOCK_BEGIN_LABEL "LBB"
4364 #endif
4365 #ifndef BLOCK_END_LABEL
4366 #define BLOCK_END_LABEL "LBE"
4367 #endif
4368 #ifndef LINE_CODE_LABEL
4369 #define LINE_CODE_LABEL "LM"
4370 #endif
4371 #ifndef SEPARATE_LINE_CODE_LABEL
4372 #define SEPARATE_LINE_CODE_LABEL "LSM"
4373 #endif
4374 \f
4375 /* We allow a language front-end to designate a function that is to be
4376 called to "demangle" any name before it is put into a DIE. */
4377
4378 static const char *(*demangle_name_func) (const char *);
4379
4380 void
4381 dwarf2out_set_demangle_name_func (const char *(*func) (const char *))
4382 {
4383 demangle_name_func = func;
4384 }
4385
4386 /* Test if rtl node points to a pseudo register. */
4387
4388 static inline int
4389 is_pseudo_reg (rtx rtl)
4390 {
4391 return ((REG_P (rtl) && REGNO (rtl) >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
4392 || (GET_CODE (rtl) == SUBREG
4393 && REGNO (SUBREG_REG (rtl)) >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER));
4394 }
4395
4396 /* Return a reference to a type, with its const and volatile qualifiers
4397 removed. */
4398
4399 static inline tree
4400 type_main_variant (tree type)
4401 {
4402 type = TYPE_MAIN_VARIANT (type);
4403
4404 /* ??? There really should be only one main variant among any group of
4405 variants of a given type (and all of the MAIN_VARIANT values for all
4406 members of the group should point to that one type) but sometimes the C
4407 front-end messes this up for array types, so we work around that bug
4408 here. */
4409 if (TREE_CODE (type) == ARRAY_TYPE)
4410 while (type != TYPE_MAIN_VARIANT (type))
4411 type = TYPE_MAIN_VARIANT (type);
4412
4413 return type;
4414 }
4415
4416 /* Return nonzero if the given type node represents a tagged type. */
4417
4418 static inline int
4419 is_tagged_type (tree type)
4420 {
4421 enum tree_code code = TREE_CODE (type);
4422
4423 return (code == RECORD_TYPE || code == UNION_TYPE
4424 || code == QUAL_UNION_TYPE || code == ENUMERAL_TYPE);
4425 }
4426
4427 /* Convert a DIE tag into its string name. */
4428
4429 static const char *
4430 dwarf_tag_name (unsigned int tag)
4431 {
4432 switch (tag)
4433 {
4434 case DW_TAG_padding:
4435 return "DW_TAG_padding";
4436 case DW_TAG_array_type:
4437 return "DW_TAG_array_type";
4438 case DW_TAG_class_type:
4439 return "DW_TAG_class_type";
4440 case DW_TAG_entry_point:
4441 return "DW_TAG_entry_point";
4442 case DW_TAG_enumeration_type:
4443 return "DW_TAG_enumeration_type";
4444 case DW_TAG_formal_parameter:
4445 return "DW_TAG_formal_parameter";
4446 case DW_TAG_imported_declaration:
4447 return "DW_TAG_imported_declaration";
4448 case DW_TAG_label:
4449 return "DW_TAG_label";
4450 case DW_TAG_lexical_block:
4451 return "DW_TAG_lexical_block";
4452 case DW_TAG_member:
4453 return "DW_TAG_member";
4454 case DW_TAG_pointer_type:
4455 return "DW_TAG_pointer_type";
4456 case DW_TAG_reference_type:
4457 return "DW_TAG_reference_type";
4458 case DW_TAG_compile_unit:
4459 return "DW_TAG_compile_unit";
4460 case DW_TAG_string_type:
4461 return "DW_TAG_string_type";
4462 case DW_TAG_structure_type:
4463 return "DW_TAG_structure_type";
4464 case DW_TAG_subroutine_type:
4465 return "DW_TAG_subroutine_type";
4466 case DW_TAG_typedef:
4467 return "DW_TAG_typedef";
4468 case DW_TAG_union_type:
4469 return "DW_TAG_union_type";
4470 case DW_TAG_unspecified_parameters:
4471 return "DW_TAG_unspecified_parameters";
4472 case DW_TAG_variant:
4473 return "DW_TAG_variant";
4474 case DW_TAG_common_block:
4475 return "DW_TAG_common_block";
4476 case DW_TAG_common_inclusion:
4477 return "DW_TAG_common_inclusion";
4478 case DW_TAG_inheritance:
4479 return "DW_TAG_inheritance";
4480 case DW_TAG_inlined_subroutine:
4481 return "DW_TAG_inlined_subroutine";
4482 case DW_TAG_module:
4483 return "DW_TAG_module";
4484 case DW_TAG_ptr_to_member_type:
4485 return "DW_TAG_ptr_to_member_type";
4486 case DW_TAG_set_type:
4487 return "DW_TAG_set_type";
4488 case DW_TAG_subrange_type:
4489 return "DW_TAG_subrange_type";
4490 case DW_TAG_with_stmt:
4491 return "DW_TAG_with_stmt";
4492 case DW_TAG_access_declaration:
4493 return "DW_TAG_access_declaration";
4494 case DW_TAG_base_type:
4495 return "DW_TAG_base_type";
4496 case DW_TAG_catch_block:
4497 return "DW_TAG_catch_block";
4498 case DW_TAG_const_type:
4499 return "DW_TAG_const_type";
4500 case DW_TAG_constant:
4501 return "DW_TAG_constant";
4502 case DW_TAG_enumerator:
4503 return "DW_TAG_enumerator";
4504 case DW_TAG_file_type:
4505 return "DW_TAG_file_type";
4506 case DW_TAG_friend:
4507 return "DW_TAG_friend";
4508 case DW_TAG_namelist:
4509 return "DW_TAG_namelist";
4510 case DW_TAG_namelist_item:
4511 return "DW_TAG_namelist_item";
4512 case DW_TAG_namespace:
4513 return "DW_TAG_namespace";
4514 case DW_TAG_packed_type:
4515 return "DW_TAG_packed_type";
4516 case DW_TAG_subprogram:
4517 return "DW_TAG_subprogram";
4518 case DW_TAG_template_type_param:
4519 return "DW_TAG_template_type_param";
4520 case DW_TAG_template_value_param:
4521 return "DW_TAG_template_value_param";
4522 case DW_TAG_thrown_type:
4523 return "DW_TAG_thrown_type";
4524 case DW_TAG_try_block:
4525 return "DW_TAG_try_block";
4526 case DW_TAG_variant_part:
4527 return "DW_TAG_variant_part";
4528 case DW_TAG_variable:
4529 return "DW_TAG_variable";
4530 case DW_TAG_volatile_type:
4531 return "DW_TAG_volatile_type";
4532 case DW_TAG_imported_module:
4533 return "DW_TAG_imported_module";
4534 case DW_TAG_MIPS_loop:
4535 return "DW_TAG_MIPS_loop";
4536 case DW_TAG_format_label:
4537 return "DW_TAG_format_label";
4538 case DW_TAG_function_template:
4539 return "DW_TAG_function_template";
4540 case DW_TAG_class_template:
4541 return "DW_TAG_class_template";
4542 case DW_TAG_GNU_BINCL:
4543 return "DW_TAG_GNU_BINCL";
4544 case DW_TAG_GNU_EINCL:
4545 return "DW_TAG_GNU_EINCL";
4546 default:
4547 return "DW_TAG_<unknown>";
4548 }
4549 }
4550
4551 /* Convert a DWARF attribute code into its string name. */
4552
4553 static const char *
4554 dwarf_attr_name (unsigned int attr)
4555 {
4556 switch (attr)
4557 {
4558 case DW_AT_sibling:
4559 return "DW_AT_sibling";
4560 case DW_AT_location:
4561 return "DW_AT_location";
4562 case DW_AT_name:
4563 return "DW_AT_name";
4564 case DW_AT_ordering:
4565 return "DW_AT_ordering";
4566 case DW_AT_subscr_data:
4567 return "DW_AT_subscr_data";
4568 case DW_AT_byte_size:
4569 return "DW_AT_byte_size";
4570 case DW_AT_bit_offset:
4571 return "DW_AT_bit_offset";
4572 case DW_AT_bit_size:
4573 return "DW_AT_bit_size";
4574 case DW_AT_element_list:
4575 return "DW_AT_element_list";
4576 case DW_AT_stmt_list:
4577 return "DW_AT_stmt_list";
4578 case DW_AT_low_pc:
4579 return "DW_AT_low_pc";
4580 case DW_AT_high_pc:
4581 return "DW_AT_high_pc";
4582 case DW_AT_language:
4583 return "DW_AT_language";
4584 case DW_AT_member:
4585 return "DW_AT_member";
4586 case DW_AT_discr:
4587 return "DW_AT_discr";
4588 case DW_AT_discr_value:
4589 return "DW_AT_discr_value";
4590 case DW_AT_visibility:
4591 return "DW_AT_visibility";
4592 case DW_AT_import:
4593 return "DW_AT_import";
4594 case DW_AT_string_length:
4595 return "DW_AT_string_length";
4596 case DW_AT_common_reference:
4597 return "DW_AT_common_reference";
4598 case DW_AT_comp_dir:
4599 return "DW_AT_comp_dir";
4600 case DW_AT_const_value:
4601 return "DW_AT_const_value";
4602 case DW_AT_containing_type:
4603 return "DW_AT_containing_type";
4604 case DW_AT_default_value:
4605 return "DW_AT_default_value";
4606 case DW_AT_inline:
4607 return "DW_AT_inline";
4608 case DW_AT_is_optional:
4609 return "DW_AT_is_optional";
4610 case DW_AT_lower_bound:
4611 return "DW_AT_lower_bound";
4612 case DW_AT_producer:
4613 return "DW_AT_producer";
4614 case DW_AT_prototyped:
4615 return "DW_AT_prototyped";
4616 case DW_AT_return_addr:
4617 return "DW_AT_return_addr";
4618 case DW_AT_start_scope:
4619 return "DW_AT_start_scope";
4620 case DW_AT_stride_size:
4621 return "DW_AT_stride_size";
4622 case DW_AT_upper_bound:
4623 return "DW_AT_upper_bound";
4624 case DW_AT_abstract_origin:
4625 return "DW_AT_abstract_origin";
4626 case DW_AT_accessibility:
4627 return "DW_AT_accessibility";
4628 case DW_AT_address_class:
4629 return "DW_AT_address_class";
4630 case DW_AT_artificial:
4631 return "DW_AT_artificial";
4632 case DW_AT_base_types:
4633 return "DW_AT_base_types";
4634 case DW_AT_calling_convention:
4635 return "DW_AT_calling_convention";
4636 case DW_AT_count:
4637 return "DW_AT_count";
4638 case DW_AT_data_member_location:
4639 return "DW_AT_data_member_location";
4640 case DW_AT_decl_column:
4641 return "DW_AT_decl_column";
4642 case DW_AT_decl_file:
4643 return "DW_AT_decl_file";
4644 case DW_AT_decl_line:
4645 return "DW_AT_decl_line";
4646 case DW_AT_declaration:
4647 return "DW_AT_declaration";
4648 case DW_AT_discr_list:
4649 return "DW_AT_discr_list";
4650 case DW_AT_encoding:
4651 return "DW_AT_encoding";
4652 case DW_AT_external:
4653 return "DW_AT_external";
4654 case DW_AT_frame_base:
4655 return "DW_AT_frame_base";
4656 case DW_AT_friend:
4657 return "DW_AT_friend";
4658 case DW_AT_identifier_case:
4659 return "DW_AT_identifier_case";
4660 case DW_AT_macro_info:
4661 return "DW_AT_macro_info";
4662 case DW_AT_namelist_items:
4663 return "DW_AT_namelist_items";
4664 case DW_AT_priority:
4665 return "DW_AT_priority";
4666 case DW_AT_segment:
4667 return "DW_AT_segment";
4668 case DW_AT_specification:
4669 return "DW_AT_specification";
4670 case DW_AT_static_link:
4671 return "DW_AT_static_link";
4672 case DW_AT_type:
4673 return "DW_AT_type";
4674 case DW_AT_use_location:
4675 return "DW_AT_use_location";
4676 case DW_AT_variable_parameter:
4677 return "DW_AT_variable_parameter";
4678 case DW_AT_virtuality:
4679 return "DW_AT_virtuality";
4680 case DW_AT_vtable_elem_location:
4681 return "DW_AT_vtable_elem_location";
4682
4683 case DW_AT_allocated:
4684 return "DW_AT_allocated";
4685 case DW_AT_associated:
4686 return "DW_AT_associated";
4687 case DW_AT_data_location:
4688 return "DW_AT_data_location";
4689 case DW_AT_stride:
4690 return "DW_AT_stride";
4691 case DW_AT_entry_pc:
4692 return "DW_AT_entry_pc";
4693 case DW_AT_use_UTF8:
4694 return "DW_AT_use_UTF8";
4695 case DW_AT_extension:
4696 return "DW_AT_extension";
4697 case DW_AT_ranges:
4698 return "DW_AT_ranges";
4699 case DW_AT_trampoline:
4700 return "DW_AT_trampoline";
4701 case DW_AT_call_column:
4702 return "DW_AT_call_column";
4703 case DW_AT_call_file:
4704 return "DW_AT_call_file";
4705 case DW_AT_call_line:
4706 return "DW_AT_call_line";
4707
4708 case DW_AT_MIPS_fde:
4709 return "DW_AT_MIPS_fde";
4710 case DW_AT_MIPS_loop_begin:
4711 return "DW_AT_MIPS_loop_begin";
4712 case DW_AT_MIPS_tail_loop_begin:
4713 return "DW_AT_MIPS_tail_loop_begin";
4714 case DW_AT_MIPS_epilog_begin:
4715 return "DW_AT_MIPS_epilog_begin";
4716 case DW_AT_MIPS_loop_unroll_factor:
4717 return "DW_AT_MIPS_loop_unroll_factor";
4718 case DW_AT_MIPS_software_pipeline_depth:
4719 return "DW_AT_MIPS_software_pipeline_depth";
4720 case DW_AT_MIPS_linkage_name:
4721 return "DW_AT_MIPS_linkage_name";
4722 case DW_AT_MIPS_stride:
4723 return "DW_AT_MIPS_stride";
4724 case DW_AT_MIPS_abstract_name:
4725 return "DW_AT_MIPS_abstract_name";
4726 case DW_AT_MIPS_clone_origin:
4727 return "DW_AT_MIPS_clone_origin";
4728 case DW_AT_MIPS_has_inlines:
4729 return "DW_AT_MIPS_has_inlines";
4730
4731 case DW_AT_sf_names:
4732 return "DW_AT_sf_names";
4733 case DW_AT_src_info:
4734 return "DW_AT_src_info";
4735 case DW_AT_mac_info:
4736 return "DW_AT_mac_info";
4737 case DW_AT_src_coords:
4738 return "DW_AT_src_coords";
4739 case DW_AT_body_begin:
4740 return "DW_AT_body_begin";
4741 case DW_AT_body_end:
4742 return "DW_AT_body_end";
4743 case DW_AT_GNU_vector:
4744 return "DW_AT_GNU_vector";
4745
4746 case DW_AT_VMS_rtnbeg_pd_address:
4747 return "DW_AT_VMS_rtnbeg_pd_address";
4748
4749 default:
4750 return "DW_AT_<unknown>";
4751 }
4752 }
4753
4754 /* Convert a DWARF value form code into its string name. */
4755
4756 static const char *
4757 dwarf_form_name (unsigned int form)
4758 {
4759 switch (form)
4760 {
4761 case DW_FORM_addr:
4762 return "DW_FORM_addr";
4763 case DW_FORM_block2:
4764 return "DW_FORM_block2";
4765 case DW_FORM_block4:
4766 return "DW_FORM_block4";
4767 case DW_FORM_data2:
4768 return "DW_FORM_data2";
4769 case DW_FORM_data4:
4770 return "DW_FORM_data4";
4771 case DW_FORM_data8:
4772 return "DW_FORM_data8";
4773 case DW_FORM_string:
4774 return "DW_FORM_string";
4775 case DW_FORM_block:
4776 return "DW_FORM_block";
4777 case DW_FORM_block1:
4778 return "DW_FORM_block1";
4779 case DW_FORM_data1:
4780 return "DW_FORM_data1";
4781 case DW_FORM_flag:
4782 return "DW_FORM_flag";
4783 case DW_FORM_sdata:
4784 return "DW_FORM_sdata";
4785 case DW_FORM_strp:
4786 return "DW_FORM_strp";
4787 case DW_FORM_udata:
4788 return "DW_FORM_udata";
4789 case DW_FORM_ref_addr:
4790 return "DW_FORM_ref_addr";
4791 case DW_FORM_ref1:
4792 return "DW_FORM_ref1";
4793 case DW_FORM_ref2:
4794 return "DW_FORM_ref2";
4795 case DW_FORM_ref4:
4796 return "DW_FORM_ref4";
4797 case DW_FORM_ref8:
4798 return "DW_FORM_ref8";
4799 case DW_FORM_ref_udata:
4800 return "DW_FORM_ref_udata";
4801 case DW_FORM_indirect:
4802 return "DW_FORM_indirect";
4803 default:
4804 return "DW_FORM_<unknown>";
4805 }
4806 }
4807 \f
4808 /* Determine the "ultimate origin" of a decl. The decl may be an inlined
4809 instance of an inlined instance of a decl which is local to an inline
4810 function, so we have to trace all of the way back through the origin chain
4811 to find out what sort of node actually served as the original seed for the
4812 given block. */
4813
4814 static tree
4815 decl_ultimate_origin (tree decl)
4816 {
4817 if (!CODE_CONTAINS_STRUCT (TREE_CODE (decl), TS_DECL_COMMON))
4818 return NULL_TREE;
4819
4820 /* output_inline_function sets DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN for all the
4821 nodes in the function to point to themselves; ignore that if
4822 we're trying to output the abstract instance of this function. */
4823 if (DECL_ABSTRACT (decl) && DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN (decl) == decl)
4824 return NULL_TREE;
4825
4826 /* Since the DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN for a DECL is supposed to be the
4827 most distant ancestor, this should never happen. */
4828 gcc_assert (!DECL_FROM_INLINE (DECL_ORIGIN (decl)));
4829
4830 return DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN (decl);
4831 }
4832
4833 /* Determine the "ultimate origin" of a block. The block may be an inlined
4834 instance of an inlined instance of a block which is local to an inline
4835 function, so we have to trace all of the way back through the origin chain
4836 to find out what sort of node actually served as the original seed for the
4837 given block. */
4838
4839 static tree
4840 block_ultimate_origin (tree block)
4841 {
4842 tree immediate_origin = BLOCK_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN (block);
4843
4844 /* output_inline_function sets BLOCK_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN for all the
4845 nodes in the function to point to themselves; ignore that if
4846 we're trying to output the abstract instance of this function. */
4847 if (BLOCK_ABSTRACT (block) && immediate_origin == block)
4848 return NULL_TREE;
4849
4850 if (immediate_origin == NULL_TREE)
4851 return NULL_TREE;
4852 else
4853 {
4854 tree ret_val;
4855 tree lookahead = immediate_origin;
4856
4857 do
4858 {
4859 ret_val = lookahead;
4860 lookahead = (TREE_CODE (ret_val) == BLOCK
4861 ? BLOCK_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN (ret_val) : NULL);
4862 }
4863 while (lookahead != NULL && lookahead != ret_val);
4864
4865 /* The block's abstract origin chain may not be the *ultimate* origin of
4866 the block. It could lead to a DECL that has an abstract origin set.
4867 If so, we want that DECL's abstract origin (which is what DECL_ORIGIN
4868 will give us if it has one). Note that DECL's abstract origins are
4869 supposed to be the most distant ancestor (or so decl_ultimate_origin
4870 claims), so we don't need to loop following the DECL origins. */
4871 if (DECL_P (ret_val))
4872 return DECL_ORIGIN (ret_val);
4873
4874 return ret_val;
4875 }
4876 }
4877
4878 /* Get the class to which DECL belongs, if any. In g++, the DECL_CONTEXT
4879 of a virtual function may refer to a base class, so we check the 'this'
4880 parameter. */
4881
4882 static tree
4883 decl_class_context (tree decl)
4884 {
4885 tree context = NULL_TREE;
4886
4887 if (TREE_CODE (decl) != FUNCTION_DECL || ! DECL_VINDEX (decl))
4888 context = DECL_CONTEXT (decl);
4889 else
4890 context = TYPE_MAIN_VARIANT
4891 (TREE_TYPE (TREE_VALUE (TYPE_ARG_TYPES (TREE_TYPE (decl)))));
4892
4893 if (context && !TYPE_P (context))
4894 context = NULL_TREE;
4895
4896 return context;
4897 }
4898 \f
4899 /* Add an attribute/value pair to a DIE. */
4900
4901 static inline void
4902 add_dwarf_attr (dw_die_ref die, dw_attr_ref attr)
4903 {
4904 /* Maybe this should be an assert? */
4905 if (die == NULL)
4906 return;
4907
4908 if (die->die_attr == NULL)
4909 die->die_attr = VEC_alloc (dw_attr_node, gc, 1);
4910 VEC_safe_push (dw_attr_node, gc, die->die_attr, attr);
4911 }
4912
4913 static inline enum dw_val_class
4914 AT_class (dw_attr_ref a)
4915 {
4916 return a->dw_attr_val.val_class;
4917 }
4918
4919 /* Add a flag value attribute to a DIE. */
4920
4921 static inline void
4922 add_AT_flag (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind, unsigned int flag)
4923 {
4924 dw_attr_node attr;
4925
4926 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
4927 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_flag;
4928 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_flag = flag;
4929 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
4930 }
4931
4932 static inline unsigned
4933 AT_flag (dw_attr_ref a)
4934 {
4935 gcc_assert (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_flag);
4936 return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_flag;
4937 }
4938
4939 /* Add a signed integer attribute value to a DIE. */
4940
4941 static inline void
4942 add_AT_int (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind, HOST_WIDE_INT int_val)
4943 {
4944 dw_attr_node attr;
4945
4946 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
4947 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_const;
4948 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_int = int_val;
4949 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
4950 }
4951
4952 static inline HOST_WIDE_INT
4953 AT_int (dw_attr_ref a)
4954 {
4955 gcc_assert (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_const);
4956 return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_int;
4957 }
4958
4959 /* Add an unsigned integer attribute value to a DIE. */
4960
4961 static inline void
4962 add_AT_unsigned (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,
4963 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT unsigned_val)
4964 {
4965 dw_attr_node attr;
4966
4967 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
4968 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_unsigned_const;
4969 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_unsigned = unsigned_val;
4970 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
4971 }
4972
4973 static inline unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT
4974 AT_unsigned (dw_attr_ref a)
4975 {
4976 gcc_assert (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_unsigned_const);
4977 return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_unsigned;
4978 }
4979
4980 /* Add an unsigned double integer attribute value to a DIE. */
4981
4982 static inline void
4983 add_AT_long_long (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,
4984 long unsigned int val_hi, long unsigned int val_low)
4985 {
4986 dw_attr_node attr;
4987
4988 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
4989 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_long_long;
4990 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_long_long.hi = val_hi;
4991 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_long_long.low = val_low;
4992 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
4993 }
4994
4995 /* Add a floating point attribute value to a DIE and return it. */
4996
4997 static inline void
4998 add_AT_vec (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,
4999 unsigned int length, unsigned int elt_size, unsigned char *array)
5000 {
5001 dw_attr_node attr;
5002
5003 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
5004 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_vec;
5005 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_vec.length = length;
5006 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_vec.elt_size = elt_size;
5007 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_vec.array = array;
5008 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
5009 }
5010
5011 /* Hash and equality functions for debug_str_hash. */
5012
5013 static hashval_t
5014 debug_str_do_hash (const void *x)
5015 {
5016 return htab_hash_string (((const struct indirect_string_node *)x)->str);
5017 }
5018
5019 static int
5020 debug_str_eq (const void *x1, const void *x2)
5021 {
5022 return strcmp ((((const struct indirect_string_node *)x1)->str),
5023 (const char *)x2) == 0;
5024 }
5025
5026 /* Add a string attribute value to a DIE. */
5027
5028 static inline void
5029 add_AT_string (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind, const char *str)
5030 {
5031 dw_attr_node attr;
5032 struct indirect_string_node *node;
5033 void **slot;
5034
5035 if (! debug_str_hash)
5036 debug_str_hash = htab_create_ggc (10, debug_str_do_hash,
5037 debug_str_eq, NULL);
5038
5039 slot = htab_find_slot_with_hash (debug_str_hash, str,
5040 htab_hash_string (str), INSERT);
5041 if (*slot == NULL)
5042 *slot = ggc_alloc_cleared (sizeof (struct indirect_string_node));
5043 node = (struct indirect_string_node *) *slot;
5044 node->str = ggc_strdup (str);
5045 node->refcount++;
5046
5047 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
5048 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_str;
5049 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_str = node;
5050 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
5051 }
5052
5053 static inline const char *
5054 AT_string (dw_attr_ref a)
5055 {
5056 gcc_assert (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_str);
5057 return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_str->str;
5058 }
5059
5060 /* Find out whether a string should be output inline in DIE
5061 or out-of-line in .debug_str section. */
5062
5063 static int
5064 AT_string_form (dw_attr_ref a)
5065 {
5066 struct indirect_string_node *node;
5067 unsigned int len;
5068 char label[32];
5069
5070 gcc_assert (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_str);
5071
5072 node = a->dw_attr_val.v.val_str;
5073 if (node->form)
5074 return node->form;
5075
5076 len = strlen (node->str) + 1;
5077
5078 /* If the string is shorter or equal to the size of the reference, it is
5079 always better to put it inline. */
5080 if (len <= DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE || node->refcount == 0)
5081 return node->form = DW_FORM_string;
5082
5083 /* If we cannot expect the linker to merge strings in .debug_str
5084 section, only put it into .debug_str if it is worth even in this
5085 single module. */
5086 if ((debug_str_section->common.flags & SECTION_MERGE) == 0
5087 && (len - DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE) * node->refcount <= len)
5088 return node->form = DW_FORM_string;
5089
5090 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label, "LASF", dw2_string_counter);
5091 ++dw2_string_counter;
5092 node->label = xstrdup (label);
5093
5094 return node->form = DW_FORM_strp;
5095 }
5096
5097 /* Add a DIE reference attribute value to a DIE. */
5098
5099 static inline void
5100 add_AT_die_ref (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind, dw_die_ref targ_die)
5101 {
5102 dw_attr_node attr;
5103
5104 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
5105 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_die_ref;
5106 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_die_ref.die = targ_die;
5107 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_die_ref.external = 0;
5108 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
5109 }
5110
5111 /* Add an AT_specification attribute to a DIE, and also make the back
5112 pointer from the specification to the definition. */
5113
5114 static inline void
5115 add_AT_specification (dw_die_ref die, dw_die_ref targ_die)
5116 {
5117 add_AT_die_ref (die, DW_AT_specification, targ_die);
5118 gcc_assert (!targ_die->die_definition);
5119 targ_die->die_definition = die;
5120 }
5121
5122 static inline dw_die_ref
5123 AT_ref (dw_attr_ref a)
5124 {
5125 gcc_assert (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_die_ref);
5126 return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_die_ref.die;
5127 }
5128
5129 static inline int
5130 AT_ref_external (dw_attr_ref a)
5131 {
5132 if (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_die_ref)
5133 return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_die_ref.external;
5134
5135 return 0;
5136 }
5137
5138 static inline void
5139 set_AT_ref_external (dw_attr_ref a, int i)
5140 {
5141 gcc_assert (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_die_ref);
5142 a->dw_attr_val.v.val_die_ref.external = i;
5143 }
5144
5145 /* Add an FDE reference attribute value to a DIE. */
5146
5147 static inline void
5148 add_AT_fde_ref (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind, unsigned int targ_fde)
5149 {
5150 dw_attr_node attr;
5151
5152 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
5153 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_fde_ref;
5154 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_fde_index = targ_fde;
5155 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
5156 }
5157
5158 /* Add a location description attribute value to a DIE. */
5159
5160 static inline void
5161 add_AT_loc (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind, dw_loc_descr_ref loc)
5162 {
5163 dw_attr_node attr;
5164
5165 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
5166 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_loc;
5167 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_loc = loc;
5168 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
5169 }
5170
5171 static inline dw_loc_descr_ref
5172 AT_loc (dw_attr_ref a)
5173 {
5174 gcc_assert (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_loc);
5175 return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_loc;
5176 }
5177
5178 static inline void
5179 add_AT_loc_list (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind, dw_loc_list_ref loc_list)
5180 {
5181 dw_attr_node attr;
5182
5183 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
5184 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_loc_list;
5185 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_loc_list = loc_list;
5186 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
5187 have_location_lists = true;
5188 }
5189
5190 static inline dw_loc_list_ref
5191 AT_loc_list (dw_attr_ref a)
5192 {
5193 gcc_assert (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_loc_list);
5194 return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_loc_list;
5195 }
5196
5197 /* Add an address constant attribute value to a DIE. */
5198
5199 static inline void
5200 add_AT_addr (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind, rtx addr)
5201 {
5202 dw_attr_node attr;
5203
5204 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
5205 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_addr;
5206 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_addr = addr;
5207 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
5208 }
5209
5210 /* Get the RTX from to an address DIE attribute. */
5211
5212 static inline rtx
5213 AT_addr (dw_attr_ref a)
5214 {
5215 gcc_assert (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_addr);
5216 return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_addr;
5217 }
5218
5219 /* Add a file attribute value to a DIE. */
5220
5221 static inline void
5222 add_AT_file (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,
5223 struct dwarf_file_data *fd)
5224 {
5225 dw_attr_node attr;
5226
5227 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
5228 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_file;
5229 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_file = fd;
5230 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
5231 }
5232
5233 /* Get the dwarf_file_data from a file DIE attribute. */
5234
5235 static inline struct dwarf_file_data *
5236 AT_file (dw_attr_ref a)
5237 {
5238 gcc_assert (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_file);
5239 return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_file;
5240 }
5241
5242 /* Add a label identifier attribute value to a DIE. */
5243
5244 static inline void
5245 add_AT_lbl_id (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind, const char *lbl_id)
5246 {
5247 dw_attr_node attr;
5248
5249 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
5250 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_lbl_id;
5251 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_lbl_id = xstrdup (lbl_id);
5252 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
5253 }
5254
5255 /* Add a section offset attribute value to a DIE, an offset into the
5256 debug_line section. */
5257
5258 static inline void
5259 add_AT_lineptr (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,
5260 const char *label)
5261 {
5262 dw_attr_node attr;
5263
5264 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
5265 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_lineptr;
5266 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_lbl_id = xstrdup (label);
5267 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
5268 }
5269
5270 /* Add a section offset attribute value to a DIE, an offset into the
5271 debug_macinfo section. */
5272
5273 static inline void
5274 add_AT_macptr (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,
5275 const char *label)
5276 {
5277 dw_attr_node attr;
5278
5279 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
5280 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_macptr;
5281 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_lbl_id = xstrdup (label);
5282 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
5283 }
5284
5285 /* Add an offset attribute value to a DIE. */
5286
5287 static inline void
5288 add_AT_offset (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,
5289 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT offset)
5290 {
5291 dw_attr_node attr;
5292
5293 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
5294 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_offset;
5295 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_offset = offset;
5296 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
5297 }
5298
5299 /* Add an range_list attribute value to a DIE. */
5300
5301 static void
5302 add_AT_range_list (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,
5303 long unsigned int offset)
5304 {
5305 dw_attr_node attr;
5306
5307 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
5308 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_range_list;
5309 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_offset = offset;
5310 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
5311 }
5312
5313 static inline const char *
5314 AT_lbl (dw_attr_ref a)
5315 {
5316 gcc_assert (a && (AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_lbl_id
5317 || AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_lineptr
5318 || AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_macptr));
5319 return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_lbl_id;
5320 }
5321
5322 /* Get the attribute of type attr_kind. */
5323
5324 static dw_attr_ref
5325 get_AT (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind)
5326 {
5327 dw_attr_ref a;
5328 unsigned ix;
5329 dw_die_ref spec = NULL;
5330
5331 if (! die)
5332 return NULL;
5333
5334 for (ix = 0; VEC_iterate (dw_attr_node, die->die_attr, ix, a); ix++)
5335 if (a->dw_attr == attr_kind)
5336 return a;
5337 else if (a->dw_attr == DW_AT_specification
5338 || a->dw_attr == DW_AT_abstract_origin)
5339 spec = AT_ref (a);
5340
5341 if (spec)
5342 return get_AT (spec, attr_kind);
5343
5344 return NULL;
5345 }
5346
5347 /* Return the "low pc" attribute value, typically associated with a subprogram
5348 DIE. Return null if the "low pc" attribute is either not present, or if it
5349 cannot be represented as an assembler label identifier. */
5350
5351 static inline const char *
5352 get_AT_low_pc (dw_die_ref die)
5353 {
5354 dw_attr_ref a = get_AT (die, DW_AT_low_pc);
5355
5356 return a ? AT_lbl (a) : NULL;
5357 }
5358
5359 /* Return the "high pc" attribute value, typically associated with a subprogram
5360 DIE. Return null if the "high pc" attribute is either not present, or if it
5361 cannot be represented as an assembler label identifier. */
5362
5363 static inline const char *
5364 get_AT_hi_pc (dw_die_ref die)
5365 {
5366 dw_attr_ref a = get_AT (die, DW_AT_high_pc);
5367
5368 return a ? AT_lbl (a) : NULL;
5369 }
5370
5371 /* Return the value of the string attribute designated by ATTR_KIND, or
5372 NULL if it is not present. */
5373
5374 static inline const char *
5375 get_AT_string (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind)
5376 {
5377 dw_attr_ref a = get_AT (die, attr_kind);
5378
5379 return a ? AT_string (a) : NULL;
5380 }
5381
5382 /* Return the value of the flag attribute designated by ATTR_KIND, or -1
5383 if it is not present. */
5384
5385 static inline int
5386 get_AT_flag (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind)
5387 {
5388 dw_attr_ref a = get_AT (die, attr_kind);
5389
5390 return a ? AT_flag (a) : 0;
5391 }
5392
5393 /* Return the value of the unsigned attribute designated by ATTR_KIND, or 0
5394 if it is not present. */
5395
5396 static inline unsigned
5397 get_AT_unsigned (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind)
5398 {
5399 dw_attr_ref a = get_AT (die, attr_kind);
5400
5401 return a ? AT_unsigned (a) : 0;
5402 }
5403
5404 static inline dw_die_ref
5405 get_AT_ref (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind)
5406 {
5407 dw_attr_ref a = get_AT (die, attr_kind);
5408
5409 return a ? AT_ref (a) : NULL;
5410 }
5411
5412 static inline struct dwarf_file_data *
5413 get_AT_file (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind)
5414 {
5415 dw_attr_ref a = get_AT (die, attr_kind);
5416
5417 return a ? AT_file (a) : NULL;
5418 }
5419
5420 /* Return TRUE if the language is C or C++. */
5421
5422 static inline bool
5423 is_c_family (void)
5424 {
5425 unsigned int lang = get_AT_unsigned (comp_unit_die, DW_AT_language);
5426
5427 return (lang == DW_LANG_C || lang == DW_LANG_C89 || lang == DW_LANG_ObjC
5428 || lang == DW_LANG_C99
5429 || lang == DW_LANG_C_plus_plus || lang == DW_LANG_ObjC_plus_plus);
5430 }
5431
5432 /* Return TRUE if the language is C++. */
5433
5434 static inline bool
5435 is_cxx (void)
5436 {
5437 unsigned int lang = get_AT_unsigned (comp_unit_die, DW_AT_language);
5438
5439 return lang == DW_LANG_C_plus_plus || lang == DW_LANG_ObjC_plus_plus;
5440 }
5441
5442 /* Return TRUE if the language is Fortran. */
5443
5444 static inline bool
5445 is_fortran (void)
5446 {
5447 unsigned int lang = get_AT_unsigned (comp_unit_die, DW_AT_language);
5448
5449 return (lang == DW_LANG_Fortran77
5450 || lang == DW_LANG_Fortran90
5451 || lang == DW_LANG_Fortran95);
5452 }
5453
5454 /* Return TRUE if the language is Java. */
5455
5456 static inline bool
5457 is_java (void)
5458 {
5459 unsigned int lang = get_AT_unsigned (comp_unit_die, DW_AT_language);
5460
5461 return lang == DW_LANG_Java;
5462 }
5463
5464 /* Return TRUE if the language is Ada. */
5465
5466 static inline bool
5467 is_ada (void)
5468 {
5469 unsigned int lang = get_AT_unsigned (comp_unit_die, DW_AT_language);
5470
5471 return lang == DW_LANG_Ada95 || lang == DW_LANG_Ada83;
5472 }
5473
5474 /* Remove the specified attribute if present. */
5475
5476 static void
5477 remove_AT (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind)
5478 {
5479 dw_attr_ref a;
5480 unsigned ix;
5481
5482 if (! die)
5483 return;
5484
5485 for (ix = 0; VEC_iterate (dw_attr_node, die->die_attr, ix, a); ix++)
5486 if (a->dw_attr == attr_kind)
5487 {
5488 if (AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_str)
5489 if (a->dw_attr_val.v.val_str->refcount)
5490 a->dw_attr_val.v.val_str->refcount--;
5491
5492 /* VEC_ordered_remove should help reduce the number of abbrevs
5493 that are needed. */
5494 VEC_ordered_remove (dw_attr_node, die->die_attr, ix);
5495 return;
5496 }
5497 }
5498
5499 /* Remove CHILD from its parent. PREV must have the property that
5500 PREV->DIE_SIB == CHILD. Does not alter CHILD. */
5501
5502 static void
5503 remove_child_with_prev (dw_die_ref child, dw_die_ref prev)
5504 {
5505 gcc_assert (child->die_parent == prev->die_parent);
5506 gcc_assert (prev->die_sib == child);
5507 if (prev == child)
5508 {
5509 gcc_assert (child->die_parent->die_child == child);
5510 prev = NULL;
5511 }
5512 else
5513 prev->die_sib = child->die_sib;
5514 if (child->die_parent->die_child == child)
5515 child->die_parent->die_child = prev;
5516 }
5517
5518 /* Remove child DIE whose die_tag is TAG. Do nothing if no child
5519 matches TAG. */
5520
5521 static void
5522 remove_child_TAG (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_tag tag)
5523 {
5524 dw_die_ref c;
5525
5526 c = die->die_child;
5527 if (c) do {
5528 dw_die_ref prev = c;
5529 c = c->die_sib;
5530 while (c->die_tag == tag)
5531 {
5532 remove_child_with_prev (c, prev);
5533 /* Might have removed every child. */
5534 if (c == c->die_sib)
5535 return;
5536 c = c->die_sib;
5537 }
5538 } while (c != die->die_child);
5539 }
5540
5541 /* Add a CHILD_DIE as the last child of DIE. */
5542
5543 static void
5544 add_child_die (dw_die_ref die, dw_die_ref child_die)
5545 {
5546 /* FIXME this should probably be an assert. */
5547 if (! die || ! child_die)
5548 return;
5549 gcc_assert (die != child_die);
5550
5551 child_die->die_parent = die;
5552 if (die->die_child)
5553 {
5554 child_die->die_sib = die->die_child->die_sib;
5555 die->die_child->die_sib = child_die;
5556 }
5557 else
5558 child_die->die_sib = child_die;
5559 die->die_child = child_die;
5560 }
5561
5562 /* Move CHILD, which must be a child of PARENT or the DIE for which PARENT
5563 is the specification, to the end of PARENT's list of children.
5564 This is done by removing and re-adding it. */
5565
5566 static void
5567 splice_child_die (dw_die_ref parent, dw_die_ref child)
5568 {
5569 dw_die_ref p;
5570
5571 /* We want the declaration DIE from inside the class, not the
5572 specification DIE at toplevel. */
5573 if (child->die_parent != parent)
5574 {
5575 dw_die_ref tmp = get_AT_ref (child, DW_AT_specification);
5576
5577 if (tmp)
5578 child = tmp;
5579 }
5580
5581 gcc_assert (child->die_parent == parent
5582 || (child->die_parent
5583 == get_AT_ref (parent, DW_AT_specification)));
5584
5585 for (p = child->die_parent->die_child; ; p = p->die_sib)
5586 if (p->die_sib == child)
5587 {
5588 remove_child_with_prev (child, p);
5589 break;
5590 }
5591
5592 add_child_die (parent, child);
5593 }
5594
5595 /* Return a pointer to a newly created DIE node. */
5596
5597 static inline dw_die_ref
5598 new_die (enum dwarf_tag tag_value, dw_die_ref parent_die, tree t)
5599 {
5600 dw_die_ref die = ggc_alloc_cleared (sizeof (die_node));
5601
5602 die->die_tag = tag_value;
5603
5604 if (parent_die != NULL)
5605 add_child_die (parent_die, die);
5606 else
5607 {
5608 limbo_die_node *limbo_node;
5609
5610 limbo_node = ggc_alloc_cleared (sizeof (limbo_die_node));
5611 limbo_node->die = die;
5612 limbo_node->created_for = t;
5613 limbo_node->next = limbo_die_list;
5614 limbo_die_list = limbo_node;
5615 }
5616
5617 return die;
5618 }
5619
5620 /* Return the DIE associated with the given type specifier. */
5621
5622 static inline dw_die_ref
5623 lookup_type_die (tree type)
5624 {
5625 return TYPE_SYMTAB_DIE (type);
5626 }
5627
5628 /* Equate a DIE to a given type specifier. */
5629
5630 static inline void
5631 equate_type_number_to_die (tree type, dw_die_ref type_die)
5632 {
5633 TYPE_SYMTAB_DIE (type) = type_die;
5634 }
5635
5636 /* Returns a hash value for X (which really is a die_struct). */
5637
5638 static hashval_t
5639 decl_die_table_hash (const void *x)
5640 {
5641 return (hashval_t) ((const dw_die_ref) x)->decl_id;
5642 }
5643
5644 /* Return nonzero if decl_id of die_struct X is the same as UID of decl *Y. */
5645
5646 static int
5647 decl_die_table_eq (const void *x, const void *y)
5648 {
5649 return (((const dw_die_ref) x)->decl_id == DECL_UID ((const tree) y));
5650 }
5651
5652 /* Return the DIE associated with a given declaration. */
5653
5654 static inline dw_die_ref
5655 lookup_decl_die (tree decl)
5656 {
5657 return htab_find_with_hash (decl_die_table, decl, DECL_UID (decl));
5658 }
5659
5660 /* Returns a hash value for X (which really is a var_loc_list). */
5661
5662 static hashval_t
5663 decl_loc_table_hash (const void *x)
5664 {
5665 return (hashval_t) ((const var_loc_list *) x)->decl_id;
5666 }
5667
5668 /* Return nonzero if decl_id of var_loc_list X is the same as
5669 UID of decl *Y. */
5670
5671 static int
5672 decl_loc_table_eq (const void *x, const void *y)
5673 {
5674 return (((const var_loc_list *) x)->decl_id == DECL_UID ((const tree) y));
5675 }
5676
5677 /* Return the var_loc list associated with a given declaration. */
5678
5679 static inline var_loc_list *
5680 lookup_decl_loc (tree decl)
5681 {
5682 return htab_find_with_hash (decl_loc_table, decl, DECL_UID (decl));
5683 }
5684
5685 /* Equate a DIE to a particular declaration. */
5686
5687 static void
5688 equate_decl_number_to_die (tree decl, dw_die_ref decl_die)
5689 {
5690 unsigned int decl_id = DECL_UID (decl);
5691 void **slot;
5692
5693 slot = htab_find_slot_with_hash (decl_die_table, decl, decl_id, INSERT);
5694 *slot = decl_die;
5695 decl_die->decl_id = decl_id;
5696 }
5697
5698 /* Add a variable location node to the linked list for DECL. */
5699
5700 static void
5701 add_var_loc_to_decl (tree decl, struct var_loc_node *loc)
5702 {
5703 unsigned int decl_id = DECL_UID (decl);
5704 var_loc_list *temp;
5705 void **slot;
5706
5707 slot = htab_find_slot_with_hash (decl_loc_table, decl, decl_id, INSERT);
5708 if (*slot == NULL)
5709 {
5710 temp = ggc_alloc_cleared (sizeof (var_loc_list));
5711 temp->decl_id = decl_id;
5712 *slot = temp;
5713 }
5714 else
5715 temp = *slot;
5716
5717 if (temp->last)
5718 {
5719 /* If the current location is the same as the end of the list,
5720 we have nothing to do. */
5721 if (!rtx_equal_p (NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_LOC (temp->last->var_loc_note),
5722 NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_LOC (loc->var_loc_note)))
5723 {
5724 /* Add LOC to the end of list and update LAST. */
5725 temp->last->next = loc;
5726 temp->last = loc;
5727 }
5728 }
5729 /* Do not add empty location to the beginning of the list. */
5730 else if (NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_LOC (loc->var_loc_note) != NULL_RTX)
5731 {
5732 temp->first = loc;
5733 temp->last = loc;
5734 }
5735 }
5736 \f
5737 /* Keep track of the number of spaces used to indent the
5738 output of the debugging routines that print the structure of
5739 the DIE internal representation. */
5740 static int print_indent;
5741
5742 /* Indent the line the number of spaces given by print_indent. */
5743
5744 static inline void
5745 print_spaces (FILE *outfile)
5746 {
5747 fprintf (outfile, "%*s", print_indent, "");
5748 }
5749
5750 /* Print the information associated with a given DIE, and its children.
5751 This routine is a debugging aid only. */
5752
5753 static void
5754 print_die (dw_die_ref die, FILE *outfile)
5755 {
5756 dw_attr_ref a;
5757 dw_die_ref c;
5758 unsigned ix;
5759
5760 print_spaces (outfile);
5761 fprintf (outfile, "DIE %4lu: %s\n",
5762 die->die_offset, dwarf_tag_name (die->die_tag));
5763 print_spaces (outfile);
5764 fprintf (outfile, " abbrev id: %lu", die->die_abbrev);
5765 fprintf (outfile, " offset: %lu\n", die->die_offset);
5766
5767 for (ix = 0; VEC_iterate (dw_attr_node, die->die_attr, ix, a); ix++)
5768 {
5769 print_spaces (outfile);
5770 fprintf (outfile, " %s: ", dwarf_attr_name (a->dw_attr));
5771
5772 switch (AT_class (a))
5773 {
5774 case dw_val_class_addr:
5775 fprintf (outfile, "address");
5776 break;
5777 case dw_val_class_offset:
5778 fprintf (outfile, "offset");
5779 break;
5780 case dw_val_class_loc:
5781 fprintf (outfile, "location descriptor");
5782 break;
5783 case dw_val_class_loc_list:
5784 fprintf (outfile, "location list -> label:%s",
5785 AT_loc_list (a)->ll_symbol);
5786 break;
5787 case dw_val_class_range_list:
5788 fprintf (outfile, "range list");
5789 break;
5790 case dw_val_class_const:
5791 fprintf (outfile, HOST_WIDE_INT_PRINT_DEC, AT_int (a));
5792 break;
5793 case dw_val_class_unsigned_const:
5794 fprintf (outfile, HOST_WIDE_INT_PRINT_UNSIGNED, AT_unsigned (a));
5795 break;
5796 case dw_val_class_long_long:
5797 fprintf (outfile, "constant (%lu,%lu)",
5798 a->dw_attr_val.v.val_long_long.hi,
5799 a->dw_attr_val.v.val_long_long.low);
5800 break;
5801 case dw_val_class_vec:
5802 fprintf (outfile, "floating-point or vector constant");
5803 break;
5804 case dw_val_class_flag:
5805 fprintf (outfile, "%u", AT_flag (a));
5806 break;
5807 case dw_val_class_die_ref:
5808 if (AT_ref (a) != NULL)
5809 {
5810 if (AT_ref (a)->die_symbol)
5811 fprintf (outfile, "die -> label: %s", AT_ref (a)->die_symbol);
5812 else
5813 fprintf (outfile, "die -> %lu", AT_ref (a)->die_offset);
5814 }
5815 else
5816 fprintf (outfile, "die -> <null>");
5817 break;
5818 case dw_val_class_lbl_id:
5819 case dw_val_class_lineptr:
5820 case dw_val_class_macptr:
5821 fprintf (outfile, "label: %s", AT_lbl (a));
5822 break;
5823 case dw_val_class_str:
5824 if (AT_string (a) != NULL)
5825 fprintf (outfile, "\"%s\"", AT_string (a));
5826 else
5827 fprintf (outfile, "<null>");
5828 break;
5829 case dw_val_class_file:
5830 fprintf (outfile, "\"%s\" (%d)", AT_file (a)->filename,
5831 AT_file (a)->emitted_number);
5832 break;
5833 default:
5834 break;
5835 }
5836
5837 fprintf (outfile, "\n");
5838 }
5839
5840 if (die->die_child != NULL)
5841 {
5842 print_indent += 4;
5843 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, print_die (c, outfile));
5844 print_indent -= 4;
5845 }
5846 if (print_indent == 0)
5847 fprintf (outfile, "\n");
5848 }
5849
5850 /* Print the contents of the source code line number correspondence table.
5851 This routine is a debugging aid only. */
5852
5853 static void
5854 print_dwarf_line_table (FILE *outfile)
5855 {
5856 unsigned i;
5857 dw_line_info_ref line_info;
5858
5859 fprintf (outfile, "\n\nDWARF source line information\n");
5860 for (i = 1; i < line_info_table_in_use; i++)
5861 {
5862 line_info = &line_info_table[i];
5863 fprintf (outfile, "%5d: %4ld %6ld\n", i,
5864 line_info->dw_file_num,
5865 line_info->dw_line_num);
5866 }
5867
5868 fprintf (outfile, "\n\n");
5869 }
5870
5871 /* Print the information collected for a given DIE. */
5872
5873 void
5874 debug_dwarf_die (dw_die_ref die)
5875 {
5876 print_die (die, stderr);
5877 }
5878
5879 /* Print all DWARF information collected for the compilation unit.
5880 This routine is a debugging aid only. */
5881
5882 void
5883 debug_dwarf (void)
5884 {
5885 print_indent = 0;
5886 print_die (comp_unit_die, stderr);
5887 if (! DWARF2_ASM_LINE_DEBUG_INFO)
5888 print_dwarf_line_table (stderr);
5889 }
5890 \f
5891 /* Start a new compilation unit DIE for an include file. OLD_UNIT is the CU
5892 for the enclosing include file, if any. BINCL_DIE is the DW_TAG_GNU_BINCL
5893 DIE that marks the start of the DIEs for this include file. */
5894
5895 static dw_die_ref
5896 push_new_compile_unit (dw_die_ref old_unit, dw_die_ref bincl_die)
5897 {
5898 const char *filename = get_AT_string (bincl_die, DW_AT_name);
5899 dw_die_ref new_unit = gen_compile_unit_die (filename);
5900
5901 new_unit->die_sib = old_unit;
5902 return new_unit;
5903 }
5904
5905 /* Close an include-file CU and reopen the enclosing one. */
5906
5907 static dw_die_ref
5908 pop_compile_unit (dw_die_ref old_unit)
5909 {
5910 dw_die_ref new_unit = old_unit->die_sib;
5911
5912 old_unit->die_sib = NULL;
5913 return new_unit;
5914 }
5915
5916 #define CHECKSUM(FOO) md5_process_bytes (&(FOO), sizeof (FOO), ctx)
5917 #define CHECKSUM_STRING(FOO) md5_process_bytes ((FOO), strlen (FOO), ctx)
5918
5919 /* Calculate the checksum of a location expression. */
5920
5921 static inline void
5922 loc_checksum (dw_loc_descr_ref loc, struct md5_ctx *ctx)
5923 {
5924 CHECKSUM (loc->dw_loc_opc);
5925 CHECKSUM (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1);
5926 CHECKSUM (loc->dw_loc_oprnd2);
5927 }
5928
5929 /* Calculate the checksum of an attribute. */
5930
5931 static void
5932 attr_checksum (dw_attr_ref at, struct md5_ctx *ctx, int *mark)
5933 {
5934 dw_loc_descr_ref loc;
5935 rtx r;
5936
5937 CHECKSUM (at->dw_attr);
5938
5939 /* We don't care that this was compiled with a different compiler
5940 snapshot; if the output is the same, that's what matters. */
5941 if (at->dw_attr == DW_AT_producer)
5942 return;
5943
5944 switch (AT_class (at))
5945 {
5946 case dw_val_class_const:
5947 CHECKSUM (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_int);
5948 break;
5949 case dw_val_class_unsigned_const:
5950 CHECKSUM (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_unsigned);
5951 break;
5952 case dw_val_class_long_long:
5953 CHECKSUM (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_long_long);
5954 break;
5955 case dw_val_class_vec:
5956 CHECKSUM (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_vec);
5957 break;
5958 case dw_val_class_flag:
5959 CHECKSUM (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_flag);
5960 break;
5961 case dw_val_class_str:
5962 CHECKSUM_STRING (AT_string (at));
5963 break;
5964
5965 case dw_val_class_addr:
5966 r = AT_addr (at);
5967 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (r) == SYMBOL_REF);
5968 CHECKSUM_STRING (XSTR (r, 0));
5969 break;
5970
5971 case dw_val_class_offset:
5972 CHECKSUM (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_offset);
5973 break;
5974
5975 case dw_val_class_loc:
5976 for (loc = AT_loc (at); loc; loc = loc->dw_loc_next)
5977 loc_checksum (loc, ctx);
5978 break;
5979
5980 case dw_val_class_die_ref:
5981 die_checksum (AT_ref (at), ctx, mark);
5982 break;
5983
5984 case dw_val_class_fde_ref:
5985 case dw_val_class_lbl_id:
5986 case dw_val_class_lineptr:
5987 case dw_val_class_macptr:
5988 break;
5989
5990 case dw_val_class_file:
5991 CHECKSUM_STRING (AT_file (at)->filename);
5992 break;
5993
5994 default:
5995 break;
5996 }
5997 }
5998
5999 /* Calculate the checksum of a DIE. */
6000
6001 static void
6002 die_checksum (dw_die_ref die, struct md5_ctx *ctx, int *mark)
6003 {
6004 dw_die_ref c;
6005 dw_attr_ref a;
6006 unsigned ix;
6007
6008 /* To avoid infinite recursion. */
6009 if (die->die_mark)
6010 {
6011 CHECKSUM (die->die_mark);
6012 return;
6013 }
6014 die->die_mark = ++(*mark);
6015
6016 CHECKSUM (die->die_tag);
6017
6018 for (ix = 0; VEC_iterate (dw_attr_node, die->die_attr, ix, a); ix++)
6019 attr_checksum (a, ctx, mark);
6020
6021 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, die_checksum (c, ctx, mark));
6022 }
6023
6024 #undef CHECKSUM
6025 #undef CHECKSUM_STRING
6026
6027 /* Do the location expressions look same? */
6028 static inline int
6029 same_loc_p (dw_loc_descr_ref loc1, dw_loc_descr_ref loc2, int *mark)
6030 {
6031 return loc1->dw_loc_opc == loc2->dw_loc_opc
6032 && same_dw_val_p (&loc1->dw_loc_oprnd1, &loc2->dw_loc_oprnd1, mark)
6033 && same_dw_val_p (&loc1->dw_loc_oprnd2, &loc2->dw_loc_oprnd2, mark);
6034 }
6035
6036 /* Do the values look the same? */
6037 static int
6038 same_dw_val_p (dw_val_node *v1, dw_val_node *v2, int *mark)
6039 {
6040 dw_loc_descr_ref loc1, loc2;
6041 rtx r1, r2;
6042
6043 if (v1->val_class != v2->val_class)
6044 return 0;
6045
6046 switch (v1->val_class)
6047 {
6048 case dw_val_class_const:
6049 return v1->v.val_int == v2->v.val_int;
6050 case dw_val_class_unsigned_const:
6051 return v1->v.val_unsigned == v2->v.val_unsigned;
6052 case dw_val_class_long_long:
6053 return v1->v.val_long_long.hi == v2->v.val_long_long.hi
6054 && v1->v.val_long_long.low == v2->v.val_long_long.low;
6055 case dw_val_class_vec:
6056 if (v1->v.val_vec.length != v2->v.val_vec.length
6057 || v1->v.val_vec.elt_size != v2->v.val_vec.elt_size)
6058 return 0;
6059 if (memcmp (v1->v.val_vec.array, v2->v.val_vec.array,
6060 v1->v.val_vec.length * v1->v.val_vec.elt_size))
6061 return 0;
6062 return 1;
6063 case dw_val_class_flag:
6064 return v1->v.val_flag == v2->v.val_flag;
6065 case dw_val_class_str:
6066 return !strcmp(v1->v.val_str->str, v2->v.val_str->str);
6067
6068 case dw_val_class_addr:
6069 r1 = v1->v.val_addr;
6070 r2 = v2->v.val_addr;
6071 if (GET_CODE (r1) != GET_CODE (r2))
6072 return 0;
6073 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (r1) == SYMBOL_REF);
6074 return !strcmp (XSTR (r1, 0), XSTR (r2, 0));
6075
6076 case dw_val_class_offset:
6077 return v1->v.val_offset == v2->v.val_offset;
6078
6079 case dw_val_class_loc:
6080 for (loc1 = v1->v.val_loc, loc2 = v2->v.val_loc;
6081 loc1 && loc2;
6082 loc1 = loc1->dw_loc_next, loc2 = loc2->dw_loc_next)
6083 if (!same_loc_p (loc1, loc2, mark))
6084 return 0;
6085 return !loc1 && !loc2;
6086
6087 case dw_val_class_die_ref:
6088 return same_die_p (v1->v.val_die_ref.die, v2->v.val_die_ref.die, mark);
6089
6090 case dw_val_class_fde_ref:
6091 case dw_val_class_lbl_id:
6092 case dw_val_class_lineptr:
6093 case dw_val_class_macptr:
6094 return 1;
6095
6096 case dw_val_class_file:
6097 return v1->v.val_file == v2->v.val_file;
6098
6099 default:
6100 return 1;
6101 }
6102 }
6103
6104 /* Do the attributes look the same? */
6105
6106 static int
6107 same_attr_p (dw_attr_ref at1, dw_attr_ref at2, int *mark)
6108 {
6109 if (at1->dw_attr != at2->dw_attr)
6110 return 0;
6111
6112 /* We don't care that this was compiled with a different compiler
6113 snapshot; if the output is the same, that's what matters. */
6114 if (at1->dw_attr == DW_AT_producer)
6115 return 1;
6116
6117 return same_dw_val_p (&at1->dw_attr_val, &at2->dw_attr_val, mark);
6118 }
6119
6120 /* Do the dies look the same? */
6121
6122 static int
6123 same_die_p (dw_die_ref die1, dw_die_ref die2, int *mark)
6124 {
6125 dw_die_ref c1, c2;
6126 dw_attr_ref a1;
6127 unsigned ix;
6128
6129 /* To avoid infinite recursion. */
6130 if (die1->die_mark)
6131 return die1->die_mark == die2->die_mark;
6132 die1->die_mark = die2->die_mark = ++(*mark);
6133
6134 if (die1->die_tag != die2->die_tag)
6135 return 0;
6136
6137 if (VEC_length (dw_attr_node, die1->die_attr)
6138 != VEC_length (dw_attr_node, die2->die_attr))
6139 return 0;
6140
6141 for (ix = 0; VEC_iterate (dw_attr_node, die1->die_attr, ix, a1); ix++)
6142 if (!same_attr_p (a1, VEC_index (dw_attr_node, die2->die_attr, ix), mark))
6143 return 0;
6144
6145 c1 = die1->die_child;
6146 c2 = die2->die_child;
6147 if (! c1)
6148 {
6149 if (c2)
6150 return 0;
6151 }
6152 else
6153 for (;;)
6154 {
6155 if (!same_die_p (c1, c2, mark))
6156 return 0;
6157 c1 = c1->die_sib;
6158 c2 = c2->die_sib;
6159 if (c1 == die1->die_child)
6160 {
6161 if (c2 == die2->die_child)
6162 break;
6163 else
6164 return 0;
6165 }
6166 }
6167
6168 return 1;
6169 }
6170
6171 /* Do the dies look the same? Wrapper around same_die_p. */
6172
6173 static int
6174 same_die_p_wrap (dw_die_ref die1, dw_die_ref die2)
6175 {
6176 int mark = 0;
6177 int ret = same_die_p (die1, die2, &mark);
6178
6179 unmark_all_dies (die1);
6180 unmark_all_dies (die2);
6181
6182 return ret;
6183 }
6184
6185 /* The prefix to attach to symbols on DIEs in the current comdat debug
6186 info section. */
6187 static char *comdat_symbol_id;
6188
6189 /* The index of the current symbol within the current comdat CU. */
6190 static unsigned int comdat_symbol_number;
6191
6192 /* Calculate the MD5 checksum of the compilation unit DIE UNIT_DIE and its
6193 children, and set comdat_symbol_id accordingly. */
6194
6195 static void
6196 compute_section_prefix (dw_die_ref unit_die)
6197 {
6198 const char *die_name = get_AT_string (unit_die, DW_AT_name);
6199 const char *base = die_name ? lbasename (die_name) : "anonymous";
6200 char *name = alloca (strlen (base) + 64);
6201 char *p;
6202 int i, mark;
6203 unsigned char checksum[16];
6204 struct md5_ctx ctx;
6205
6206 /* Compute the checksum of the DIE, then append part of it as hex digits to
6207 the name filename of the unit. */
6208
6209 md5_init_ctx (&ctx);
6210 mark = 0;
6211 die_checksum (unit_die, &ctx, &mark);
6212 unmark_all_dies (unit_die);
6213 md5_finish_ctx (&ctx, checksum);
6214
6215 sprintf (name, "%s.", base);
6216 clean_symbol_name (name);
6217
6218 p = name + strlen (name);
6219 for (i = 0; i < 4; i++)
6220 {
6221 sprintf (p, "%.2x", checksum[i]);
6222 p += 2;
6223 }
6224
6225 comdat_symbol_id = unit_die->die_symbol = xstrdup (name);
6226 comdat_symbol_number = 0;
6227 }
6228
6229 /* Returns nonzero if DIE represents a type, in the sense of TYPE_P. */
6230
6231 static int
6232 is_type_die (dw_die_ref die)
6233 {
6234 switch (die->die_tag)
6235 {
6236 case DW_TAG_array_type:
6237 case DW_TAG_class_type:
6238 case DW_TAG_enumeration_type:
6239 case DW_TAG_pointer_type:
6240 case DW_TAG_reference_type:
6241 case DW_TAG_string_type:
6242 case DW_TAG_structure_type:
6243 case DW_TAG_subroutine_type:
6244 case DW_TAG_union_type:
6245 case DW_TAG_ptr_to_member_type:
6246 case DW_TAG_set_type:
6247 case DW_TAG_subrange_type:
6248 case DW_TAG_base_type:
6249 case DW_TAG_const_type:
6250 case DW_TAG_file_type:
6251 case DW_TAG_packed_type:
6252 case DW_TAG_volatile_type:
6253 case DW_TAG_typedef:
6254 return 1;
6255 default:
6256 return 0;
6257 }
6258 }
6259
6260 /* Returns 1 iff C is the sort of DIE that should go into a COMDAT CU.
6261 Basically, we want to choose the bits that are likely to be shared between
6262 compilations (types) and leave out the bits that are specific to individual
6263 compilations (functions). */
6264
6265 static int
6266 is_comdat_die (dw_die_ref c)
6267 {
6268 /* I think we want to leave base types and __vtbl_ptr_type in the main CU, as
6269 we do for stabs. The advantage is a greater likelihood of sharing between
6270 objects that don't include headers in the same order (and therefore would
6271 put the base types in a different comdat). jason 8/28/00 */
6272
6273 if (c->die_tag == DW_TAG_base_type)
6274 return 0;
6275
6276 if (c->die_tag == DW_TAG_pointer_type
6277 || c->die_tag == DW_TAG_reference_type
6278 || c->die_tag == DW_TAG_const_type
6279 || c->die_tag == DW_TAG_volatile_type)
6280 {
6281 dw_die_ref t = get_AT_ref (c, DW_AT_type);
6282
6283 return t ? is_comdat_die (t) : 0;
6284 }
6285
6286 return is_type_die (c);
6287 }
6288
6289 /* Returns 1 iff C is the sort of DIE that might be referred to from another
6290 compilation unit. */
6291
6292 static int
6293 is_symbol_die (dw_die_ref c)
6294 {
6295 return (is_type_die (c)
6296 || (get_AT (c, DW_AT_declaration)
6297 && !get_AT (c, DW_AT_specification))
6298 || c->die_tag == DW_TAG_namespace);
6299 }
6300
6301 static char *
6302 gen_internal_sym (const char *prefix)
6303 {
6304 char buf[256];
6305
6306 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (buf, prefix, label_num++);
6307 return xstrdup (buf);
6308 }
6309
6310 /* Assign symbols to all worthy DIEs under DIE. */
6311
6312 static void
6313 assign_symbol_names (dw_die_ref die)
6314 {
6315 dw_die_ref c;
6316
6317 if (is_symbol_die (die))
6318 {
6319 if (comdat_symbol_id)
6320 {
6321 char *p = alloca (strlen (comdat_symbol_id) + 64);
6322
6323 sprintf (p, "%s.%s.%x", DIE_LABEL_PREFIX,
6324 comdat_symbol_id, comdat_symbol_number++);
6325 die->die_symbol = xstrdup (p);
6326 }
6327 else
6328 die->die_symbol = gen_internal_sym ("LDIE");
6329 }
6330
6331 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, assign_symbol_names (c));
6332 }
6333
6334 struct cu_hash_table_entry
6335 {
6336 dw_die_ref cu;
6337 unsigned min_comdat_num, max_comdat_num;
6338 struct cu_hash_table_entry *next;
6339 };
6340
6341 /* Routines to manipulate hash table of CUs. */
6342 static hashval_t
6343 htab_cu_hash (const void *of)
6344 {
6345 const struct cu_hash_table_entry *entry = of;
6346
6347 return htab_hash_string (entry->cu->die_symbol);
6348 }
6349
6350 static int
6351 htab_cu_eq (const void *of1, const void *of2)
6352 {
6353 const struct cu_hash_table_entry *entry1 = of1;
6354 const struct die_struct *entry2 = of2;
6355
6356 return !strcmp (entry1->cu->die_symbol, entry2->die_symbol);
6357 }
6358
6359 static void
6360 htab_cu_del (void *what)
6361 {
6362 struct cu_hash_table_entry *next, *entry = what;
6363
6364 while (entry)
6365 {
6366 next = entry->next;
6367 free (entry);
6368 entry = next;
6369 }
6370 }
6371
6372 /* Check whether we have already seen this CU and set up SYM_NUM
6373 accordingly. */
6374 static int
6375 check_duplicate_cu (dw_die_ref cu, htab_t htable, unsigned int *sym_num)
6376 {
6377 struct cu_hash_table_entry dummy;
6378 struct cu_hash_table_entry **slot, *entry, *last = &dummy;
6379
6380 dummy.max_comdat_num = 0;
6381
6382 slot = (struct cu_hash_table_entry **)
6383 htab_find_slot_with_hash (htable, cu, htab_hash_string (cu->die_symbol),
6384 INSERT);
6385 entry = *slot;
6386
6387 for (; entry; last = entry, entry = entry->next)
6388 {
6389 if (same_die_p_wrap (cu, entry->cu))
6390 break;
6391 }
6392
6393 if (entry)
6394 {
6395 *sym_num = entry->min_comdat_num;
6396 return 1;
6397 }
6398
6399 entry = XCNEW (struct cu_hash_table_entry);
6400 entry->cu = cu;
6401 entry->min_comdat_num = *sym_num = last->max_comdat_num;
6402 entry->next = *slot;
6403 *slot = entry;
6404
6405 return 0;
6406 }
6407
6408 /* Record SYM_NUM to record of CU in HTABLE. */
6409 static void
6410 record_comdat_symbol_number (dw_die_ref cu, htab_t htable, unsigned int sym_num)
6411 {
6412 struct cu_hash_table_entry **slot, *entry;
6413
6414 slot = (struct cu_hash_table_entry **)
6415 htab_find_slot_with_hash (htable, cu, htab_hash_string (cu->die_symbol),
6416 NO_INSERT);
6417 entry = *slot;
6418
6419 entry->max_comdat_num = sym_num;
6420 }
6421
6422 /* Traverse the DIE (which is always comp_unit_die), and set up
6423 additional compilation units for each of the include files we see
6424 bracketed by BINCL/EINCL. */
6425
6426 static void
6427 break_out_includes (dw_die_ref die)
6428 {
6429 dw_die_ref c;
6430 dw_die_ref unit = NULL;
6431 limbo_die_node *node, **pnode;
6432 htab_t cu_hash_table;
6433
6434 c = die->die_child;
6435 if (c) do {
6436 dw_die_ref prev = c;
6437 c = c->die_sib;
6438 while (c->die_tag == DW_TAG_GNU_BINCL || c->die_tag == DW_TAG_GNU_EINCL
6439 || (unit && is_comdat_die (c)))
6440 {
6441 dw_die_ref next = c->die_sib;
6442
6443 /* This DIE is for a secondary CU; remove it from the main one. */
6444 remove_child_with_prev (c, prev);
6445
6446 if (c->die_tag == DW_TAG_GNU_BINCL)
6447 unit = push_new_compile_unit (unit, c);
6448 else if (c->die_tag == DW_TAG_GNU_EINCL)
6449 unit = pop_compile_unit (unit);
6450 else
6451 add_child_die (unit, c);
6452 c = next;
6453 if (c == die->die_child)
6454 break;
6455 }
6456 } while (c != die->die_child);
6457
6458 #if 0
6459 /* We can only use this in debugging, since the frontend doesn't check
6460 to make sure that we leave every include file we enter. */
6461 gcc_assert (!unit);
6462 #endif
6463
6464 assign_symbol_names (die);
6465 cu_hash_table = htab_create (10, htab_cu_hash, htab_cu_eq, htab_cu_del);
6466 for (node = limbo_die_list, pnode = &limbo_die_list;
6467 node;
6468 node = node->next)
6469 {
6470 int is_dupl;
6471
6472 compute_section_prefix (node->die);
6473 is_dupl = check_duplicate_cu (node->die, cu_hash_table,
6474 &comdat_symbol_number);
6475 assign_symbol_names (node->die);
6476 if (is_dupl)
6477 *pnode = node->next;
6478 else
6479 {
6480 pnode = &node->next;
6481 record_comdat_symbol_number (node->die, cu_hash_table,
6482 comdat_symbol_number);
6483 }
6484 }
6485 htab_delete (cu_hash_table);
6486 }
6487
6488 /* Traverse the DIE and add a sibling attribute if it may have the
6489 effect of speeding up access to siblings. To save some space,
6490 avoid generating sibling attributes for DIE's without children. */
6491
6492 static void
6493 add_sibling_attributes (dw_die_ref die)
6494 {
6495 dw_die_ref c;
6496
6497 if (! die->die_child)
6498 return;
6499
6500 if (die->die_parent && die != die->die_parent->die_child)
6501 add_AT_die_ref (die, DW_AT_sibling, die->die_sib);
6502
6503 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, add_sibling_attributes (c));
6504 }
6505
6506 /* Output all location lists for the DIE and its children. */
6507
6508 static void
6509 output_location_lists (dw_die_ref die)
6510 {
6511 dw_die_ref c;
6512 dw_attr_ref a;
6513 unsigned ix;
6514
6515 for (ix = 0; VEC_iterate (dw_attr_node, die->die_attr, ix, a); ix++)
6516 if (AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_loc_list)
6517 output_loc_list (AT_loc_list (a));
6518
6519 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, output_location_lists (c));
6520 }
6521
6522 /* The format of each DIE (and its attribute value pairs) is encoded in an
6523 abbreviation table. This routine builds the abbreviation table and assigns
6524 a unique abbreviation id for each abbreviation entry. The children of each
6525 die are visited recursively. */
6526
6527 static void
6528 build_abbrev_table (dw_die_ref die)
6529 {
6530 unsigned long abbrev_id;
6531 unsigned int n_alloc;
6532 dw_die_ref c;
6533 dw_attr_ref a;
6534 unsigned ix;
6535
6536 /* Scan the DIE references, and mark as external any that refer to
6537 DIEs from other CUs (i.e. those which are not marked). */
6538 for (ix = 0; VEC_iterate (dw_attr_node, die->die_attr, ix, a); ix++)
6539 if (AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_die_ref
6540 && AT_ref (a)->die_mark == 0)
6541 {
6542 gcc_assert (AT_ref (a)->die_symbol);
6543
6544 set_AT_ref_external (a, 1);
6545 }
6546
6547 for (abbrev_id = 1; abbrev_id < abbrev_die_table_in_use; ++abbrev_id)
6548 {
6549 dw_die_ref abbrev = abbrev_die_table[abbrev_id];
6550 dw_attr_ref die_a, abbrev_a;
6551 unsigned ix;
6552 bool ok = true;
6553
6554 if (abbrev->die_tag != die->die_tag)
6555 continue;
6556 if ((abbrev->die_child != NULL) != (die->die_child != NULL))
6557 continue;
6558
6559 if (VEC_length (dw_attr_node, abbrev->die_attr)
6560 != VEC_length (dw_attr_node, die->die_attr))
6561 continue;
6562
6563 for (ix = 0; VEC_iterate (dw_attr_node, die->die_attr, ix, die_a); ix++)
6564 {
6565 abbrev_a = VEC_index (dw_attr_node, abbrev->die_attr, ix);
6566 if ((abbrev_a->dw_attr != die_a->dw_attr)
6567 || (value_format (abbrev_a) != value_format (die_a)))
6568 {
6569 ok = false;
6570 break;
6571 }
6572 }
6573 if (ok)
6574 break;
6575 }
6576
6577 if (abbrev_id >= abbrev_die_table_in_use)
6578 {
6579 if (abbrev_die_table_in_use >= abbrev_die_table_allocated)
6580 {
6581 n_alloc = abbrev_die_table_allocated + ABBREV_DIE_TABLE_INCREMENT;
6582 abbrev_die_table = ggc_realloc (abbrev_die_table,
6583 sizeof (dw_die_ref) * n_alloc);
6584
6585 memset (&abbrev_die_table[abbrev_die_table_allocated], 0,
6586 (n_alloc - abbrev_die_table_allocated) * sizeof (dw_die_ref));
6587 abbrev_die_table_allocated = n_alloc;
6588 }
6589
6590 ++abbrev_die_table_in_use;
6591 abbrev_die_table[abbrev_id] = die;
6592 }
6593
6594 die->die_abbrev = abbrev_id;
6595 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, build_abbrev_table (c));
6596 }
6597 \f
6598 /* Return the power-of-two number of bytes necessary to represent VALUE. */
6599
6600 static int
6601 constant_size (long unsigned int value)
6602 {
6603 int log;
6604
6605 if (value == 0)
6606 log = 0;
6607 else
6608 log = floor_log2 (value);
6609
6610 log = log / 8;
6611 log = 1 << (floor_log2 (log) + 1);
6612
6613 return log;
6614 }
6615
6616 /* Return the size of a DIE as it is represented in the
6617 .debug_info section. */
6618
6619 static unsigned long
6620 size_of_die (dw_die_ref die)
6621 {
6622 unsigned long size = 0;
6623 dw_attr_ref a;
6624 unsigned ix;
6625
6626 size += size_of_uleb128 (die->die_abbrev);
6627 for (ix = 0; VEC_iterate (dw_attr_node, die->die_attr, ix, a); ix++)
6628 {
6629 switch (AT_class (a))
6630 {
6631 case dw_val_class_addr:
6632 size += DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE;
6633 break;
6634 case dw_val_class_offset:
6635 size += DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE;
6636 break;
6637 case dw_val_class_loc:
6638 {
6639 unsigned long lsize = size_of_locs (AT_loc (a));
6640
6641 /* Block length. */
6642 size += constant_size (lsize);
6643 size += lsize;
6644 }
6645 break;
6646 case dw_val_class_loc_list:
6647 size += DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE;
6648 break;
6649 case dw_val_class_range_list:
6650 size += DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE;
6651 break;
6652 case dw_val_class_const:
6653 size += size_of_sleb128 (AT_int (a));
6654 break;
6655 case dw_val_class_unsigned_const:
6656 size += constant_size (AT_unsigned (a));
6657 break;
6658 case dw_val_class_long_long:
6659 size += 1 + 2*HOST_BITS_PER_LONG/HOST_BITS_PER_CHAR; /* block */
6660 break;
6661 case dw_val_class_vec:
6662 size += 1 + (a->dw_attr_val.v.val_vec.length
6663 * a->dw_attr_val.v.val_vec.elt_size); /* block */
6664 break;
6665 case dw_val_class_flag:
6666 size += 1;
6667 break;
6668 case dw_val_class_die_ref:
6669 if (AT_ref_external (a))
6670 size += DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE;
6671 else
6672 size += DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE;
6673 break;
6674 case dw_val_class_fde_ref:
6675 size += DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE;
6676 break;
6677 case dw_val_class_lbl_id:
6678 size += DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE;
6679 break;
6680 case dw_val_class_lineptr:
6681 case dw_val_class_macptr:
6682 size += DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE;
6683 break;
6684 case dw_val_class_str:
6685 if (AT_string_form (a) == DW_FORM_strp)
6686 size += DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE;
6687 else
6688 size += strlen (a->dw_attr_val.v.val_str->str) + 1;
6689 break;
6690 case dw_val_class_file:
6691 size += constant_size (maybe_emit_file (a->dw_attr_val.v.val_file));
6692 break;
6693 default:
6694 gcc_unreachable ();
6695 }
6696 }
6697
6698 return size;
6699 }
6700
6701 /* Size the debugging information associated with a given DIE. Visits the
6702 DIE's children recursively. Updates the global variable next_die_offset, on
6703 each time through. Uses the current value of next_die_offset to update the
6704 die_offset field in each DIE. */
6705
6706 static void
6707 calc_die_sizes (dw_die_ref die)
6708 {
6709 dw_die_ref c;
6710
6711 die->die_offset = next_die_offset;
6712 next_die_offset += size_of_die (die);
6713
6714 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, calc_die_sizes (c));
6715
6716 if (die->die_child != NULL)
6717 /* Count the null byte used to terminate sibling lists. */
6718 next_die_offset += 1;
6719 }
6720
6721 /* Set the marks for a die and its children. We do this so
6722 that we know whether or not a reference needs to use FORM_ref_addr; only
6723 DIEs in the same CU will be marked. We used to clear out the offset
6724 and use that as the flag, but ran into ordering problems. */
6725
6726 static void
6727 mark_dies (dw_die_ref die)
6728 {
6729 dw_die_ref c;
6730
6731 gcc_assert (!die->die_mark);
6732
6733 die->die_mark = 1;
6734 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, mark_dies (c));
6735 }
6736
6737 /* Clear the marks for a die and its children. */
6738
6739 static void
6740 unmark_dies (dw_die_ref die)
6741 {
6742 dw_die_ref c;
6743
6744 gcc_assert (die->die_mark);
6745
6746 die->die_mark = 0;
6747 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, unmark_dies (c));
6748 }
6749
6750 /* Clear the marks for a die, its children and referred dies. */
6751
6752 static void
6753 unmark_all_dies (dw_die_ref die)
6754 {
6755 dw_die_ref c;
6756 dw_attr_ref a;
6757 unsigned ix;
6758
6759 if (!die->die_mark)
6760 return;
6761 die->die_mark = 0;
6762
6763 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, unmark_all_dies (c));
6764
6765 for (ix = 0; VEC_iterate (dw_attr_node, die->die_attr, ix, a); ix++)
6766 if (AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_die_ref)
6767 unmark_all_dies (AT_ref (a));
6768 }
6769
6770 /* Return the size of the .debug_pubnames or .debug_pubtypes table
6771 generated for the compilation unit. */
6772
6773 static unsigned long
6774 size_of_pubnames (VEC (pubname_entry, gc) * names)
6775 {
6776 unsigned long size;
6777 unsigned i;
6778 pubname_ref p;
6779
6780 size = DWARF_PUBNAMES_HEADER_SIZE;
6781 for (i = 0; VEC_iterate (pubname_entry, names, i, p); i++)
6782 if (names != pubtype_table
6783 || p->die->die_offset != 0
6784 || !flag_eliminate_unused_debug_types)
6785 size += strlen (p->name) + DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE + 1;
6786
6787 size += DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE;
6788 return size;
6789 }
6790
6791 /* Return the size of the information in the .debug_aranges section. */
6792
6793 static unsigned long
6794 size_of_aranges (void)
6795 {
6796 unsigned long size;
6797
6798 size = DWARF_ARANGES_HEADER_SIZE;
6799
6800 /* Count the address/length pair for this compilation unit. */
6801 size += 2 * DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE;
6802 size += 2 * DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE * arange_table_in_use;
6803
6804 /* Count the two zero words used to terminated the address range table. */
6805 size += 2 * DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE;
6806 return size;
6807 }
6808 \f
6809 /* Select the encoding of an attribute value. */
6810
6811 static enum dwarf_form
6812 value_format (dw_attr_ref a)
6813 {
6814 switch (a->dw_attr_val.val_class)
6815 {
6816 case dw_val_class_addr:
6817 return DW_FORM_addr;
6818 case dw_val_class_range_list:
6819 case dw_val_class_offset:
6820 case dw_val_class_loc_list:
6821 switch (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE)
6822 {
6823 case 4:
6824 return DW_FORM_data4;
6825 case 8:
6826 return DW_FORM_data8;
6827 default:
6828 gcc_unreachable ();
6829 }
6830 case dw_val_class_loc:
6831 switch (constant_size (size_of_locs (AT_loc (a))))
6832 {
6833 case 1:
6834 return DW_FORM_block1;
6835 case 2:
6836 return DW_FORM_block2;
6837 default:
6838 gcc_unreachable ();
6839 }
6840 case dw_val_class_const:
6841 return DW_FORM_sdata;
6842 case dw_val_class_unsigned_const:
6843 switch (constant_size (AT_unsigned (a)))
6844 {
6845 case 1:
6846 return DW_FORM_data1;
6847 case 2:
6848 return DW_FORM_data2;
6849 case 4:
6850 return DW_FORM_data4;
6851 case 8:
6852 return DW_FORM_data8;
6853 default:
6854 gcc_unreachable ();
6855 }
6856 case dw_val_class_long_long:
6857 return DW_FORM_block1;
6858 case dw_val_class_vec:
6859 return DW_FORM_block1;
6860 case dw_val_class_flag:
6861 return DW_FORM_flag;
6862 case dw_val_class_die_ref:
6863 if (AT_ref_external (a))
6864 return DW_FORM_ref_addr;
6865 else
6866 return DW_FORM_ref;
6867 case dw_val_class_fde_ref:
6868 return DW_FORM_data;
6869 case dw_val_class_lbl_id:
6870 return DW_FORM_addr;
6871 case dw_val_class_lineptr:
6872 case dw_val_class_macptr:
6873 return DW_FORM_data;
6874 case dw_val_class_str:
6875 return AT_string_form (a);
6876 case dw_val_class_file:
6877 switch (constant_size (maybe_emit_file (a->dw_attr_val.v.val_file)))
6878 {
6879 case 1:
6880 return DW_FORM_data1;
6881 case 2:
6882 return DW_FORM_data2;
6883 case 4:
6884 return DW_FORM_data4;
6885 default:
6886 gcc_unreachable ();
6887 }
6888
6889 default:
6890 gcc_unreachable ();
6891 }
6892 }
6893
6894 /* Output the encoding of an attribute value. */
6895
6896 static void
6897 output_value_format (dw_attr_ref a)
6898 {
6899 enum dwarf_form form = value_format (a);
6900
6901 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (form, "(%s)", dwarf_form_name (form));
6902 }
6903
6904 /* Output the .debug_abbrev section which defines the DIE abbreviation
6905 table. */
6906
6907 static void
6908 output_abbrev_section (void)
6909 {
6910 unsigned long abbrev_id;
6911
6912 for (abbrev_id = 1; abbrev_id < abbrev_die_table_in_use; ++abbrev_id)
6913 {
6914 dw_die_ref abbrev = abbrev_die_table[abbrev_id];
6915 unsigned ix;
6916 dw_attr_ref a_attr;
6917
6918 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (abbrev_id, "(abbrev code)");
6919 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (abbrev->die_tag, "(TAG: %s)",
6920 dwarf_tag_name (abbrev->die_tag));
6921
6922 if (abbrev->die_child != NULL)
6923 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_children_yes, "DW_children_yes");
6924 else
6925 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_children_no, "DW_children_no");
6926
6927 for (ix = 0; VEC_iterate (dw_attr_node, abbrev->die_attr, ix, a_attr);
6928 ix++)
6929 {
6930 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (a_attr->dw_attr, "(%s)",
6931 dwarf_attr_name (a_attr->dw_attr));
6932 output_value_format (a_attr);
6933 }
6934
6935 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, NULL);
6936 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, NULL);
6937 }
6938
6939 /* Terminate the table. */
6940 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, NULL);
6941 }
6942
6943 /* Output a symbol we can use to refer to this DIE from another CU. */
6944
6945 static inline void
6946 output_die_symbol (dw_die_ref die)
6947 {
6948 char *sym = die->die_symbol;
6949
6950 if (sym == 0)
6951 return;
6952
6953 if (strncmp (sym, DIE_LABEL_PREFIX, sizeof (DIE_LABEL_PREFIX) - 1) == 0)
6954 /* We make these global, not weak; if the target doesn't support
6955 .linkonce, it doesn't support combining the sections, so debugging
6956 will break. */
6957 targetm.asm_out.globalize_label (asm_out_file, sym);
6958
6959 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, sym);
6960 }
6961
6962 /* Return a new location list, given the begin and end range, and the
6963 expression. gensym tells us whether to generate a new internal symbol for
6964 this location list node, which is done for the head of the list only. */
6965
6966 static inline dw_loc_list_ref
6967 new_loc_list (dw_loc_descr_ref expr, const char *begin, const char *end,
6968 const char *section, unsigned int gensym)
6969 {
6970 dw_loc_list_ref retlist = ggc_alloc_cleared (sizeof (dw_loc_list_node));
6971
6972 retlist->begin = begin;
6973 retlist->end = end;
6974 retlist->expr = expr;
6975 retlist->section = section;
6976 if (gensym)
6977 retlist->ll_symbol = gen_internal_sym ("LLST");
6978
6979 return retlist;
6980 }
6981
6982 /* Add a location description expression to a location list. */
6983
6984 static inline void
6985 add_loc_descr_to_loc_list (dw_loc_list_ref *list_head, dw_loc_descr_ref descr,
6986 const char *begin, const char *end,
6987 const char *section)
6988 {
6989 dw_loc_list_ref *d;
6990
6991 /* Find the end of the chain. */
6992 for (d = list_head; (*d) != NULL; d = &(*d)->dw_loc_next)
6993 ;
6994
6995 /* Add a new location list node to the list. */
6996 *d = new_loc_list (descr, begin, end, section, 0);
6997 }
6998
6999 static void
7000 dwarf2out_switch_text_section (void)
7001 {
7002 dw_fde_ref fde;
7003
7004 gcc_assert (cfun);
7005
7006 fde = &fde_table[fde_table_in_use - 1];
7007 fde->dw_fde_switched_sections = true;
7008 fde->dw_fde_hot_section_label = cfun->hot_section_label;
7009 fde->dw_fde_hot_section_end_label = cfun->hot_section_end_label;
7010 fde->dw_fde_unlikely_section_label = cfun->cold_section_label;
7011 fde->dw_fde_unlikely_section_end_label = cfun->cold_section_end_label;
7012 have_multiple_function_sections = true;
7013
7014 /* Reset the current label on switching text sections, so that we
7015 don't attempt to advance_loc4 between labels in different sections. */
7016 fde->dw_fde_current_label = NULL;
7017 }
7018
7019 /* Output the location list given to us. */
7020
7021 static void
7022 output_loc_list (dw_loc_list_ref list_head)
7023 {
7024 dw_loc_list_ref curr = list_head;
7025
7026 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, list_head->ll_symbol);
7027
7028 /* Walk the location list, and output each range + expression. */
7029 for (curr = list_head; curr != NULL; curr = curr->dw_loc_next)
7030 {
7031 unsigned long size;
7032 if (!have_multiple_function_sections)
7033 {
7034 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, curr->begin, curr->section,
7035 "Location list begin address (%s)",
7036 list_head->ll_symbol);
7037 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, curr->end, curr->section,
7038 "Location list end address (%s)",
7039 list_head->ll_symbol);
7040 }
7041 else
7042 {
7043 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, curr->begin,
7044 "Location list begin address (%s)",
7045 list_head->ll_symbol);
7046 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, curr->end,
7047 "Location list end address (%s)",
7048 list_head->ll_symbol);
7049 }
7050 size = size_of_locs (curr->expr);
7051
7052 /* Output the block length for this list of location operations. */
7053 gcc_assert (size <= 0xffff);
7054 dw2_asm_output_data (2, size, "%s", "Location expression size");
7055
7056 output_loc_sequence (curr->expr);
7057 }
7058
7059 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, 0,
7060 "Location list terminator begin (%s)",
7061 list_head->ll_symbol);
7062 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, 0,
7063 "Location list terminator end (%s)",
7064 list_head->ll_symbol);
7065 }
7066
7067 /* Output the DIE and its attributes. Called recursively to generate
7068 the definitions of each child DIE. */
7069
7070 static void
7071 output_die (dw_die_ref die)
7072 {
7073 dw_attr_ref a;
7074 dw_die_ref c;
7075 unsigned long size;
7076 unsigned ix;
7077
7078 /* If someone in another CU might refer to us, set up a symbol for
7079 them to point to. */
7080 if (die->die_symbol)
7081 output_die_symbol (die);
7082
7083 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (die->die_abbrev, "(DIE (0x%lx) %s)",
7084 die->die_offset, dwarf_tag_name (die->die_tag));
7085
7086 for (ix = 0; VEC_iterate (dw_attr_node, die->die_attr, ix, a); ix++)
7087 {
7088 const char *name = dwarf_attr_name (a->dw_attr);
7089
7090 switch (AT_class (a))
7091 {
7092 case dw_val_class_addr:
7093 dw2_asm_output_addr_rtx (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, AT_addr (a), "%s", name);
7094 break;
7095
7096 case dw_val_class_offset:
7097 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, a->dw_attr_val.v.val_offset,
7098 "%s", name);
7099 break;
7100
7101 case dw_val_class_range_list:
7102 {
7103 char *p = strchr (ranges_section_label, '\0');
7104
7105 sprintf (p, "+" HOST_WIDE_INT_PRINT_HEX,
7106 a->dw_attr_val.v.val_offset);
7107 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, ranges_section_label,
7108 debug_ranges_section, "%s", name);
7109 *p = '\0';
7110 }
7111 break;
7112
7113 case dw_val_class_loc:
7114 size = size_of_locs (AT_loc (a));
7115
7116 /* Output the block length for this list of location operations. */
7117 dw2_asm_output_data (constant_size (size), size, "%s", name);
7118
7119 output_loc_sequence (AT_loc (a));
7120 break;
7121
7122 case dw_val_class_const:
7123 /* ??? It would be slightly more efficient to use a scheme like is
7124 used for unsigned constants below, but gdb 4.x does not sign
7125 extend. Gdb 5.x does sign extend. */
7126 dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128 (AT_int (a), "%s", name);
7127 break;
7128
7129 case dw_val_class_unsigned_const:
7130 dw2_asm_output_data (constant_size (AT_unsigned (a)),
7131 AT_unsigned (a), "%s", name);
7132 break;
7133
7134 case dw_val_class_long_long:
7135 {
7136 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT first, second;
7137
7138 dw2_asm_output_data (1,
7139 2 * HOST_BITS_PER_LONG / HOST_BITS_PER_CHAR,
7140 "%s", name);
7141
7142 if (WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN)
7143 {
7144 first = a->dw_attr_val.v.val_long_long.hi;
7145 second = a->dw_attr_val.v.val_long_long.low;
7146 }
7147 else
7148 {
7149 first = a->dw_attr_val.v.val_long_long.low;
7150 second = a->dw_attr_val.v.val_long_long.hi;
7151 }
7152
7153 dw2_asm_output_data (HOST_BITS_PER_LONG / HOST_BITS_PER_CHAR,
7154 first, "long long constant");
7155 dw2_asm_output_data (HOST_BITS_PER_LONG / HOST_BITS_PER_CHAR,
7156 second, NULL);
7157 }
7158 break;
7159
7160 case dw_val_class_vec:
7161 {
7162 unsigned int elt_size = a->dw_attr_val.v.val_vec.elt_size;
7163 unsigned int len = a->dw_attr_val.v.val_vec.length;
7164 unsigned int i;
7165 unsigned char *p;
7166
7167 dw2_asm_output_data (1, len * elt_size, "%s", name);
7168 if (elt_size > sizeof (HOST_WIDE_INT))
7169 {
7170 elt_size /= 2;
7171 len *= 2;
7172 }
7173 for (i = 0, p = a->dw_attr_val.v.val_vec.array;
7174 i < len;
7175 i++, p += elt_size)
7176 dw2_asm_output_data (elt_size, extract_int (p, elt_size),
7177 "fp or vector constant word %u", i);
7178 break;
7179 }
7180
7181 case dw_val_class_flag:
7182 dw2_asm_output_data (1, AT_flag (a), "%s", name);
7183 break;
7184
7185 case dw_val_class_loc_list:
7186 {
7187 char *sym = AT_loc_list (a)->ll_symbol;
7188
7189 gcc_assert (sym);
7190 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, sym, debug_loc_section,
7191 "%s", name);
7192 }
7193 break;
7194
7195 case dw_val_class_die_ref:
7196 if (AT_ref_external (a))
7197 {
7198 char *sym = AT_ref (a)->die_symbol;
7199
7200 gcc_assert (sym);
7201 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, sym, debug_info_section,
7202 "%s", name);
7203 }
7204 else
7205 {
7206 gcc_assert (AT_ref (a)->die_offset);
7207 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, AT_ref (a)->die_offset,
7208 "%s", name);
7209 }
7210 break;
7211
7212 case dw_val_class_fde_ref:
7213 {
7214 char l1[20];
7215
7216 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (l1, FDE_LABEL,
7217 a->dw_attr_val.v.val_fde_index * 2);
7218 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, l1, debug_frame_section,
7219 "%s", name);
7220 }
7221 break;
7222
7223 case dw_val_class_lbl_id:
7224 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, AT_lbl (a), "%s", name);
7225 break;
7226
7227 case dw_val_class_lineptr:
7228 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, AT_lbl (a),
7229 debug_line_section, "%s", name);
7230 break;
7231
7232 case dw_val_class_macptr:
7233 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, AT_lbl (a),
7234 debug_macinfo_section, "%s", name);
7235 break;
7236
7237 case dw_val_class_str:
7238 if (AT_string_form (a) == DW_FORM_strp)
7239 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE,
7240 a->dw_attr_val.v.val_str->label,
7241 debug_str_section,
7242 "%s: \"%s\"", name, AT_string (a));
7243 else
7244 dw2_asm_output_nstring (AT_string (a), -1, "%s", name);
7245 break;
7246
7247 case dw_val_class_file:
7248 {
7249 int f = maybe_emit_file (a->dw_attr_val.v.val_file);
7250
7251 dw2_asm_output_data (constant_size (f), f, "%s (%s)", name,
7252 a->dw_attr_val.v.val_file->filename);
7253 break;
7254 }
7255
7256 default:
7257 gcc_unreachable ();
7258 }
7259 }
7260
7261 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, output_die (c));
7262
7263 /* Add null byte to terminate sibling list. */
7264 if (die->die_child != NULL)
7265 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "end of children of DIE 0x%lx",
7266 die->die_offset);
7267 }
7268
7269 /* Output the compilation unit that appears at the beginning of the
7270 .debug_info section, and precedes the DIE descriptions. */
7271
7272 static void
7273 output_compilation_unit_header (void)
7274 {
7275 if (DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE - DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE == 4)
7276 dw2_asm_output_data (4, 0xffffffff,
7277 "Initial length escape value indicating 64-bit DWARF extension");
7278 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE,
7279 next_die_offset - DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE,
7280 "Length of Compilation Unit Info");
7281 dw2_asm_output_data (2, DWARF_VERSION, "DWARF version number");
7282 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, abbrev_section_label,
7283 debug_abbrev_section,
7284 "Offset Into Abbrev. Section");
7285 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, "Pointer Size (in bytes)");
7286 }
7287
7288 /* Output the compilation unit DIE and its children. */
7289
7290 static void
7291 output_comp_unit (dw_die_ref die, int output_if_empty)
7292 {
7293 const char *secname;
7294 char *oldsym, *tmp;
7295
7296 /* Unless we are outputting main CU, we may throw away empty ones. */
7297 if (!output_if_empty && die->die_child == NULL)
7298 return;
7299
7300 /* Even if there are no children of this DIE, we must output the information
7301 about the compilation unit. Otherwise, on an empty translation unit, we
7302 will generate a present, but empty, .debug_info section. IRIX 6.5 `nm'
7303 will then complain when examining the file. First mark all the DIEs in
7304 this CU so we know which get local refs. */
7305 mark_dies (die);
7306
7307 build_abbrev_table (die);
7308
7309 /* Initialize the beginning DIE offset - and calculate sizes/offsets. */
7310 next_die_offset = DWARF_COMPILE_UNIT_HEADER_SIZE;
7311 calc_die_sizes (die);
7312
7313 oldsym = die->die_symbol;
7314 if (oldsym)
7315 {
7316 tmp = alloca (strlen (oldsym) + 24);
7317
7318 sprintf (tmp, ".gnu.linkonce.wi.%s", oldsym);
7319 secname = tmp;
7320 die->die_symbol = NULL;
7321 switch_to_section (get_section (secname, SECTION_DEBUG, NULL));
7322 }
7323 else
7324 switch_to_section (debug_info_section);
7325
7326 /* Output debugging information. */
7327 output_compilation_unit_header ();
7328 output_die (die);
7329
7330 /* Leave the marks on the main CU, so we can check them in
7331 output_pubnames. */
7332 if (oldsym)
7333 {
7334 unmark_dies (die);
7335 die->die_symbol = oldsym;
7336 }
7337 }
7338
7339 /* Return the DWARF2/3 pubname associated with a decl. */
7340
7341 static const char *
7342 dwarf2_name (tree decl, int scope)
7343 {
7344 return lang_hooks.dwarf_name (decl, scope ? 1 : 0);
7345 }
7346
7347 /* Add a new entry to .debug_pubnames if appropriate. */
7348
7349 static void
7350 add_pubname (tree decl, dw_die_ref die)
7351 {
7352 pubname_entry e;
7353
7354 if (! TREE_PUBLIC (decl))
7355 return;
7356
7357 e.die = die;
7358 e.name = xstrdup (dwarf2_name (decl, 1));
7359 VEC_safe_push (pubname_entry, gc, pubname_table, &e);
7360 }
7361
7362 /* Add a new entry to .debug_pubtypes if appropriate. */
7363
7364 static void
7365 add_pubtype (tree decl, dw_die_ref die)
7366 {
7367 pubname_entry e;
7368
7369 e.name = NULL;
7370 if ((TREE_PUBLIC (decl)
7371 || die->die_parent == comp_unit_die)
7372 && (die->die_tag == DW_TAG_typedef || COMPLETE_TYPE_P (decl)))
7373 {
7374 e.die = die;
7375 if (TYPE_P (decl))
7376 {
7377 if (TYPE_NAME (decl))
7378 {
7379 if (TREE_CODE (TYPE_NAME (decl)) == IDENTIFIER_NODE)
7380 e.name = IDENTIFIER_POINTER (TYPE_NAME (decl));
7381 else if (TREE_CODE (TYPE_NAME (decl)) == TYPE_DECL
7382 && DECL_NAME (TYPE_NAME (decl)))
7383 e.name = IDENTIFIER_POINTER (DECL_NAME (TYPE_NAME (decl)));
7384 else
7385 e.name = xstrdup ((const char *) get_AT_string (die, DW_AT_name));
7386 }
7387 }
7388 else
7389 e.name = xstrdup (dwarf2_name (decl, 1));
7390
7391 /* If we don't have a name for the type, there's no point in adding
7392 it to the table. */
7393 if (e.name && e.name[0] != '\0')
7394 VEC_safe_push (pubname_entry, gc, pubtype_table, &e);
7395 }
7396 }
7397
7398 /* Output the public names table used to speed up access to externally
7399 visible names; or the public types table used to find type definitions. */
7400
7401 static void
7402 output_pubnames (VEC (pubname_entry, gc) * names)
7403 {
7404 unsigned i;
7405 unsigned long pubnames_length = size_of_pubnames (names);
7406 pubname_ref pub;
7407
7408 if (DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE - DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE == 4)
7409 dw2_asm_output_data (4, 0xffffffff,
7410 "Initial length escape value indicating 64-bit DWARF extension");
7411 if (names == pubname_table)
7412 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, pubnames_length,
7413 "Length of Public Names Info");
7414 else
7415 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, pubnames_length,
7416 "Length of Public Type Names Info");
7417 dw2_asm_output_data (2, DWARF_VERSION, "DWARF Version");
7418 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, debug_info_section_label,
7419 debug_info_section,
7420 "Offset of Compilation Unit Info");
7421 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, next_die_offset,
7422 "Compilation Unit Length");
7423
7424 for (i = 0; VEC_iterate (pubname_entry, names, i, pub); i++)
7425 {
7426 /* We shouldn't see pubnames for DIEs outside of the main CU. */
7427 if (names == pubname_table)
7428 gcc_assert (pub->die->die_mark);
7429
7430 if (names != pubtype_table
7431 || pub->die->die_offset != 0
7432 || !flag_eliminate_unused_debug_types)
7433 {
7434 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, pub->die->die_offset,
7435 "DIE offset");
7436
7437 dw2_asm_output_nstring (pub->name, -1, "external name");
7438 }
7439 }
7440
7441 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, 0, NULL);
7442 }
7443
7444 /* Add a new entry to .debug_aranges if appropriate. */
7445
7446 static void
7447 add_arange (tree decl, dw_die_ref die)
7448 {
7449 if (! DECL_SECTION_NAME (decl))
7450 return;
7451
7452 if (arange_table_in_use == arange_table_allocated)
7453 {
7454 arange_table_allocated += ARANGE_TABLE_INCREMENT;
7455 arange_table = ggc_realloc (arange_table,
7456 (arange_table_allocated
7457 * sizeof (dw_die_ref)));
7458 memset (arange_table + arange_table_in_use, 0,
7459 ARANGE_TABLE_INCREMENT * sizeof (dw_die_ref));
7460 }
7461
7462 arange_table[arange_table_in_use++] = die;
7463 }
7464
7465 /* Output the information that goes into the .debug_aranges table.
7466 Namely, define the beginning and ending address range of the
7467 text section generated for this compilation unit. */
7468
7469 static void
7470 output_aranges (void)
7471 {
7472 unsigned i;
7473 unsigned long aranges_length = size_of_aranges ();
7474
7475 if (DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE - DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE == 4)
7476 dw2_asm_output_data (4, 0xffffffff,
7477 "Initial length escape value indicating 64-bit DWARF extension");
7478 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, aranges_length,
7479 "Length of Address Ranges Info");
7480 dw2_asm_output_data (2, DWARF_VERSION, "DWARF Version");
7481 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, debug_info_section_label,
7482 debug_info_section,
7483 "Offset of Compilation Unit Info");
7484 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, "Size of Address");
7485 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "Size of Segment Descriptor");
7486
7487 /* We need to align to twice the pointer size here. */
7488 if (DWARF_ARANGES_PAD_SIZE)
7489 {
7490 /* Pad using a 2 byte words so that padding is correct for any
7491 pointer size. */
7492 dw2_asm_output_data (2, 0, "Pad to %d byte boundary",
7493 2 * DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE);
7494 for (i = 2; i < (unsigned) DWARF_ARANGES_PAD_SIZE; i += 2)
7495 dw2_asm_output_data (2, 0, NULL);
7496 }
7497
7498 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, text_section_label, "Address");
7499 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, text_end_label,
7500 text_section_label, "Length");
7501 if (flag_reorder_blocks_and_partition)
7502 {
7503 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, cold_text_section_label,
7504 "Address");
7505 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, cold_end_label,
7506 cold_text_section_label, "Length");
7507 }
7508
7509 for (i = 0; i < arange_table_in_use; i++)
7510 {
7511 dw_die_ref die = arange_table[i];
7512
7513 /* We shouldn't see aranges for DIEs outside of the main CU. */
7514 gcc_assert (die->die_mark);
7515
7516 if (die->die_tag == DW_TAG_subprogram)
7517 {
7518 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, get_AT_low_pc (die),
7519 "Address");
7520 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, get_AT_hi_pc (die),
7521 get_AT_low_pc (die), "Length");
7522 }
7523 else
7524 {
7525 /* A static variable; extract the symbol from DW_AT_location.
7526 Note that this code isn't currently hit, as we only emit
7527 aranges for functions (jason 9/23/99). */
7528 dw_attr_ref a = get_AT (die, DW_AT_location);
7529 dw_loc_descr_ref loc;
7530
7531 gcc_assert (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_loc);
7532
7533 loc = AT_loc (a);
7534 gcc_assert (loc->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_addr);
7535
7536 dw2_asm_output_addr_rtx (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE,
7537 loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_addr, "Address");
7538 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE,
7539 get_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_byte_size),
7540 "Length");
7541 }
7542 }
7543
7544 /* Output the terminator words. */
7545 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, 0, NULL);
7546 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, 0, NULL);
7547 }
7548
7549 /* Add a new entry to .debug_ranges. Return the offset at which it
7550 was placed. */
7551
7552 static unsigned int
7553 add_ranges (tree block)
7554 {
7555 unsigned int in_use = ranges_table_in_use;
7556
7557 if (in_use == ranges_table_allocated)
7558 {
7559 ranges_table_allocated += RANGES_TABLE_INCREMENT;
7560 ranges_table
7561 = ggc_realloc (ranges_table, (ranges_table_allocated
7562 * sizeof (struct dw_ranges_struct)));
7563 memset (ranges_table + ranges_table_in_use, 0,
7564 RANGES_TABLE_INCREMENT * sizeof (struct dw_ranges_struct));
7565 }
7566
7567 ranges_table[in_use].block_num = (block ? BLOCK_NUMBER (block) : 0);
7568 ranges_table_in_use = in_use + 1;
7569
7570 return in_use * 2 * DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE;
7571 }
7572
7573 static void
7574 output_ranges (void)
7575 {
7576 unsigned i;
7577 static const char *const start_fmt = "Offset 0x%x";
7578 const char *fmt = start_fmt;
7579
7580 for (i = 0; i < ranges_table_in_use; i++)
7581 {
7582 int block_num = ranges_table[i].block_num;
7583
7584 if (block_num)
7585 {
7586 char blabel[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
7587 char elabel[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
7588
7589 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (blabel, BLOCK_BEGIN_LABEL, block_num);
7590 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (elabel, BLOCK_END_LABEL, block_num);
7591
7592 /* If all code is in the text section, then the compilation
7593 unit base address defaults to DW_AT_low_pc, which is the
7594 base of the text section. */
7595 if (!have_multiple_function_sections)
7596 {
7597 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, blabel,
7598 text_section_label,
7599 fmt, i * 2 * DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE);
7600 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, elabel,
7601 text_section_label, NULL);
7602 }
7603
7604 /* Otherwise, we add a DW_AT_entry_pc attribute to force the
7605 compilation unit base address to zero, which allows us to
7606 use absolute addresses, and not worry about whether the
7607 target supports cross-section arithmetic. */
7608 else
7609 {
7610 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, blabel,
7611 fmt, i * 2 * DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE);
7612 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, elabel, NULL);
7613 }
7614
7615 fmt = NULL;
7616 }
7617 else
7618 {
7619 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, 0, NULL);
7620 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, 0, NULL);
7621 fmt = start_fmt;
7622 }
7623 }
7624 }
7625
7626 /* Data structure containing information about input files. */
7627 struct file_info
7628 {
7629 const char *path; /* Complete file name. */
7630 const char *fname; /* File name part. */
7631 int length; /* Length of entire string. */
7632 struct dwarf_file_data * file_idx; /* Index in input file table. */
7633 int dir_idx; /* Index in directory table. */
7634 };
7635
7636 /* Data structure containing information about directories with source
7637 files. */
7638 struct dir_info
7639 {
7640 const char *path; /* Path including directory name. */
7641 int length; /* Path length. */
7642 int prefix; /* Index of directory entry which is a prefix. */
7643 int count; /* Number of files in this directory. */
7644 int dir_idx; /* Index of directory used as base. */
7645 };
7646
7647 /* Callback function for file_info comparison. We sort by looking at
7648 the directories in the path. */
7649
7650 static int
7651 file_info_cmp (const void *p1, const void *p2)
7652 {
7653 const struct file_info *s1 = p1;
7654 const struct file_info *s2 = p2;
7655 unsigned char *cp1;
7656 unsigned char *cp2;
7657
7658 /* Take care of file names without directories. We need to make sure that
7659 we return consistent values to qsort since some will get confused if
7660 we return the same value when identical operands are passed in opposite
7661 orders. So if neither has a directory, return 0 and otherwise return
7662 1 or -1 depending on which one has the directory. */
7663 if ((s1->path == s1->fname || s2->path == s2->fname))
7664 return (s2->path == s2->fname) - (s1->path == s1->fname);
7665
7666 cp1 = (unsigned char *) s1->path;
7667 cp2 = (unsigned char *) s2->path;
7668
7669 while (1)
7670 {
7671 ++cp1;
7672 ++cp2;
7673 /* Reached the end of the first path? If so, handle like above. */
7674 if ((cp1 == (unsigned char *) s1->fname)
7675 || (cp2 == (unsigned char *) s2->fname))
7676 return ((cp2 == (unsigned char *) s2->fname)
7677 - (cp1 == (unsigned char *) s1->fname));
7678
7679 /* Character of current path component the same? */
7680 else if (*cp1 != *cp2)
7681 return *cp1 - *cp2;
7682 }
7683 }
7684
7685 struct file_name_acquire_data
7686 {
7687 struct file_info *files;
7688 int used_files;
7689 int max_files;
7690 };
7691
7692 /* Traversal function for the hash table. */
7693
7694 static int
7695 file_name_acquire (void ** slot, void *data)
7696 {
7697 struct file_name_acquire_data *fnad = data;
7698 struct dwarf_file_data *d = *slot;
7699 struct file_info *fi;
7700 const char *f;
7701
7702 gcc_assert (fnad->max_files >= d->emitted_number);
7703
7704 if (! d->emitted_number)
7705 return 1;
7706
7707 gcc_assert (fnad->max_files != fnad->used_files);
7708
7709 fi = fnad->files + fnad->used_files++;
7710
7711 /* Skip all leading "./". */
7712 f = d->filename;
7713 while (f[0] == '.' && IS_DIR_SEPARATOR (f[1]))
7714 f += 2;
7715
7716 /* Create a new array entry. */
7717 fi->path = f;
7718 fi->length = strlen (f);
7719 fi->file_idx = d;
7720
7721 /* Search for the file name part. */
7722 f = strrchr (f, DIR_SEPARATOR);
7723 #if defined (DIR_SEPARATOR_2)
7724 {
7725 char *g = strrchr (fi->path, DIR_SEPARATOR_2);
7726
7727 if (g != NULL)
7728 {
7729 if (f == NULL || f < g)
7730 f = g;
7731 }
7732 }
7733 #endif
7734
7735 fi->fname = f == NULL ? fi->path : f + 1;
7736 return 1;
7737 }
7738
7739 /* Output the directory table and the file name table. We try to minimize
7740 the total amount of memory needed. A heuristic is used to avoid large
7741 slowdowns with many input files. */
7742
7743 static void
7744 output_file_names (void)
7745 {
7746 struct file_name_acquire_data fnad;
7747 int numfiles;
7748 struct file_info *files;
7749 struct dir_info *dirs;
7750 int *saved;
7751 int *savehere;
7752 int *backmap;
7753 int ndirs;
7754 int idx_offset;
7755 int i;
7756 int idx;
7757
7758 if (!last_emitted_file)
7759 {
7760 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "End directory table");
7761 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "End file name table");
7762 return;
7763 }
7764
7765 numfiles = last_emitted_file->emitted_number;
7766
7767 /* Allocate the various arrays we need. */
7768 files = alloca (numfiles * sizeof (struct file_info));
7769 dirs = alloca (numfiles * sizeof (struct dir_info));
7770
7771 fnad.files = files;
7772 fnad.used_files = 0;
7773 fnad.max_files = numfiles;
7774 htab_traverse (file_table, file_name_acquire, &fnad);
7775 gcc_assert (fnad.used_files == fnad.max_files);
7776
7777 qsort (files, numfiles, sizeof (files[0]), file_info_cmp);
7778
7779 /* Find all the different directories used. */
7780 dirs[0].path = files[0].path;
7781 dirs[0].length = files[0].fname - files[0].path;
7782 dirs[0].prefix = -1;
7783 dirs[0].count = 1;
7784 dirs[0].dir_idx = 0;
7785 files[0].dir_idx = 0;
7786 ndirs = 1;
7787
7788 for (i = 1; i < numfiles; i++)
7789 if (files[i].fname - files[i].path == dirs[ndirs - 1].length
7790 && memcmp (dirs[ndirs - 1].path, files[i].path,
7791 dirs[ndirs - 1].length) == 0)
7792 {
7793 /* Same directory as last entry. */
7794 files[i].dir_idx = ndirs - 1;
7795 ++dirs[ndirs - 1].count;
7796 }
7797 else
7798 {
7799 int j;
7800
7801 /* This is a new directory. */
7802 dirs[ndirs].path = files[i].path;
7803 dirs[ndirs].length = files[i].fname - files[i].path;
7804 dirs[ndirs].count = 1;
7805 dirs[ndirs].dir_idx = ndirs;
7806 files[i].dir_idx = ndirs;
7807
7808 /* Search for a prefix. */
7809 dirs[ndirs].prefix = -1;
7810 for (j = 0; j < ndirs; j++)
7811 if (dirs[j].length < dirs[ndirs].length
7812 && dirs[j].length > 1
7813 && (dirs[ndirs].prefix == -1
7814 || dirs[j].length > dirs[dirs[ndirs].prefix].length)
7815 && memcmp (dirs[j].path, dirs[ndirs].path, dirs[j].length) == 0)
7816 dirs[ndirs].prefix = j;
7817
7818 ++ndirs;
7819 }
7820
7821 /* Now to the actual work. We have to find a subset of the directories which
7822 allow expressing the file name using references to the directory table
7823 with the least amount of characters. We do not do an exhaustive search
7824 where we would have to check out every combination of every single
7825 possible prefix. Instead we use a heuristic which provides nearly optimal
7826 results in most cases and never is much off. */
7827 saved = alloca (ndirs * sizeof (int));
7828 savehere = alloca (ndirs * sizeof (int));
7829
7830 memset (saved, '\0', ndirs * sizeof (saved[0]));
7831 for (i = 0; i < ndirs; i++)
7832 {
7833 int j;
7834 int total;
7835
7836 /* We can always save some space for the current directory. But this
7837 does not mean it will be enough to justify adding the directory. */
7838 savehere[i] = dirs[i].length;
7839 total = (savehere[i] - saved[i]) * dirs[i].count;
7840
7841 for (j = i + 1; j < ndirs; j++)
7842 {
7843 savehere[j] = 0;
7844 if (saved[j] < dirs[i].length)
7845 {
7846 /* Determine whether the dirs[i] path is a prefix of the
7847 dirs[j] path. */
7848 int k;
7849
7850 k = dirs[j].prefix;
7851 while (k != -1 && k != (int) i)
7852 k = dirs[k].prefix;
7853
7854 if (k == (int) i)
7855 {
7856 /* Yes it is. We can possibly save some memory by
7857 writing the filenames in dirs[j] relative to
7858 dirs[i]. */
7859 savehere[j] = dirs[i].length;
7860 total += (savehere[j] - saved[j]) * dirs[j].count;
7861 }
7862 }
7863 }
7864
7865 /* Check whether we can save enough to justify adding the dirs[i]
7866 directory. */
7867 if (total > dirs[i].length + 1)
7868 {
7869 /* It's worthwhile adding. */
7870 for (j = i; j < ndirs; j++)
7871 if (savehere[j] > 0)
7872 {
7873 /* Remember how much we saved for this directory so far. */
7874 saved[j] = savehere[j];
7875
7876 /* Remember the prefix directory. */
7877 dirs[j].dir_idx = i;
7878 }
7879 }
7880 }
7881
7882 /* Emit the directory name table. */
7883 idx = 1;
7884 idx_offset = dirs[0].length > 0 ? 1 : 0;
7885 for (i = 1 - idx_offset; i < ndirs; i++)
7886 dw2_asm_output_nstring (dirs[i].path, dirs[i].length - 1,
7887 "Directory Entry: 0x%x", i + idx_offset);
7888
7889 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "End directory table");
7890
7891 /* We have to emit them in the order of emitted_number since that's
7892 used in the debug info generation. To do this efficiently we
7893 generate a back-mapping of the indices first. */
7894 backmap = alloca (numfiles * sizeof (int));
7895 for (i = 0; i < numfiles; i++)
7896 backmap[files[i].file_idx->emitted_number - 1] = i;
7897
7898 /* Now write all the file names. */
7899 for (i = 0; i < numfiles; i++)
7900 {
7901 int file_idx = backmap[i];
7902 int dir_idx = dirs[files[file_idx].dir_idx].dir_idx;
7903
7904 dw2_asm_output_nstring (files[file_idx].path + dirs[dir_idx].length, -1,
7905 "File Entry: 0x%x", (unsigned) i + 1);
7906
7907 /* Include directory index. */
7908 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (dir_idx + idx_offset, NULL);
7909
7910 /* Modification time. */
7911 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (0, NULL);
7912
7913 /* File length in bytes. */
7914 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (0, NULL);
7915 }
7916
7917 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "End file name table");
7918 }
7919
7920
7921 /* Output the source line number correspondence information. This
7922 information goes into the .debug_line section. */
7923
7924 static void
7925 output_line_info (void)
7926 {
7927 char l1[20], l2[20], p1[20], p2[20];
7928 char line_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
7929 char prev_line_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
7930 unsigned opc;
7931 unsigned n_op_args;
7932 unsigned long lt_index;
7933 unsigned long current_line;
7934 long line_offset;
7935 long line_delta;
7936 unsigned long current_file;
7937 unsigned long function;
7938
7939 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (l1, LINE_NUMBER_BEGIN_LABEL, 0);
7940 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (l2, LINE_NUMBER_END_LABEL, 0);
7941 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (p1, LN_PROLOG_AS_LABEL, 0);
7942 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (p2, LN_PROLOG_END_LABEL, 0);
7943
7944 if (DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE - DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE == 4)
7945 dw2_asm_output_data (4, 0xffffffff,
7946 "Initial length escape value indicating 64-bit DWARF extension");
7947 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, l2, l1,
7948 "Length of Source Line Info");
7949 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, l1);
7950
7951 dw2_asm_output_data (2, DWARF_VERSION, "DWARF Version");
7952 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, p2, p1, "Prolog Length");
7953 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, p1);
7954
7955 /* Define the architecture-dependent minimum instruction length (in
7956 bytes). In this implementation of DWARF, this field is used for
7957 information purposes only. Since GCC generates assembly language,
7958 we have no a priori knowledge of how many instruction bytes are
7959 generated for each source line, and therefore can use only the
7960 DW_LNE_set_address and DW_LNS_fixed_advance_pc line information
7961 commands. Accordingly, we fix this as `1', which is "correct
7962 enough" for all architectures, and don't let the target override. */
7963 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 1,
7964 "Minimum Instruction Length");
7965
7966 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DWARF_LINE_DEFAULT_IS_STMT_START,
7967 "Default is_stmt_start flag");
7968 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DWARF_LINE_BASE,
7969 "Line Base Value (Special Opcodes)");
7970 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DWARF_LINE_RANGE,
7971 "Line Range Value (Special Opcodes)");
7972 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DWARF_LINE_OPCODE_BASE,
7973 "Special Opcode Base");
7974
7975 for (opc = 1; opc < DWARF_LINE_OPCODE_BASE; opc++)
7976 {
7977 switch (opc)
7978 {
7979 case DW_LNS_advance_pc:
7980 case DW_LNS_advance_line:
7981 case DW_LNS_set_file:
7982 case DW_LNS_set_column:
7983 case DW_LNS_fixed_advance_pc:
7984 n_op_args = 1;
7985 break;
7986 default:
7987 n_op_args = 0;
7988 break;
7989 }
7990
7991 dw2_asm_output_data (1, n_op_args, "opcode: 0x%x has %d args",
7992 opc, n_op_args);
7993 }
7994
7995 /* Write out the information about the files we use. */
7996 output_file_names ();
7997 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, p2);
7998
7999 /* We used to set the address register to the first location in the text
8000 section here, but that didn't accomplish anything since we already
8001 have a line note for the opening brace of the first function. */
8002
8003 /* Generate the line number to PC correspondence table, encoded as
8004 a series of state machine operations. */
8005 current_file = 1;
8006 current_line = 1;
8007
8008 if (cfun && in_cold_section_p)
8009 strcpy (prev_line_label, cfun->cold_section_label);
8010 else
8011 strcpy (prev_line_label, text_section_label);
8012 for (lt_index = 1; lt_index < line_info_table_in_use; ++lt_index)
8013 {
8014 dw_line_info_ref line_info = &line_info_table[lt_index];
8015
8016 #if 0
8017 /* Disable this optimization for now; GDB wants to see two line notes
8018 at the beginning of a function so it can find the end of the
8019 prologue. */
8020
8021 /* Don't emit anything for redundant notes. Just updating the
8022 address doesn't accomplish anything, because we already assume
8023 that anything after the last address is this line. */
8024 if (line_info->dw_line_num == current_line
8025 && line_info->dw_file_num == current_file)
8026 continue;
8027 #endif
8028
8029 /* Emit debug info for the address of the current line.
8030
8031 Unfortunately, we have little choice here currently, and must always
8032 use the most general form. GCC does not know the address delta
8033 itself, so we can't use DW_LNS_advance_pc. Many ports do have length
8034 attributes which will give an upper bound on the address range. We
8035 could perhaps use length attributes to determine when it is safe to
8036 use DW_LNS_fixed_advance_pc. */
8037
8038 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (line_label, LINE_CODE_LABEL, lt_index);
8039 if (0)
8040 {
8041 /* This can handle deltas up to 0xffff. This takes 3 bytes. */
8042 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNS_fixed_advance_pc,
8043 "DW_LNS_fixed_advance_pc");
8044 dw2_asm_output_delta (2, line_label, prev_line_label, NULL);
8045 }
8046 else
8047 {
8048 /* This can handle any delta. This takes
8049 4+DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE bytes. */
8050 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "DW_LNE_set_address");
8051 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (1 + DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, NULL);
8052 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNE_set_address, NULL);
8053 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, line_label, NULL);
8054 }
8055
8056 strcpy (prev_line_label, line_label);
8057
8058 /* Emit debug info for the source file of the current line, if
8059 different from the previous line. */
8060 if (line_info->dw_file_num != current_file)
8061 {
8062 current_file = line_info->dw_file_num;
8063 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNS_set_file, "DW_LNS_set_file");
8064 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (current_file, "%lu", current_file);
8065 }
8066
8067 /* Emit debug info for the current line number, choosing the encoding
8068 that uses the least amount of space. */
8069 if (line_info->dw_line_num != current_line)
8070 {
8071 line_offset = line_info->dw_line_num - current_line;
8072 line_delta = line_offset - DWARF_LINE_BASE;
8073 current_line = line_info->dw_line_num;
8074 if (line_delta >= 0 && line_delta < (DWARF_LINE_RANGE - 1))
8075 /* This can handle deltas from -10 to 234, using the current
8076 definitions of DWARF_LINE_BASE and DWARF_LINE_RANGE. This
8077 takes 1 byte. */
8078 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DWARF_LINE_OPCODE_BASE + line_delta,
8079 "line %lu", current_line);
8080 else
8081 {
8082 /* This can handle any delta. This takes at least 4 bytes,
8083 depending on the value being encoded. */
8084 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNS_advance_line,
8085 "advance to line %lu", current_line);
8086 dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128 (line_offset, NULL);
8087 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNS_copy, "DW_LNS_copy");
8088 }
8089 }
8090 else
8091 /* We still need to start a new row, so output a copy insn. */
8092 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNS_copy, "DW_LNS_copy");
8093 }
8094
8095 /* Emit debug info for the address of the end of the function. */
8096 if (0)
8097 {
8098 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNS_fixed_advance_pc,
8099 "DW_LNS_fixed_advance_pc");
8100 dw2_asm_output_delta (2, text_end_label, prev_line_label, NULL);
8101 }
8102 else
8103 {
8104 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "DW_LNE_set_address");
8105 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (1 + DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, NULL);
8106 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNE_set_address, NULL);
8107 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, text_end_label, NULL);
8108 }
8109
8110 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "DW_LNE_end_sequence");
8111 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (1, NULL);
8112 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNE_end_sequence, NULL);
8113
8114 function = 0;
8115 current_file = 1;
8116 current_line = 1;
8117 for (lt_index = 0; lt_index < separate_line_info_table_in_use;)
8118 {
8119 dw_separate_line_info_ref line_info
8120 = &separate_line_info_table[lt_index];
8121
8122 #if 0
8123 /* Don't emit anything for redundant notes. */
8124 if (line_info->dw_line_num == current_line
8125 && line_info->dw_file_num == current_file
8126 && line_info->function == function)
8127 goto cont;
8128 #endif
8129
8130 /* Emit debug info for the address of the current line. If this is
8131 a new function, or the first line of a function, then we need
8132 to handle it differently. */
8133 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (line_label, SEPARATE_LINE_CODE_LABEL,
8134 lt_index);
8135 if (function != line_info->function)
8136 {
8137 function = line_info->function;
8138
8139 /* Set the address register to the first line in the function. */
8140 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "DW_LNE_set_address");
8141 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (1 + DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, NULL);
8142 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNE_set_address, NULL);
8143 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, line_label, NULL);
8144 }
8145 else
8146 {
8147 /* ??? See the DW_LNS_advance_pc comment above. */
8148 if (0)
8149 {
8150 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNS_fixed_advance_pc,
8151 "DW_LNS_fixed_advance_pc");
8152 dw2_asm_output_delta (2, line_label, prev_line_label, NULL);
8153 }
8154 else
8155 {
8156 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "DW_LNE_set_address");
8157 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (1 + DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, NULL);
8158 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNE_set_address, NULL);
8159 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, line_label, NULL);
8160 }
8161 }
8162
8163 strcpy (prev_line_label, line_label);
8164
8165 /* Emit debug info for the source file of the current line, if
8166 different from the previous line. */
8167 if (line_info->dw_file_num != current_file)
8168 {
8169 current_file = line_info->dw_file_num;
8170 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNS_set_file, "DW_LNS_set_file");
8171 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (current_file, "%lu", current_file);
8172 }
8173
8174 /* Emit debug info for the current line number, choosing the encoding
8175 that uses the least amount of space. */
8176 if (line_info->dw_line_num != current_line)
8177 {
8178 line_offset = line_info->dw_line_num - current_line;
8179 line_delta = line_offset - DWARF_LINE_BASE;
8180 current_line = line_info->dw_line_num;
8181 if (line_delta >= 0 && line_delta < (DWARF_LINE_RANGE - 1))
8182 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DWARF_LINE_OPCODE_BASE + line_delta,
8183 "line %lu", current_line);
8184 else
8185 {
8186 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNS_advance_line,
8187 "advance to line %lu", current_line);
8188 dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128 (line_offset, NULL);
8189 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNS_copy, "DW_LNS_copy");
8190 }
8191 }
8192 else
8193 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNS_copy, "DW_LNS_copy");
8194
8195 #if 0
8196 cont:
8197 #endif
8198
8199 lt_index++;
8200
8201 /* If we're done with a function, end its sequence. */
8202 if (lt_index == separate_line_info_table_in_use
8203 || separate_line_info_table[lt_index].function != function)
8204 {
8205 current_file = 1;
8206 current_line = 1;
8207
8208 /* Emit debug info for the address of the end of the function. */
8209 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (line_label, FUNC_END_LABEL, function);
8210 if (0)
8211 {
8212 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNS_fixed_advance_pc,
8213 "DW_LNS_fixed_advance_pc");
8214 dw2_asm_output_delta (2, line_label, prev_line_label, NULL);
8215 }
8216 else
8217 {
8218 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "DW_LNE_set_address");
8219 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (1 + DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, NULL);
8220 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNE_set_address, NULL);
8221 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, line_label, NULL);
8222 }
8223
8224 /* Output the marker for the end of this sequence. */
8225 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "DW_LNE_end_sequence");
8226 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (1, NULL);
8227 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNE_end_sequence, NULL);
8228 }
8229 }
8230
8231 /* Output the marker for the end of the line number info. */
8232 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, l2);
8233 }
8234 \f
8235 /* Given a pointer to a tree node for some base type, return a pointer to
8236 a DIE that describes the given type.
8237
8238 This routine must only be called for GCC type nodes that correspond to
8239 Dwarf base (fundamental) types. */
8240
8241 static dw_die_ref
8242 base_type_die (tree type)
8243 {
8244 dw_die_ref base_type_result;
8245 enum dwarf_type encoding;
8246
8247 if (TREE_CODE (type) == ERROR_MARK || TREE_CODE (type) == VOID_TYPE)
8248 return 0;
8249
8250 switch (TREE_CODE (type))
8251 {
8252 case INTEGER_TYPE:
8253 if (TYPE_STRING_FLAG (type))
8254 {
8255 if (TYPE_UNSIGNED (type))
8256 encoding = DW_ATE_unsigned_char;
8257 else
8258 encoding = DW_ATE_signed_char;
8259 }
8260 else if (TYPE_UNSIGNED (type))
8261 encoding = DW_ATE_unsigned;
8262 else
8263 encoding = DW_ATE_signed;
8264 break;
8265
8266 case REAL_TYPE:
8267 if (DECIMAL_FLOAT_MODE_P (TYPE_MODE (type)))
8268 encoding = DW_ATE_decimal_float;
8269 else
8270 encoding = DW_ATE_float;
8271 break;
8272
8273 /* Dwarf2 doesn't know anything about complex ints, so use
8274 a user defined type for it. */
8275 case COMPLEX_TYPE:
8276 if (TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (type)) == REAL_TYPE)
8277 encoding = DW_ATE_complex_float;
8278 else
8279 encoding = DW_ATE_lo_user;
8280 break;
8281
8282 case BOOLEAN_TYPE:
8283 /* GNU FORTRAN/Ada/C++ BOOLEAN type. */
8284 encoding = DW_ATE_boolean;
8285 break;
8286
8287 default:
8288 /* No other TREE_CODEs are Dwarf fundamental types. */
8289 gcc_unreachable ();
8290 }
8291
8292 base_type_result = new_die (DW_TAG_base_type, comp_unit_die, type);
8293
8294 /* This probably indicates a bug. */
8295 if (! TYPE_NAME (type))
8296 add_name_attribute (base_type_result, "__unknown__");
8297
8298 add_AT_unsigned (base_type_result, DW_AT_byte_size,
8299 int_size_in_bytes (type));
8300 add_AT_unsigned (base_type_result, DW_AT_encoding, encoding);
8301
8302 return base_type_result;
8303 }
8304
8305 /* Given a pointer to an arbitrary ..._TYPE tree node, return nonzero if the
8306 given input type is a Dwarf "fundamental" type. Otherwise return null. */
8307
8308 static inline int
8309 is_base_type (tree type)
8310 {
8311 switch (TREE_CODE (type))
8312 {
8313 case ERROR_MARK:
8314 case VOID_TYPE:
8315 case INTEGER_TYPE:
8316 case REAL_TYPE:
8317 case COMPLEX_TYPE:
8318 case BOOLEAN_TYPE:
8319 return 1;
8320
8321 case ARRAY_TYPE:
8322 case RECORD_TYPE:
8323 case UNION_TYPE:
8324 case QUAL_UNION_TYPE:
8325 case ENUMERAL_TYPE:
8326 case FUNCTION_TYPE:
8327 case METHOD_TYPE:
8328 case POINTER_TYPE:
8329 case REFERENCE_TYPE:
8330 case OFFSET_TYPE:
8331 case LANG_TYPE:
8332 case VECTOR_TYPE:
8333 return 0;
8334
8335 default:
8336 gcc_unreachable ();
8337 }
8338
8339 return 0;
8340 }
8341
8342 /* Given a pointer to a tree node, assumed to be some kind of a ..._TYPE
8343 node, return the size in bits for the type if it is a constant, or else
8344 return the alignment for the type if the type's size is not constant, or
8345 else return BITS_PER_WORD if the type actually turns out to be an
8346 ERROR_MARK node. */
8347
8348 static inline unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT
8349 simple_type_size_in_bits (tree type)
8350 {
8351 if (TREE_CODE (type) == ERROR_MARK)
8352 return BITS_PER_WORD;
8353 else if (TYPE_SIZE (type) == NULL_TREE)
8354 return 0;
8355 else if (host_integerp (TYPE_SIZE (type), 1))
8356 return tree_low_cst (TYPE_SIZE (type), 1);
8357 else
8358 return TYPE_ALIGN (type);
8359 }
8360
8361 /* Return true if the debug information for the given type should be
8362 emitted as a subrange type. */
8363
8364 static inline bool
8365 is_subrange_type (tree type)
8366 {
8367 tree subtype = TREE_TYPE (type);
8368
8369 /* Subrange types are identified by the fact that they are integer
8370 types, and that they have a subtype which is either an integer type
8371 or an enumeral type. */
8372
8373 if (TREE_CODE (type) != INTEGER_TYPE
8374 || subtype == NULL_TREE)
8375 return false;
8376
8377 if (TREE_CODE (subtype) != INTEGER_TYPE
8378 && TREE_CODE (subtype) != ENUMERAL_TYPE)
8379 return false;
8380
8381 if (TREE_CODE (type) == TREE_CODE (subtype)
8382 && int_size_in_bytes (type) == int_size_in_bytes (subtype)
8383 && TYPE_MIN_VALUE (type) != NULL
8384 && TYPE_MIN_VALUE (subtype) != NULL
8385 && tree_int_cst_equal (TYPE_MIN_VALUE (type), TYPE_MIN_VALUE (subtype))
8386 && TYPE_MAX_VALUE (type) != NULL
8387 && TYPE_MAX_VALUE (subtype) != NULL
8388 && tree_int_cst_equal (TYPE_MAX_VALUE (type), TYPE_MAX_VALUE (subtype)))
8389 {
8390 /* The type and its subtype have the same representation. If in
8391 addition the two types also have the same name, then the given
8392 type is not a subrange type, but rather a plain base type. */
8393 /* FIXME: brobecker/2004-03-22:
8394 Sizetype INTEGER_CSTs nodes are canonicalized. It should
8395 therefore be sufficient to check the TYPE_SIZE node pointers
8396 rather than checking the actual size. Unfortunately, we have
8397 found some cases, such as in the Ada "integer" type, where
8398 this is not the case. Until this problem is solved, we need to
8399 keep checking the actual size. */
8400 tree type_name = TYPE_NAME (type);
8401 tree subtype_name = TYPE_NAME (subtype);
8402
8403 if (type_name != NULL && TREE_CODE (type_name) == TYPE_DECL)
8404 type_name = DECL_NAME (type_name);
8405
8406 if (subtype_name != NULL && TREE_CODE (subtype_name) == TYPE_DECL)
8407 subtype_name = DECL_NAME (subtype_name);
8408
8409 if (type_name == subtype_name)
8410 return false;
8411 }
8412
8413 return true;
8414 }
8415
8416 /* Given a pointer to a tree node for a subrange type, return a pointer
8417 to a DIE that describes the given type. */
8418
8419 static dw_die_ref
8420 subrange_type_die (tree type, dw_die_ref context_die)
8421 {
8422 dw_die_ref subrange_die;
8423 const HOST_WIDE_INT size_in_bytes = int_size_in_bytes (type);
8424
8425 if (context_die == NULL)
8426 context_die = comp_unit_die;
8427
8428 subrange_die = new_die (DW_TAG_subrange_type, context_die, type);
8429
8430 if (int_size_in_bytes (TREE_TYPE (type)) != size_in_bytes)
8431 {
8432 /* The size of the subrange type and its base type do not match,
8433 so we need to generate a size attribute for the subrange type. */
8434 add_AT_unsigned (subrange_die, DW_AT_byte_size, size_in_bytes);
8435 }
8436
8437 if (TYPE_MIN_VALUE (type) != NULL)
8438 add_bound_info (subrange_die, DW_AT_lower_bound,
8439 TYPE_MIN_VALUE (type));
8440 if (TYPE_MAX_VALUE (type) != NULL)
8441 add_bound_info (subrange_die, DW_AT_upper_bound,
8442 TYPE_MAX_VALUE (type));
8443
8444 return subrange_die;
8445 }
8446
8447 /* Given a pointer to an arbitrary ..._TYPE tree node, return a debugging
8448 entry that chains various modifiers in front of the given type. */
8449
8450 static dw_die_ref
8451 modified_type_die (tree type, int is_const_type, int is_volatile_type,
8452 dw_die_ref context_die)
8453 {
8454 enum tree_code code = TREE_CODE (type);
8455 dw_die_ref mod_type_die;
8456 dw_die_ref sub_die = NULL;
8457 tree item_type = NULL;
8458 tree qualified_type;
8459 tree name;
8460
8461 if (code == ERROR_MARK)
8462 return NULL;
8463
8464 /* See if we already have the appropriately qualified variant of
8465 this type. */
8466 qualified_type
8467 = get_qualified_type (type,
8468 ((is_const_type ? TYPE_QUAL_CONST : 0)
8469 | (is_volatile_type ? TYPE_QUAL_VOLATILE : 0)));
8470
8471 /* If we do, then we can just use its DIE, if it exists. */
8472 if (qualified_type)
8473 {
8474 mod_type_die = lookup_type_die (qualified_type);
8475 if (mod_type_die)
8476 return mod_type_die;
8477 }
8478
8479 name = qualified_type ? TYPE_NAME (qualified_type) : NULL;
8480
8481 /* Handle C typedef types. */
8482 if (name && TREE_CODE (name) == TYPE_DECL && DECL_ORIGINAL_TYPE (name))
8483 {
8484 tree dtype = TREE_TYPE (name);
8485
8486 if (qualified_type == dtype)
8487 {
8488 /* For a named type, use the typedef. */
8489 gen_type_die (qualified_type, context_die);
8490 return lookup_type_die (qualified_type);
8491 }
8492 else if (is_const_type < TYPE_READONLY (dtype)
8493 || is_volatile_type < TYPE_VOLATILE (dtype)
8494 || (is_const_type <= TYPE_READONLY (dtype)
8495 && is_volatile_type <= TYPE_VOLATILE (dtype)
8496 && DECL_ORIGINAL_TYPE (name) != type))
8497 /* cv-unqualified version of named type. Just use the unnamed
8498 type to which it refers. */
8499 return modified_type_die (DECL_ORIGINAL_TYPE (name),
8500 is_const_type, is_volatile_type,
8501 context_die);
8502 /* Else cv-qualified version of named type; fall through. */
8503 }
8504
8505 if (is_const_type)
8506 {
8507 mod_type_die = new_die (DW_TAG_const_type, comp_unit_die, type);
8508 sub_die = modified_type_die (type, 0, is_volatile_type, context_die);
8509 }
8510 else if (is_volatile_type)
8511 {
8512 mod_type_die = new_die (DW_TAG_volatile_type, comp_unit_die, type);
8513 sub_die = modified_type_die (type, 0, 0, context_die);
8514 }
8515 else if (code == POINTER_TYPE)
8516 {
8517 mod_type_die = new_die (DW_TAG_pointer_type, comp_unit_die, type);
8518 add_AT_unsigned (mod_type_die, DW_AT_byte_size,
8519 simple_type_size_in_bits (type) / BITS_PER_UNIT);
8520 item_type = TREE_TYPE (type);
8521 }
8522 else if (code == REFERENCE_TYPE)
8523 {
8524 mod_type_die = new_die (DW_TAG_reference_type, comp_unit_die, type);
8525 add_AT_unsigned (mod_type_die, DW_AT_byte_size,
8526 simple_type_size_in_bits (type) / BITS_PER_UNIT);
8527 item_type = TREE_TYPE (type);
8528 }
8529 else if (is_subrange_type (type))
8530 {
8531 mod_type_die = subrange_type_die (type, context_die);
8532 item_type = TREE_TYPE (type);
8533 }
8534 else if (is_base_type (type))
8535 mod_type_die = base_type_die (type);
8536 else
8537 {
8538 gen_type_die (type, context_die);
8539
8540 /* We have to get the type_main_variant here (and pass that to the
8541 `lookup_type_die' routine) because the ..._TYPE node we have
8542 might simply be a *copy* of some original type node (where the
8543 copy was created to help us keep track of typedef names) and
8544 that copy might have a different TYPE_UID from the original
8545 ..._TYPE node. */
8546 if (TREE_CODE (type) != VECTOR_TYPE)
8547 return lookup_type_die (type_main_variant (type));
8548 else
8549 /* Vectors have the debugging information in the type,
8550 not the main variant. */
8551 return lookup_type_die (type);
8552 }
8553
8554 /* Builtin types don't have a DECL_ORIGINAL_TYPE. For those,
8555 don't output a DW_TAG_typedef, since there isn't one in the
8556 user's program; just attach a DW_AT_name to the type. */
8557 if (name
8558 && (TREE_CODE (name) != TYPE_DECL || TREE_TYPE (name) == qualified_type))
8559 {
8560 if (TREE_CODE (name) == TYPE_DECL)
8561 /* Could just call add_name_and_src_coords_attributes here,
8562 but since this is a builtin type it doesn't have any
8563 useful source coordinates anyway. */
8564 name = DECL_NAME (name);
8565 add_name_attribute (mod_type_die, IDENTIFIER_POINTER (name));
8566 }
8567
8568 if (qualified_type)
8569 equate_type_number_to_die (qualified_type, mod_type_die);
8570
8571 if (item_type)
8572 /* We must do this after the equate_type_number_to_die call, in case
8573 this is a recursive type. This ensures that the modified_type_die
8574 recursion will terminate even if the type is recursive. Recursive
8575 types are possible in Ada. */
8576 sub_die = modified_type_die (item_type,
8577 TYPE_READONLY (item_type),
8578 TYPE_VOLATILE (item_type),
8579 context_die);
8580
8581 if (sub_die != NULL)
8582 add_AT_die_ref (mod_type_die, DW_AT_type, sub_die);
8583
8584 return mod_type_die;
8585 }
8586
8587 /* Given a pointer to an arbitrary ..._TYPE tree node, return true if it is
8588 an enumerated type. */
8589
8590 static inline int
8591 type_is_enum (tree type)
8592 {
8593 return TREE_CODE (type) == ENUMERAL_TYPE;
8594 }
8595
8596 /* Return the DBX register number described by a given RTL node. */
8597
8598 static unsigned int
8599 dbx_reg_number (rtx rtl)
8600 {
8601 unsigned regno = REGNO (rtl);
8602
8603 gcc_assert (regno < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER);
8604
8605 #ifdef LEAF_REG_REMAP
8606 if (current_function_uses_only_leaf_regs)
8607 {
8608 int leaf_reg = LEAF_REG_REMAP (regno);
8609 if (leaf_reg != -1)
8610 regno = (unsigned) leaf_reg;
8611 }
8612 #endif
8613
8614 return DBX_REGISTER_NUMBER (regno);
8615 }
8616
8617 /* Optionally add a DW_OP_piece term to a location description expression.
8618 DW_OP_piece is only added if the location description expression already
8619 doesn't end with DW_OP_piece. */
8620
8621 static void
8622 add_loc_descr_op_piece (dw_loc_descr_ref *list_head, int size)
8623 {
8624 dw_loc_descr_ref loc;
8625
8626 if (*list_head != NULL)
8627 {
8628 /* Find the end of the chain. */
8629 for (loc = *list_head; loc->dw_loc_next != NULL; loc = loc->dw_loc_next)
8630 ;
8631
8632 if (loc->dw_loc_opc != DW_OP_piece)
8633 loc->dw_loc_next = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_piece, size, 0);
8634 }
8635 }
8636
8637 /* Return a location descriptor that designates a machine register or
8638 zero if there is none. */
8639
8640 static dw_loc_descr_ref
8641 reg_loc_descriptor (rtx rtl)
8642 {
8643 rtx regs;
8644
8645 if (REGNO (rtl) >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
8646 return 0;
8647
8648 regs = targetm.dwarf_register_span (rtl);
8649
8650 if (hard_regno_nregs[REGNO (rtl)][GET_MODE (rtl)] > 1 || regs)
8651 return multiple_reg_loc_descriptor (rtl, regs);
8652 else
8653 return one_reg_loc_descriptor (dbx_reg_number (rtl));
8654 }
8655
8656 /* Return a location descriptor that designates a machine register for
8657 a given hard register number. */
8658
8659 static dw_loc_descr_ref
8660 one_reg_loc_descriptor (unsigned int regno)
8661 {
8662 if (regno <= 31)
8663 return new_loc_descr (DW_OP_reg0 + regno, 0, 0);
8664 else
8665 return new_loc_descr (DW_OP_regx, regno, 0);
8666 }
8667
8668 /* Given an RTL of a register, return a location descriptor that
8669 designates a value that spans more than one register. */
8670
8671 static dw_loc_descr_ref
8672 multiple_reg_loc_descriptor (rtx rtl, rtx regs)
8673 {
8674 int nregs, size, i;
8675 unsigned reg;
8676 dw_loc_descr_ref loc_result = NULL;
8677
8678 reg = REGNO (rtl);
8679 #ifdef LEAF_REG_REMAP
8680 if (current_function_uses_only_leaf_regs)
8681 {
8682 int leaf_reg = LEAF_REG_REMAP (reg);
8683 if (leaf_reg != -1)
8684 reg = (unsigned) leaf_reg;
8685 }
8686 #endif
8687 gcc_assert ((unsigned) DBX_REGISTER_NUMBER (reg) == dbx_reg_number (rtl));
8688 nregs = hard_regno_nregs[REGNO (rtl)][GET_MODE (rtl)];
8689
8690 /* Simple, contiguous registers. */
8691 if (regs == NULL_RTX)
8692 {
8693 size = GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (rtl)) / nregs;
8694
8695 loc_result = NULL;
8696 while (nregs--)
8697 {
8698 dw_loc_descr_ref t;
8699
8700 t = one_reg_loc_descriptor (DBX_REGISTER_NUMBER (reg));
8701 add_loc_descr (&loc_result, t);
8702 add_loc_descr_op_piece (&loc_result, size);
8703 ++reg;
8704 }
8705 return loc_result;
8706 }
8707
8708 /* Now onto stupid register sets in non contiguous locations. */
8709
8710 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (regs) == PARALLEL);
8711
8712 size = GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (XVECEXP (regs, 0, 0)));
8713 loc_result = NULL;
8714
8715 for (i = 0; i < XVECLEN (regs, 0); ++i)
8716 {
8717 dw_loc_descr_ref t;
8718
8719 t = one_reg_loc_descriptor (REGNO (XVECEXP (regs, 0, i)));
8720 add_loc_descr (&loc_result, t);
8721 size = GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (XVECEXP (regs, 0, 0)));
8722 add_loc_descr_op_piece (&loc_result, size);
8723 }
8724 return loc_result;
8725 }
8726
8727 /* Return a location descriptor that designates a constant. */
8728
8729 static dw_loc_descr_ref
8730 int_loc_descriptor (HOST_WIDE_INT i)
8731 {
8732 enum dwarf_location_atom op;
8733
8734 /* Pick the smallest representation of a constant, rather than just
8735 defaulting to the LEB encoding. */
8736 if (i >= 0)
8737 {
8738 if (i <= 31)
8739 op = DW_OP_lit0 + i;
8740 else if (i <= 0xff)
8741 op = DW_OP_const1u;
8742 else if (i <= 0xffff)
8743 op = DW_OP_const2u;
8744 else if (HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT == 32
8745 || i <= 0xffffffff)
8746 op = DW_OP_const4u;
8747 else
8748 op = DW_OP_constu;
8749 }
8750 else
8751 {
8752 if (i >= -0x80)
8753 op = DW_OP_const1s;
8754 else if (i >= -0x8000)
8755 op = DW_OP_const2s;
8756 else if (HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT == 32
8757 || i >= -0x80000000)
8758 op = DW_OP_const4s;
8759 else
8760 op = DW_OP_consts;
8761 }
8762
8763 return new_loc_descr (op, i, 0);
8764 }
8765
8766 /* Return a location descriptor that designates a base+offset location. */
8767
8768 static dw_loc_descr_ref
8769 based_loc_descr (rtx reg, HOST_WIDE_INT offset)
8770 {
8771 unsigned int regno;
8772
8773 /* We only use "frame base" when we're sure we're talking about the
8774 post-prologue local stack frame. We do this by *not* running
8775 register elimination until this point, and recognizing the special
8776 argument pointer and soft frame pointer rtx's. */
8777 if (reg == arg_pointer_rtx || reg == frame_pointer_rtx)
8778 {
8779 rtx elim = eliminate_regs (reg, VOIDmode, NULL_RTX);
8780
8781 if (elim != reg)
8782 {
8783 if (GET_CODE (elim) == PLUS)
8784 {
8785 offset += INTVAL (XEXP (elim, 1));
8786 elim = XEXP (elim, 0);
8787 }
8788 gcc_assert (elim == (frame_pointer_needed ? hard_frame_pointer_rtx
8789 : stack_pointer_rtx));
8790 offset += frame_pointer_fb_offset;
8791
8792 return new_loc_descr (DW_OP_fbreg, offset, 0);
8793 }
8794 }
8795
8796 regno = dbx_reg_number (reg);
8797 if (regno <= 31)
8798 return new_loc_descr (DW_OP_breg0 + regno, offset, 0);
8799 else
8800 return new_loc_descr (DW_OP_bregx, regno, offset);
8801 }
8802
8803 /* Return true if this RTL expression describes a base+offset calculation. */
8804
8805 static inline int
8806 is_based_loc (rtx rtl)
8807 {
8808 return (GET_CODE (rtl) == PLUS
8809 && ((REG_P (XEXP (rtl, 0))
8810 && REGNO (XEXP (rtl, 0)) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
8811 && GET_CODE (XEXP (rtl, 1)) == CONST_INT)));
8812 }
8813
8814 /* The following routine converts the RTL for a variable or parameter
8815 (resident in memory) into an equivalent Dwarf representation of a
8816 mechanism for getting the address of that same variable onto the top of a
8817 hypothetical "address evaluation" stack.
8818
8819 When creating memory location descriptors, we are effectively transforming
8820 the RTL for a memory-resident object into its Dwarf postfix expression
8821 equivalent. This routine recursively descends an RTL tree, turning
8822 it into Dwarf postfix code as it goes.
8823
8824 MODE is the mode of the memory reference, needed to handle some
8825 autoincrement addressing modes.
8826
8827 CAN_USE_FBREG is a flag whether we can use DW_AT_frame_base in the
8828 location list for RTL.
8829
8830 Return 0 if we can't represent the location. */
8831
8832 static dw_loc_descr_ref
8833 mem_loc_descriptor (rtx rtl, enum machine_mode mode)
8834 {
8835 dw_loc_descr_ref mem_loc_result = NULL;
8836 enum dwarf_location_atom op;
8837
8838 /* Note that for a dynamically sized array, the location we will generate a
8839 description of here will be the lowest numbered location which is
8840 actually within the array. That's *not* necessarily the same as the
8841 zeroth element of the array. */
8842
8843 rtl = targetm.delegitimize_address (rtl);
8844
8845 switch (GET_CODE (rtl))
8846 {
8847 case POST_INC:
8848 case POST_DEC:
8849 case POST_MODIFY:
8850 /* POST_INC and POST_DEC can be handled just like a SUBREG. So we
8851 just fall into the SUBREG code. */
8852
8853 /* ... fall through ... */
8854
8855 case SUBREG:
8856 /* The case of a subreg may arise when we have a local (register)
8857 variable or a formal (register) parameter which doesn't quite fill
8858 up an entire register. For now, just assume that it is
8859 legitimate to make the Dwarf info refer to the whole register which
8860 contains the given subreg. */
8861 rtl = XEXP (rtl, 0);
8862
8863 /* ... fall through ... */
8864
8865 case REG:
8866 /* Whenever a register number forms a part of the description of the
8867 method for calculating the (dynamic) address of a memory resident
8868 object, DWARF rules require the register number be referred to as
8869 a "base register". This distinction is not based in any way upon
8870 what category of register the hardware believes the given register
8871 belongs to. This is strictly DWARF terminology we're dealing with
8872 here. Note that in cases where the location of a memory-resident
8873 data object could be expressed as: OP_ADD (OP_BASEREG (basereg),
8874 OP_CONST (0)) the actual DWARF location descriptor that we generate
8875 may just be OP_BASEREG (basereg). This may look deceptively like
8876 the object in question was allocated to a register (rather than in
8877 memory) so DWARF consumers need to be aware of the subtle
8878 distinction between OP_REG and OP_BASEREG. */
8879 if (REGNO (rtl) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
8880 mem_loc_result = based_loc_descr (rtl, 0);
8881 break;
8882
8883 case MEM:
8884 mem_loc_result = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), GET_MODE (rtl));
8885 if (mem_loc_result != 0)
8886 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_deref, 0, 0));
8887 break;
8888
8889 case LO_SUM:
8890 rtl = XEXP (rtl, 1);
8891
8892 /* ... fall through ... */
8893
8894 case LABEL_REF:
8895 /* Some ports can transform a symbol ref into a label ref, because
8896 the symbol ref is too far away and has to be dumped into a constant
8897 pool. */
8898 case CONST:
8899 case SYMBOL_REF:
8900 /* Alternatively, the symbol in the constant pool might be referenced
8901 by a different symbol. */
8902 if (GET_CODE (rtl) == SYMBOL_REF && CONSTANT_POOL_ADDRESS_P (rtl))
8903 {
8904 bool marked;
8905 rtx tmp = get_pool_constant_mark (rtl, &marked);
8906
8907 if (GET_CODE (tmp) == SYMBOL_REF)
8908 {
8909 rtl = tmp;
8910 if (CONSTANT_POOL_ADDRESS_P (tmp))
8911 get_pool_constant_mark (tmp, &marked);
8912 else
8913 marked = true;
8914 }
8915
8916 /* If all references to this pool constant were optimized away,
8917 it was not output and thus we can't represent it.
8918 FIXME: might try to use DW_OP_const_value here, though
8919 DW_OP_piece complicates it. */
8920 if (!marked)
8921 return 0;
8922 }
8923
8924 mem_loc_result = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_addr, 0, 0);
8925 mem_loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_addr;
8926 mem_loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_addr = rtl;
8927 VEC_safe_push (rtx, gc, used_rtx_array, rtl);
8928 break;
8929
8930 case PRE_MODIFY:
8931 /* Extract the PLUS expression nested inside and fall into
8932 PLUS code below. */
8933 rtl = XEXP (rtl, 1);
8934 goto plus;
8935
8936 case PRE_INC:
8937 case PRE_DEC:
8938 /* Turn these into a PLUS expression and fall into the PLUS code
8939 below. */
8940 rtl = gen_rtx_PLUS (word_mode, XEXP (rtl, 0),
8941 GEN_INT (GET_CODE (rtl) == PRE_INC
8942 ? GET_MODE_UNIT_SIZE (mode)
8943 : -GET_MODE_UNIT_SIZE (mode)));
8944
8945 /* ... fall through ... */
8946
8947 case PLUS:
8948 plus:
8949 if (is_based_loc (rtl))
8950 mem_loc_result = based_loc_descr (XEXP (rtl, 0),
8951 INTVAL (XEXP (rtl, 1)));
8952 else
8953 {
8954 mem_loc_result = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), mode);
8955 if (mem_loc_result == 0)
8956 break;
8957
8958 if (GET_CODE (XEXP (rtl, 1)) == CONST_INT
8959 && INTVAL (XEXP (rtl, 1)) >= 0)
8960 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result,
8961 new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus_uconst,
8962 INTVAL (XEXP (rtl, 1)), 0));
8963 else
8964 {
8965 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result,
8966 mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 1), mode));
8967 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result,
8968 new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus, 0, 0));
8969 }
8970 }
8971 break;
8972
8973 /* If a pseudo-reg is optimized away, it is possible for it to
8974 be replaced with a MEM containing a multiply or shift. */
8975 case MULT:
8976 op = DW_OP_mul;
8977 goto do_binop;
8978
8979 case ASHIFT:
8980 op = DW_OP_shl;
8981 goto do_binop;
8982
8983 case ASHIFTRT:
8984 op = DW_OP_shra;
8985 goto do_binop;
8986
8987 case LSHIFTRT:
8988 op = DW_OP_shr;
8989 goto do_binop;
8990
8991 do_binop:
8992 {
8993 dw_loc_descr_ref op0 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), mode);
8994 dw_loc_descr_ref op1 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 1), mode);
8995
8996 if (op0 == 0 || op1 == 0)
8997 break;
8998
8999 mem_loc_result = op0;
9000 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, op1);
9001 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, new_loc_descr (op, 0, 0));
9002 break;
9003 }
9004
9005 case CONST_INT:
9006 mem_loc_result = int_loc_descriptor (INTVAL (rtl));
9007 break;
9008
9009 default:
9010 gcc_unreachable ();
9011 }
9012
9013 return mem_loc_result;
9014 }
9015
9016 /* Return a descriptor that describes the concatenation of two locations.
9017 This is typically a complex variable. */
9018
9019 static dw_loc_descr_ref
9020 concat_loc_descriptor (rtx x0, rtx x1)
9021 {
9022 dw_loc_descr_ref cc_loc_result = NULL;
9023 dw_loc_descr_ref x0_ref = loc_descriptor (x0);
9024 dw_loc_descr_ref x1_ref = loc_descriptor (x1);
9025
9026 if (x0_ref == 0 || x1_ref == 0)
9027 return 0;
9028
9029 cc_loc_result = x0_ref;
9030 add_loc_descr_op_piece (&cc_loc_result, GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (x0)));
9031
9032 add_loc_descr (&cc_loc_result, x1_ref);
9033 add_loc_descr_op_piece (&cc_loc_result, GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (x1)));
9034
9035 return cc_loc_result;
9036 }
9037
9038 /* Return a descriptor that describes the concatenation of N
9039 locations. */
9040
9041 static dw_loc_descr_ref
9042 concatn_loc_descriptor (rtx concatn)
9043 {
9044 unsigned int i;
9045 dw_loc_descr_ref cc_loc_result = NULL;
9046 unsigned int n = XVECLEN (concatn, 0);
9047
9048 for (i = 0; i < n; ++i)
9049 {
9050 dw_loc_descr_ref ref;
9051 rtx x = XVECEXP (concatn, 0, i);
9052
9053 ref = loc_descriptor (x);
9054 if (ref == NULL)
9055 return NULL;
9056
9057 add_loc_descr (&cc_loc_result, ref);
9058 add_loc_descr_op_piece (&cc_loc_result, GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (x)));
9059 }
9060
9061 return cc_loc_result;
9062 }
9063
9064 /* Output a proper Dwarf location descriptor for a variable or parameter
9065 which is either allocated in a register or in a memory location. For a
9066 register, we just generate an OP_REG and the register number. For a
9067 memory location we provide a Dwarf postfix expression describing how to
9068 generate the (dynamic) address of the object onto the address stack.
9069
9070 If we don't know how to describe it, return 0. */
9071
9072 static dw_loc_descr_ref
9073 loc_descriptor (rtx rtl)
9074 {
9075 dw_loc_descr_ref loc_result = NULL;
9076
9077 switch (GET_CODE (rtl))
9078 {
9079 case SUBREG:
9080 /* The case of a subreg may arise when we have a local (register)
9081 variable or a formal (register) parameter which doesn't quite fill
9082 up an entire register. For now, just assume that it is
9083 legitimate to make the Dwarf info refer to the whole register which
9084 contains the given subreg. */
9085 rtl = SUBREG_REG (rtl);
9086
9087 /* ... fall through ... */
9088
9089 case REG:
9090 loc_result = reg_loc_descriptor (rtl);
9091 break;
9092
9093 case MEM:
9094 loc_result = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), GET_MODE (rtl));
9095 break;
9096
9097 case CONCAT:
9098 loc_result = concat_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), XEXP (rtl, 1));
9099 break;
9100
9101 case CONCATN:
9102 loc_result = concatn_loc_descriptor (rtl);
9103 break;
9104
9105 case VAR_LOCATION:
9106 /* Single part. */
9107 if (GET_CODE (XEXP (rtl, 1)) != PARALLEL)
9108 {
9109 loc_result = loc_descriptor (XEXP (XEXP (rtl, 1), 0));
9110 break;
9111 }
9112
9113 rtl = XEXP (rtl, 1);
9114 /* FALLTHRU */
9115
9116 case PARALLEL:
9117 {
9118 rtvec par_elems = XVEC (rtl, 0);
9119 int num_elem = GET_NUM_ELEM (par_elems);
9120 enum machine_mode mode;
9121 int i;
9122
9123 /* Create the first one, so we have something to add to. */
9124 loc_result = loc_descriptor (XEXP (RTVEC_ELT (par_elems, 0), 0));
9125 mode = GET_MODE (XEXP (RTVEC_ELT (par_elems, 0), 0));
9126 add_loc_descr_op_piece (&loc_result, GET_MODE_SIZE (mode));
9127 for (i = 1; i < num_elem; i++)
9128 {
9129 dw_loc_descr_ref temp;
9130
9131 temp = loc_descriptor (XEXP (RTVEC_ELT (par_elems, i), 0));
9132 add_loc_descr (&loc_result, temp);
9133 mode = GET_MODE (XEXP (RTVEC_ELT (par_elems, i), 0));
9134 add_loc_descr_op_piece (&loc_result, GET_MODE_SIZE (mode));
9135 }
9136 }
9137 break;
9138
9139 default:
9140 gcc_unreachable ();
9141 }
9142
9143 return loc_result;
9144 }
9145
9146 /* Similar, but generate the descriptor from trees instead of rtl. This comes
9147 up particularly with variable length arrays. WANT_ADDRESS is 2 if this is
9148 a top-level invocation of loc_descriptor_from_tree; is 1 if this is not a
9149 top-level invocation, and we require the address of LOC; is 0 if we require
9150 the value of LOC. */
9151
9152 static dw_loc_descr_ref
9153 loc_descriptor_from_tree_1 (tree loc, int want_address)
9154 {
9155 dw_loc_descr_ref ret, ret1;
9156 int have_address = 0;
9157 enum dwarf_location_atom op;
9158
9159 /* ??? Most of the time we do not take proper care for sign/zero
9160 extending the values properly. Hopefully this won't be a real
9161 problem... */
9162
9163 switch (TREE_CODE (loc))
9164 {
9165 case ERROR_MARK:
9166 return 0;
9167
9168 case PLACEHOLDER_EXPR:
9169 /* This case involves extracting fields from an object to determine the
9170 position of other fields. We don't try to encode this here. The
9171 only user of this is Ada, which encodes the needed information using
9172 the names of types. */
9173 return 0;
9174
9175 case CALL_EXPR:
9176 return 0;
9177
9178 case PREINCREMENT_EXPR:
9179 case PREDECREMENT_EXPR:
9180 case POSTINCREMENT_EXPR:
9181 case POSTDECREMENT_EXPR:
9182 /* There are no opcodes for these operations. */
9183 return 0;
9184
9185 case ADDR_EXPR:
9186 /* If we already want an address, there's nothing we can do. */
9187 if (want_address)
9188 return 0;
9189
9190 /* Otherwise, process the argument and look for the address. */
9191 return loc_descriptor_from_tree_1 (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0), 1);
9192
9193 case VAR_DECL:
9194 if (DECL_THREAD_LOCAL_P (loc))
9195 {
9196 rtx rtl;
9197
9198 /* If this is not defined, we have no way to emit the data. */
9199 if (!targetm.have_tls || !targetm.asm_out.output_dwarf_dtprel)
9200 return 0;
9201
9202 /* The way DW_OP_GNU_push_tls_address is specified, we can only
9203 look up addresses of objects in the current module. */
9204 if (DECL_EXTERNAL (loc))
9205 return 0;
9206
9207 rtl = rtl_for_decl_location (loc);
9208 if (rtl == NULL_RTX)
9209 return 0;
9210
9211 if (!MEM_P (rtl))
9212 return 0;
9213 rtl = XEXP (rtl, 0);
9214 if (! CONSTANT_P (rtl))
9215 return 0;
9216
9217 ret = new_loc_descr (INTERNAL_DW_OP_tls_addr, 0, 0);
9218 ret->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_addr;
9219 ret->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_addr = rtl;
9220
9221 ret1 = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_GNU_push_tls_address, 0, 0);
9222 add_loc_descr (&ret, ret1);
9223
9224 have_address = 1;
9225 break;
9226 }
9227 /* FALLTHRU */
9228
9229 case PARM_DECL:
9230 if (DECL_HAS_VALUE_EXPR_P (loc))
9231 return loc_descriptor_from_tree_1 (DECL_VALUE_EXPR (loc),
9232 want_address);
9233 /* FALLTHRU */
9234
9235 case RESULT_DECL:
9236 case FUNCTION_DECL:
9237 {
9238 rtx rtl = rtl_for_decl_location (loc);
9239
9240 if (rtl == NULL_RTX)
9241 return 0;
9242 else if (GET_CODE (rtl) == CONST_INT)
9243 {
9244 HOST_WIDE_INT val = INTVAL (rtl);
9245 if (TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (loc)))
9246 val &= GET_MODE_MASK (DECL_MODE (loc));
9247 ret = int_loc_descriptor (val);
9248 }
9249 else if (GET_CODE (rtl) == CONST_STRING)
9250 return 0;
9251 else if (CONSTANT_P (rtl))
9252 {
9253 ret = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_addr, 0, 0);
9254 ret->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_addr;
9255 ret->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_addr = rtl;
9256 }
9257 else
9258 {
9259 enum machine_mode mode;
9260
9261 /* Certain constructs can only be represented at top-level. */
9262 if (want_address == 2)
9263 return loc_descriptor (rtl);
9264
9265 mode = GET_MODE (rtl);
9266 if (MEM_P (rtl))
9267 {
9268 rtl = XEXP (rtl, 0);
9269 have_address = 1;
9270 }
9271 ret = mem_loc_descriptor (rtl, mode);
9272 }
9273 }
9274 break;
9275
9276 case INDIRECT_REF:
9277 ret = loc_descriptor_from_tree_1 (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0), 0);
9278 have_address = 1;
9279 break;
9280
9281 case COMPOUND_EXPR:
9282 return loc_descriptor_from_tree_1 (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 1), want_address);
9283
9284 case NOP_EXPR:
9285 case CONVERT_EXPR:
9286 case NON_LVALUE_EXPR:
9287 case VIEW_CONVERT_EXPR:
9288 case SAVE_EXPR:
9289 case GIMPLE_MODIFY_STMT:
9290 return loc_descriptor_from_tree_1 (GENERIC_TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0),
9291 want_address);
9292
9293 case COMPONENT_REF:
9294 case BIT_FIELD_REF:
9295 case ARRAY_REF:
9296 case ARRAY_RANGE_REF:
9297 {
9298 tree obj, offset;
9299 HOST_WIDE_INT bitsize, bitpos, bytepos;
9300 enum machine_mode mode;
9301 int volatilep;
9302 int unsignedp = TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (loc));
9303
9304 obj = get_inner_reference (loc, &bitsize, &bitpos, &offset, &mode,
9305 &unsignedp, &volatilep, false);
9306
9307 if (obj == loc)
9308 return 0;
9309
9310 ret = loc_descriptor_from_tree_1 (obj, 1);
9311 if (ret == 0
9312 || bitpos % BITS_PER_UNIT != 0 || bitsize % BITS_PER_UNIT != 0)
9313 return 0;
9314
9315 if (offset != NULL_TREE)
9316 {
9317 /* Variable offset. */
9318 add_loc_descr (&ret, loc_descriptor_from_tree_1 (offset, 0));
9319 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus, 0, 0));
9320 }
9321
9322 bytepos = bitpos / BITS_PER_UNIT;
9323 if (bytepos > 0)
9324 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus_uconst, bytepos, 0));
9325 else if (bytepos < 0)
9326 {
9327 add_loc_descr (&ret, int_loc_descriptor (bytepos));
9328 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus, 0, 0));
9329 }
9330
9331 have_address = 1;
9332 break;
9333 }
9334
9335 case INTEGER_CST:
9336 if (host_integerp (loc, 0))
9337 ret = int_loc_descriptor (tree_low_cst (loc, 0));
9338 else
9339 return 0;
9340 break;
9341
9342 case CONSTRUCTOR:
9343 {
9344 /* Get an RTL for this, if something has been emitted. */
9345 rtx rtl = lookup_constant_def (loc);
9346 enum machine_mode mode;
9347
9348 if (!rtl || !MEM_P (rtl))
9349 return 0;
9350 mode = GET_MODE (rtl);
9351 rtl = XEXP (rtl, 0);
9352 ret = mem_loc_descriptor (rtl, mode);
9353 have_address = 1;
9354 break;
9355 }
9356
9357 case TRUTH_AND_EXPR:
9358 case TRUTH_ANDIF_EXPR:
9359 case BIT_AND_EXPR:
9360 op = DW_OP_and;
9361 goto do_binop;
9362
9363 case TRUTH_XOR_EXPR:
9364 case BIT_XOR_EXPR:
9365 op = DW_OP_xor;
9366 goto do_binop;
9367
9368 case TRUTH_OR_EXPR:
9369 case TRUTH_ORIF_EXPR:
9370 case BIT_IOR_EXPR:
9371 op = DW_OP_or;
9372 goto do_binop;
9373
9374 case FLOOR_DIV_EXPR:
9375 case CEIL_DIV_EXPR:
9376 case ROUND_DIV_EXPR:
9377 case TRUNC_DIV_EXPR:
9378 op = DW_OP_div;
9379 goto do_binop;
9380
9381 case MINUS_EXPR:
9382 op = DW_OP_minus;
9383 goto do_binop;
9384
9385 case FLOOR_MOD_EXPR:
9386 case CEIL_MOD_EXPR:
9387 case ROUND_MOD_EXPR:
9388 case TRUNC_MOD_EXPR:
9389 op = DW_OP_mod;
9390 goto do_binop;
9391
9392 case MULT_EXPR:
9393 op = DW_OP_mul;
9394 goto do_binop;
9395
9396 case LSHIFT_EXPR:
9397 op = DW_OP_shl;
9398 goto do_binop;
9399
9400 case RSHIFT_EXPR:
9401 op = (TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (loc)) ? DW_OP_shr : DW_OP_shra);
9402 goto do_binop;
9403
9404 case PLUS_EXPR:
9405 if (TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 1)) == INTEGER_CST
9406 && host_integerp (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 1), 0))
9407 {
9408 ret = loc_descriptor_from_tree_1 (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0), 0);
9409 if (ret == 0)
9410 return 0;
9411
9412 add_loc_descr (&ret,
9413 new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus_uconst,
9414 tree_low_cst (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 1),
9415 0),
9416 0));
9417 break;
9418 }
9419
9420 op = DW_OP_plus;
9421 goto do_binop;
9422
9423 case LE_EXPR:
9424 if (TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0))))
9425 return 0;
9426
9427 op = DW_OP_le;
9428 goto do_binop;
9429
9430 case GE_EXPR:
9431 if (TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0))))
9432 return 0;
9433
9434 op = DW_OP_ge;
9435 goto do_binop;
9436
9437 case LT_EXPR:
9438 if (TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0))))
9439 return 0;
9440
9441 op = DW_OP_lt;
9442 goto do_binop;
9443
9444 case GT_EXPR:
9445 if (TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0))))
9446 return 0;
9447
9448 op = DW_OP_gt;
9449 goto do_binop;
9450
9451 case EQ_EXPR:
9452 op = DW_OP_eq;
9453 goto do_binop;
9454
9455 case NE_EXPR:
9456 op = DW_OP_ne;
9457 goto do_binop;
9458
9459 do_binop:
9460 ret = loc_descriptor_from_tree_1 (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0), 0);
9461 ret1 = loc_descriptor_from_tree_1 (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 1), 0);
9462 if (ret == 0 || ret1 == 0)
9463 return 0;
9464
9465 add_loc_descr (&ret, ret1);
9466 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (op, 0, 0));
9467 break;
9468
9469 case TRUTH_NOT_EXPR:
9470 case BIT_NOT_EXPR:
9471 op = DW_OP_not;
9472 goto do_unop;
9473
9474 case ABS_EXPR:
9475 op = DW_OP_abs;
9476 goto do_unop;
9477
9478 case NEGATE_EXPR:
9479 op = DW_OP_neg;
9480 goto do_unop;
9481
9482 do_unop:
9483 ret = loc_descriptor_from_tree_1 (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0), 0);
9484 if (ret == 0)
9485 return 0;
9486
9487 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (op, 0, 0));
9488 break;
9489
9490 case MIN_EXPR:
9491 case MAX_EXPR:
9492 {
9493 const enum tree_code code =
9494 TREE_CODE (loc) == MIN_EXPR ? GT_EXPR : LT_EXPR;
9495
9496 loc = build3 (COND_EXPR, TREE_TYPE (loc),
9497 build2 (code, integer_type_node,
9498 TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0), TREE_OPERAND (loc, 1)),
9499 TREE_OPERAND (loc, 1), TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0));
9500 }
9501
9502 /* ... fall through ... */
9503
9504 case COND_EXPR:
9505 {
9506 dw_loc_descr_ref lhs
9507 = loc_descriptor_from_tree_1 (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 1), 0);
9508 dw_loc_descr_ref rhs
9509 = loc_descriptor_from_tree_1 (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 2), 0);
9510 dw_loc_descr_ref bra_node, jump_node, tmp;
9511
9512 ret = loc_descriptor_from_tree_1 (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0), 0);
9513 if (ret == 0 || lhs == 0 || rhs == 0)
9514 return 0;
9515
9516 bra_node = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_bra, 0, 0);
9517 add_loc_descr (&ret, bra_node);
9518
9519 add_loc_descr (&ret, rhs);
9520 jump_node = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_skip, 0, 0);
9521 add_loc_descr (&ret, jump_node);
9522
9523 add_loc_descr (&ret, lhs);
9524 bra_node->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_loc;
9525 bra_node->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_loc = lhs;
9526
9527 /* ??? Need a node to point the skip at. Use a nop. */
9528 tmp = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_nop, 0, 0);
9529 add_loc_descr (&ret, tmp);
9530 jump_node->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_loc;
9531 jump_node->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_loc = tmp;
9532 }
9533 break;
9534
9535 case FIX_TRUNC_EXPR:
9536 return 0;
9537
9538 default:
9539 /* Leave front-end specific codes as simply unknown. This comes
9540 up, for instance, with the C STMT_EXPR. */
9541 if ((unsigned int) TREE_CODE (loc)
9542 >= (unsigned int) LAST_AND_UNUSED_TREE_CODE)
9543 return 0;
9544
9545 #ifdef ENABLE_CHECKING
9546 /* Otherwise this is a generic code; we should just lists all of
9547 these explicitly. We forgot one. */
9548 gcc_unreachable ();
9549 #else
9550 /* In a release build, we want to degrade gracefully: better to
9551 generate incomplete debugging information than to crash. */
9552 return NULL;
9553 #endif
9554 }
9555
9556 /* Show if we can't fill the request for an address. */
9557 if (want_address && !have_address)
9558 return 0;
9559
9560 /* If we've got an address and don't want one, dereference. */
9561 if (!want_address && have_address && ret)
9562 {
9563 HOST_WIDE_INT size = int_size_in_bytes (TREE_TYPE (loc));
9564
9565 if (size > DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE || size == -1)
9566 return 0;
9567 else if (size == DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
9568 op = DW_OP_deref;
9569 else
9570 op = DW_OP_deref_size;
9571
9572 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (op, size, 0));
9573 }
9574
9575 return ret;
9576 }
9577
9578 static inline dw_loc_descr_ref
9579 loc_descriptor_from_tree (tree loc)
9580 {
9581 return loc_descriptor_from_tree_1 (loc, 2);
9582 }
9583
9584 /* Given a value, round it up to the lowest multiple of `boundary'
9585 which is not less than the value itself. */
9586
9587 static inline HOST_WIDE_INT
9588 ceiling (HOST_WIDE_INT value, unsigned int boundary)
9589 {
9590 return (((value + boundary - 1) / boundary) * boundary);
9591 }
9592
9593 /* Given a pointer to what is assumed to be a FIELD_DECL node, return a
9594 pointer to the declared type for the relevant field variable, or return
9595 `integer_type_node' if the given node turns out to be an
9596 ERROR_MARK node. */
9597
9598 static inline tree
9599 field_type (tree decl)
9600 {
9601 tree type;
9602
9603 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == ERROR_MARK)
9604 return integer_type_node;
9605
9606 type = DECL_BIT_FIELD_TYPE (decl);
9607 if (type == NULL_TREE)
9608 type = TREE_TYPE (decl);
9609
9610 return type;
9611 }
9612
9613 /* Given a pointer to a tree node, return the alignment in bits for
9614 it, or else return BITS_PER_WORD if the node actually turns out to
9615 be an ERROR_MARK node. */
9616
9617 static inline unsigned
9618 simple_type_align_in_bits (tree type)
9619 {
9620 return (TREE_CODE (type) != ERROR_MARK) ? TYPE_ALIGN (type) : BITS_PER_WORD;
9621 }
9622
9623 static inline unsigned
9624 simple_decl_align_in_bits (tree decl)
9625 {
9626 return (TREE_CODE (decl) != ERROR_MARK) ? DECL_ALIGN (decl) : BITS_PER_WORD;
9627 }
9628
9629 /* Return the result of rounding T up to ALIGN. */
9630
9631 static inline HOST_WIDE_INT
9632 round_up_to_align (HOST_WIDE_INT t, unsigned int align)
9633 {
9634 /* We must be careful if T is negative because HOST_WIDE_INT can be
9635 either "above" or "below" unsigned int as per the C promotion
9636 rules, depending on the host, thus making the signedness of the
9637 direct multiplication and division unpredictable. */
9638 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT u = (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) t;
9639
9640 u += align - 1;
9641 u /= align;
9642 u *= align;
9643
9644 return (HOST_WIDE_INT) u;
9645 }
9646
9647 /* Given a pointer to a FIELD_DECL, compute and return the byte offset of the
9648 lowest addressed byte of the "containing object" for the given FIELD_DECL,
9649 or return 0 if we are unable to determine what that offset is, either
9650 because the argument turns out to be a pointer to an ERROR_MARK node, or
9651 because the offset is actually variable. (We can't handle the latter case
9652 just yet). */
9653
9654 static HOST_WIDE_INT
9655 field_byte_offset (tree decl)
9656 {
9657 unsigned int type_align_in_bits;
9658 unsigned int decl_align_in_bits;
9659 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT type_size_in_bits;
9660 HOST_WIDE_INT object_offset_in_bits;
9661 tree type;
9662 tree field_size_tree;
9663 HOST_WIDE_INT bitpos_int;
9664 HOST_WIDE_INT deepest_bitpos;
9665 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT field_size_in_bits;
9666
9667 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == ERROR_MARK)
9668 return 0;
9669
9670 gcc_assert (TREE_CODE (decl) == FIELD_DECL);
9671
9672 type = field_type (decl);
9673 field_size_tree = DECL_SIZE (decl);
9674
9675 /* The size could be unspecified if there was an error, or for
9676 a flexible array member. */
9677 if (! field_size_tree)
9678 field_size_tree = bitsize_zero_node;
9679
9680 /* We cannot yet cope with fields whose positions are variable, so
9681 for now, when we see such things, we simply return 0. Someday, we may
9682 be able to handle such cases, but it will be damn difficult. */
9683 if (! host_integerp (bit_position (decl), 0))
9684 return 0;
9685
9686 bitpos_int = int_bit_position (decl);
9687
9688 /* If we don't know the size of the field, pretend it's a full word. */
9689 if (host_integerp (field_size_tree, 1))
9690 field_size_in_bits = tree_low_cst (field_size_tree, 1);
9691 else
9692 field_size_in_bits = BITS_PER_WORD;
9693
9694 type_size_in_bits = simple_type_size_in_bits (type);
9695 type_align_in_bits = simple_type_align_in_bits (type);
9696 decl_align_in_bits = simple_decl_align_in_bits (decl);
9697
9698 /* The GCC front-end doesn't make any attempt to keep track of the starting
9699 bit offset (relative to the start of the containing structure type) of the
9700 hypothetical "containing object" for a bit-field. Thus, when computing
9701 the byte offset value for the start of the "containing object" of a
9702 bit-field, we must deduce this information on our own. This can be rather
9703 tricky to do in some cases. For example, handling the following structure
9704 type definition when compiling for an i386/i486 target (which only aligns
9705 long long's to 32-bit boundaries) can be very tricky:
9706
9707 struct S { int field1; long long field2:31; };
9708
9709 Fortunately, there is a simple rule-of-thumb which can be used in such
9710 cases. When compiling for an i386/i486, GCC will allocate 8 bytes for the
9711 structure shown above. It decides to do this based upon one simple rule
9712 for bit-field allocation. GCC allocates each "containing object" for each
9713 bit-field at the first (i.e. lowest addressed) legitimate alignment
9714 boundary (based upon the required minimum alignment for the declared type
9715 of the field) which it can possibly use, subject to the condition that
9716 there is still enough available space remaining in the containing object
9717 (when allocated at the selected point) to fully accommodate all of the
9718 bits of the bit-field itself.
9719
9720 This simple rule makes it obvious why GCC allocates 8 bytes for each
9721 object of the structure type shown above. When looking for a place to
9722 allocate the "containing object" for `field2', the compiler simply tries
9723 to allocate a 64-bit "containing object" at each successive 32-bit
9724 boundary (starting at zero) until it finds a place to allocate that 64-
9725 bit field such that at least 31 contiguous (and previously unallocated)
9726 bits remain within that selected 64 bit field. (As it turns out, for the
9727 example above, the compiler finds it is OK to allocate the "containing
9728 object" 64-bit field at bit-offset zero within the structure type.)
9729
9730 Here we attempt to work backwards from the limited set of facts we're
9731 given, and we try to deduce from those facts, where GCC must have believed
9732 that the containing object started (within the structure type). The value
9733 we deduce is then used (by the callers of this routine) to generate
9734 DW_AT_location and DW_AT_bit_offset attributes for fields (both bit-fields
9735 and, in the case of DW_AT_location, regular fields as well). */
9736
9737 /* Figure out the bit-distance from the start of the structure to the
9738 "deepest" bit of the bit-field. */
9739 deepest_bitpos = bitpos_int + field_size_in_bits;
9740
9741 /* This is the tricky part. Use some fancy footwork to deduce where the
9742 lowest addressed bit of the containing object must be. */
9743 object_offset_in_bits = deepest_bitpos - type_size_in_bits;
9744
9745 /* Round up to type_align by default. This works best for bitfields. */
9746 object_offset_in_bits
9747 = round_up_to_align (object_offset_in_bits, type_align_in_bits);
9748
9749 if (object_offset_in_bits > bitpos_int)
9750 {
9751 /* Sigh, the decl must be packed. */
9752 object_offset_in_bits = deepest_bitpos - type_size_in_bits;
9753
9754 /* Round up to decl_align instead. */
9755 object_offset_in_bits
9756 = round_up_to_align (object_offset_in_bits, decl_align_in_bits);
9757 }
9758
9759 return object_offset_in_bits / BITS_PER_UNIT;
9760 }
9761 \f
9762 /* The following routines define various Dwarf attributes and any data
9763 associated with them. */
9764
9765 /* Add a location description attribute value to a DIE.
9766
9767 This emits location attributes suitable for whole variables and
9768 whole parameters. Note that the location attributes for struct fields are
9769 generated by the routine `data_member_location_attribute' below. */
9770
9771 static inline void
9772 add_AT_location_description (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,
9773 dw_loc_descr_ref descr)
9774 {
9775 if (descr != 0)
9776 add_AT_loc (die, attr_kind, descr);
9777 }
9778
9779 /* Attach the specialized form of location attribute used for data members of
9780 struct and union types. In the special case of a FIELD_DECL node which
9781 represents a bit-field, the "offset" part of this special location
9782 descriptor must indicate the distance in bytes from the lowest-addressed
9783 byte of the containing struct or union type to the lowest-addressed byte of
9784 the "containing object" for the bit-field. (See the `field_byte_offset'
9785 function above).
9786
9787 For any given bit-field, the "containing object" is a hypothetical object
9788 (of some integral or enum type) within which the given bit-field lives. The
9789 type of this hypothetical "containing object" is always the same as the
9790 declared type of the individual bit-field itself (for GCC anyway... the
9791 DWARF spec doesn't actually mandate this). Note that it is the size (in
9792 bytes) of the hypothetical "containing object" which will be given in the
9793 DW_AT_byte_size attribute for this bit-field. (See the
9794 `byte_size_attribute' function below.) It is also used when calculating the
9795 value of the DW_AT_bit_offset attribute. (See the `bit_offset_attribute'
9796 function below.) */
9797
9798 static void
9799 add_data_member_location_attribute (dw_die_ref die, tree decl)
9800 {
9801 HOST_WIDE_INT offset;
9802 dw_loc_descr_ref loc_descr = 0;
9803
9804 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == TREE_BINFO)
9805 {
9806 /* We're working on the TAG_inheritance for a base class. */
9807 if (BINFO_VIRTUAL_P (decl) && is_cxx ())
9808 {
9809 /* For C++ virtual bases we can't just use BINFO_OFFSET, as they
9810 aren't at a fixed offset from all (sub)objects of the same
9811 type. We need to extract the appropriate offset from our
9812 vtable. The following dwarf expression means
9813
9814 BaseAddr = ObAddr + *((*ObAddr) - Offset)
9815
9816 This is specific to the V3 ABI, of course. */
9817
9818 dw_loc_descr_ref tmp;
9819
9820 /* Make a copy of the object address. */
9821 tmp = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_dup, 0, 0);
9822 add_loc_descr (&loc_descr, tmp);
9823
9824 /* Extract the vtable address. */
9825 tmp = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_deref, 0, 0);
9826 add_loc_descr (&loc_descr, tmp);
9827
9828 /* Calculate the address of the offset. */
9829 offset = tree_low_cst (BINFO_VPTR_FIELD (decl), 0);
9830 gcc_assert (offset < 0);
9831
9832 tmp = int_loc_descriptor (-offset);
9833 add_loc_descr (&loc_descr, tmp);
9834 tmp = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_minus, 0, 0);
9835 add_loc_descr (&loc_descr, tmp);
9836
9837 /* Extract the offset. */
9838 tmp = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_deref, 0, 0);
9839 add_loc_descr (&loc_descr, tmp);
9840
9841 /* Add it to the object address. */
9842 tmp = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus, 0, 0);
9843 add_loc_descr (&loc_descr, tmp);
9844 }
9845 else
9846 offset = tree_low_cst (BINFO_OFFSET (decl), 0);
9847 }
9848 else
9849 offset = field_byte_offset (decl);
9850
9851 if (! loc_descr)
9852 {
9853 enum dwarf_location_atom op;
9854
9855 /* The DWARF2 standard says that we should assume that the structure
9856 address is already on the stack, so we can specify a structure field
9857 address by using DW_OP_plus_uconst. */
9858
9859 #ifdef MIPS_DEBUGGING_INFO
9860 /* ??? The SGI dwarf reader does not handle the DW_OP_plus_uconst
9861 operator correctly. It works only if we leave the offset on the
9862 stack. */
9863 op = DW_OP_constu;
9864 #else
9865 op = DW_OP_plus_uconst;
9866 #endif
9867
9868 loc_descr = new_loc_descr (op, offset, 0);
9869 }
9870
9871 add_AT_loc (die, DW_AT_data_member_location, loc_descr);
9872 }
9873
9874 /* Writes integer values to dw_vec_const array. */
9875
9876 static void
9877 insert_int (HOST_WIDE_INT val, unsigned int size, unsigned char *dest)
9878 {
9879 while (size != 0)
9880 {
9881 *dest++ = val & 0xff;
9882 val >>= 8;
9883 --size;
9884 }
9885 }
9886
9887 /* Reads integers from dw_vec_const array. Inverse of insert_int. */
9888
9889 static HOST_WIDE_INT
9890 extract_int (const unsigned char *src, unsigned int size)
9891 {
9892 HOST_WIDE_INT val = 0;
9893
9894 src += size;
9895 while (size != 0)
9896 {
9897 val <<= 8;
9898 val |= *--src & 0xff;
9899 --size;
9900 }
9901 return val;
9902 }
9903
9904 /* Writes floating point values to dw_vec_const array. */
9905
9906 static void
9907 insert_float (rtx rtl, unsigned char *array)
9908 {
9909 REAL_VALUE_TYPE rv;
9910 long val[4];
9911 int i;
9912
9913 REAL_VALUE_FROM_CONST_DOUBLE (rv, rtl);
9914 real_to_target (val, &rv, GET_MODE (rtl));
9915
9916 /* real_to_target puts 32-bit pieces in each long. Pack them. */
9917 for (i = 0; i < GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (rtl)) / 4; i++)
9918 {
9919 insert_int (val[i], 4, array);
9920 array += 4;
9921 }
9922 }
9923
9924 /* Attach a DW_AT_const_value attribute for a variable or a parameter which
9925 does not have a "location" either in memory or in a register. These
9926 things can arise in GNU C when a constant is passed as an actual parameter
9927 to an inlined function. They can also arise in C++ where declared
9928 constants do not necessarily get memory "homes". */
9929
9930 static void
9931 add_const_value_attribute (dw_die_ref die, rtx rtl)
9932 {
9933 switch (GET_CODE (rtl))
9934 {
9935 case CONST_INT:
9936 {
9937 HOST_WIDE_INT val = INTVAL (rtl);
9938
9939 if (val < 0)
9940 add_AT_int (die, DW_AT_const_value, val);
9941 else
9942 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_const_value, (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) val);
9943 }
9944 break;
9945
9946 case CONST_DOUBLE:
9947 /* Note that a CONST_DOUBLE rtx could represent either an integer or a
9948 floating-point constant. A CONST_DOUBLE is used whenever the
9949 constant requires more than one word in order to be adequately
9950 represented. We output CONST_DOUBLEs as blocks. */
9951 {
9952 enum machine_mode mode = GET_MODE (rtl);
9953
9954 if (SCALAR_FLOAT_MODE_P (mode))
9955 {
9956 unsigned int length = GET_MODE_SIZE (mode);
9957 unsigned char *array = ggc_alloc (length);
9958
9959 insert_float (rtl, array);
9960 add_AT_vec (die, DW_AT_const_value, length / 4, 4, array);
9961 }
9962 else
9963 {
9964 /* ??? We really should be using HOST_WIDE_INT throughout. */
9965 gcc_assert (HOST_BITS_PER_LONG == HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT);
9966
9967 add_AT_long_long (die, DW_AT_const_value,
9968 CONST_DOUBLE_HIGH (rtl), CONST_DOUBLE_LOW (rtl));
9969 }
9970 }
9971 break;
9972
9973 case CONST_VECTOR:
9974 {
9975 enum machine_mode mode = GET_MODE (rtl);
9976 unsigned int elt_size = GET_MODE_UNIT_SIZE (mode);
9977 unsigned int length = CONST_VECTOR_NUNITS (rtl);
9978 unsigned char *array = ggc_alloc (length * elt_size);
9979 unsigned int i;
9980 unsigned char *p;
9981
9982 switch (GET_MODE_CLASS (mode))
9983 {
9984 case MODE_VECTOR_INT:
9985 for (i = 0, p = array; i < length; i++, p += elt_size)
9986 {
9987 rtx elt = CONST_VECTOR_ELT (rtl, i);
9988 HOST_WIDE_INT lo, hi;
9989
9990 switch (GET_CODE (elt))
9991 {
9992 case CONST_INT:
9993 lo = INTVAL (elt);
9994 hi = -(lo < 0);
9995 break;
9996
9997 case CONST_DOUBLE:
9998 lo = CONST_DOUBLE_LOW (elt);
9999 hi = CONST_DOUBLE_HIGH (elt);
10000 break;
10001
10002 default:
10003 gcc_unreachable ();
10004 }
10005
10006 if (elt_size <= sizeof (HOST_WIDE_INT))
10007 insert_int (lo, elt_size, p);
10008 else
10009 {
10010 unsigned char *p0 = p;
10011 unsigned char *p1 = p + sizeof (HOST_WIDE_INT);
10012
10013 gcc_assert (elt_size == 2 * sizeof (HOST_WIDE_INT));
10014 if (WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN)
10015 {
10016 p0 = p1;
10017 p1 = p;
10018 }
10019 insert_int (lo, sizeof (HOST_WIDE_INT), p0);
10020 insert_int (hi, sizeof (HOST_WIDE_INT), p1);
10021 }
10022 }
10023 break;
10024
10025 case MODE_VECTOR_FLOAT:
10026 for (i = 0, p = array; i < length; i++, p += elt_size)
10027 {
10028 rtx elt = CONST_VECTOR_ELT (rtl, i);
10029 insert_float (elt, p);
10030 }
10031 break;
10032
10033 default:
10034 gcc_unreachable ();
10035 }
10036
10037 add_AT_vec (die, DW_AT_const_value, length, elt_size, array);
10038 }
10039 break;
10040
10041 case CONST_STRING:
10042 add_AT_string (die, DW_AT_const_value, XSTR (rtl, 0));
10043 break;
10044
10045 case SYMBOL_REF:
10046 case LABEL_REF:
10047 case CONST:
10048 add_AT_addr (die, DW_AT_const_value, rtl);
10049 VEC_safe_push (rtx, gc, used_rtx_array, rtl);
10050 break;
10051
10052 case PLUS:
10053 /* In cases where an inlined instance of an inline function is passed
10054 the address of an `auto' variable (which is local to the caller) we
10055 can get a situation where the DECL_RTL of the artificial local
10056 variable (for the inlining) which acts as a stand-in for the
10057 corresponding formal parameter (of the inline function) will look
10058 like (plus:SI (reg:SI FRAME_PTR) (const_int ...)). This is not
10059 exactly a compile-time constant expression, but it isn't the address
10060 of the (artificial) local variable either. Rather, it represents the
10061 *value* which the artificial local variable always has during its
10062 lifetime. We currently have no way to represent such quasi-constant
10063 values in Dwarf, so for now we just punt and generate nothing. */
10064 break;
10065
10066 default:
10067 /* No other kinds of rtx should be possible here. */
10068 gcc_unreachable ();
10069 }
10070
10071 }
10072
10073 /* Determine whether the evaluation of EXPR references any variables
10074 or functions which aren't otherwise used (and therefore may not be
10075 output). */
10076 static tree
10077 reference_to_unused (tree * tp, int * walk_subtrees,
10078 void * data ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
10079 {
10080 if (! EXPR_P (*tp) && ! GIMPLE_STMT_P (*tp) && ! CONSTANT_CLASS_P (*tp))
10081 *walk_subtrees = 0;
10082
10083 if (DECL_P (*tp) && ! TREE_PUBLIC (*tp) && ! TREE_USED (*tp)
10084 && ! TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (*tp))
10085 return *tp;
10086 else if (DECL_P (*tp) && TREE_CODE (*tp) != FUNCTION_DECL)
10087 {
10088 struct varpool_node *node = varpool_node (*tp);
10089 if (!node->needed)
10090 return *tp;
10091 }
10092
10093 return NULL_TREE;
10094 }
10095
10096 /* Generate an RTL constant from a decl initializer INIT with decl type TYPE,
10097 for use in a later add_const_value_attribute call. */
10098
10099 static rtx
10100 rtl_for_decl_init (tree init, tree type)
10101 {
10102 rtx rtl = NULL_RTX;
10103
10104 /* If a variable is initialized with a string constant without embedded
10105 zeros, build CONST_STRING. */
10106 if (TREE_CODE (init) == STRING_CST && TREE_CODE (type) == ARRAY_TYPE)
10107 {
10108 tree enttype = TREE_TYPE (type);
10109 tree domain = TYPE_DOMAIN (type);
10110 enum machine_mode mode = TYPE_MODE (enttype);
10111
10112 if (GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) == MODE_INT && GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) == 1
10113 && domain
10114 && integer_zerop (TYPE_MIN_VALUE (domain))
10115 && compare_tree_int (TYPE_MAX_VALUE (domain),
10116 TREE_STRING_LENGTH (init) - 1) == 0
10117 && ((size_t) TREE_STRING_LENGTH (init)
10118 == strlen (TREE_STRING_POINTER (init)) + 1))
10119 rtl = gen_rtx_CONST_STRING (VOIDmode,
10120 ggc_strdup (TREE_STRING_POINTER (init)));
10121 }
10122 /* Other aggregates, and complex values, could be represented using
10123 CONCAT: FIXME! */
10124 else if (AGGREGATE_TYPE_P (type) || TREE_CODE (type) == COMPLEX_TYPE)
10125 ;
10126 /* Vectors only work if their mode is supported by the target.
10127 FIXME: generic vectors ought to work too. */
10128 else if (TREE_CODE (type) == VECTOR_TYPE && TYPE_MODE (type) == BLKmode)
10129 ;
10130 /* If the initializer is something that we know will expand into an
10131 immediate RTL constant, expand it now. We must be careful not to
10132 reference variables which won't be output. */
10133 else if (initializer_constant_valid_p (init, type)
10134 && ! walk_tree (&init, reference_to_unused, NULL, NULL))
10135 {
10136 rtl = expand_expr (init, NULL_RTX, VOIDmode, EXPAND_INITIALIZER);
10137
10138 /* If expand_expr returns a MEM, it wasn't immediate. */
10139 gcc_assert (!rtl || !MEM_P (rtl));
10140 }
10141
10142 return rtl;
10143 }
10144
10145 /* Generate RTL for the variable DECL to represent its location. */
10146
10147 static rtx
10148 rtl_for_decl_location (tree decl)
10149 {
10150 rtx rtl;
10151
10152 /* Here we have to decide where we are going to say the parameter "lives"
10153 (as far as the debugger is concerned). We only have a couple of
10154 choices. GCC provides us with DECL_RTL and with DECL_INCOMING_RTL.
10155
10156 DECL_RTL normally indicates where the parameter lives during most of the
10157 activation of the function. If optimization is enabled however, this
10158 could be either NULL or else a pseudo-reg. Both of those cases indicate
10159 that the parameter doesn't really live anywhere (as far as the code
10160 generation parts of GCC are concerned) during most of the function's
10161 activation. That will happen (for example) if the parameter is never
10162 referenced within the function.
10163
10164 We could just generate a location descriptor here for all non-NULL
10165 non-pseudo values of DECL_RTL and ignore all of the rest, but we can be
10166 a little nicer than that if we also consider DECL_INCOMING_RTL in cases
10167 where DECL_RTL is NULL or is a pseudo-reg.
10168
10169 Note however that we can only get away with using DECL_INCOMING_RTL as
10170 a backup substitute for DECL_RTL in certain limited cases. In cases
10171 where DECL_ARG_TYPE (decl) indicates the same type as TREE_TYPE (decl),
10172 we can be sure that the parameter was passed using the same type as it is
10173 declared to have within the function, and that its DECL_INCOMING_RTL
10174 points us to a place where a value of that type is passed.
10175
10176 In cases where DECL_ARG_TYPE (decl) and TREE_TYPE (decl) are different,
10177 we cannot (in general) use DECL_INCOMING_RTL as a substitute for DECL_RTL
10178 because in these cases DECL_INCOMING_RTL points us to a value of some
10179 type which is *different* from the type of the parameter itself. Thus,
10180 if we tried to use DECL_INCOMING_RTL to generate a location attribute in
10181 such cases, the debugger would end up (for example) trying to fetch a
10182 `float' from a place which actually contains the first part of a
10183 `double'. That would lead to really incorrect and confusing
10184 output at debug-time.
10185
10186 So, in general, we *do not* use DECL_INCOMING_RTL as a backup for DECL_RTL
10187 in cases where DECL_ARG_TYPE (decl) != TREE_TYPE (decl). There
10188 are a couple of exceptions however. On little-endian machines we can
10189 get away with using DECL_INCOMING_RTL even when DECL_ARG_TYPE (decl) is
10190 not the same as TREE_TYPE (decl), but only when DECL_ARG_TYPE (decl) is
10191 an integral type that is smaller than TREE_TYPE (decl). These cases arise
10192 when (on a little-endian machine) a non-prototyped function has a
10193 parameter declared to be of type `short' or `char'. In such cases,
10194 TREE_TYPE (decl) will be `short' or `char', DECL_ARG_TYPE (decl) will
10195 be `int', and DECL_INCOMING_RTL will point to the lowest-order byte of the
10196 passed `int' value. If the debugger then uses that address to fetch
10197 a `short' or a `char' (on a little-endian machine) the result will be
10198 the correct data, so we allow for such exceptional cases below.
10199
10200 Note that our goal here is to describe the place where the given formal
10201 parameter lives during most of the function's activation (i.e. between the
10202 end of the prologue and the start of the epilogue). We'll do that as best
10203 as we can. Note however that if the given formal parameter is modified
10204 sometime during the execution of the function, then a stack backtrace (at
10205 debug-time) will show the function as having been called with the *new*
10206 value rather than the value which was originally passed in. This happens
10207 rarely enough that it is not a major problem, but it *is* a problem, and
10208 I'd like to fix it.
10209
10210 A future version of dwarf2out.c may generate two additional attributes for
10211 any given DW_TAG_formal_parameter DIE which will describe the "passed
10212 type" and the "passed location" for the given formal parameter in addition
10213 to the attributes we now generate to indicate the "declared type" and the
10214 "active location" for each parameter. This additional set of attributes
10215 could be used by debuggers for stack backtraces. Separately, note that
10216 sometimes DECL_RTL can be NULL and DECL_INCOMING_RTL can be NULL also.
10217 This happens (for example) for inlined-instances of inline function formal
10218 parameters which are never referenced. This really shouldn't be
10219 happening. All PARM_DECL nodes should get valid non-NULL
10220 DECL_INCOMING_RTL values. FIXME. */
10221
10222 /* Use DECL_RTL as the "location" unless we find something better. */
10223 rtl = DECL_RTL_IF_SET (decl);
10224
10225 /* When generating abstract instances, ignore everything except
10226 constants, symbols living in memory, and symbols living in
10227 fixed registers. */
10228 if (! reload_completed)
10229 {
10230 if (rtl
10231 && (CONSTANT_P (rtl)
10232 || (MEM_P (rtl)
10233 && CONSTANT_P (XEXP (rtl, 0)))
10234 || (REG_P (rtl)
10235 && TREE_CODE (decl) == VAR_DECL
10236 && TREE_STATIC (decl))))
10237 {
10238 rtl = targetm.delegitimize_address (rtl);
10239 return rtl;
10240 }
10241 rtl = NULL_RTX;
10242 }
10243 else if (TREE_CODE (decl) == PARM_DECL)
10244 {
10245 if (rtl == NULL_RTX || is_pseudo_reg (rtl))
10246 {
10247 tree declared_type = TREE_TYPE (decl);
10248 tree passed_type = DECL_ARG_TYPE (decl);
10249 enum machine_mode dmode = TYPE_MODE (declared_type);
10250 enum machine_mode pmode = TYPE_MODE (passed_type);
10251
10252 /* This decl represents a formal parameter which was optimized out.
10253 Note that DECL_INCOMING_RTL may be NULL in here, but we handle
10254 all cases where (rtl == NULL_RTX) just below. */
10255 if (dmode == pmode)
10256 rtl = DECL_INCOMING_RTL (decl);
10257 else if (SCALAR_INT_MODE_P (dmode)
10258 && GET_MODE_SIZE (dmode) <= GET_MODE_SIZE (pmode)
10259 && DECL_INCOMING_RTL (decl))
10260 {
10261 rtx inc = DECL_INCOMING_RTL (decl);
10262 if (REG_P (inc))
10263 rtl = inc;
10264 else if (MEM_P (inc))
10265 {
10266 if (BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN)
10267 rtl = adjust_address_nv (inc, dmode,
10268 GET_MODE_SIZE (pmode)
10269 - GET_MODE_SIZE (dmode));
10270 else
10271 rtl = inc;
10272 }
10273 }
10274 }
10275
10276 /* If the parm was passed in registers, but lives on the stack, then
10277 make a big endian correction if the mode of the type of the
10278 parameter is not the same as the mode of the rtl. */
10279 /* ??? This is the same series of checks that are made in dbxout.c before
10280 we reach the big endian correction code there. It isn't clear if all
10281 of these checks are necessary here, but keeping them all is the safe
10282 thing to do. */
10283 else if (MEM_P (rtl)
10284 && XEXP (rtl, 0) != const0_rtx
10285 && ! CONSTANT_P (XEXP (rtl, 0))
10286 /* Not passed in memory. */
10287 && !MEM_P (DECL_INCOMING_RTL (decl))
10288 /* Not passed by invisible reference. */
10289 && (!REG_P (XEXP (rtl, 0))
10290 || REGNO (XEXP (rtl, 0)) == HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
10291 || REGNO (XEXP (rtl, 0)) == STACK_POINTER_REGNUM
10292 #if ARG_POINTER_REGNUM != HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
10293 || REGNO (XEXP (rtl, 0)) == ARG_POINTER_REGNUM
10294 #endif
10295 )
10296 /* Big endian correction check. */
10297 && BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN
10298 && TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (decl)) != GET_MODE (rtl)
10299 && (GET_MODE_SIZE (TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (decl)))
10300 < UNITS_PER_WORD))
10301 {
10302 int offset = (UNITS_PER_WORD
10303 - GET_MODE_SIZE (TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (decl))));
10304
10305 rtl = gen_rtx_MEM (TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (decl)),
10306 plus_constant (XEXP (rtl, 0), offset));
10307 }
10308 }
10309 else if (TREE_CODE (decl) == VAR_DECL
10310 && rtl
10311 && MEM_P (rtl)
10312 && GET_MODE (rtl) != TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (decl))
10313 && BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN)
10314 {
10315 int rsize = GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (rtl));
10316 int dsize = GET_MODE_SIZE (TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (decl)));
10317
10318 /* If a variable is declared "register" yet is smaller than
10319 a register, then if we store the variable to memory, it
10320 looks like we're storing a register-sized value, when in
10321 fact we are not. We need to adjust the offset of the
10322 storage location to reflect the actual value's bytes,
10323 else gdb will not be able to display it. */
10324 if (rsize > dsize)
10325 rtl = gen_rtx_MEM (TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (decl)),
10326 plus_constant (XEXP (rtl, 0), rsize-dsize));
10327 }
10328
10329 /* A variable with no DECL_RTL but a DECL_INITIAL is a compile-time constant,
10330 and will have been substituted directly into all expressions that use it.
10331 C does not have such a concept, but C++ and other languages do. */
10332 if (!rtl && TREE_CODE (decl) == VAR_DECL && DECL_INITIAL (decl))
10333 rtl = rtl_for_decl_init (DECL_INITIAL (decl), TREE_TYPE (decl));
10334
10335 if (rtl)
10336 rtl = targetm.delegitimize_address (rtl);
10337
10338 /* If we don't look past the constant pool, we risk emitting a
10339 reference to a constant pool entry that isn't referenced from
10340 code, and thus is not emitted. */
10341 if (rtl)
10342 rtl = avoid_constant_pool_reference (rtl);
10343
10344 return rtl;
10345 }
10346
10347 /* We need to figure out what section we should use as the base for the
10348 address ranges where a given location is valid.
10349 1. If this particular DECL has a section associated with it, use that.
10350 2. If this function has a section associated with it, use that.
10351 3. Otherwise, use the text section.
10352 XXX: If you split a variable across multiple sections, we won't notice. */
10353
10354 static const char *
10355 secname_for_decl (tree decl)
10356 {
10357 const char *secname;
10358
10359 if (VAR_OR_FUNCTION_DECL_P (decl) && DECL_SECTION_NAME (decl))
10360 {
10361 tree sectree = DECL_SECTION_NAME (decl);
10362 secname = TREE_STRING_POINTER (sectree);
10363 }
10364 else if (current_function_decl && DECL_SECTION_NAME (current_function_decl))
10365 {
10366 tree sectree = DECL_SECTION_NAME (current_function_decl);
10367 secname = TREE_STRING_POINTER (sectree);
10368 }
10369 else if (cfun && in_cold_section_p)
10370 secname = cfun->cold_section_label;
10371 else
10372 secname = text_section_label;
10373
10374 return secname;
10375 }
10376
10377 /* Generate *either* a DW_AT_location attribute or else a DW_AT_const_value
10378 data attribute for a variable or a parameter. We generate the
10379 DW_AT_const_value attribute only in those cases where the given variable
10380 or parameter does not have a true "location" either in memory or in a
10381 register. This can happen (for example) when a constant is passed as an
10382 actual argument in a call to an inline function. (It's possible that
10383 these things can crop up in other ways also.) Note that one type of
10384 constant value which can be passed into an inlined function is a constant
10385 pointer. This can happen for example if an actual argument in an inlined
10386 function call evaluates to a compile-time constant address. */
10387
10388 static void
10389 add_location_or_const_value_attribute (dw_die_ref die, tree decl,
10390 enum dwarf_attribute attr)
10391 {
10392 rtx rtl;
10393 dw_loc_descr_ref descr;
10394 var_loc_list *loc_list;
10395 struct var_loc_node *node;
10396 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == ERROR_MARK)
10397 return;
10398
10399 gcc_assert (TREE_CODE (decl) == VAR_DECL || TREE_CODE (decl) == PARM_DECL
10400 || TREE_CODE (decl) == RESULT_DECL);
10401
10402 /* See if we possibly have multiple locations for this variable. */
10403 loc_list = lookup_decl_loc (decl);
10404
10405 /* If it truly has multiple locations, the first and last node will
10406 differ. */
10407 if (loc_list && loc_list->first != loc_list->last)
10408 {
10409 const char *endname, *secname;
10410 dw_loc_list_ref list;
10411 rtx varloc;
10412
10413 /* Now that we know what section we are using for a base,
10414 actually construct the list of locations.
10415 The first location information is what is passed to the
10416 function that creates the location list, and the remaining
10417 locations just get added on to that list.
10418 Note that we only know the start address for a location
10419 (IE location changes), so to build the range, we use
10420 the range [current location start, next location start].
10421 This means we have to special case the last node, and generate
10422 a range of [last location start, end of function label]. */
10423
10424 node = loc_list->first;
10425 varloc = NOTE_VAR_LOCATION (node->var_loc_note);
10426 secname = secname_for_decl (decl);
10427
10428 list = new_loc_list (loc_descriptor (varloc),
10429 node->label, node->next->label, secname, 1);
10430 node = node->next;
10431
10432 for (; node->next; node = node->next)
10433 if (NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_LOC (node->var_loc_note) != NULL_RTX)
10434 {
10435 /* The variable has a location between NODE->LABEL and
10436 NODE->NEXT->LABEL. */
10437 varloc = NOTE_VAR_LOCATION (node->var_loc_note);
10438 add_loc_descr_to_loc_list (&list, loc_descriptor (varloc),
10439 node->label, node->next->label, secname);
10440 }
10441
10442 /* If the variable has a location at the last label
10443 it keeps its location until the end of function. */
10444 if (NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_LOC (node->var_loc_note) != NULL_RTX)
10445 {
10446 char label_id[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
10447
10448 varloc = NOTE_VAR_LOCATION (node->var_loc_note);
10449 if (!current_function_decl)
10450 endname = text_end_label;
10451 else
10452 {
10453 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label_id, FUNC_END_LABEL,
10454 current_function_funcdef_no);
10455 endname = ggc_strdup (label_id);
10456 }
10457 add_loc_descr_to_loc_list (&list, loc_descriptor (varloc),
10458 node->label, endname, secname);
10459 }
10460
10461 /* Finally, add the location list to the DIE, and we are done. */
10462 add_AT_loc_list (die, attr, list);
10463 return;
10464 }
10465
10466 /* Try to get some constant RTL for this decl, and use that as the value of
10467 the location. */
10468
10469 rtl = rtl_for_decl_location (decl);
10470 if (rtl && (CONSTANT_P (rtl) || GET_CODE (rtl) == CONST_STRING))
10471 {
10472 add_const_value_attribute (die, rtl);
10473 return;
10474 }
10475
10476 /* If we have tried to generate the location otherwise, and it
10477 didn't work out (we wouldn't be here if we did), and we have a one entry
10478 location list, try generating a location from that. */
10479 if (loc_list && loc_list->first)
10480 {
10481 node = loc_list->first;
10482 descr = loc_descriptor (NOTE_VAR_LOCATION (node->var_loc_note));
10483 if (descr)
10484 {
10485 add_AT_location_description (die, attr, descr);
10486 return;
10487 }
10488 }
10489
10490 /* We couldn't get any rtl, so try directly generating the location
10491 description from the tree. */
10492 descr = loc_descriptor_from_tree (decl);
10493 if (descr)
10494 {
10495 add_AT_location_description (die, attr, descr);
10496 return;
10497 }
10498 /* None of that worked, so it must not really have a location;
10499 try adding a constant value attribute from the DECL_INITIAL. */
10500 tree_add_const_value_attribute (die, decl);
10501 }
10502
10503 /* If we don't have a copy of this variable in memory for some reason (such
10504 as a C++ member constant that doesn't have an out-of-line definition),
10505 we should tell the debugger about the constant value. */
10506
10507 static void
10508 tree_add_const_value_attribute (dw_die_ref var_die, tree decl)
10509 {
10510 tree init = DECL_INITIAL (decl);
10511 tree type = TREE_TYPE (decl);
10512 rtx rtl;
10513
10514 if (TREE_READONLY (decl) && ! TREE_THIS_VOLATILE (decl) && init)
10515 /* OK */;
10516 else
10517 return;
10518
10519 rtl = rtl_for_decl_init (init, type);
10520 if (rtl)
10521 add_const_value_attribute (var_die, rtl);
10522 }
10523
10524 /* Convert the CFI instructions for the current function into a
10525 location list. This is used for DW_AT_frame_base when we targeting
10526 a dwarf2 consumer that does not support the dwarf3
10527 DW_OP_call_frame_cfa. OFFSET is a constant to be added to all CFA
10528 expressions. */
10529
10530 static dw_loc_list_ref
10531 convert_cfa_to_fb_loc_list (HOST_WIDE_INT offset)
10532 {
10533 dw_fde_ref fde;
10534 dw_loc_list_ref list, *list_tail;
10535 dw_cfi_ref cfi;
10536 dw_cfa_location last_cfa, next_cfa;
10537 const char *start_label, *last_label, *section;
10538
10539 fde = &fde_table[fde_table_in_use - 1];
10540
10541 section = secname_for_decl (current_function_decl);
10542 list_tail = &list;
10543 list = NULL;
10544
10545 next_cfa.reg = INVALID_REGNUM;
10546 next_cfa.offset = 0;
10547 next_cfa.indirect = 0;
10548 next_cfa.base_offset = 0;
10549
10550 start_label = fde->dw_fde_begin;
10551
10552 /* ??? Bald assumption that the CIE opcode list does not contain
10553 advance opcodes. */
10554 for (cfi = cie_cfi_head; cfi; cfi = cfi->dw_cfi_next)
10555 lookup_cfa_1 (cfi, &next_cfa);
10556
10557 last_cfa = next_cfa;
10558 last_label = start_label;
10559
10560 for (cfi = fde->dw_fde_cfi; cfi; cfi = cfi->dw_cfi_next)
10561 switch (cfi->dw_cfi_opc)
10562 {
10563 case DW_CFA_set_loc:
10564 case DW_CFA_advance_loc1:
10565 case DW_CFA_advance_loc2:
10566 case DW_CFA_advance_loc4:
10567 if (!cfa_equal_p (&last_cfa, &next_cfa))
10568 {
10569 *list_tail = new_loc_list (build_cfa_loc (&last_cfa, offset),
10570 start_label, last_label, section,
10571 list == NULL);
10572
10573 list_tail = &(*list_tail)->dw_loc_next;
10574 last_cfa = next_cfa;
10575 start_label = last_label;
10576 }
10577 last_label = cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_addr;
10578 break;
10579
10580 case DW_CFA_advance_loc:
10581 /* The encoding is complex enough that we should never emit this. */
10582 case DW_CFA_remember_state:
10583 case DW_CFA_restore_state:
10584 /* We don't handle these two in this function. It would be possible
10585 if it were to be required. */
10586 gcc_unreachable ();
10587
10588 default:
10589 lookup_cfa_1 (cfi, &next_cfa);
10590 break;
10591 }
10592
10593 if (!cfa_equal_p (&last_cfa, &next_cfa))
10594 {
10595 *list_tail = new_loc_list (build_cfa_loc (&last_cfa, offset),
10596 start_label, last_label, section,
10597 list == NULL);
10598 list_tail = &(*list_tail)->dw_loc_next;
10599 start_label = last_label;
10600 }
10601 *list_tail = new_loc_list (build_cfa_loc (&next_cfa, offset),
10602 start_label, fde->dw_fde_end, section,
10603 list == NULL);
10604
10605 return list;
10606 }
10607
10608 /* Compute a displacement from the "steady-state frame pointer" to the
10609 frame base (often the same as the CFA), and store it in
10610 frame_pointer_fb_offset. OFFSET is added to the displacement
10611 before the latter is negated. */
10612
10613 static void
10614 compute_frame_pointer_to_fb_displacement (HOST_WIDE_INT offset)
10615 {
10616 rtx reg, elim;
10617
10618 #ifdef FRAME_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET
10619 reg = frame_pointer_rtx;
10620 offset += FRAME_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET (current_function_decl);
10621 #else
10622 reg = arg_pointer_rtx;
10623 offset += ARG_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET (current_function_decl);
10624 #endif
10625
10626 elim = eliminate_regs (reg, VOIDmode, NULL_RTX);
10627 if (GET_CODE (elim) == PLUS)
10628 {
10629 offset += INTVAL (XEXP (elim, 1));
10630 elim = XEXP (elim, 0);
10631 }
10632 gcc_assert (elim == (frame_pointer_needed ? hard_frame_pointer_rtx
10633 : stack_pointer_rtx));
10634
10635 frame_pointer_fb_offset = -offset;
10636 }
10637
10638 /* Generate a DW_AT_name attribute given some string value to be included as
10639 the value of the attribute. */
10640
10641 static void
10642 add_name_attribute (dw_die_ref die, const char *name_string)
10643 {
10644 if (name_string != NULL && *name_string != 0)
10645 {
10646 if (demangle_name_func)
10647 name_string = (*demangle_name_func) (name_string);
10648
10649 add_AT_string (die, DW_AT_name, name_string);
10650 }
10651 }
10652
10653 /* Generate a DW_AT_comp_dir attribute for DIE. */
10654
10655 static void
10656 add_comp_dir_attribute (dw_die_ref die)
10657 {
10658 const char *wd = get_src_pwd ();
10659 if (wd != NULL)
10660 add_AT_string (die, DW_AT_comp_dir, wd);
10661 }
10662
10663 /* Given a tree node describing an array bound (either lower or upper) output
10664 a representation for that bound. */
10665
10666 static void
10667 add_bound_info (dw_die_ref subrange_die, enum dwarf_attribute bound_attr, tree bound)
10668 {
10669 switch (TREE_CODE (bound))
10670 {
10671 case ERROR_MARK:
10672 return;
10673
10674 /* All fixed-bounds are represented by INTEGER_CST nodes. */
10675 case INTEGER_CST:
10676 if (! host_integerp (bound, 0)
10677 || (bound_attr == DW_AT_lower_bound
10678 && (((is_c_family () || is_java ()) && integer_zerop (bound))
10679 || (is_fortran () && integer_onep (bound)))))
10680 /* Use the default. */
10681 ;
10682 else
10683 add_AT_unsigned (subrange_die, bound_attr, tree_low_cst (bound, 0));
10684 break;
10685
10686 case CONVERT_EXPR:
10687 case NOP_EXPR:
10688 case NON_LVALUE_EXPR:
10689 case VIEW_CONVERT_EXPR:
10690 add_bound_info (subrange_die, bound_attr, TREE_OPERAND (bound, 0));
10691 break;
10692
10693 case SAVE_EXPR:
10694 break;
10695
10696 case VAR_DECL:
10697 case PARM_DECL:
10698 case RESULT_DECL:
10699 {
10700 dw_die_ref decl_die = lookup_decl_die (bound);
10701
10702 /* ??? Can this happen, or should the variable have been bound
10703 first? Probably it can, since I imagine that we try to create
10704 the types of parameters in the order in which they exist in
10705 the list, and won't have created a forward reference to a
10706 later parameter. */
10707 if (decl_die != NULL)
10708 add_AT_die_ref (subrange_die, bound_attr, decl_die);
10709 break;
10710 }
10711
10712 default:
10713 {
10714 /* Otherwise try to create a stack operation procedure to
10715 evaluate the value of the array bound. */
10716
10717 dw_die_ref ctx, decl_die;
10718 dw_loc_descr_ref loc;
10719
10720 loc = loc_descriptor_from_tree (bound);
10721 if (loc == NULL)
10722 break;
10723
10724 if (current_function_decl == 0)
10725 ctx = comp_unit_die;
10726 else
10727 ctx = lookup_decl_die (current_function_decl);
10728
10729 decl_die = new_die (DW_TAG_variable, ctx, bound);
10730 add_AT_flag (decl_die, DW_AT_artificial, 1);
10731 add_type_attribute (decl_die, TREE_TYPE (bound), 1, 0, ctx);
10732 add_AT_loc (decl_die, DW_AT_location, loc);
10733
10734 add_AT_die_ref (subrange_die, bound_attr, decl_die);
10735 break;
10736 }
10737 }
10738 }
10739
10740 /* Note that the block of subscript information for an array type also
10741 includes information about the element type of type given array type. */
10742
10743 static void
10744 add_subscript_info (dw_die_ref type_die, tree type)
10745 {
10746 #ifndef MIPS_DEBUGGING_INFO
10747 unsigned dimension_number;
10748 #endif
10749 tree lower, upper;
10750 dw_die_ref subrange_die;
10751
10752 /* The GNU compilers represent multidimensional array types as sequences of
10753 one dimensional array types whose element types are themselves array
10754 types. Here we squish that down, so that each multidimensional array
10755 type gets only one array_type DIE in the Dwarf debugging info. The draft
10756 Dwarf specification say that we are allowed to do this kind of
10757 compression in C (because there is no difference between an array or
10758 arrays and a multidimensional array in C) but for other source languages
10759 (e.g. Ada) we probably shouldn't do this. */
10760
10761 /* ??? The SGI dwarf reader fails for multidimensional arrays with a
10762 const enum type. E.g. const enum machine_mode insn_operand_mode[2][10].
10763 We work around this by disabling this feature. See also
10764 gen_array_type_die. */
10765 #ifndef MIPS_DEBUGGING_INFO
10766 for (dimension_number = 0;
10767 TREE_CODE (type) == ARRAY_TYPE;
10768 type = TREE_TYPE (type), dimension_number++)
10769 #endif
10770 {
10771 tree domain = TYPE_DOMAIN (type);
10772
10773 /* Arrays come in three flavors: Unspecified bounds, fixed bounds,
10774 and (in GNU C only) variable bounds. Handle all three forms
10775 here. */
10776 subrange_die = new_die (DW_TAG_subrange_type, type_die, NULL);
10777 if (domain)
10778 {
10779 /* We have an array type with specified bounds. */
10780 lower = TYPE_MIN_VALUE (domain);
10781 upper = TYPE_MAX_VALUE (domain);
10782
10783 /* Define the index type. */
10784 if (TREE_TYPE (domain))
10785 {
10786 /* ??? This is probably an Ada unnamed subrange type. Ignore the
10787 TREE_TYPE field. We can't emit debug info for this
10788 because it is an unnamed integral type. */
10789 if (TREE_CODE (domain) == INTEGER_TYPE
10790 && TYPE_NAME (domain) == NULL_TREE
10791 && TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (domain)) == INTEGER_TYPE
10792 && TYPE_NAME (TREE_TYPE (domain)) == NULL_TREE)
10793 ;
10794 else
10795 add_type_attribute (subrange_die, TREE_TYPE (domain), 0, 0,
10796 type_die);
10797 }
10798
10799 /* ??? If upper is NULL, the array has unspecified length,
10800 but it does have a lower bound. This happens with Fortran
10801 dimension arr(N:*)
10802 Since the debugger is definitely going to need to know N
10803 to produce useful results, go ahead and output the lower
10804 bound solo, and hope the debugger can cope. */
10805
10806 add_bound_info (subrange_die, DW_AT_lower_bound, lower);
10807 if (upper)
10808 add_bound_info (subrange_die, DW_AT_upper_bound, upper);
10809 }
10810
10811 /* Otherwise we have an array type with an unspecified length. The
10812 DWARF-2 spec does not say how to handle this; let's just leave out the
10813 bounds. */
10814 }
10815 }
10816
10817 static void
10818 add_byte_size_attribute (dw_die_ref die, tree tree_node)
10819 {
10820 unsigned size;
10821
10822 switch (TREE_CODE (tree_node))
10823 {
10824 case ERROR_MARK:
10825 size = 0;
10826 break;
10827 case ENUMERAL_TYPE:
10828 case RECORD_TYPE:
10829 case UNION_TYPE:
10830 case QUAL_UNION_TYPE:
10831 size = int_size_in_bytes (tree_node);
10832 break;
10833 case FIELD_DECL:
10834 /* For a data member of a struct or union, the DW_AT_byte_size is
10835 generally given as the number of bytes normally allocated for an
10836 object of the *declared* type of the member itself. This is true
10837 even for bit-fields. */
10838 size = simple_type_size_in_bits (field_type (tree_node)) / BITS_PER_UNIT;
10839 break;
10840 default:
10841 gcc_unreachable ();
10842 }
10843
10844 /* Note that `size' might be -1 when we get to this point. If it is, that
10845 indicates that the byte size of the entity in question is variable. We
10846 have no good way of expressing this fact in Dwarf at the present time,
10847 so just let the -1 pass on through. */
10848 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_byte_size, size);
10849 }
10850
10851 /* For a FIELD_DECL node which represents a bit-field, output an attribute
10852 which specifies the distance in bits from the highest order bit of the
10853 "containing object" for the bit-field to the highest order bit of the
10854 bit-field itself.
10855
10856 For any given bit-field, the "containing object" is a hypothetical object
10857 (of some integral or enum type) within which the given bit-field lives. The
10858 type of this hypothetical "containing object" is always the same as the
10859 declared type of the individual bit-field itself. The determination of the
10860 exact location of the "containing object" for a bit-field is rather
10861 complicated. It's handled by the `field_byte_offset' function (above).
10862
10863 Note that it is the size (in bytes) of the hypothetical "containing object"
10864 which will be given in the DW_AT_byte_size attribute for this bit-field.
10865 (See `byte_size_attribute' above). */
10866
10867 static inline void
10868 add_bit_offset_attribute (dw_die_ref die, tree decl)
10869 {
10870 HOST_WIDE_INT object_offset_in_bytes = field_byte_offset (decl);
10871 tree type = DECL_BIT_FIELD_TYPE (decl);
10872 HOST_WIDE_INT bitpos_int;
10873 HOST_WIDE_INT highest_order_object_bit_offset;
10874 HOST_WIDE_INT highest_order_field_bit_offset;
10875 HOST_WIDE_INT unsigned bit_offset;
10876
10877 /* Must be a field and a bit field. */
10878 gcc_assert (type && TREE_CODE (decl) == FIELD_DECL);
10879
10880 /* We can't yet handle bit-fields whose offsets are variable, so if we
10881 encounter such things, just return without generating any attribute
10882 whatsoever. Likewise for variable or too large size. */
10883 if (! host_integerp (bit_position (decl), 0)
10884 || ! host_integerp (DECL_SIZE (decl), 1))
10885 return;
10886
10887 bitpos_int = int_bit_position (decl);
10888
10889 /* Note that the bit offset is always the distance (in bits) from the
10890 highest-order bit of the "containing object" to the highest-order bit of
10891 the bit-field itself. Since the "high-order end" of any object or field
10892 is different on big-endian and little-endian machines, the computation
10893 below must take account of these differences. */
10894 highest_order_object_bit_offset = object_offset_in_bytes * BITS_PER_UNIT;
10895 highest_order_field_bit_offset = bitpos_int;
10896
10897 if (! BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN)
10898 {
10899 highest_order_field_bit_offset += tree_low_cst (DECL_SIZE (decl), 0);
10900 highest_order_object_bit_offset += simple_type_size_in_bits (type);
10901 }
10902
10903 bit_offset
10904 = (! BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN
10905 ? highest_order_object_bit_offset - highest_order_field_bit_offset
10906 : highest_order_field_bit_offset - highest_order_object_bit_offset);
10907
10908 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_bit_offset, bit_offset);
10909 }
10910
10911 /* For a FIELD_DECL node which represents a bit field, output an attribute
10912 which specifies the length in bits of the given field. */
10913
10914 static inline void
10915 add_bit_size_attribute (dw_die_ref die, tree decl)
10916 {
10917 /* Must be a field and a bit field. */
10918 gcc_assert (TREE_CODE (decl) == FIELD_DECL
10919 && DECL_BIT_FIELD_TYPE (decl));
10920
10921 if (host_integerp (DECL_SIZE (decl), 1))
10922 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_bit_size, tree_low_cst (DECL_SIZE (decl), 1));
10923 }
10924
10925 /* If the compiled language is ANSI C, then add a 'prototyped'
10926 attribute, if arg types are given for the parameters of a function. */
10927
10928 static inline void
10929 add_prototyped_attribute (dw_die_ref die, tree func_type)
10930 {
10931 if (get_AT_unsigned (comp_unit_die, DW_AT_language) == DW_LANG_C89
10932 && TYPE_ARG_TYPES (func_type) != NULL)
10933 add_AT_flag (die, DW_AT_prototyped, 1);
10934 }
10935
10936 /* Add an 'abstract_origin' attribute below a given DIE. The DIE is found
10937 by looking in either the type declaration or object declaration
10938 equate table. */
10939
10940 static inline void
10941 add_abstract_origin_attribute (dw_die_ref die, tree origin)
10942 {
10943 dw_die_ref origin_die = NULL;
10944
10945 if (TREE_CODE (origin) != FUNCTION_DECL)
10946 {
10947 /* We may have gotten separated from the block for the inlined
10948 function, if we're in an exception handler or some such; make
10949 sure that the abstract function has been written out.
10950
10951 Doing this for nested functions is wrong, however; functions are
10952 distinct units, and our context might not even be inline. */
10953 tree fn = origin;
10954
10955 if (TYPE_P (fn))
10956 fn = TYPE_STUB_DECL (fn);
10957
10958 fn = decl_function_context (fn);
10959 if (fn)
10960 dwarf2out_abstract_function (fn);
10961 }
10962
10963 if (DECL_P (origin))
10964 origin_die = lookup_decl_die (origin);
10965 else if (TYPE_P (origin))
10966 origin_die = lookup_type_die (origin);
10967
10968 /* XXX: Functions that are never lowered don't always have correct block
10969 trees (in the case of java, they simply have no block tree, in some other
10970 languages). For these functions, there is nothing we can really do to
10971 output correct debug info for inlined functions in all cases. Rather
10972 than die, we'll just produce deficient debug info now, in that we will
10973 have variables without a proper abstract origin. In the future, when all
10974 functions are lowered, we should re-add a gcc_assert (origin_die)
10975 here. */
10976
10977 if (origin_die)
10978 add_AT_die_ref (die, DW_AT_abstract_origin, origin_die);
10979 }
10980
10981 /* We do not currently support the pure_virtual attribute. */
10982
10983 static inline void
10984 add_pure_or_virtual_attribute (dw_die_ref die, tree func_decl)
10985 {
10986 if (DECL_VINDEX (func_decl))
10987 {
10988 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_virtuality, DW_VIRTUALITY_virtual);
10989
10990 if (host_integerp (DECL_VINDEX (func_decl), 0))
10991 add_AT_loc (die, DW_AT_vtable_elem_location,
10992 new_loc_descr (DW_OP_constu,
10993 tree_low_cst (DECL_VINDEX (func_decl), 0),
10994 0));
10995
10996 /* GNU extension: Record what type this method came from originally. */
10997 if (debug_info_level > DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
10998 add_AT_die_ref (die, DW_AT_containing_type,
10999 lookup_type_die (DECL_CONTEXT (func_decl)));
11000 }
11001 }
11002 \f
11003 /* Add source coordinate attributes for the given decl. */
11004
11005 static void
11006 add_src_coords_attributes (dw_die_ref die, tree decl)
11007 {
11008 expanded_location s = expand_location (DECL_SOURCE_LOCATION (decl));
11009
11010 add_AT_file (die, DW_AT_decl_file, lookup_filename (s.file));
11011 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_decl_line, s.line);
11012 }
11013
11014 /* Add a DW_AT_name attribute and source coordinate attribute for the
11015 given decl, but only if it actually has a name. */
11016
11017 static void
11018 add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (dw_die_ref die, tree decl)
11019 {
11020 tree decl_name;
11021
11022 decl_name = DECL_NAME (decl);
11023 if (decl_name != NULL && IDENTIFIER_POINTER (decl_name) != NULL)
11024 {
11025 add_name_attribute (die, dwarf2_name (decl, 0));
11026 if (! DECL_ARTIFICIAL (decl))
11027 add_src_coords_attributes (die, decl);
11028
11029 if ((TREE_CODE (decl) == FUNCTION_DECL || TREE_CODE (decl) == VAR_DECL)
11030 && TREE_PUBLIC (decl)
11031 && DECL_ASSEMBLER_NAME (decl) != DECL_NAME (decl)
11032 && !DECL_ABSTRACT (decl)
11033 && !(TREE_CODE (decl) == VAR_DECL && DECL_REGISTER (decl)))
11034 add_AT_string (die, DW_AT_MIPS_linkage_name,
11035 IDENTIFIER_POINTER (DECL_ASSEMBLER_NAME (decl)));
11036 }
11037
11038 #ifdef VMS_DEBUGGING_INFO
11039 /* Get the function's name, as described by its RTL. This may be different
11040 from the DECL_NAME name used in the source file. */
11041 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == FUNCTION_DECL && TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (decl))
11042 {
11043 add_AT_addr (die, DW_AT_VMS_rtnbeg_pd_address,
11044 XEXP (DECL_RTL (decl), 0));
11045 VEC_safe_push (tree, gc, used_rtx_array, XEXP (DECL_RTL (decl), 0));
11046 }
11047 #endif
11048 }
11049
11050 /* Push a new declaration scope. */
11051
11052 static void
11053 push_decl_scope (tree scope)
11054 {
11055 VEC_safe_push (tree, gc, decl_scope_table, scope);
11056 }
11057
11058 /* Pop a declaration scope. */
11059
11060 static inline void
11061 pop_decl_scope (void)
11062 {
11063 VEC_pop (tree, decl_scope_table);
11064 }
11065
11066 /* Return the DIE for the scope that immediately contains this type.
11067 Non-named types get global scope. Named types nested in other
11068 types get their containing scope if it's open, or global scope
11069 otherwise. All other types (i.e. function-local named types) get
11070 the current active scope. */
11071
11072 static dw_die_ref
11073 scope_die_for (tree t, dw_die_ref context_die)
11074 {
11075 dw_die_ref scope_die = NULL;
11076 tree containing_scope;
11077 int i;
11078
11079 /* Non-types always go in the current scope. */
11080 gcc_assert (TYPE_P (t));
11081
11082 containing_scope = TYPE_CONTEXT (t);
11083
11084 /* Use the containing namespace if it was passed in (for a declaration). */
11085 if (containing_scope && TREE_CODE (containing_scope) == NAMESPACE_DECL)
11086 {
11087 if (context_die == lookup_decl_die (containing_scope))
11088 /* OK */;
11089 else
11090 containing_scope = NULL_TREE;
11091 }
11092
11093 /* Ignore function type "scopes" from the C frontend. They mean that
11094 a tagged type is local to a parmlist of a function declarator, but
11095 that isn't useful to DWARF. */
11096 if (containing_scope && TREE_CODE (containing_scope) == FUNCTION_TYPE)
11097 containing_scope = NULL_TREE;
11098
11099 if (containing_scope == NULL_TREE)
11100 scope_die = comp_unit_die;
11101 else if (TYPE_P (containing_scope))
11102 {
11103 /* For types, we can just look up the appropriate DIE. But
11104 first we check to see if we're in the middle of emitting it
11105 so we know where the new DIE should go. */
11106 for (i = VEC_length (tree, decl_scope_table) - 1; i >= 0; --i)
11107 if (VEC_index (tree, decl_scope_table, i) == containing_scope)
11108 break;
11109
11110 if (i < 0)
11111 {
11112 gcc_assert (debug_info_level <= DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE
11113 || TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (containing_scope));
11114
11115 /* If none of the current dies are suitable, we get file scope. */
11116 scope_die = comp_unit_die;
11117 }
11118 else
11119 scope_die = lookup_type_die (containing_scope);
11120 }
11121 else
11122 scope_die = context_die;
11123
11124 return scope_die;
11125 }
11126
11127 /* Returns nonzero if CONTEXT_DIE is internal to a function. */
11128
11129 static inline int
11130 local_scope_p (dw_die_ref context_die)
11131 {
11132 for (; context_die; context_die = context_die->die_parent)
11133 if (context_die->die_tag == DW_TAG_inlined_subroutine
11134 || context_die->die_tag == DW_TAG_subprogram)
11135 return 1;
11136
11137 return 0;
11138 }
11139
11140 /* Returns nonzero if CONTEXT_DIE is a class or namespace, for deciding
11141 whether or not to treat a DIE in this context as a declaration. */
11142
11143 static inline int
11144 class_or_namespace_scope_p (dw_die_ref context_die)
11145 {
11146 return (context_die
11147 && (context_die->die_tag == DW_TAG_structure_type
11148 || context_die->die_tag == DW_TAG_union_type
11149 || context_die->die_tag == DW_TAG_namespace));
11150 }
11151
11152 /* Many forms of DIEs require a "type description" attribute. This
11153 routine locates the proper "type descriptor" die for the type given
11154 by 'type', and adds a DW_AT_type attribute below the given die. */
11155
11156 static void
11157 add_type_attribute (dw_die_ref object_die, tree type, int decl_const,
11158 int decl_volatile, dw_die_ref context_die)
11159 {
11160 enum tree_code code = TREE_CODE (type);
11161 dw_die_ref type_die = NULL;
11162
11163 /* ??? If this type is an unnamed subrange type of an integral or
11164 floating-point type, use the inner type. This is because we have no
11165 support for unnamed types in base_type_die. This can happen if this is
11166 an Ada subrange type. Correct solution is emit a subrange type die. */
11167 if ((code == INTEGER_TYPE || code == REAL_TYPE)
11168 && TREE_TYPE (type) != 0 && TYPE_NAME (type) == 0)
11169 type = TREE_TYPE (type), code = TREE_CODE (type);
11170
11171 if (code == ERROR_MARK
11172 /* Handle a special case. For functions whose return type is void, we
11173 generate *no* type attribute. (Note that no object may have type
11174 `void', so this only applies to function return types). */
11175 || code == VOID_TYPE)
11176 return;
11177
11178 type_die = modified_type_die (type,
11179 decl_const || TYPE_READONLY (type),
11180 decl_volatile || TYPE_VOLATILE (type),
11181 context_die);
11182
11183 if (type_die != NULL)
11184 add_AT_die_ref (object_die, DW_AT_type, type_die);
11185 }
11186
11187 /* Given an object die, add the calling convention attribute for the
11188 function call type. */
11189 static void
11190 add_calling_convention_attribute (dw_die_ref subr_die, tree type)
11191 {
11192 enum dwarf_calling_convention value = DW_CC_normal;
11193
11194 value = targetm.dwarf_calling_convention (type);
11195
11196 /* Only add the attribute if the backend requests it, and
11197 is not DW_CC_normal. */
11198 if (value && (value != DW_CC_normal))
11199 add_AT_unsigned (subr_die, DW_AT_calling_convention, value);
11200 }
11201
11202 /* Given a tree pointer to a struct, class, union, or enum type node, return
11203 a pointer to the (string) tag name for the given type, or zero if the type
11204 was declared without a tag. */
11205
11206 static const char *
11207 type_tag (tree type)
11208 {
11209 const char *name = 0;
11210
11211 if (TYPE_NAME (type) != 0)
11212 {
11213 tree t = 0;
11214
11215 /* Find the IDENTIFIER_NODE for the type name. */
11216 if (TREE_CODE (TYPE_NAME (type)) == IDENTIFIER_NODE)
11217 t = TYPE_NAME (type);
11218
11219 /* The g++ front end makes the TYPE_NAME of *each* tagged type point to
11220 a TYPE_DECL node, regardless of whether or not a `typedef' was
11221 involved. */
11222 else if (TREE_CODE (TYPE_NAME (type)) == TYPE_DECL
11223 && ! DECL_IGNORED_P (TYPE_NAME (type)))
11224 t = DECL_NAME (TYPE_NAME (type));
11225
11226 /* Now get the name as a string, or invent one. */
11227 if (t != 0)
11228 name = IDENTIFIER_POINTER (t);
11229 }
11230
11231 return (name == 0 || *name == '\0') ? 0 : name;
11232 }
11233
11234 /* Return the type associated with a data member, make a special check
11235 for bit field types. */
11236
11237 static inline tree
11238 member_declared_type (tree member)
11239 {
11240 return (DECL_BIT_FIELD_TYPE (member)
11241 ? DECL_BIT_FIELD_TYPE (member) : TREE_TYPE (member));
11242 }
11243
11244 /* Get the decl's label, as described by its RTL. This may be different
11245 from the DECL_NAME name used in the source file. */
11246
11247 #if 0
11248 static const char *
11249 decl_start_label (tree decl)
11250 {
11251 rtx x;
11252 const char *fnname;
11253
11254 x = DECL_RTL (decl);
11255 gcc_assert (MEM_P (x));
11256
11257 x = XEXP (x, 0);
11258 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (x) == SYMBOL_REF);
11259
11260 fnname = XSTR (x, 0);
11261 return fnname;
11262 }
11263 #endif
11264 \f
11265 /* These routines generate the internal representation of the DIE's for
11266 the compilation unit. Debugging information is collected by walking
11267 the declaration trees passed in from dwarf2out_decl(). */
11268
11269 static void
11270 gen_array_type_die (tree type, dw_die_ref context_die)
11271 {
11272 dw_die_ref scope_die = scope_die_for (type, context_die);
11273 dw_die_ref array_die;
11274 tree element_type;
11275
11276 /* ??? The SGI dwarf reader fails for array of array of enum types unless
11277 the inner array type comes before the outer array type. Thus we must
11278 call gen_type_die before we call new_die. See below also. */
11279 #ifdef MIPS_DEBUGGING_INFO
11280 gen_type_die (TREE_TYPE (type), context_die);
11281 #endif
11282
11283 array_die = new_die (DW_TAG_array_type, scope_die, type);
11284 add_name_attribute (array_die, type_tag (type));
11285 equate_type_number_to_die (type, array_die);
11286
11287 if (TREE_CODE (type) == VECTOR_TYPE)
11288 {
11289 /* The frontend feeds us a representation for the vector as a struct
11290 containing an array. Pull out the array type. */
11291 type = TREE_TYPE (TYPE_FIELDS (TYPE_DEBUG_REPRESENTATION_TYPE (type)));
11292 add_AT_flag (array_die, DW_AT_GNU_vector, 1);
11293 }
11294
11295 #if 0
11296 /* We default the array ordering. SDB will probably do
11297 the right things even if DW_AT_ordering is not present. It's not even
11298 an issue until we start to get into multidimensional arrays anyway. If
11299 SDB is ever caught doing the Wrong Thing for multi-dimensional arrays,
11300 then we'll have to put the DW_AT_ordering attribute back in. (But if
11301 and when we find out that we need to put these in, we will only do so
11302 for multidimensional arrays. */
11303 add_AT_unsigned (array_die, DW_AT_ordering, DW_ORD_row_major);
11304 #endif
11305
11306 #ifdef MIPS_DEBUGGING_INFO
11307 /* The SGI compilers handle arrays of unknown bound by setting
11308 AT_declaration and not emitting any subrange DIEs. */
11309 if (! TYPE_DOMAIN (type))
11310 add_AT_flag (array_die, DW_AT_declaration, 1);
11311 else
11312 #endif
11313 add_subscript_info (array_die, type);
11314
11315 /* Add representation of the type of the elements of this array type. */
11316 element_type = TREE_TYPE (type);
11317
11318 /* ??? The SGI dwarf reader fails for multidimensional arrays with a
11319 const enum type. E.g. const enum machine_mode insn_operand_mode[2][10].
11320 We work around this by disabling this feature. See also
11321 add_subscript_info. */
11322 #ifndef MIPS_DEBUGGING_INFO
11323 while (TREE_CODE (element_type) == ARRAY_TYPE)
11324 element_type = TREE_TYPE (element_type);
11325
11326 gen_type_die (element_type, context_die);
11327 #endif
11328
11329 add_type_attribute (array_die, element_type, 0, 0, context_die);
11330
11331 if (get_AT (array_die, DW_AT_name))
11332 add_pubtype (type, array_die);
11333 }
11334
11335 #if 0
11336 static void
11337 gen_entry_point_die (tree decl, dw_die_ref context_die)
11338 {
11339 tree origin = decl_ultimate_origin (decl);
11340 dw_die_ref decl_die = new_die (DW_TAG_entry_point, context_die, decl);
11341
11342 if (origin != NULL)
11343 add_abstract_origin_attribute (decl_die, origin);
11344 else
11345 {
11346 add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (decl_die, decl);
11347 add_type_attribute (decl_die, TREE_TYPE (TREE_TYPE (decl)),
11348 0, 0, context_die);
11349 }
11350
11351 if (DECL_ABSTRACT (decl))
11352 equate_decl_number_to_die (decl, decl_die);
11353 else
11354 add_AT_lbl_id (decl_die, DW_AT_low_pc, decl_start_label (decl));
11355 }
11356 #endif
11357
11358 /* Walk through the list of incomplete types again, trying once more to
11359 emit full debugging info for them. */
11360
11361 static void
11362 retry_incomplete_types (void)
11363 {
11364 int i;
11365
11366 for (i = VEC_length (tree, incomplete_types) - 1; i >= 0; i--)
11367 gen_type_die (VEC_index (tree, incomplete_types, i), comp_unit_die);
11368 }
11369
11370 /* Generate a DIE to represent an inlined instance of an enumeration type. */
11371
11372 static void
11373 gen_inlined_enumeration_type_die (tree type, dw_die_ref context_die)
11374 {
11375 dw_die_ref type_die = new_die (DW_TAG_enumeration_type, context_die, type);
11376
11377 /* We do not check for TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type) being set, as the type may
11378 be incomplete and such types are not marked. */
11379 add_abstract_origin_attribute (type_die, type);
11380 }
11381
11382 /* Generate a DIE to represent an inlined instance of a structure type. */
11383
11384 static void
11385 gen_inlined_structure_type_die (tree type, dw_die_ref context_die)
11386 {
11387 dw_die_ref type_die = new_die (DW_TAG_structure_type, context_die, type);
11388
11389 /* We do not check for TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type) being set, as the type may
11390 be incomplete and such types are not marked. */
11391 add_abstract_origin_attribute (type_die, type);
11392 }
11393
11394 /* Generate a DIE to represent an inlined instance of a union type. */
11395
11396 static void
11397 gen_inlined_union_type_die (tree type, dw_die_ref context_die)
11398 {
11399 dw_die_ref type_die = new_die (DW_TAG_union_type, context_die, type);
11400
11401 /* We do not check for TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type) being set, as the type may
11402 be incomplete and such types are not marked. */
11403 add_abstract_origin_attribute (type_die, type);
11404 }
11405
11406 /* Generate a DIE to represent an enumeration type. Note that these DIEs
11407 include all of the information about the enumeration values also. Each
11408 enumerated type name/value is listed as a child of the enumerated type
11409 DIE. */
11410
11411 static dw_die_ref
11412 gen_enumeration_type_die (tree type, dw_die_ref context_die)
11413 {
11414 dw_die_ref type_die = lookup_type_die (type);
11415
11416 if (type_die == NULL)
11417 {
11418 type_die = new_die (DW_TAG_enumeration_type,
11419 scope_die_for (type, context_die), type);
11420 equate_type_number_to_die (type, type_die);
11421 add_name_attribute (type_die, type_tag (type));
11422 }
11423 else if (! TYPE_SIZE (type))
11424 return type_die;
11425 else
11426 remove_AT (type_die, DW_AT_declaration);
11427
11428 /* Handle a GNU C/C++ extension, i.e. incomplete enum types. If the
11429 given enum type is incomplete, do not generate the DW_AT_byte_size
11430 attribute or the DW_AT_element_list attribute. */
11431 if (TYPE_SIZE (type))
11432 {
11433 tree link;
11434
11435 TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type) = 1;
11436 add_byte_size_attribute (type_die, type);
11437 if (TYPE_STUB_DECL (type) != NULL_TREE)
11438 add_src_coords_attributes (type_die, TYPE_STUB_DECL (type));
11439
11440 /* If the first reference to this type was as the return type of an
11441 inline function, then it may not have a parent. Fix this now. */
11442 if (type_die->die_parent == NULL)
11443 add_child_die (scope_die_for (type, context_die), type_die);
11444
11445 for (link = TYPE_VALUES (type);
11446 link != NULL; link = TREE_CHAIN (link))
11447 {
11448 dw_die_ref enum_die = new_die (DW_TAG_enumerator, type_die, link);
11449 tree value = TREE_VALUE (link);
11450
11451 add_name_attribute (enum_die,
11452 IDENTIFIER_POINTER (TREE_PURPOSE (link)));
11453
11454 if (host_integerp (value, TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (value))))
11455 /* DWARF2 does not provide a way of indicating whether or
11456 not enumeration constants are signed or unsigned. GDB
11457 always assumes the values are signed, so we output all
11458 values as if they were signed. That means that
11459 enumeration constants with very large unsigned values
11460 will appear to have negative values in the debugger. */
11461 add_AT_int (enum_die, DW_AT_const_value,
11462 tree_low_cst (value, tree_int_cst_sgn (value) > 0));
11463 }
11464 }
11465 else
11466 add_AT_flag (type_die, DW_AT_declaration, 1);
11467
11468 if (get_AT (type_die, DW_AT_name))
11469 add_pubtype (type, type_die);
11470
11471 return type_die;
11472 }
11473
11474 /* Generate a DIE to represent either a real live formal parameter decl or to
11475 represent just the type of some formal parameter position in some function
11476 type.
11477
11478 Note that this routine is a bit unusual because its argument may be a
11479 ..._DECL node (i.e. either a PARM_DECL or perhaps a VAR_DECL which
11480 represents an inlining of some PARM_DECL) or else some sort of a ..._TYPE
11481 node. If it's the former then this function is being called to output a
11482 DIE to represent a formal parameter object (or some inlining thereof). If
11483 it's the latter, then this function is only being called to output a
11484 DW_TAG_formal_parameter DIE to stand as a placeholder for some formal
11485 argument type of some subprogram type. */
11486
11487 static dw_die_ref
11488 gen_formal_parameter_die (tree node, dw_die_ref context_die)
11489 {
11490 dw_die_ref parm_die
11491 = new_die (DW_TAG_formal_parameter, context_die, node);
11492 tree origin;
11493
11494 switch (TREE_CODE_CLASS (TREE_CODE (node)))
11495 {
11496 case tcc_declaration:
11497 origin = decl_ultimate_origin (node);
11498 if (origin != NULL)
11499 add_abstract_origin_attribute (parm_die, origin);
11500 else
11501 {
11502 add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (parm_die, node);
11503 add_type_attribute (parm_die, TREE_TYPE (node),
11504 TREE_READONLY (node),
11505 TREE_THIS_VOLATILE (node),
11506 context_die);
11507 if (DECL_ARTIFICIAL (node))
11508 add_AT_flag (parm_die, DW_AT_artificial, 1);
11509 }
11510
11511 equate_decl_number_to_die (node, parm_die);
11512 if (! DECL_ABSTRACT (node))
11513 add_location_or_const_value_attribute (parm_die, node, DW_AT_location);
11514
11515 break;
11516
11517 case tcc_type:
11518 /* We were called with some kind of a ..._TYPE node. */
11519 add_type_attribute (parm_die, node, 0, 0, context_die);
11520 break;
11521
11522 default:
11523 gcc_unreachable ();
11524 }
11525
11526 return parm_die;
11527 }
11528
11529 /* Generate a special type of DIE used as a stand-in for a trailing ellipsis
11530 at the end of an (ANSI prototyped) formal parameters list. */
11531
11532 static void
11533 gen_unspecified_parameters_die (tree decl_or_type, dw_die_ref context_die)
11534 {
11535 new_die (DW_TAG_unspecified_parameters, context_die, decl_or_type);
11536 }
11537
11538 /* Generate a list of nameless DW_TAG_formal_parameter DIEs (and perhaps a
11539 DW_TAG_unspecified_parameters DIE) to represent the types of the formal
11540 parameters as specified in some function type specification (except for
11541 those which appear as part of a function *definition*). */
11542
11543 static void
11544 gen_formal_types_die (tree function_or_method_type, dw_die_ref context_die)
11545 {
11546 tree link;
11547 tree formal_type = NULL;
11548 tree first_parm_type;
11549 tree arg;
11550
11551 if (TREE_CODE (function_or_method_type) == FUNCTION_DECL)
11552 {
11553 arg = DECL_ARGUMENTS (function_or_method_type);
11554 function_or_method_type = TREE_TYPE (function_or_method_type);
11555 }
11556 else
11557 arg = NULL_TREE;
11558
11559 first_parm_type = TYPE_ARG_TYPES (function_or_method_type);
11560
11561 /* Make our first pass over the list of formal parameter types and output a
11562 DW_TAG_formal_parameter DIE for each one. */
11563 for (link = first_parm_type; link; )
11564 {
11565 dw_die_ref parm_die;
11566
11567 formal_type = TREE_VALUE (link);
11568 if (formal_type == void_type_node)
11569 break;
11570
11571 /* Output a (nameless) DIE to represent the formal parameter itself. */
11572 parm_die = gen_formal_parameter_die (formal_type, context_die);
11573 if ((TREE_CODE (function_or_method_type) == METHOD_TYPE
11574 && link == first_parm_type)
11575 || (arg && DECL_ARTIFICIAL (arg)))
11576 add_AT_flag (parm_die, DW_AT_artificial, 1);
11577
11578 link = TREE_CHAIN (link);
11579 if (arg)
11580 arg = TREE_CHAIN (arg);
11581 }
11582
11583 /* If this function type has an ellipsis, add a
11584 DW_TAG_unspecified_parameters DIE to the end of the parameter list. */
11585 if (formal_type != void_type_node)
11586 gen_unspecified_parameters_die (function_or_method_type, context_die);
11587
11588 /* Make our second (and final) pass over the list of formal parameter types
11589 and output DIEs to represent those types (as necessary). */
11590 for (link = TYPE_ARG_TYPES (function_or_method_type);
11591 link && TREE_VALUE (link);
11592 link = TREE_CHAIN (link))
11593 gen_type_die (TREE_VALUE (link), context_die);
11594 }
11595
11596 /* We want to generate the DIE for TYPE so that we can generate the
11597 die for MEMBER, which has been defined; we will need to refer back
11598 to the member declaration nested within TYPE. If we're trying to
11599 generate minimal debug info for TYPE, processing TYPE won't do the
11600 trick; we need to attach the member declaration by hand. */
11601
11602 static void
11603 gen_type_die_for_member (tree type, tree member, dw_die_ref context_die)
11604 {
11605 gen_type_die (type, context_die);
11606
11607 /* If we're trying to avoid duplicate debug info, we may not have
11608 emitted the member decl for this function. Emit it now. */
11609 if (TYPE_DECL_SUPPRESS_DEBUG (TYPE_STUB_DECL (type))
11610 && ! lookup_decl_die (member))
11611 {
11612 dw_die_ref type_die;
11613 gcc_assert (!decl_ultimate_origin (member));
11614
11615 push_decl_scope (type);
11616 type_die = lookup_type_die (type);
11617 if (TREE_CODE (member) == FUNCTION_DECL)
11618 gen_subprogram_die (member, type_die);
11619 else if (TREE_CODE (member) == FIELD_DECL)
11620 {
11621 /* Ignore the nameless fields that are used to skip bits but handle
11622 C++ anonymous unions and structs. */
11623 if (DECL_NAME (member) != NULL_TREE
11624 || TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (member)) == UNION_TYPE
11625 || TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (member)) == RECORD_TYPE)
11626 {
11627 gen_type_die (member_declared_type (member), type_die);
11628 gen_field_die (member, type_die);
11629 }
11630 }
11631 else
11632 gen_variable_die (member, type_die);
11633
11634 pop_decl_scope ();
11635 }
11636 }
11637
11638 /* Generate the DWARF2 info for the "abstract" instance of a function which we
11639 may later generate inlined and/or out-of-line instances of. */
11640
11641 static void
11642 dwarf2out_abstract_function (tree decl)
11643 {
11644 dw_die_ref old_die;
11645 tree save_fn;
11646 struct function *save_cfun;
11647 tree context;
11648 int was_abstract = DECL_ABSTRACT (decl);
11649
11650 /* Make sure we have the actual abstract inline, not a clone. */
11651 decl = DECL_ORIGIN (decl);
11652
11653 old_die = lookup_decl_die (decl);
11654 if (old_die && get_AT (old_die, DW_AT_inline))
11655 /* We've already generated the abstract instance. */
11656 return;
11657
11658 /* Be sure we've emitted the in-class declaration DIE (if any) first, so
11659 we don't get confused by DECL_ABSTRACT. */
11660 if (debug_info_level > DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
11661 {
11662 context = decl_class_context (decl);
11663 if (context)
11664 gen_type_die_for_member
11665 (context, decl, decl_function_context (decl) ? NULL : comp_unit_die);
11666 }
11667
11668 /* Pretend we've just finished compiling this function. */
11669 save_fn = current_function_decl;
11670 save_cfun = cfun;
11671 current_function_decl = decl;
11672 cfun = DECL_STRUCT_FUNCTION (decl);
11673
11674 set_decl_abstract_flags (decl, 1);
11675 dwarf2out_decl (decl);
11676 if (! was_abstract)
11677 set_decl_abstract_flags (decl, 0);
11678
11679 current_function_decl = save_fn;
11680 cfun = save_cfun;
11681 }
11682
11683 /* Helper function of premark_used_types() which gets called through
11684 htab_traverse_resize().
11685
11686 Marks the DIE of a given type in *SLOT as perennial, so it never gets
11687 marked as unused by prune_unused_types. */
11688 static int
11689 premark_used_types_helper (void **slot, void *data ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
11690 {
11691 tree type;
11692 dw_die_ref die;
11693
11694 type = *slot;
11695 die = lookup_type_die (type);
11696 if (die != NULL)
11697 die->die_perennial_p = 1;
11698 return 1;
11699 }
11700
11701 /* Mark all members of used_types_hash as perennial. */
11702 static void
11703 premark_used_types (void)
11704 {
11705 if (cfun && cfun->used_types_hash)
11706 htab_traverse (cfun->used_types_hash, premark_used_types_helper, NULL);
11707 }
11708
11709 /* Generate a DIE to represent a declared function (either file-scope or
11710 block-local). */
11711
11712 static void
11713 gen_subprogram_die (tree decl, dw_die_ref context_die)
11714 {
11715 char label_id[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
11716 tree origin = decl_ultimate_origin (decl);
11717 dw_die_ref subr_die;
11718 tree fn_arg_types;
11719 tree outer_scope;
11720 dw_die_ref old_die = lookup_decl_die (decl);
11721 int declaration = (current_function_decl != decl
11722 || class_or_namespace_scope_p (context_die));
11723
11724 premark_used_types ();
11725
11726 /* It is possible to have both DECL_ABSTRACT and DECLARATION be true if we
11727 started to generate the abstract instance of an inline, decided to output
11728 its containing class, and proceeded to emit the declaration of the inline
11729 from the member list for the class. If so, DECLARATION takes priority;
11730 we'll get back to the abstract instance when done with the class. */
11731
11732 /* The class-scope declaration DIE must be the primary DIE. */
11733 if (origin && declaration && class_or_namespace_scope_p (context_die))
11734 {
11735 origin = NULL;
11736 gcc_assert (!old_die);
11737 }
11738
11739 /* Now that the C++ front end lazily declares artificial member fns, we
11740 might need to retrofit the declaration into its class. */
11741 if (!declaration && !origin && !old_die
11742 && DECL_CONTEXT (decl) && TYPE_P (DECL_CONTEXT (decl))
11743 && !class_or_namespace_scope_p (context_die)
11744 && debug_info_level > DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
11745 old_die = force_decl_die (decl);
11746
11747 if (origin != NULL)
11748 {
11749 gcc_assert (!declaration || local_scope_p (context_die));
11750
11751 /* Fixup die_parent for the abstract instance of a nested
11752 inline function. */
11753 if (old_die && old_die->die_parent == NULL)
11754 add_child_die (context_die, old_die);
11755
11756 subr_die = new_die (DW_TAG_subprogram, context_die, decl);
11757 add_abstract_origin_attribute (subr_die, origin);
11758 }
11759 else if (old_die)
11760 {
11761 expanded_location s = expand_location (DECL_SOURCE_LOCATION (decl));
11762 struct dwarf_file_data * file_index = lookup_filename (s.file);
11763
11764 if (!get_AT_flag (old_die, DW_AT_declaration)
11765 /* We can have a normal definition following an inline one in the
11766 case of redefinition of GNU C extern inlines.
11767 It seems reasonable to use AT_specification in this case. */
11768 && !get_AT (old_die, DW_AT_inline))
11769 {
11770 /* Detect and ignore this case, where we are trying to output
11771 something we have already output. */
11772 return;
11773 }
11774
11775 /* If the definition comes from the same place as the declaration,
11776 maybe use the old DIE. We always want the DIE for this function
11777 that has the *_pc attributes to be under comp_unit_die so the
11778 debugger can find it. We also need to do this for abstract
11779 instances of inlines, since the spec requires the out-of-line copy
11780 to have the same parent. For local class methods, this doesn't
11781 apply; we just use the old DIE. */
11782 if ((old_die->die_parent == comp_unit_die || context_die == NULL)
11783 && (DECL_ARTIFICIAL (decl)
11784 || (get_AT_file (old_die, DW_AT_decl_file) == file_index
11785 && (get_AT_unsigned (old_die, DW_AT_decl_line)
11786 == (unsigned) s.line))))
11787 {
11788 subr_die = old_die;
11789
11790 /* Clear out the declaration attribute and the formal parameters.
11791 Do not remove all children, because it is possible that this
11792 declaration die was forced using force_decl_die(). In such
11793 cases die that forced declaration die (e.g. TAG_imported_module)
11794 is one of the children that we do not want to remove. */
11795 remove_AT (subr_die, DW_AT_declaration);
11796 remove_child_TAG (subr_die, DW_TAG_formal_parameter);
11797 }
11798 else
11799 {
11800 subr_die = new_die (DW_TAG_subprogram, context_die, decl);
11801 add_AT_specification (subr_die, old_die);
11802 if (get_AT_file (old_die, DW_AT_decl_file) != file_index)
11803 add_AT_file (subr_die, DW_AT_decl_file, file_index);
11804 if (get_AT_unsigned (old_die, DW_AT_decl_line) != (unsigned) s.line)
11805 add_AT_unsigned (subr_die, DW_AT_decl_line, s.line);
11806 }
11807 }
11808 else
11809 {
11810 subr_die = new_die (DW_TAG_subprogram, context_die, decl);
11811
11812 if (TREE_PUBLIC (decl))
11813 add_AT_flag (subr_die, DW_AT_external, 1);
11814
11815 add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (subr_die, decl);
11816 if (debug_info_level > DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
11817 {
11818 add_prototyped_attribute (subr_die, TREE_TYPE (decl));
11819 add_type_attribute (subr_die, TREE_TYPE (TREE_TYPE (decl)),
11820 0, 0, context_die);
11821 }
11822
11823 add_pure_or_virtual_attribute (subr_die, decl);
11824 if (DECL_ARTIFICIAL (decl))
11825 add_AT_flag (subr_die, DW_AT_artificial, 1);
11826
11827 if (TREE_PROTECTED (decl))
11828 add_AT_unsigned (subr_die, DW_AT_accessibility, DW_ACCESS_protected);
11829 else if (TREE_PRIVATE (decl))
11830 add_AT_unsigned (subr_die, DW_AT_accessibility, DW_ACCESS_private);
11831 }
11832
11833 if (declaration)
11834 {
11835 if (!old_die || !get_AT (old_die, DW_AT_inline))
11836 {
11837 add_AT_flag (subr_die, DW_AT_declaration, 1);
11838
11839 /* The first time we see a member function, it is in the context of
11840 the class to which it belongs. We make sure of this by emitting
11841 the class first. The next time is the definition, which is
11842 handled above. The two may come from the same source text.
11843
11844 Note that force_decl_die() forces function declaration die. It is
11845 later reused to represent definition. */
11846 equate_decl_number_to_die (decl, subr_die);
11847 }
11848 }
11849 else if (DECL_ABSTRACT (decl))
11850 {
11851 if (DECL_DECLARED_INLINE_P (decl))
11852 {
11853 if (cgraph_function_possibly_inlined_p (decl))
11854 add_AT_unsigned (subr_die, DW_AT_inline, DW_INL_declared_inlined);
11855 else
11856 add_AT_unsigned (subr_die, DW_AT_inline, DW_INL_declared_not_inlined);
11857 }
11858 else
11859 {
11860 if (cgraph_function_possibly_inlined_p (decl))
11861 add_AT_unsigned (subr_die, DW_AT_inline, DW_INL_inlined);
11862 else
11863 add_AT_unsigned (subr_die, DW_AT_inline, DW_INL_not_inlined);
11864 }
11865
11866 equate_decl_number_to_die (decl, subr_die);
11867 }
11868 else if (!DECL_EXTERNAL (decl))
11869 {
11870 HOST_WIDE_INT cfa_fb_offset;
11871
11872 if (!old_die || !get_AT (old_die, DW_AT_inline))
11873 equate_decl_number_to_die (decl, subr_die);
11874
11875 if (!flag_reorder_blocks_and_partition)
11876 {
11877 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label_id, FUNC_BEGIN_LABEL,
11878 current_function_funcdef_no);
11879 add_AT_lbl_id (subr_die, DW_AT_low_pc, label_id);
11880 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label_id, FUNC_END_LABEL,
11881 current_function_funcdef_no);
11882 add_AT_lbl_id (subr_die, DW_AT_high_pc, label_id);
11883
11884 add_pubname (decl, subr_die);
11885 add_arange (decl, subr_die);
11886 }
11887 else
11888 { /* Do nothing for now; maybe need to duplicate die, one for
11889 hot section and ond for cold section, then use the hot/cold
11890 section begin/end labels to generate the aranges... */
11891 /*
11892 add_AT_lbl_id (subr_die, DW_AT_low_pc, hot_section_label);
11893 add_AT_lbl_id (subr_die, DW_AT_high_pc, hot_section_end_label);
11894 add_AT_lbl_id (subr_die, DW_AT_lo_user, unlikely_section_label);
11895 add_AT_lbl_id (subr_die, DW_AT_hi_user, cold_section_end_label);
11896
11897 add_pubname (decl, subr_die);
11898 add_arange (decl, subr_die);
11899 add_arange (decl, subr_die);
11900 */
11901 }
11902
11903 #ifdef MIPS_DEBUGGING_INFO
11904 /* Add a reference to the FDE for this routine. */
11905 add_AT_fde_ref (subr_die, DW_AT_MIPS_fde, current_funcdef_fde);
11906 #endif
11907
11908 cfa_fb_offset = CFA_FRAME_BASE_OFFSET (decl);
11909
11910 /* We define the "frame base" as the function's CFA. This is more
11911 convenient for several reasons: (1) It's stable across the prologue
11912 and epilogue, which makes it better than just a frame pointer,
11913 (2) With dwarf3, there exists a one-byte encoding that allows us
11914 to reference the .debug_frame data by proxy, but failing that,
11915 (3) We can at least reuse the code inspection and interpretation
11916 code that determines the CFA position at various points in the
11917 function. */
11918 /* ??? Use some command-line or configury switch to enable the use
11919 of dwarf3 DW_OP_call_frame_cfa. At present there are no dwarf
11920 consumers that understand it; fall back to "pure" dwarf2 and
11921 convert the CFA data into a location list. */
11922 {
11923 dw_loc_list_ref list = convert_cfa_to_fb_loc_list (cfa_fb_offset);
11924 if (list->dw_loc_next)
11925 add_AT_loc_list (subr_die, DW_AT_frame_base, list);
11926 else
11927 add_AT_loc (subr_die, DW_AT_frame_base, list->expr);
11928 }
11929
11930 /* Compute a displacement from the "steady-state frame pointer" to
11931 the CFA. The former is what all stack slots and argument slots
11932 will reference in the rtl; the later is what we've told the
11933 debugger about. We'll need to adjust all frame_base references
11934 by this displacement. */
11935 compute_frame_pointer_to_fb_displacement (cfa_fb_offset);
11936
11937 if (cfun->static_chain_decl)
11938 add_AT_location_description (subr_die, DW_AT_static_link,
11939 loc_descriptor_from_tree (cfun->static_chain_decl));
11940 }
11941
11942 /* Now output descriptions of the arguments for this function. This gets
11943 (unnecessarily?) complex because of the fact that the DECL_ARGUMENT list
11944 for a FUNCTION_DECL doesn't indicate cases where there was a trailing
11945 `...' at the end of the formal parameter list. In order to find out if
11946 there was a trailing ellipsis or not, we must instead look at the type
11947 associated with the FUNCTION_DECL. This will be a node of type
11948 FUNCTION_TYPE. If the chain of type nodes hanging off of this
11949 FUNCTION_TYPE node ends with a void_type_node then there should *not* be
11950 an ellipsis at the end. */
11951
11952 /* In the case where we are describing a mere function declaration, all we
11953 need to do here (and all we *can* do here) is to describe the *types* of
11954 its formal parameters. */
11955 if (debug_info_level <= DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
11956 ;
11957 else if (declaration)
11958 gen_formal_types_die (decl, subr_die);
11959 else
11960 {
11961 /* Generate DIEs to represent all known formal parameters. */
11962 tree arg_decls = DECL_ARGUMENTS (decl);
11963 tree parm;
11964
11965 /* When generating DIEs, generate the unspecified_parameters DIE
11966 instead if we come across the arg "__builtin_va_alist" */
11967 for (parm = arg_decls; parm; parm = TREE_CHAIN (parm))
11968 if (TREE_CODE (parm) == PARM_DECL)
11969 {
11970 if (DECL_NAME (parm)
11971 && !strcmp (IDENTIFIER_POINTER (DECL_NAME (parm)),
11972 "__builtin_va_alist"))
11973 gen_unspecified_parameters_die (parm, subr_die);
11974 else
11975 gen_decl_die (parm, subr_die);
11976 }
11977
11978 /* Decide whether we need an unspecified_parameters DIE at the end.
11979 There are 2 more cases to do this for: 1) the ansi ... declaration -
11980 this is detectable when the end of the arg list is not a
11981 void_type_node 2) an unprototyped function declaration (not a
11982 definition). This just means that we have no info about the
11983 parameters at all. */
11984 fn_arg_types = TYPE_ARG_TYPES (TREE_TYPE (decl));
11985 if (fn_arg_types != NULL)
11986 {
11987 /* This is the prototyped case, check for.... */
11988 if (TREE_VALUE (tree_last (fn_arg_types)) != void_type_node)
11989 gen_unspecified_parameters_die (decl, subr_die);
11990 }
11991 else if (DECL_INITIAL (decl) == NULL_TREE)
11992 gen_unspecified_parameters_die (decl, subr_die);
11993 }
11994
11995 /* Output Dwarf info for all of the stuff within the body of the function
11996 (if it has one - it may be just a declaration). */
11997 outer_scope = DECL_INITIAL (decl);
11998
11999 /* OUTER_SCOPE is a pointer to the outermost BLOCK node created to represent
12000 a function. This BLOCK actually represents the outermost binding contour
12001 for the function, i.e. the contour in which the function's formal
12002 parameters and labels get declared. Curiously, it appears that the front
12003 end doesn't actually put the PARM_DECL nodes for the current function onto
12004 the BLOCK_VARS list for this outer scope, but are strung off of the
12005 DECL_ARGUMENTS list for the function instead.
12006
12007 The BLOCK_VARS list for the `outer_scope' does provide us with a list of
12008 the LABEL_DECL nodes for the function however, and we output DWARF info
12009 for those in decls_for_scope. Just within the `outer_scope' there will be
12010 a BLOCK node representing the function's outermost pair of curly braces,
12011 and any blocks used for the base and member initializers of a C++
12012 constructor function. */
12013 if (! declaration && TREE_CODE (outer_scope) != ERROR_MARK)
12014 {
12015 /* Emit a DW_TAG_variable DIE for a named return value. */
12016 if (DECL_NAME (DECL_RESULT (decl)))
12017 gen_decl_die (DECL_RESULT (decl), subr_die);
12018
12019 current_function_has_inlines = 0;
12020 decls_for_scope (outer_scope, subr_die, 0);
12021
12022 #if 0 && defined (MIPS_DEBUGGING_INFO)
12023 if (current_function_has_inlines)
12024 {
12025 add_AT_flag (subr_die, DW_AT_MIPS_has_inlines, 1);
12026 if (! comp_unit_has_inlines)
12027 {
12028 add_AT_flag (comp_unit_die, DW_AT_MIPS_has_inlines, 1);
12029 comp_unit_has_inlines = 1;
12030 }
12031 }
12032 #endif
12033 }
12034 /* Add the calling convention attribute if requested. */
12035 add_calling_convention_attribute (subr_die, TREE_TYPE (decl));
12036
12037 }
12038
12039 /* Generate a DIE to represent a declared data object. */
12040
12041 static void
12042 gen_variable_die (tree decl, dw_die_ref context_die)
12043 {
12044 tree origin = decl_ultimate_origin (decl);
12045 dw_die_ref var_die = new_die (DW_TAG_variable, context_die, decl);
12046
12047 dw_die_ref old_die = lookup_decl_die (decl);
12048 int declaration = (DECL_EXTERNAL (decl)
12049 /* If DECL is COMDAT and has not actually been
12050 emitted, we cannot take its address; there
12051 might end up being no definition anywhere in
12052 the program. For example, consider the C++
12053 test case:
12054
12055 template <class T>
12056 struct S { static const int i = 7; };
12057
12058 template <class T>
12059 const int S<T>::i;
12060
12061 int f() { return S<int>::i; }
12062
12063 Here, S<int>::i is not DECL_EXTERNAL, but no
12064 definition is required, so the compiler will
12065 not emit a definition. */
12066 || (TREE_CODE (decl) == VAR_DECL
12067 && DECL_COMDAT (decl) && !TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (decl))
12068 || class_or_namespace_scope_p (context_die));
12069
12070 if (origin != NULL)
12071 add_abstract_origin_attribute (var_die, origin);
12072
12073 /* Loop unrolling can create multiple blocks that refer to the same
12074 static variable, so we must test for the DW_AT_declaration flag.
12075
12076 ??? Loop unrolling/reorder_blocks should perhaps be rewritten to
12077 copy decls and set the DECL_ABSTRACT flag on them instead of
12078 sharing them.
12079
12080 ??? Duplicated blocks have been rewritten to use .debug_ranges.
12081
12082 ??? The declare_in_namespace support causes us to get two DIEs for one
12083 variable, both of which are declarations. We want to avoid considering
12084 one to be a specification, so we must test that this DIE is not a
12085 declaration. */
12086 else if (old_die && TREE_STATIC (decl) && ! declaration
12087 && get_AT_flag (old_die, DW_AT_declaration) == 1)
12088 {
12089 /* This is a definition of a C++ class level static. */
12090 add_AT_specification (var_die, old_die);
12091 if (DECL_NAME (decl))
12092 {
12093 expanded_location s = expand_location (DECL_SOURCE_LOCATION (decl));
12094 struct dwarf_file_data * file_index = lookup_filename (s.file);
12095
12096 if (get_AT_file (old_die, DW_AT_decl_file) != file_index)
12097 add_AT_file (var_die, DW_AT_decl_file, file_index);
12098
12099 if (get_AT_unsigned (old_die, DW_AT_decl_line) != (unsigned) s.line)
12100 add_AT_unsigned (var_die, DW_AT_decl_line, s.line);
12101 }
12102 }
12103 else
12104 {
12105 add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (var_die, decl);
12106 add_type_attribute (var_die, TREE_TYPE (decl), TREE_READONLY (decl),
12107 TREE_THIS_VOLATILE (decl), context_die);
12108
12109 if (TREE_PUBLIC (decl))
12110 add_AT_flag (var_die, DW_AT_external, 1);
12111
12112 if (DECL_ARTIFICIAL (decl))
12113 add_AT_flag (var_die, DW_AT_artificial, 1);
12114
12115 if (TREE_PROTECTED (decl))
12116 add_AT_unsigned (var_die, DW_AT_accessibility, DW_ACCESS_protected);
12117 else if (TREE_PRIVATE (decl))
12118 add_AT_unsigned (var_die, DW_AT_accessibility, DW_ACCESS_private);
12119 }
12120
12121 if (declaration)
12122 add_AT_flag (var_die, DW_AT_declaration, 1);
12123
12124 if (DECL_ABSTRACT (decl) || declaration)
12125 equate_decl_number_to_die (decl, var_die);
12126
12127 if (! declaration && ! DECL_ABSTRACT (decl))
12128 {
12129 add_location_or_const_value_attribute (var_die, decl, DW_AT_location);
12130 add_pubname (decl, var_die);
12131 }
12132 else
12133 tree_add_const_value_attribute (var_die, decl);
12134 }
12135
12136 /* Generate a DIE to represent a label identifier. */
12137
12138 static void
12139 gen_label_die (tree decl, dw_die_ref context_die)
12140 {
12141 tree origin = decl_ultimate_origin (decl);
12142 dw_die_ref lbl_die = new_die (DW_TAG_label, context_die, decl);
12143 rtx insn;
12144 char label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
12145
12146 if (origin != NULL)
12147 add_abstract_origin_attribute (lbl_die, origin);
12148 else
12149 add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (lbl_die, decl);
12150
12151 if (DECL_ABSTRACT (decl))
12152 equate_decl_number_to_die (decl, lbl_die);
12153 else
12154 {
12155 insn = DECL_RTL_IF_SET (decl);
12156
12157 /* Deleted labels are programmer specified labels which have been
12158 eliminated because of various optimizations. We still emit them
12159 here so that it is possible to put breakpoints on them. */
12160 if (insn
12161 && (LABEL_P (insn)
12162 || ((NOTE_P (insn)
12163 && NOTE_LINE_NUMBER (insn) == NOTE_INSN_DELETED_LABEL))))
12164 {
12165 /* When optimization is enabled (via -O) some parts of the compiler
12166 (e.g. jump.c and cse.c) may try to delete CODE_LABEL insns which
12167 represent source-level labels which were explicitly declared by
12168 the user. This really shouldn't be happening though, so catch
12169 it if it ever does happen. */
12170 gcc_assert (!INSN_DELETED_P (insn));
12171
12172 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label, "L", CODE_LABEL_NUMBER (insn));
12173 add_AT_lbl_id (lbl_die, DW_AT_low_pc, label);
12174 }
12175 }
12176 }
12177
12178 /* A helper function for gen_inlined_subroutine_die. Add source coordinate
12179 attributes to the DIE for a block STMT, to describe where the inlined
12180 function was called from. This is similar to add_src_coords_attributes. */
12181
12182 static inline void
12183 add_call_src_coords_attributes (tree stmt, dw_die_ref die)
12184 {
12185 expanded_location s = expand_location (BLOCK_SOURCE_LOCATION (stmt));
12186
12187 add_AT_file (die, DW_AT_call_file, lookup_filename (s.file));
12188 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_call_line, s.line);
12189 }
12190
12191 /* A helper function for gen_lexical_block_die and gen_inlined_subroutine_die.
12192 Add low_pc and high_pc attributes to the DIE for a block STMT. */
12193
12194 static inline void
12195 add_high_low_attributes (tree stmt, dw_die_ref die)
12196 {
12197 char label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
12198
12199 if (BLOCK_FRAGMENT_CHAIN (stmt))
12200 {
12201 tree chain;
12202
12203 add_AT_range_list (die, DW_AT_ranges, add_ranges (stmt));
12204
12205 chain = BLOCK_FRAGMENT_CHAIN (stmt);
12206 do
12207 {
12208 add_ranges (chain);
12209 chain = BLOCK_FRAGMENT_CHAIN (chain);
12210 }
12211 while (chain);
12212 add_ranges (NULL);
12213 }
12214 else
12215 {
12216 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label, BLOCK_BEGIN_LABEL,
12217 BLOCK_NUMBER (stmt));
12218 add_AT_lbl_id (die, DW_AT_low_pc, label);
12219 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label, BLOCK_END_LABEL,
12220 BLOCK_NUMBER (stmt));
12221 add_AT_lbl_id (die, DW_AT_high_pc, label);
12222 }
12223 }
12224
12225 /* Generate a DIE for a lexical block. */
12226
12227 static void
12228 gen_lexical_block_die (tree stmt, dw_die_ref context_die, int depth)
12229 {
12230 dw_die_ref stmt_die = new_die (DW_TAG_lexical_block, context_die, stmt);
12231
12232 if (! BLOCK_ABSTRACT (stmt))
12233 add_high_low_attributes (stmt, stmt_die);
12234
12235 decls_for_scope (stmt, stmt_die, depth);
12236 }
12237
12238 /* Generate a DIE for an inlined subprogram. */
12239
12240 static void
12241 gen_inlined_subroutine_die (tree stmt, dw_die_ref context_die, int depth)
12242 {
12243 tree decl = block_ultimate_origin (stmt);
12244
12245 /* Emit info for the abstract instance first, if we haven't yet. We
12246 must emit this even if the block is abstract, otherwise when we
12247 emit the block below (or elsewhere), we may end up trying to emit
12248 a die whose origin die hasn't been emitted, and crashing. */
12249 dwarf2out_abstract_function (decl);
12250
12251 if (! BLOCK_ABSTRACT (stmt))
12252 {
12253 dw_die_ref subr_die
12254 = new_die (DW_TAG_inlined_subroutine, context_die, stmt);
12255
12256 add_abstract_origin_attribute (subr_die, decl);
12257 add_high_low_attributes (stmt, subr_die);
12258 add_call_src_coords_attributes (stmt, subr_die);
12259
12260 decls_for_scope (stmt, subr_die, depth);
12261 current_function_has_inlines = 1;
12262 }
12263 else
12264 /* We may get here if we're the outer block of function A that was
12265 inlined into function B that was inlined into function C. When
12266 generating debugging info for C, dwarf2out_abstract_function(B)
12267 would mark all inlined blocks as abstract, including this one.
12268 So, we wouldn't (and shouldn't) expect labels to be generated
12269 for this one. Instead, just emit debugging info for
12270 declarations within the block. This is particularly important
12271 in the case of initializers of arguments passed from B to us:
12272 if they're statement expressions containing declarations, we
12273 wouldn't generate dies for their abstract variables, and then,
12274 when generating dies for the real variables, we'd die (pun
12275 intended :-) */
12276 gen_lexical_block_die (stmt, context_die, depth);
12277 }
12278
12279 /* Generate a DIE for a field in a record, or structure. */
12280
12281 static void
12282 gen_field_die (tree decl, dw_die_ref context_die)
12283 {
12284 dw_die_ref decl_die;
12285
12286 if (TREE_TYPE (decl) == error_mark_node)
12287 return;
12288
12289 decl_die = new_die (DW_TAG_member, context_die, decl);
12290 add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (decl_die, decl);
12291 add_type_attribute (decl_die, member_declared_type (decl),
12292 TREE_READONLY (decl), TREE_THIS_VOLATILE (decl),
12293 context_die);
12294
12295 if (DECL_BIT_FIELD_TYPE (decl))
12296 {
12297 add_byte_size_attribute (decl_die, decl);
12298 add_bit_size_attribute (decl_die, decl);
12299 add_bit_offset_attribute (decl_die, decl);
12300 }
12301
12302 if (TREE_CODE (DECL_FIELD_CONTEXT (decl)) != UNION_TYPE)
12303 add_data_member_location_attribute (decl_die, decl);
12304
12305 if (DECL_ARTIFICIAL (decl))
12306 add_AT_flag (decl_die, DW_AT_artificial, 1);
12307
12308 if (TREE_PROTECTED (decl))
12309 add_AT_unsigned (decl_die, DW_AT_accessibility, DW_ACCESS_protected);
12310 else if (TREE_PRIVATE (decl))
12311 add_AT_unsigned (decl_die, DW_AT_accessibility, DW_ACCESS_private);
12312
12313 /* Equate decl number to die, so that we can look up this decl later on. */
12314 equate_decl_number_to_die (decl, decl_die);
12315 }
12316
12317 #if 0
12318 /* Don't generate either pointer_type DIEs or reference_type DIEs here.
12319 Use modified_type_die instead.
12320 We keep this code here just in case these types of DIEs may be needed to
12321 represent certain things in other languages (e.g. Pascal) someday. */
12322
12323 static void
12324 gen_pointer_type_die (tree type, dw_die_ref context_die)
12325 {
12326 dw_die_ref ptr_die
12327 = new_die (DW_TAG_pointer_type, scope_die_for (type, context_die), type);
12328
12329 equate_type_number_to_die (type, ptr_die);
12330 add_type_attribute (ptr_die, TREE_TYPE (type), 0, 0, context_die);
12331 add_AT_unsigned (mod_type_die, DW_AT_byte_size, PTR_SIZE);
12332 }
12333
12334 /* Don't generate either pointer_type DIEs or reference_type DIEs here.
12335 Use modified_type_die instead.
12336 We keep this code here just in case these types of DIEs may be needed to
12337 represent certain things in other languages (e.g. Pascal) someday. */
12338
12339 static void
12340 gen_reference_type_die (tree type, dw_die_ref context_die)
12341 {
12342 dw_die_ref ref_die
12343 = new_die (DW_TAG_reference_type, scope_die_for (type, context_die), type);
12344
12345 equate_type_number_to_die (type, ref_die);
12346 add_type_attribute (ref_die, TREE_TYPE (type), 0, 0, context_die);
12347 add_AT_unsigned (mod_type_die, DW_AT_byte_size, PTR_SIZE);
12348 }
12349 #endif
12350
12351 /* Generate a DIE for a pointer to a member type. */
12352
12353 static void
12354 gen_ptr_to_mbr_type_die (tree type, dw_die_ref context_die)
12355 {
12356 dw_die_ref ptr_die
12357 = new_die (DW_TAG_ptr_to_member_type,
12358 scope_die_for (type, context_die), type);
12359
12360 equate_type_number_to_die (type, ptr_die);
12361 add_AT_die_ref (ptr_die, DW_AT_containing_type,
12362 lookup_type_die (TYPE_OFFSET_BASETYPE (type)));
12363 add_type_attribute (ptr_die, TREE_TYPE (type), 0, 0, context_die);
12364 }
12365
12366 /* Generate the DIE for the compilation unit. */
12367
12368 static dw_die_ref
12369 gen_compile_unit_die (const char *filename)
12370 {
12371 dw_die_ref die;
12372 char producer[250];
12373 const char *language_string = lang_hooks.name;
12374 int language;
12375
12376 die = new_die (DW_TAG_compile_unit, NULL, NULL);
12377
12378 if (filename)
12379 {
12380 add_name_attribute (die, filename);
12381 /* Don't add cwd for <built-in>. */
12382 if (!IS_ABSOLUTE_PATH (filename) && filename[0] != '<')
12383 add_comp_dir_attribute (die);
12384 }
12385
12386 sprintf (producer, "%s %s", language_string, version_string);
12387
12388 #ifdef MIPS_DEBUGGING_INFO
12389 /* The MIPS/SGI compilers place the 'cc' command line options in the producer
12390 string. The SGI debugger looks for -g, -g1, -g2, or -g3; if they do
12391 not appear in the producer string, the debugger reaches the conclusion
12392 that the object file is stripped and has no debugging information.
12393 To get the MIPS/SGI debugger to believe that there is debugging
12394 information in the object file, we add a -g to the producer string. */
12395 if (debug_info_level > DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
12396 strcat (producer, " -g");
12397 #endif
12398
12399 add_AT_string (die, DW_AT_producer, producer);
12400
12401 if (strcmp (language_string, "GNU C++") == 0)
12402 language = DW_LANG_C_plus_plus;
12403 else if (strcmp (language_string, "GNU Ada") == 0)
12404 language = DW_LANG_Ada95;
12405 else if (strcmp (language_string, "GNU F77") == 0)
12406 language = DW_LANG_Fortran77;
12407 else if (strcmp (language_string, "GNU F95") == 0)
12408 language = DW_LANG_Fortran95;
12409 else if (strcmp (language_string, "GNU Pascal") == 0)
12410 language = DW_LANG_Pascal83;
12411 else if (strcmp (language_string, "GNU Java") == 0)
12412 language = DW_LANG_Java;
12413 else if (strcmp (language_string, "GNU Objective-C") == 0)
12414 language = DW_LANG_ObjC;
12415 else if (strcmp (language_string, "GNU Objective-C++") == 0)
12416 language = DW_LANG_ObjC_plus_plus;
12417 else
12418 language = DW_LANG_C89;
12419
12420 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_language, language);
12421 return die;
12422 }
12423
12424 /* Generate the DIE for a base class. */
12425
12426 static void
12427 gen_inheritance_die (tree binfo, tree access, dw_die_ref context_die)
12428 {
12429 dw_die_ref die = new_die (DW_TAG_inheritance, context_die, binfo);
12430
12431 add_type_attribute (die, BINFO_TYPE (binfo), 0, 0, context_die);
12432 add_data_member_location_attribute (die, binfo);
12433
12434 if (BINFO_VIRTUAL_P (binfo))
12435 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_virtuality, DW_VIRTUALITY_virtual);
12436
12437 if (access == access_public_node)
12438 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_accessibility, DW_ACCESS_public);
12439 else if (access == access_protected_node)
12440 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_accessibility, DW_ACCESS_protected);
12441 }
12442
12443 /* Generate a DIE for a class member. */
12444
12445 static void
12446 gen_member_die (tree type, dw_die_ref context_die)
12447 {
12448 tree member;
12449 tree binfo = TYPE_BINFO (type);
12450 dw_die_ref child;
12451
12452 /* If this is not an incomplete type, output descriptions of each of its
12453 members. Note that as we output the DIEs necessary to represent the
12454 members of this record or union type, we will also be trying to output
12455 DIEs to represent the *types* of those members. However the `type'
12456 function (above) will specifically avoid generating type DIEs for member
12457 types *within* the list of member DIEs for this (containing) type except
12458 for those types (of members) which are explicitly marked as also being
12459 members of this (containing) type themselves. The g++ front- end can
12460 force any given type to be treated as a member of some other (containing)
12461 type by setting the TYPE_CONTEXT of the given (member) type to point to
12462 the TREE node representing the appropriate (containing) type. */
12463
12464 /* First output info about the base classes. */
12465 if (binfo)
12466 {
12467 VEC(tree,gc) *accesses = BINFO_BASE_ACCESSES (binfo);
12468 int i;
12469 tree base;
12470
12471 for (i = 0; BINFO_BASE_ITERATE (binfo, i, base); i++)
12472 gen_inheritance_die (base,
12473 (accesses ? VEC_index (tree, accesses, i)
12474 : access_public_node), context_die);
12475 }
12476
12477 /* Now output info about the data members and type members. */
12478 for (member = TYPE_FIELDS (type); member; member = TREE_CHAIN (member))
12479 {
12480 /* If we thought we were generating minimal debug info for TYPE
12481 and then changed our minds, some of the member declarations
12482 may have already been defined. Don't define them again, but
12483 do put them in the right order. */
12484
12485 child = lookup_decl_die (member);
12486 if (child)
12487 splice_child_die (context_die, child);
12488 else
12489 gen_decl_die (member, context_die);
12490 }
12491
12492 /* Now output info about the function members (if any). */
12493 for (member = TYPE_METHODS (type); member; member = TREE_CHAIN (member))
12494 {
12495 /* Don't include clones in the member list. */
12496 if (DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN (member))
12497 continue;
12498
12499 child = lookup_decl_die (member);
12500 if (child)
12501 splice_child_die (context_die, child);
12502 else
12503 gen_decl_die (member, context_die);
12504 }
12505 }
12506
12507 /* Generate a DIE for a structure or union type. If TYPE_DECL_SUPPRESS_DEBUG
12508 is set, we pretend that the type was never defined, so we only get the
12509 member DIEs needed by later specification DIEs. */
12510
12511 static void
12512 gen_struct_or_union_type_die (tree type, dw_die_ref context_die)
12513 {
12514 dw_die_ref type_die = lookup_type_die (type);
12515 dw_die_ref scope_die = 0;
12516 int nested = 0;
12517 int complete = (TYPE_SIZE (type)
12518 && (! TYPE_STUB_DECL (type)
12519 || ! TYPE_DECL_SUPPRESS_DEBUG (TYPE_STUB_DECL (type))));
12520 int ns_decl = (context_die && context_die->die_tag == DW_TAG_namespace);
12521
12522 if (type_die && ! complete)
12523 return;
12524
12525 if (TYPE_CONTEXT (type) != NULL_TREE
12526 && (AGGREGATE_TYPE_P (TYPE_CONTEXT (type))
12527 || TREE_CODE (TYPE_CONTEXT (type)) == NAMESPACE_DECL))
12528 nested = 1;
12529
12530 scope_die = scope_die_for (type, context_die);
12531
12532 if (! type_die || (nested && scope_die == comp_unit_die))
12533 /* First occurrence of type or toplevel definition of nested class. */
12534 {
12535 dw_die_ref old_die = type_die;
12536
12537 type_die = new_die (TREE_CODE (type) == RECORD_TYPE
12538 ? DW_TAG_structure_type : DW_TAG_union_type,
12539 scope_die, type);
12540 equate_type_number_to_die (type, type_die);
12541 if (old_die)
12542 add_AT_specification (type_die, old_die);
12543 else
12544 add_name_attribute (type_die, type_tag (type));
12545 }
12546 else
12547 remove_AT (type_die, DW_AT_declaration);
12548
12549 /* If this type has been completed, then give it a byte_size attribute and
12550 then give a list of members. */
12551 if (complete && !ns_decl)
12552 {
12553 /* Prevent infinite recursion in cases where the type of some member of
12554 this type is expressed in terms of this type itself. */
12555 TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type) = 1;
12556 add_byte_size_attribute (type_die, type);
12557 if (TYPE_STUB_DECL (type) != NULL_TREE)
12558 add_src_coords_attributes (type_die, TYPE_STUB_DECL (type));
12559
12560 /* If the first reference to this type was as the return type of an
12561 inline function, then it may not have a parent. Fix this now. */
12562 if (type_die->die_parent == NULL)
12563 add_child_die (scope_die, type_die);
12564
12565 push_decl_scope (type);
12566 gen_member_die (type, type_die);
12567 pop_decl_scope ();
12568
12569 /* GNU extension: Record what type our vtable lives in. */
12570 if (TYPE_VFIELD (type))
12571 {
12572 tree vtype = DECL_FCONTEXT (TYPE_VFIELD (type));
12573
12574 gen_type_die (vtype, context_die);
12575 add_AT_die_ref (type_die, DW_AT_containing_type,
12576 lookup_type_die (vtype));
12577 }
12578 }
12579 else
12580 {
12581 add_AT_flag (type_die, DW_AT_declaration, 1);
12582
12583 /* We don't need to do this for function-local types. */
12584 if (TYPE_STUB_DECL (type)
12585 && ! decl_function_context (TYPE_STUB_DECL (type)))
12586 VEC_safe_push (tree, gc, incomplete_types, type);
12587 }
12588
12589 if (get_AT (type_die, DW_AT_name))
12590 add_pubtype (type, type_die);
12591 }
12592
12593 /* Generate a DIE for a subroutine _type_. */
12594
12595 static void
12596 gen_subroutine_type_die (tree type, dw_die_ref context_die)
12597 {
12598 tree return_type = TREE_TYPE (type);
12599 dw_die_ref subr_die
12600 = new_die (DW_TAG_subroutine_type,
12601 scope_die_for (type, context_die), type);
12602
12603 equate_type_number_to_die (type, subr_die);
12604 add_prototyped_attribute (subr_die, type);
12605 add_type_attribute (subr_die, return_type, 0, 0, context_die);
12606 gen_formal_types_die (type, subr_die);
12607
12608 if (get_AT (subr_die, DW_AT_name))
12609 add_pubtype (type, subr_die);
12610 }
12611
12612 /* Generate a DIE for a type definition. */
12613
12614 static void
12615 gen_typedef_die (tree decl, dw_die_ref context_die)
12616 {
12617 dw_die_ref type_die;
12618 tree origin;
12619
12620 if (TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (decl))
12621 return;
12622
12623 TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (decl) = 1;
12624 type_die = new_die (DW_TAG_typedef, context_die, decl);
12625 origin = decl_ultimate_origin (decl);
12626 if (origin != NULL)
12627 add_abstract_origin_attribute (type_die, origin);
12628 else
12629 {
12630 tree type;
12631
12632 add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (type_die, decl);
12633 if (DECL_ORIGINAL_TYPE (decl))
12634 {
12635 type = DECL_ORIGINAL_TYPE (decl);
12636
12637 gcc_assert (type != TREE_TYPE (decl));
12638 equate_type_number_to_die (TREE_TYPE (decl), type_die);
12639 }
12640 else
12641 type = TREE_TYPE (decl);
12642
12643 add_type_attribute (type_die, type, TREE_READONLY (decl),
12644 TREE_THIS_VOLATILE (decl), context_die);
12645 }
12646
12647 if (DECL_ABSTRACT (decl))
12648 equate_decl_number_to_die (decl, type_die);
12649
12650 if (get_AT (type_die, DW_AT_name))
12651 add_pubtype (decl, type_die);
12652 }
12653
12654 /* Generate a type description DIE. */
12655
12656 static void
12657 gen_type_die (tree type, dw_die_ref context_die)
12658 {
12659 int need_pop;
12660
12661 if (type == NULL_TREE || type == error_mark_node)
12662 return;
12663
12664 if (TYPE_NAME (type) && TREE_CODE (TYPE_NAME (type)) == TYPE_DECL
12665 && DECL_ORIGINAL_TYPE (TYPE_NAME (type)))
12666 {
12667 if (TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type))
12668 return;
12669
12670 /* Prevent broken recursion; we can't hand off to the same type. */
12671 gcc_assert (DECL_ORIGINAL_TYPE (TYPE_NAME (type)) != type);
12672
12673 TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type) = 1;
12674 gen_decl_die (TYPE_NAME (type), context_die);
12675 return;
12676 }
12677
12678 /* We are going to output a DIE to represent the unqualified version
12679 of this type (i.e. without any const or volatile qualifiers) so
12680 get the main variant (i.e. the unqualified version) of this type
12681 now. (Vectors are special because the debugging info is in the
12682 cloned type itself). */
12683 if (TREE_CODE (type) != VECTOR_TYPE)
12684 type = type_main_variant (type);
12685
12686 if (TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type))
12687 return;
12688
12689 switch (TREE_CODE (type))
12690 {
12691 case ERROR_MARK:
12692 break;
12693
12694 case POINTER_TYPE:
12695 case REFERENCE_TYPE:
12696 /* We must set TREE_ASM_WRITTEN in case this is a recursive type. This
12697 ensures that the gen_type_die recursion will terminate even if the
12698 type is recursive. Recursive types are possible in Ada. */
12699 /* ??? We could perhaps do this for all types before the switch
12700 statement. */
12701 TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type) = 1;
12702
12703 /* For these types, all that is required is that we output a DIE (or a
12704 set of DIEs) to represent the "basis" type. */
12705 gen_type_die (TREE_TYPE (type), context_die);
12706 break;
12707
12708 case OFFSET_TYPE:
12709 /* This code is used for C++ pointer-to-data-member types.
12710 Output a description of the relevant class type. */
12711 gen_type_die (TYPE_OFFSET_BASETYPE (type), context_die);
12712
12713 /* Output a description of the type of the object pointed to. */
12714 gen_type_die (TREE_TYPE (type), context_die);
12715
12716 /* Now output a DIE to represent this pointer-to-data-member type
12717 itself. */
12718 gen_ptr_to_mbr_type_die (type, context_die);
12719 break;
12720
12721 case FUNCTION_TYPE:
12722 /* Force out return type (in case it wasn't forced out already). */
12723 gen_type_die (TREE_TYPE (type), context_die);
12724 gen_subroutine_type_die (type, context_die);
12725 break;
12726
12727 case METHOD_TYPE:
12728 /* Force out return type (in case it wasn't forced out already). */
12729 gen_type_die (TREE_TYPE (type), context_die);
12730 gen_subroutine_type_die (type, context_die);
12731 break;
12732
12733 case ARRAY_TYPE:
12734 gen_array_type_die (type, context_die);
12735 break;
12736
12737 case VECTOR_TYPE:
12738 gen_array_type_die (type, context_die);
12739 break;
12740
12741 case ENUMERAL_TYPE:
12742 case RECORD_TYPE:
12743 case UNION_TYPE:
12744 case QUAL_UNION_TYPE:
12745 /* If this is a nested type whose containing class hasn't been written
12746 out yet, writing it out will cover this one, too. This does not apply
12747 to instantiations of member class templates; they need to be added to
12748 the containing class as they are generated. FIXME: This hurts the
12749 idea of combining type decls from multiple TUs, since we can't predict
12750 what set of template instantiations we'll get. */
12751 if (TYPE_CONTEXT (type)
12752 && AGGREGATE_TYPE_P (TYPE_CONTEXT (type))
12753 && ! TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (TYPE_CONTEXT (type)))
12754 {
12755 gen_type_die (TYPE_CONTEXT (type), context_die);
12756
12757 if (TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type))
12758 return;
12759
12760 /* If that failed, attach ourselves to the stub. */
12761 push_decl_scope (TYPE_CONTEXT (type));
12762 context_die = lookup_type_die (TYPE_CONTEXT (type));
12763 need_pop = 1;
12764 }
12765 else
12766 {
12767 declare_in_namespace (type, context_die);
12768 need_pop = 0;
12769 }
12770
12771 if (TREE_CODE (type) == ENUMERAL_TYPE)
12772 {
12773 /* This might have been written out by the call to
12774 declare_in_namespace. */
12775 if (!TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type))
12776 gen_enumeration_type_die (type, context_die);
12777 }
12778 else
12779 gen_struct_or_union_type_die (type, context_die);
12780
12781 if (need_pop)
12782 pop_decl_scope ();
12783
12784 /* Don't set TREE_ASM_WRITTEN on an incomplete struct; we want to fix
12785 it up if it is ever completed. gen_*_type_die will set it for us
12786 when appropriate. */
12787 return;
12788
12789 case VOID_TYPE:
12790 case INTEGER_TYPE:
12791 case REAL_TYPE:
12792 case COMPLEX_TYPE:
12793 case BOOLEAN_TYPE:
12794 /* No DIEs needed for fundamental types. */
12795 break;
12796
12797 case LANG_TYPE:
12798 /* No Dwarf representation currently defined. */
12799 break;
12800
12801 default:
12802 gcc_unreachable ();
12803 }
12804
12805 TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type) = 1;
12806 }
12807
12808 /* Generate a DIE for a tagged type instantiation. */
12809
12810 static void
12811 gen_tagged_type_instantiation_die (tree type, dw_die_ref context_die)
12812 {
12813 if (type == NULL_TREE || type == error_mark_node)
12814 return;
12815
12816 /* We are going to output a DIE to represent the unqualified version of
12817 this type (i.e. without any const or volatile qualifiers) so make sure
12818 that we have the main variant (i.e. the unqualified version) of this
12819 type now. */
12820 gcc_assert (type == type_main_variant (type));
12821
12822 /* Do not check TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type) as it may not be set if this is
12823 an instance of an unresolved type. */
12824
12825 switch (TREE_CODE (type))
12826 {
12827 case ERROR_MARK:
12828 break;
12829
12830 case ENUMERAL_TYPE:
12831 gen_inlined_enumeration_type_die (type, context_die);
12832 break;
12833
12834 case RECORD_TYPE:
12835 gen_inlined_structure_type_die (type, context_die);
12836 break;
12837
12838 case UNION_TYPE:
12839 case QUAL_UNION_TYPE:
12840 gen_inlined_union_type_die (type, context_die);
12841 break;
12842
12843 default:
12844 gcc_unreachable ();
12845 }
12846 }
12847
12848 /* Generate a DW_TAG_lexical_block DIE followed by DIEs to represent all of the
12849 things which are local to the given block. */
12850
12851 static void
12852 gen_block_die (tree stmt, dw_die_ref context_die, int depth)
12853 {
12854 int must_output_die = 0;
12855 tree origin;
12856 tree decl;
12857 enum tree_code origin_code;
12858
12859 /* Ignore blocks that are NULL. */
12860 if (stmt == NULL_TREE)
12861 return;
12862
12863 /* If the block is one fragment of a non-contiguous block, do not
12864 process the variables, since they will have been done by the
12865 origin block. Do process subblocks. */
12866 if (BLOCK_FRAGMENT_ORIGIN (stmt))
12867 {
12868 tree sub;
12869
12870 for (sub = BLOCK_SUBBLOCKS (stmt); sub; sub = BLOCK_CHAIN (sub))
12871 gen_block_die (sub, context_die, depth + 1);
12872
12873 return;
12874 }
12875
12876 /* Determine the "ultimate origin" of this block. This block may be an
12877 inlined instance of an inlined instance of inline function, so we have
12878 to trace all of the way back through the origin chain to find out what
12879 sort of node actually served as the original seed for the creation of
12880 the current block. */
12881 origin = block_ultimate_origin (stmt);
12882 origin_code = (origin != NULL) ? TREE_CODE (origin) : ERROR_MARK;
12883
12884 /* Determine if we need to output any Dwarf DIEs at all to represent this
12885 block. */
12886 if (origin_code == FUNCTION_DECL)
12887 /* The outer scopes for inlinings *must* always be represented. We
12888 generate DW_TAG_inlined_subroutine DIEs for them. (See below.) */
12889 must_output_die = 1;
12890 else
12891 {
12892 /* In the case where the current block represents an inlining of the
12893 "body block" of an inline function, we must *NOT* output any DIE for
12894 this block because we have already output a DIE to represent the whole
12895 inlined function scope and the "body block" of any function doesn't
12896 really represent a different scope according to ANSI C rules. So we
12897 check here to make sure that this block does not represent a "body
12898 block inlining" before trying to set the MUST_OUTPUT_DIE flag. */
12899 if (! is_body_block (origin ? origin : stmt))
12900 {
12901 /* Determine if this block directly contains any "significant"
12902 local declarations which we will need to output DIEs for. */
12903 if (debug_info_level > DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
12904 /* We are not in terse mode so *any* local declaration counts
12905 as being a "significant" one. */
12906 must_output_die = (BLOCK_VARS (stmt) != NULL
12907 && (TREE_USED (stmt)
12908 || TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (stmt)
12909 || BLOCK_ABSTRACT (stmt)));
12910 else
12911 /* We are in terse mode, so only local (nested) function
12912 definitions count as "significant" local declarations. */
12913 for (decl = BLOCK_VARS (stmt);
12914 decl != NULL; decl = TREE_CHAIN (decl))
12915 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == FUNCTION_DECL
12916 && DECL_INITIAL (decl))
12917 {
12918 must_output_die = 1;
12919 break;
12920 }
12921 }
12922 }
12923
12924 /* It would be a waste of space to generate a Dwarf DW_TAG_lexical_block
12925 DIE for any block which contains no significant local declarations at
12926 all. Rather, in such cases we just call `decls_for_scope' so that any
12927 needed Dwarf info for any sub-blocks will get properly generated. Note
12928 that in terse mode, our definition of what constitutes a "significant"
12929 local declaration gets restricted to include only inlined function
12930 instances and local (nested) function definitions. */
12931 if (must_output_die)
12932 {
12933 if (origin_code == FUNCTION_DECL)
12934 gen_inlined_subroutine_die (stmt, context_die, depth);
12935 else
12936 gen_lexical_block_die (stmt, context_die, depth);
12937 }
12938 else
12939 decls_for_scope (stmt, context_die, depth);
12940 }
12941
12942 /* Generate all of the decls declared within a given scope and (recursively)
12943 all of its sub-blocks. */
12944
12945 static void
12946 decls_for_scope (tree stmt, dw_die_ref context_die, int depth)
12947 {
12948 tree decl;
12949 tree subblocks;
12950
12951 /* Ignore NULL blocks. */
12952 if (stmt == NULL_TREE)
12953 return;
12954
12955 if (TREE_USED (stmt))
12956 {
12957 /* Output the DIEs to represent all of the data objects and typedefs
12958 declared directly within this block but not within any nested
12959 sub-blocks. Also, nested function and tag DIEs have been
12960 generated with a parent of NULL; fix that up now. */
12961 for (decl = BLOCK_VARS (stmt); decl != NULL; decl = TREE_CHAIN (decl))
12962 {
12963 dw_die_ref die;
12964
12965 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == FUNCTION_DECL)
12966 die = lookup_decl_die (decl);
12967 else if (TREE_CODE (decl) == TYPE_DECL && TYPE_DECL_IS_STUB (decl))
12968 die = lookup_type_die (TREE_TYPE (decl));
12969 else
12970 die = NULL;
12971
12972 if (die != NULL && die->die_parent == NULL)
12973 add_child_die (context_die, die);
12974 /* Do not produce debug information for static variables since
12975 these might be optimized out. We are called for these later
12976 in varpool_analyze_pending_decls. */
12977 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == VAR_DECL && TREE_STATIC (decl))
12978 ;
12979 else
12980 gen_decl_die (decl, context_die);
12981 }
12982 }
12983
12984 /* If we're at -g1, we're not interested in subblocks. */
12985 if (debug_info_level <= DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
12986 return;
12987
12988 /* Output the DIEs to represent all sub-blocks (and the items declared
12989 therein) of this block. */
12990 for (subblocks = BLOCK_SUBBLOCKS (stmt);
12991 subblocks != NULL;
12992 subblocks = BLOCK_CHAIN (subblocks))
12993 gen_block_die (subblocks, context_die, depth + 1);
12994 }
12995
12996 /* Is this a typedef we can avoid emitting? */
12997
12998 static inline int
12999 is_redundant_typedef (tree decl)
13000 {
13001 if (TYPE_DECL_IS_STUB (decl))
13002 return 1;
13003
13004 if (DECL_ARTIFICIAL (decl)
13005 && DECL_CONTEXT (decl)
13006 && is_tagged_type (DECL_CONTEXT (decl))
13007 && TREE_CODE (TYPE_NAME (DECL_CONTEXT (decl))) == TYPE_DECL
13008 && DECL_NAME (decl) == DECL_NAME (TYPE_NAME (DECL_CONTEXT (decl))))
13009 /* Also ignore the artificial member typedef for the class name. */
13010 return 1;
13011
13012 return 0;
13013 }
13014
13015 /* Returns the DIE for decl. A DIE will always be returned. */
13016
13017 static dw_die_ref
13018 force_decl_die (tree decl)
13019 {
13020 dw_die_ref decl_die;
13021 unsigned saved_external_flag;
13022 tree save_fn = NULL_TREE;
13023 decl_die = lookup_decl_die (decl);
13024 if (!decl_die)
13025 {
13026 dw_die_ref context_die;
13027 tree decl_context = DECL_CONTEXT (decl);
13028 if (decl_context)
13029 {
13030 /* Find die that represents this context. */
13031 if (TYPE_P (decl_context))
13032 context_die = force_type_die (decl_context);
13033 else
13034 context_die = force_decl_die (decl_context);
13035 }
13036 else
13037 context_die = comp_unit_die;
13038
13039 decl_die = lookup_decl_die (decl);
13040 if (decl_die)
13041 return decl_die;
13042
13043 switch (TREE_CODE (decl))
13044 {
13045 case FUNCTION_DECL:
13046 /* Clear current_function_decl, so that gen_subprogram_die thinks
13047 that this is a declaration. At this point, we just want to force
13048 declaration die. */
13049 save_fn = current_function_decl;
13050 current_function_decl = NULL_TREE;
13051 gen_subprogram_die (decl, context_die);
13052 current_function_decl = save_fn;
13053 break;
13054
13055 case VAR_DECL:
13056 /* Set external flag to force declaration die. Restore it after
13057 gen_decl_die() call. */
13058 saved_external_flag = DECL_EXTERNAL (decl);
13059 DECL_EXTERNAL (decl) = 1;
13060 gen_decl_die (decl, context_die);
13061 DECL_EXTERNAL (decl) = saved_external_flag;
13062 break;
13063
13064 case NAMESPACE_DECL:
13065 dwarf2out_decl (decl);
13066 break;
13067
13068 default:
13069 gcc_unreachable ();
13070 }
13071
13072 /* We should be able to find the DIE now. */
13073 if (!decl_die)
13074 decl_die = lookup_decl_die (decl);
13075 gcc_assert (decl_die);
13076 }
13077
13078 return decl_die;
13079 }
13080
13081 /* Returns the DIE for TYPE. A DIE is always returned. */
13082
13083 static dw_die_ref
13084 force_type_die (tree type)
13085 {
13086 dw_die_ref type_die;
13087
13088 type_die = lookup_type_die (type);
13089 if (!type_die)
13090 {
13091 dw_die_ref context_die;
13092 if (TYPE_CONTEXT (type))
13093 {
13094 if (TYPE_P (TYPE_CONTEXT (type)))
13095 context_die = force_type_die (TYPE_CONTEXT (type));
13096 else
13097 context_die = force_decl_die (TYPE_CONTEXT (type));
13098 }
13099 else
13100 context_die = comp_unit_die;
13101
13102 type_die = lookup_type_die (type);
13103 if (type_die)
13104 return type_die;
13105 gen_type_die (type, context_die);
13106 type_die = lookup_type_die (type);
13107 gcc_assert (type_die);
13108 }
13109 return type_die;
13110 }
13111
13112 /* Force out any required namespaces to be able to output DECL,
13113 and return the new context_die for it, if it's changed. */
13114
13115 static dw_die_ref
13116 setup_namespace_context (tree thing, dw_die_ref context_die)
13117 {
13118 tree context = (DECL_P (thing)
13119 ? DECL_CONTEXT (thing) : TYPE_CONTEXT (thing));
13120 if (context && TREE_CODE (context) == NAMESPACE_DECL)
13121 /* Force out the namespace. */
13122 context_die = force_decl_die (context);
13123
13124 return context_die;
13125 }
13126
13127 /* Emit a declaration DIE for THING (which is either a DECL or a tagged
13128 type) within its namespace, if appropriate.
13129
13130 For compatibility with older debuggers, namespace DIEs only contain
13131 declarations; all definitions are emitted at CU scope. */
13132
13133 static void
13134 declare_in_namespace (tree thing, dw_die_ref context_die)
13135 {
13136 dw_die_ref ns_context;
13137
13138 if (debug_info_level <= DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
13139 return;
13140
13141 /* If this decl is from an inlined function, then don't try to emit it in its
13142 namespace, as we will get confused. It would have already been emitted
13143 when the abstract instance of the inline function was emitted anyways. */
13144 if (DECL_P (thing) && DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN (thing))
13145 return;
13146
13147 ns_context = setup_namespace_context (thing, context_die);
13148
13149 if (ns_context != context_die)
13150 {
13151 if (DECL_P (thing))
13152 gen_decl_die (thing, ns_context);
13153 else
13154 gen_type_die (thing, ns_context);
13155 }
13156 }
13157
13158 /* Generate a DIE for a namespace or namespace alias. */
13159
13160 static void
13161 gen_namespace_die (tree decl)
13162 {
13163 dw_die_ref context_die = setup_namespace_context (decl, comp_unit_die);
13164
13165 /* Namespace aliases have a DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN of the namespace
13166 they are an alias of. */
13167 if (DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN (decl) == NULL)
13168 {
13169 /* Output a real namespace. */
13170 dw_die_ref namespace_die
13171 = new_die (DW_TAG_namespace, context_die, decl);
13172 add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (namespace_die, decl);
13173 equate_decl_number_to_die (decl, namespace_die);
13174 }
13175 else
13176 {
13177 /* Output a namespace alias. */
13178
13179 /* Force out the namespace we are an alias of, if necessary. */
13180 dw_die_ref origin_die
13181 = force_decl_die (DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN (decl));
13182
13183 /* Now create the namespace alias DIE. */
13184 dw_die_ref namespace_die
13185 = new_die (DW_TAG_imported_declaration, context_die, decl);
13186 add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (namespace_die, decl);
13187 add_AT_die_ref (namespace_die, DW_AT_import, origin_die);
13188 equate_decl_number_to_die (decl, namespace_die);
13189 }
13190 }
13191
13192 /* Generate Dwarf debug information for a decl described by DECL. */
13193
13194 static void
13195 gen_decl_die (tree decl, dw_die_ref context_die)
13196 {
13197 tree origin;
13198
13199 if (DECL_P (decl) && DECL_IGNORED_P (decl))
13200 return;
13201
13202 switch (TREE_CODE (decl))
13203 {
13204 case ERROR_MARK:
13205 break;
13206
13207 case CONST_DECL:
13208 /* The individual enumerators of an enum type get output when we output
13209 the Dwarf representation of the relevant enum type itself. */
13210 break;
13211
13212 case FUNCTION_DECL:
13213 /* Don't output any DIEs to represent mere function declarations,
13214 unless they are class members or explicit block externs. */
13215 if (DECL_INITIAL (decl) == NULL_TREE && DECL_CONTEXT (decl) == NULL_TREE
13216 && (current_function_decl == NULL_TREE || DECL_ARTIFICIAL (decl)))
13217 break;
13218
13219 #if 0
13220 /* FIXME */
13221 /* This doesn't work because the C frontend sets DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN
13222 on local redeclarations of global functions. That seems broken. */
13223 if (current_function_decl != decl)
13224 /* This is only a declaration. */;
13225 #endif
13226
13227 /* If we're emitting a clone, emit info for the abstract instance. */
13228 if (DECL_ORIGIN (decl) != decl)
13229 dwarf2out_abstract_function (DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN (decl));
13230
13231 /* If we're emitting an out-of-line copy of an inline function,
13232 emit info for the abstract instance and set up to refer to it. */
13233 else if (cgraph_function_possibly_inlined_p (decl)
13234 && ! DECL_ABSTRACT (decl)
13235 && ! class_or_namespace_scope_p (context_die)
13236 /* dwarf2out_abstract_function won't emit a die if this is just
13237 a declaration. We must avoid setting DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN in
13238 that case, because that works only if we have a die. */
13239 && DECL_INITIAL (decl) != NULL_TREE)
13240 {
13241 dwarf2out_abstract_function (decl);
13242 set_decl_origin_self (decl);
13243 }
13244
13245 /* Otherwise we're emitting the primary DIE for this decl. */
13246 else if (debug_info_level > DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
13247 {
13248 /* Before we describe the FUNCTION_DECL itself, make sure that we
13249 have described its return type. */
13250 gen_type_die (TREE_TYPE (TREE_TYPE (decl)), context_die);
13251
13252 /* And its virtual context. */
13253 if (DECL_VINDEX (decl) != NULL_TREE)
13254 gen_type_die (DECL_CONTEXT (decl), context_die);
13255
13256 /* And its containing type. */
13257 origin = decl_class_context (decl);
13258 if (origin != NULL_TREE)
13259 gen_type_die_for_member (origin, decl, context_die);
13260
13261 /* And its containing namespace. */
13262 declare_in_namespace (decl, context_die);
13263 }
13264
13265 /* Now output a DIE to represent the function itself. */
13266 gen_subprogram_die (decl, context_die);
13267 break;
13268
13269 case TYPE_DECL:
13270 /* If we are in terse mode, don't generate any DIEs to represent any
13271 actual typedefs. */
13272 if (debug_info_level <= DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
13273 break;
13274
13275 /* In the special case of a TYPE_DECL node representing the declaration
13276 of some type tag, if the given TYPE_DECL is marked as having been
13277 instantiated from some other (original) TYPE_DECL node (e.g. one which
13278 was generated within the original definition of an inline function) we
13279 have to generate a special (abbreviated) DW_TAG_structure_type,
13280 DW_TAG_union_type, or DW_TAG_enumeration_type DIE here. */
13281 if (TYPE_DECL_IS_STUB (decl) && decl_ultimate_origin (decl) != NULL_TREE)
13282 {
13283 gen_tagged_type_instantiation_die (TREE_TYPE (decl), context_die);
13284 break;
13285 }
13286
13287 if (is_redundant_typedef (decl))
13288 gen_type_die (TREE_TYPE (decl), context_die);
13289 else
13290 /* Output a DIE to represent the typedef itself. */
13291 gen_typedef_die (decl, context_die);
13292 break;
13293
13294 case LABEL_DECL:
13295 if (debug_info_level >= DINFO_LEVEL_NORMAL)
13296 gen_label_die (decl, context_die);
13297 break;
13298
13299 case VAR_DECL:
13300 case RESULT_DECL:
13301 /* If we are in terse mode, don't generate any DIEs to represent any
13302 variable declarations or definitions. */
13303 if (debug_info_level <= DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
13304 break;
13305
13306 /* Output any DIEs that are needed to specify the type of this data
13307 object. */
13308 gen_type_die (TREE_TYPE (decl), context_die);
13309
13310 /* And its containing type. */
13311 origin = decl_class_context (decl);
13312 if (origin != NULL_TREE)
13313 gen_type_die_for_member (origin, decl, context_die);
13314
13315 /* And its containing namespace. */
13316 declare_in_namespace (decl, context_die);
13317
13318 /* Now output the DIE to represent the data object itself. This gets
13319 complicated because of the possibility that the VAR_DECL really
13320 represents an inlined instance of a formal parameter for an inline
13321 function. */
13322 origin = decl_ultimate_origin (decl);
13323 if (origin != NULL_TREE && TREE_CODE (origin) == PARM_DECL)
13324 gen_formal_parameter_die (decl, context_die);
13325 else
13326 gen_variable_die (decl, context_die);
13327 break;
13328
13329 case FIELD_DECL:
13330 /* Ignore the nameless fields that are used to skip bits but handle C++
13331 anonymous unions and structs. */
13332 if (DECL_NAME (decl) != NULL_TREE
13333 || TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (decl)) == UNION_TYPE
13334 || TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (decl)) == RECORD_TYPE)
13335 {
13336 gen_type_die (member_declared_type (decl), context_die);
13337 gen_field_die (decl, context_die);
13338 }
13339 break;
13340
13341 case PARM_DECL:
13342 gen_type_die (TREE_TYPE (decl), context_die);
13343 gen_formal_parameter_die (decl, context_die);
13344 break;
13345
13346 case NAMESPACE_DECL:
13347 gen_namespace_die (decl);
13348 break;
13349
13350 default:
13351 /* Probably some frontend-internal decl. Assume we don't care. */
13352 gcc_assert ((int)TREE_CODE (decl) > NUM_TREE_CODES);
13353 break;
13354 }
13355 }
13356 \f
13357 /* Output debug information for global decl DECL. Called from toplev.c after
13358 compilation proper has finished. */
13359
13360 static void
13361 dwarf2out_global_decl (tree decl)
13362 {
13363 /* Output DWARF2 information for file-scope tentative data object
13364 declarations, file-scope (extern) function declarations (which had no
13365 corresponding body) and file-scope tagged type declarations and
13366 definitions which have not yet been forced out. */
13367 if (TREE_CODE (decl) != FUNCTION_DECL || !DECL_INITIAL (decl))
13368 dwarf2out_decl (decl);
13369 }
13370
13371 /* Output debug information for type decl DECL. Called from toplev.c
13372 and from language front ends (to record built-in types). */
13373 static void
13374 dwarf2out_type_decl (tree decl, int local)
13375 {
13376 if (!local)
13377 dwarf2out_decl (decl);
13378 }
13379
13380 /* Output debug information for imported module or decl. */
13381
13382 static void
13383 dwarf2out_imported_module_or_decl (tree decl, tree context)
13384 {
13385 dw_die_ref imported_die, at_import_die;
13386 dw_die_ref scope_die;
13387 expanded_location xloc;
13388
13389 if (debug_info_level <= DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
13390 return;
13391
13392 gcc_assert (decl);
13393
13394 /* To emit DW_TAG_imported_module or DW_TAG_imported_decl, we need two DIEs.
13395 We need decl DIE for reference and scope die. First, get DIE for the decl
13396 itself. */
13397
13398 /* Get the scope die for decl context. Use comp_unit_die for global module
13399 or decl. If die is not found for non globals, force new die. */
13400 if (!context)
13401 scope_die = comp_unit_die;
13402 else if (TYPE_P (context))
13403 scope_die = force_type_die (context);
13404 else
13405 scope_die = force_decl_die (context);
13406
13407 /* For TYPE_DECL or CONST_DECL, lookup TREE_TYPE. */
13408 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == TYPE_DECL || TREE_CODE (decl) == CONST_DECL)
13409 at_import_die = force_type_die (TREE_TYPE (decl));
13410 else
13411 {
13412 at_import_die = lookup_decl_die (decl);
13413 if (!at_import_die)
13414 {
13415 /* If we're trying to avoid duplicate debug info, we may not have
13416 emitted the member decl for this field. Emit it now. */
13417 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == FIELD_DECL)
13418 {
13419 tree type = DECL_CONTEXT (decl);
13420 dw_die_ref type_context_die;
13421
13422 if (TYPE_CONTEXT (type))
13423 if (TYPE_P (TYPE_CONTEXT (type)))
13424 type_context_die = force_type_die (TYPE_CONTEXT (type));
13425 else
13426 type_context_die = force_decl_die (TYPE_CONTEXT (type));
13427 else
13428 type_context_die = comp_unit_die;
13429 gen_type_die_for_member (type, decl, type_context_die);
13430 }
13431 at_import_die = force_decl_die (decl);
13432 }
13433 }
13434
13435 /* OK, now we have DIEs for decl as well as scope. Emit imported die. */
13436 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == NAMESPACE_DECL)
13437 imported_die = new_die (DW_TAG_imported_module, scope_die, context);
13438 else
13439 imported_die = new_die (DW_TAG_imported_declaration, scope_die, context);
13440
13441 xloc = expand_location (input_location);
13442 add_AT_file (imported_die, DW_AT_decl_file, lookup_filename (xloc.file));
13443 add_AT_unsigned (imported_die, DW_AT_decl_line, xloc.line);
13444 add_AT_die_ref (imported_die, DW_AT_import, at_import_die);
13445 }
13446
13447 /* Write the debugging output for DECL. */
13448
13449 void
13450 dwarf2out_decl (tree decl)
13451 {
13452 dw_die_ref context_die = comp_unit_die;
13453
13454 switch (TREE_CODE (decl))
13455 {
13456 case ERROR_MARK:
13457 return;
13458
13459 case FUNCTION_DECL:
13460 /* What we would really like to do here is to filter out all mere
13461 file-scope declarations of file-scope functions which are never
13462 referenced later within this translation unit (and keep all of ones
13463 that *are* referenced later on) but we aren't clairvoyant, so we have
13464 no idea which functions will be referenced in the future (i.e. later
13465 on within the current translation unit). So here we just ignore all
13466 file-scope function declarations which are not also definitions. If
13467 and when the debugger needs to know something about these functions,
13468 it will have to hunt around and find the DWARF information associated
13469 with the definition of the function.
13470
13471 We can't just check DECL_EXTERNAL to find out which FUNCTION_DECL
13472 nodes represent definitions and which ones represent mere
13473 declarations. We have to check DECL_INITIAL instead. That's because
13474 the C front-end supports some weird semantics for "extern inline"
13475 function definitions. These can get inlined within the current
13476 translation unit (and thus, we need to generate Dwarf info for their
13477 abstract instances so that the Dwarf info for the concrete inlined
13478 instances can have something to refer to) but the compiler never
13479 generates any out-of-lines instances of such things (despite the fact
13480 that they *are* definitions).
13481
13482 The important point is that the C front-end marks these "extern
13483 inline" functions as DECL_EXTERNAL, but we need to generate DWARF for
13484 them anyway. Note that the C++ front-end also plays some similar games
13485 for inline function definitions appearing within include files which
13486 also contain `#pragma interface' pragmas. */
13487 if (DECL_INITIAL (decl) == NULL_TREE)
13488 return;
13489
13490 /* If we're a nested function, initially use a parent of NULL; if we're
13491 a plain function, this will be fixed up in decls_for_scope. If
13492 we're a method, it will be ignored, since we already have a DIE. */
13493 if (decl_function_context (decl)
13494 /* But if we're in terse mode, we don't care about scope. */
13495 && debug_info_level > DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
13496 context_die = NULL;
13497 break;
13498
13499 case VAR_DECL:
13500 /* Ignore this VAR_DECL if it refers to a file-scope extern data object
13501 declaration and if the declaration was never even referenced from
13502 within this entire compilation unit. We suppress these DIEs in
13503 order to save space in the .debug section (by eliminating entries
13504 which are probably useless). Note that we must not suppress
13505 block-local extern declarations (whether used or not) because that
13506 would screw-up the debugger's name lookup mechanism and cause it to
13507 miss things which really ought to be in scope at a given point. */
13508 if (DECL_EXTERNAL (decl) && !TREE_USED (decl))
13509 return;
13510
13511 /* For local statics lookup proper context die. */
13512 if (TREE_STATIC (decl) && decl_function_context (decl))
13513 context_die = lookup_decl_die (DECL_CONTEXT (decl));
13514
13515 /* If we are in terse mode, don't generate any DIEs to represent any
13516 variable declarations or definitions. */
13517 if (debug_info_level <= DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
13518 return;
13519 break;
13520
13521 case NAMESPACE_DECL:
13522 if (debug_info_level <= DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
13523 return;
13524 if (lookup_decl_die (decl) != NULL)
13525 return;
13526 break;
13527
13528 case TYPE_DECL:
13529 /* Don't emit stubs for types unless they are needed by other DIEs. */
13530 if (TYPE_DECL_SUPPRESS_DEBUG (decl))
13531 return;
13532
13533 /* Don't bother trying to generate any DIEs to represent any of the
13534 normal built-in types for the language we are compiling. */
13535 if (DECL_IS_BUILTIN (decl))
13536 {
13537 /* OK, we need to generate one for `bool' so GDB knows what type
13538 comparisons have. */
13539 if (is_cxx ()
13540 && TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (decl)) == BOOLEAN_TYPE
13541 && ! DECL_IGNORED_P (decl))
13542 modified_type_die (TREE_TYPE (decl), 0, 0, NULL);
13543
13544 return;
13545 }
13546
13547 /* If we are in terse mode, don't generate any DIEs for types. */
13548 if (debug_info_level <= DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
13549 return;
13550
13551 /* If we're a function-scope tag, initially use a parent of NULL;
13552 this will be fixed up in decls_for_scope. */
13553 if (decl_function_context (decl))
13554 context_die = NULL;
13555
13556 break;
13557
13558 default:
13559 return;
13560 }
13561
13562 gen_decl_die (decl, context_die);
13563 }
13564
13565 /* Output a marker (i.e. a label) for the beginning of the generated code for
13566 a lexical block. */
13567
13568 static void
13569 dwarf2out_begin_block (unsigned int line ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
13570 unsigned int blocknum)
13571 {
13572 switch_to_section (current_function_section ());
13573 ASM_OUTPUT_DEBUG_LABEL (asm_out_file, BLOCK_BEGIN_LABEL, blocknum);
13574 }
13575
13576 /* Output a marker (i.e. a label) for the end of the generated code for a
13577 lexical block. */
13578
13579 static void
13580 dwarf2out_end_block (unsigned int line ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, unsigned int blocknum)
13581 {
13582 switch_to_section (current_function_section ());
13583 ASM_OUTPUT_DEBUG_LABEL (asm_out_file, BLOCK_END_LABEL, blocknum);
13584 }
13585
13586 /* Returns nonzero if it is appropriate not to emit any debugging
13587 information for BLOCK, because it doesn't contain any instructions.
13588
13589 Don't allow this for blocks with nested functions or local classes
13590 as we would end up with orphans, and in the presence of scheduling
13591 we may end up calling them anyway. */
13592
13593 static bool
13594 dwarf2out_ignore_block (tree block)
13595 {
13596 tree decl;
13597
13598 for (decl = BLOCK_VARS (block); decl; decl = TREE_CHAIN (decl))
13599 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == FUNCTION_DECL
13600 || (TREE_CODE (decl) == TYPE_DECL && TYPE_DECL_IS_STUB (decl)))
13601 return 0;
13602
13603 return 1;
13604 }
13605
13606 /* Hash table routines for file_hash. */
13607
13608 static int
13609 file_table_eq (const void *p1_p, const void *p2_p)
13610 {
13611 const struct dwarf_file_data * p1 = p1_p;
13612 const char * p2 = p2_p;
13613 return strcmp (p1->filename, p2) == 0;
13614 }
13615
13616 static hashval_t
13617 file_table_hash (const void *p_p)
13618 {
13619 const struct dwarf_file_data * p = p_p;
13620 return htab_hash_string (p->filename);
13621 }
13622
13623 /* Lookup FILE_NAME (in the list of filenames that we know about here in
13624 dwarf2out.c) and return its "index". The index of each (known) filename is
13625 just a unique number which is associated with only that one filename. We
13626 need such numbers for the sake of generating labels (in the .debug_sfnames
13627 section) and references to those files numbers (in the .debug_srcinfo
13628 and.debug_macinfo sections). If the filename given as an argument is not
13629 found in our current list, add it to the list and assign it the next
13630 available unique index number. In order to speed up searches, we remember
13631 the index of the filename was looked up last. This handles the majority of
13632 all searches. */
13633
13634 static struct dwarf_file_data *
13635 lookup_filename (const char *file_name)
13636 {
13637 void ** slot;
13638 struct dwarf_file_data * created;
13639
13640 /* Check to see if the file name that was searched on the previous
13641 call matches this file name. If so, return the index. */
13642 if (file_table_last_lookup
13643 && (file_name == file_table_last_lookup->filename
13644 || strcmp (file_table_last_lookup->filename, file_name) == 0))
13645 return file_table_last_lookup;
13646
13647 /* Didn't match the previous lookup, search the table. */
13648 slot = htab_find_slot_with_hash (file_table, file_name,
13649 htab_hash_string (file_name), INSERT);
13650 if (*slot)
13651 return *slot;
13652
13653 created = ggc_alloc (sizeof (struct dwarf_file_data));
13654 created->filename = file_name;
13655 created->emitted_number = 0;
13656 *slot = created;
13657 return created;
13658 }
13659
13660 /* If the assembler will construct the file table, then translate the compiler
13661 internal file table number into the assembler file table number, and emit
13662 a .file directive if we haven't already emitted one yet. The file table
13663 numbers are different because we prune debug info for unused variables and
13664 types, which may include filenames. */
13665
13666 static int
13667 maybe_emit_file (struct dwarf_file_data * fd)
13668 {
13669 if (! fd->emitted_number)
13670 {
13671 if (last_emitted_file)
13672 fd->emitted_number = last_emitted_file->emitted_number + 1;
13673 else
13674 fd->emitted_number = 1;
13675 last_emitted_file = fd;
13676
13677 if (DWARF2_ASM_LINE_DEBUG_INFO)
13678 {
13679 fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t.file %u ", fd->emitted_number);
13680 output_quoted_string (asm_out_file, fd->filename);
13681 fputc ('\n', asm_out_file);
13682 }
13683 }
13684
13685 return fd->emitted_number;
13686 }
13687
13688 /* Called by the final INSN scan whenever we see a var location. We
13689 use it to drop labels in the right places, and throw the location in
13690 our lookup table. */
13691
13692 static void
13693 dwarf2out_var_location (rtx loc_note)
13694 {
13695 char loclabel[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
13696 struct var_loc_node *newloc;
13697 rtx prev_insn;
13698 static rtx last_insn;
13699 static const char *last_label;
13700 tree decl;
13701
13702 if (!DECL_P (NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_DECL (loc_note)))
13703 return;
13704 prev_insn = PREV_INSN (loc_note);
13705
13706 newloc = ggc_alloc_cleared (sizeof (struct var_loc_node));
13707 /* If the insn we processed last time is the previous insn
13708 and it is also a var location note, use the label we emitted
13709 last time. */
13710 if (last_insn != NULL_RTX
13711 && last_insn == prev_insn
13712 && NOTE_P (prev_insn)
13713 && NOTE_LINE_NUMBER (prev_insn) == NOTE_INSN_VAR_LOCATION)
13714 {
13715 newloc->label = last_label;
13716 }
13717 else
13718 {
13719 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (loclabel, "LVL", loclabel_num);
13720 ASM_OUTPUT_DEBUG_LABEL (asm_out_file, "LVL", loclabel_num);
13721 loclabel_num++;
13722 newloc->label = ggc_strdup (loclabel);
13723 }
13724 newloc->var_loc_note = loc_note;
13725 newloc->next = NULL;
13726
13727 if (cfun && in_cold_section_p)
13728 newloc->section_label = cfun->cold_section_label;
13729 else
13730 newloc->section_label = text_section_label;
13731
13732 last_insn = loc_note;
13733 last_label = newloc->label;
13734 decl = NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_DECL (loc_note);
13735 add_var_loc_to_decl (decl, newloc);
13736 }
13737
13738 /* We need to reset the locations at the beginning of each
13739 function. We can't do this in the end_function hook, because the
13740 declarations that use the locations won't have been output when
13741 that hook is called. Also compute have_multiple_function_sections here. */
13742
13743 static void
13744 dwarf2out_begin_function (tree fun)
13745 {
13746 htab_empty (decl_loc_table);
13747
13748 if (function_section (fun) != text_section)
13749 have_multiple_function_sections = true;
13750 }
13751
13752 /* Output a label to mark the beginning of a source code line entry
13753 and record information relating to this source line, in
13754 'line_info_table' for later output of the .debug_line section. */
13755
13756 static void
13757 dwarf2out_source_line (unsigned int line, const char *filename)
13758 {
13759 if (debug_info_level >= DINFO_LEVEL_NORMAL
13760 && line != 0)
13761 {
13762 int file_num = maybe_emit_file (lookup_filename (filename));
13763
13764 switch_to_section (current_function_section ());
13765
13766 /* If requested, emit something human-readable. */
13767 if (flag_debug_asm)
13768 fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t%s %s:%d\n", ASM_COMMENT_START,
13769 filename, line);
13770
13771 if (DWARF2_ASM_LINE_DEBUG_INFO)
13772 {
13773 /* Emit the .loc directive understood by GNU as. */
13774 fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t.loc %d %d 0\n", file_num, line);
13775
13776 /* Indicate that line number info exists. */
13777 line_info_table_in_use++;
13778 }
13779 else if (function_section (current_function_decl) != text_section)
13780 {
13781 dw_separate_line_info_ref line_info;
13782 targetm.asm_out.internal_label (asm_out_file,
13783 SEPARATE_LINE_CODE_LABEL,
13784 separate_line_info_table_in_use);
13785
13786 /* Expand the line info table if necessary. */
13787 if (separate_line_info_table_in_use
13788 == separate_line_info_table_allocated)
13789 {
13790 separate_line_info_table_allocated += LINE_INFO_TABLE_INCREMENT;
13791 separate_line_info_table
13792 = ggc_realloc (separate_line_info_table,
13793 separate_line_info_table_allocated
13794 * sizeof (dw_separate_line_info_entry));
13795 memset (separate_line_info_table
13796 + separate_line_info_table_in_use,
13797 0,
13798 (LINE_INFO_TABLE_INCREMENT
13799 * sizeof (dw_separate_line_info_entry)));
13800 }
13801
13802 /* Add the new entry at the end of the line_info_table. */
13803 line_info
13804 = &separate_line_info_table[separate_line_info_table_in_use++];
13805 line_info->dw_file_num = file_num;
13806 line_info->dw_line_num = line;
13807 line_info->function = current_function_funcdef_no;
13808 }
13809 else
13810 {
13811 dw_line_info_ref line_info;
13812
13813 targetm.asm_out.internal_label (asm_out_file, LINE_CODE_LABEL,
13814 line_info_table_in_use);
13815
13816 /* Expand the line info table if necessary. */
13817 if (line_info_table_in_use == line_info_table_allocated)
13818 {
13819 line_info_table_allocated += LINE_INFO_TABLE_INCREMENT;
13820 line_info_table
13821 = ggc_realloc (line_info_table,
13822 (line_info_table_allocated
13823 * sizeof (dw_line_info_entry)));
13824 memset (line_info_table + line_info_table_in_use, 0,
13825 LINE_INFO_TABLE_INCREMENT * sizeof (dw_line_info_entry));
13826 }
13827
13828 /* Add the new entry at the end of the line_info_table. */
13829 line_info = &line_info_table[line_info_table_in_use++];
13830 line_info->dw_file_num = file_num;
13831 line_info->dw_line_num = line;
13832 }
13833 }
13834 }
13835
13836 /* Record the beginning of a new source file. */
13837
13838 static void
13839 dwarf2out_start_source_file (unsigned int lineno, const char *filename)
13840 {
13841 if (flag_eliminate_dwarf2_dups)
13842 {
13843 /* Record the beginning of the file for break_out_includes. */
13844 dw_die_ref bincl_die;
13845
13846 bincl_die = new_die (DW_TAG_GNU_BINCL, comp_unit_die, NULL);
13847 add_AT_string (bincl_die, DW_AT_name, filename);
13848 }
13849
13850 if (debug_info_level >= DINFO_LEVEL_VERBOSE)
13851 {
13852 int file_num = maybe_emit_file (lookup_filename (filename));
13853
13854 switch_to_section (debug_macinfo_section);
13855 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_MACINFO_start_file, "Start new file");
13856 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (lineno, "Included from line number %d",
13857 lineno);
13858
13859 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (file_num, "file %s", filename);
13860 }
13861 }
13862
13863 /* Record the end of a source file. */
13864
13865 static void
13866 dwarf2out_end_source_file (unsigned int lineno ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
13867 {
13868 if (flag_eliminate_dwarf2_dups)
13869 /* Record the end of the file for break_out_includes. */
13870 new_die (DW_TAG_GNU_EINCL, comp_unit_die, NULL);
13871
13872 if (debug_info_level >= DINFO_LEVEL_VERBOSE)
13873 {
13874 switch_to_section (debug_macinfo_section);
13875 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_MACINFO_end_file, "End file");
13876 }
13877 }
13878
13879 /* Called from debug_define in toplev.c. The `buffer' parameter contains
13880 the tail part of the directive line, i.e. the part which is past the
13881 initial whitespace, #, whitespace, directive-name, whitespace part. */
13882
13883 static void
13884 dwarf2out_define (unsigned int lineno ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
13885 const char *buffer ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
13886 {
13887 if (debug_info_level >= DINFO_LEVEL_VERBOSE)
13888 {
13889 switch_to_section (debug_macinfo_section);
13890 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_MACINFO_define, "Define macro");
13891 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (lineno, "At line number %d", lineno);
13892 dw2_asm_output_nstring (buffer, -1, "The macro");
13893 }
13894 }
13895
13896 /* Called from debug_undef in toplev.c. The `buffer' parameter contains
13897 the tail part of the directive line, i.e. the part which is past the
13898 initial whitespace, #, whitespace, directive-name, whitespace part. */
13899
13900 static void
13901 dwarf2out_undef (unsigned int lineno ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
13902 const char *buffer ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
13903 {
13904 if (debug_info_level >= DINFO_LEVEL_VERBOSE)
13905 {
13906 switch_to_section (debug_macinfo_section);
13907 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_MACINFO_undef, "Undefine macro");
13908 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (lineno, "At line number %d", lineno);
13909 dw2_asm_output_nstring (buffer, -1, "The macro");
13910 }
13911 }
13912
13913 /* Set up for Dwarf output at the start of compilation. */
13914
13915 static void
13916 dwarf2out_init (const char *filename ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
13917 {
13918 /* Allocate the file_table. */
13919 file_table = htab_create_ggc (50, file_table_hash,
13920 file_table_eq, NULL);
13921
13922 /* Allocate the decl_die_table. */
13923 decl_die_table = htab_create_ggc (10, decl_die_table_hash,
13924 decl_die_table_eq, NULL);
13925
13926 /* Allocate the decl_loc_table. */
13927 decl_loc_table = htab_create_ggc (10, decl_loc_table_hash,
13928 decl_loc_table_eq, NULL);
13929
13930 /* Allocate the initial hunk of the decl_scope_table. */
13931 decl_scope_table = VEC_alloc (tree, gc, 256);
13932
13933 /* Allocate the initial hunk of the abbrev_die_table. */
13934 abbrev_die_table = ggc_alloc_cleared (ABBREV_DIE_TABLE_INCREMENT
13935 * sizeof (dw_die_ref));
13936 abbrev_die_table_allocated = ABBREV_DIE_TABLE_INCREMENT;
13937 /* Zero-th entry is allocated, but unused. */
13938 abbrev_die_table_in_use = 1;
13939
13940 /* Allocate the initial hunk of the line_info_table. */
13941 line_info_table = ggc_alloc_cleared (LINE_INFO_TABLE_INCREMENT
13942 * sizeof (dw_line_info_entry));
13943 line_info_table_allocated = LINE_INFO_TABLE_INCREMENT;
13944
13945 /* Zero-th entry is allocated, but unused. */
13946 line_info_table_in_use = 1;
13947
13948 /* Allocate the pubtypes and pubnames vectors. */
13949 pubname_table = VEC_alloc (pubname_entry, gc, 32);
13950 pubtype_table = VEC_alloc (pubname_entry, gc, 32);
13951
13952 /* Generate the initial DIE for the .debug section. Note that the (string)
13953 value given in the DW_AT_name attribute of the DW_TAG_compile_unit DIE
13954 will (typically) be a relative pathname and that this pathname should be
13955 taken as being relative to the directory from which the compiler was
13956 invoked when the given (base) source file was compiled. We will fill
13957 in this value in dwarf2out_finish. */
13958 comp_unit_die = gen_compile_unit_die (NULL);
13959
13960 incomplete_types = VEC_alloc (tree, gc, 64);
13961
13962 used_rtx_array = VEC_alloc (rtx, gc, 32);
13963
13964 debug_info_section = get_section (DEBUG_INFO_SECTION,
13965 SECTION_DEBUG, NULL);
13966 debug_abbrev_section = get_section (DEBUG_ABBREV_SECTION,
13967 SECTION_DEBUG, NULL);
13968 debug_aranges_section = get_section (DEBUG_ARANGES_SECTION,
13969 SECTION_DEBUG, NULL);
13970 debug_macinfo_section = get_section (DEBUG_MACINFO_SECTION,
13971 SECTION_DEBUG, NULL);
13972 debug_line_section = get_section (DEBUG_LINE_SECTION,
13973 SECTION_DEBUG, NULL);
13974 debug_loc_section = get_section (DEBUG_LOC_SECTION,
13975 SECTION_DEBUG, NULL);
13976 debug_pubnames_section = get_section (DEBUG_PUBNAMES_SECTION,
13977 SECTION_DEBUG, NULL);
13978 #ifdef DEBUG_PUBTYPES_SECTION
13979 debug_pubtypes_section = get_section (DEBUG_PUBTYPES_SECTION,
13980 SECTION_DEBUG, NULL);
13981 #endif
13982 debug_str_section = get_section (DEBUG_STR_SECTION,
13983 DEBUG_STR_SECTION_FLAGS, NULL);
13984 debug_ranges_section = get_section (DEBUG_RANGES_SECTION,
13985 SECTION_DEBUG, NULL);
13986 debug_frame_section = get_section (DEBUG_FRAME_SECTION,
13987 SECTION_DEBUG, NULL);
13988
13989 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (text_end_label, TEXT_END_LABEL, 0);
13990 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (abbrev_section_label,
13991 DEBUG_ABBREV_SECTION_LABEL, 0);
13992 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (text_section_label, TEXT_SECTION_LABEL, 0);
13993 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (cold_text_section_label,
13994 COLD_TEXT_SECTION_LABEL, 0);
13995 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (cold_end_label, COLD_END_LABEL, 0);
13996
13997 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (debug_info_section_label,
13998 DEBUG_INFO_SECTION_LABEL, 0);
13999 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (debug_line_section_label,
14000 DEBUG_LINE_SECTION_LABEL, 0);
14001 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (ranges_section_label,
14002 DEBUG_RANGES_SECTION_LABEL, 0);
14003 switch_to_section (debug_abbrev_section);
14004 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, abbrev_section_label);
14005 switch_to_section (debug_info_section);
14006 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, debug_info_section_label);
14007 switch_to_section (debug_line_section);
14008 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, debug_line_section_label);
14009
14010 if (debug_info_level >= DINFO_LEVEL_VERBOSE)
14011 {
14012 switch_to_section (debug_macinfo_section);
14013 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (macinfo_section_label,
14014 DEBUG_MACINFO_SECTION_LABEL, 0);
14015 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, macinfo_section_label);
14016 }
14017
14018 switch_to_section (text_section);
14019 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, text_section_label);
14020 if (flag_reorder_blocks_and_partition)
14021 {
14022 switch_to_section (unlikely_text_section ());
14023 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, cold_text_section_label);
14024 }
14025 }
14026
14027 /* A helper function for dwarf2out_finish called through
14028 ht_forall. Emit one queued .debug_str string. */
14029
14030 static int
14031 output_indirect_string (void **h, void *v ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
14032 {
14033 struct indirect_string_node *node = (struct indirect_string_node *) *h;
14034
14035 if (node->form == DW_FORM_strp)
14036 {
14037 switch_to_section (debug_str_section);
14038 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, node->label);
14039 assemble_string (node->str, strlen (node->str) + 1);
14040 }
14041
14042 return 1;
14043 }
14044
14045 #if ENABLE_ASSERT_CHECKING
14046 /* Verify that all marks are clear. */
14047
14048 static void
14049 verify_marks_clear (dw_die_ref die)
14050 {
14051 dw_die_ref c;
14052
14053 gcc_assert (! die->die_mark);
14054 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, verify_marks_clear (c));
14055 }
14056 #endif /* ENABLE_ASSERT_CHECKING */
14057
14058 /* Clear the marks for a die and its children.
14059 Be cool if the mark isn't set. */
14060
14061 static void
14062 prune_unmark_dies (dw_die_ref die)
14063 {
14064 dw_die_ref c;
14065
14066 if (die->die_mark)
14067 die->die_mark = 0;
14068 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, prune_unmark_dies (c));
14069 }
14070
14071 /* Given DIE that we're marking as used, find any other dies
14072 it references as attributes and mark them as used. */
14073
14074 static void
14075 prune_unused_types_walk_attribs (dw_die_ref die)
14076 {
14077 dw_attr_ref a;
14078 unsigned ix;
14079
14080 for (ix = 0; VEC_iterate (dw_attr_node, die->die_attr, ix, a); ix++)
14081 {
14082 if (a->dw_attr_val.val_class == dw_val_class_die_ref)
14083 {
14084 /* A reference to another DIE.
14085 Make sure that it will get emitted. */
14086 prune_unused_types_mark (a->dw_attr_val.v.val_die_ref.die, 1);
14087 }
14088 /* Set the string's refcount to 0 so that prune_unused_types_mark
14089 accounts properly for it. */
14090 if (AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_str)
14091 a->dw_attr_val.v.val_str->refcount = 0;
14092 }
14093 }
14094
14095
14096 /* Mark DIE as being used. If DOKIDS is true, then walk down
14097 to DIE's children. */
14098
14099 static void
14100 prune_unused_types_mark (dw_die_ref die, int dokids)
14101 {
14102 dw_die_ref c;
14103
14104 if (die->die_mark == 0)
14105 {
14106 /* We haven't done this node yet. Mark it as used. */
14107 die->die_mark = 1;
14108
14109 /* We also have to mark its parents as used.
14110 (But we don't want to mark our parents' kids due to this.) */
14111 if (die->die_parent)
14112 prune_unused_types_mark (die->die_parent, 0);
14113
14114 /* Mark any referenced nodes. */
14115 prune_unused_types_walk_attribs (die);
14116
14117 /* If this node is a specification,
14118 also mark the definition, if it exists. */
14119 if (get_AT_flag (die, DW_AT_declaration) && die->die_definition)
14120 prune_unused_types_mark (die->die_definition, 1);
14121 }
14122
14123 if (dokids && die->die_mark != 2)
14124 {
14125 /* We need to walk the children, but haven't done so yet.
14126 Remember that we've walked the kids. */
14127 die->die_mark = 2;
14128
14129 /* If this is an array type, we need to make sure our
14130 kids get marked, even if they're types. */
14131 if (die->die_tag == DW_TAG_array_type)
14132 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, prune_unused_types_mark (c, 1));
14133 else
14134 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, prune_unused_types_walk (c));
14135 }
14136 }
14137
14138
14139 /* Walk the tree DIE and mark types that we actually use. */
14140
14141 static void
14142 prune_unused_types_walk (dw_die_ref die)
14143 {
14144 dw_die_ref c;
14145
14146 /* Don't do anything if this node is already marked. */
14147 if (die->die_mark)
14148 return;
14149
14150 switch (die->die_tag)
14151 {
14152 case DW_TAG_const_type:
14153 case DW_TAG_packed_type:
14154 case DW_TAG_pointer_type:
14155 case DW_TAG_reference_type:
14156 case DW_TAG_volatile_type:
14157 case DW_TAG_typedef:
14158 case DW_TAG_array_type:
14159 case DW_TAG_structure_type:
14160 case DW_TAG_union_type:
14161 case DW_TAG_class_type:
14162 case DW_TAG_friend:
14163 case DW_TAG_variant_part:
14164 case DW_TAG_enumeration_type:
14165 case DW_TAG_subroutine_type:
14166 case DW_TAG_string_type:
14167 case DW_TAG_set_type:
14168 case DW_TAG_subrange_type:
14169 case DW_TAG_ptr_to_member_type:
14170 case DW_TAG_file_type:
14171 if (die->die_perennial_p)
14172 break;
14173
14174 /* It's a type node --- don't mark it. */
14175 return;
14176
14177 default:
14178 /* Mark everything else. */
14179 break;
14180 }
14181
14182 die->die_mark = 1;
14183
14184 /* Now, mark any dies referenced from here. */
14185 prune_unused_types_walk_attribs (die);
14186
14187 /* Mark children. */
14188 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, prune_unused_types_walk (c));
14189 }
14190
14191 /* Increment the string counts on strings referred to from DIE's
14192 attributes. */
14193
14194 static void
14195 prune_unused_types_update_strings (dw_die_ref die)
14196 {
14197 dw_attr_ref a;
14198 unsigned ix;
14199
14200 for (ix = 0; VEC_iterate (dw_attr_node, die->die_attr, ix, a); ix++)
14201 if (AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_str)
14202 {
14203 struct indirect_string_node *s = a->dw_attr_val.v.val_str;
14204 s->refcount++;
14205 /* Avoid unnecessarily putting strings that are used less than
14206 twice in the hash table. */
14207 if (s->refcount
14208 == ((DEBUG_STR_SECTION_FLAGS & SECTION_MERGE) ? 1 : 2))
14209 {
14210 void ** slot;
14211 slot = htab_find_slot_with_hash (debug_str_hash, s->str,
14212 htab_hash_string (s->str),
14213 INSERT);
14214 gcc_assert (*slot == NULL);
14215 *slot = s;
14216 }
14217 }
14218 }
14219
14220 /* Remove from the tree DIE any dies that aren't marked. */
14221
14222 static void
14223 prune_unused_types_prune (dw_die_ref die)
14224 {
14225 dw_die_ref c;
14226
14227 gcc_assert (die->die_mark);
14228 prune_unused_types_update_strings (die);
14229
14230 if (! die->die_child)
14231 return;
14232
14233 c = die->die_child;
14234 do {
14235 dw_die_ref prev = c;
14236 for (c = c->die_sib; ! c->die_mark; c = c->die_sib)
14237 if (c == die->die_child)
14238 {
14239 /* No marked children between 'prev' and the end of the list. */
14240 if (prev == c)
14241 /* No marked children at all. */
14242 die->die_child = NULL;
14243 else
14244 {
14245 prev->die_sib = c->die_sib;
14246 die->die_child = prev;
14247 }
14248 return;
14249 }
14250
14251 if (c != prev->die_sib)
14252 prev->die_sib = c;
14253 prune_unused_types_prune (c);
14254 } while (c != die->die_child);
14255 }
14256
14257
14258 /* Remove dies representing declarations that we never use. */
14259
14260 static void
14261 prune_unused_types (void)
14262 {
14263 unsigned int i;
14264 limbo_die_node *node;
14265 pubname_ref pub;
14266
14267 #if ENABLE_ASSERT_CHECKING
14268 /* All the marks should already be clear. */
14269 verify_marks_clear (comp_unit_die);
14270 for (node = limbo_die_list; node; node = node->next)
14271 verify_marks_clear (node->die);
14272 #endif /* ENABLE_ASSERT_CHECKING */
14273
14274 /* Set the mark on nodes that are actually used. */
14275 prune_unused_types_walk (comp_unit_die);
14276 for (node = limbo_die_list; node; node = node->next)
14277 prune_unused_types_walk (node->die);
14278
14279 /* Also set the mark on nodes referenced from the
14280 pubname_table or arange_table. */
14281 for (i = 0; VEC_iterate (pubname_entry, pubname_table, i, pub); i++)
14282 prune_unused_types_mark (pub->die, 1);
14283 for (i = 0; i < arange_table_in_use; i++)
14284 prune_unused_types_mark (arange_table[i], 1);
14285
14286 /* Get rid of nodes that aren't marked; and update the string counts. */
14287 if (debug_str_hash)
14288 htab_empty (debug_str_hash);
14289 prune_unused_types_prune (comp_unit_die);
14290 for (node = limbo_die_list; node; node = node->next)
14291 prune_unused_types_prune (node->die);
14292
14293 /* Leave the marks clear. */
14294 prune_unmark_dies (comp_unit_die);
14295 for (node = limbo_die_list; node; node = node->next)
14296 prune_unmark_dies (node->die);
14297 }
14298
14299 /* Set the parameter to true if there are any relative pathnames in
14300 the file table. */
14301 static int
14302 file_table_relative_p (void ** slot, void *param)
14303 {
14304 bool *p = param;
14305 struct dwarf_file_data *d = *slot;
14306 if (d->emitted_number && !IS_ABSOLUTE_PATH (d->filename))
14307 {
14308 *p = true;
14309 return 0;
14310 }
14311 return 1;
14312 }
14313
14314 /* Output stuff that dwarf requires at the end of every file,
14315 and generate the DWARF-2 debugging info. */
14316
14317 static void
14318 dwarf2out_finish (const char *filename)
14319 {
14320 limbo_die_node *node, *next_node;
14321 dw_die_ref die = 0;
14322
14323 /* Add the name for the main input file now. We delayed this from
14324 dwarf2out_init to avoid complications with PCH. */
14325 add_name_attribute (comp_unit_die, filename);
14326 if (!IS_ABSOLUTE_PATH (filename))
14327 add_comp_dir_attribute (comp_unit_die);
14328 else if (get_AT (comp_unit_die, DW_AT_comp_dir) == NULL)
14329 {
14330 bool p = false;
14331 htab_traverse (file_table, file_table_relative_p, &p);
14332 if (p)
14333 add_comp_dir_attribute (comp_unit_die);
14334 }
14335
14336 /* Traverse the limbo die list, and add parent/child links. The only
14337 dies without parents that should be here are concrete instances of
14338 inline functions, and the comp_unit_die. We can ignore the comp_unit_die.
14339 For concrete instances, we can get the parent die from the abstract
14340 instance. */
14341 for (node = limbo_die_list; node; node = next_node)
14342 {
14343 next_node = node->next;
14344 die = node->die;
14345
14346 if (die->die_parent == NULL)
14347 {
14348 dw_die_ref origin = get_AT_ref (die, DW_AT_abstract_origin);
14349
14350 if (origin)
14351 add_child_die (origin->die_parent, die);
14352 else if (die == comp_unit_die)
14353 ;
14354 else if (errorcount > 0 || sorrycount > 0)
14355 /* It's OK to be confused by errors in the input. */
14356 add_child_die (comp_unit_die, die);
14357 else
14358 {
14359 /* In certain situations, the lexical block containing a
14360 nested function can be optimized away, which results
14361 in the nested function die being orphaned. Likewise
14362 with the return type of that nested function. Force
14363 this to be a child of the containing function.
14364
14365 It may happen that even the containing function got fully
14366 inlined and optimized out. In that case we are lost and
14367 assign the empty child. This should not be big issue as
14368 the function is likely unreachable too. */
14369 tree context = NULL_TREE;
14370
14371 gcc_assert (node->created_for);
14372
14373 if (DECL_P (node->created_for))
14374 context = DECL_CONTEXT (node->created_for);
14375 else if (TYPE_P (node->created_for))
14376 context = TYPE_CONTEXT (node->created_for);
14377
14378 gcc_assert (context && TREE_CODE (context) == FUNCTION_DECL);
14379
14380 origin = lookup_decl_die (context);
14381 if (origin)
14382 add_child_die (origin, die);
14383 else
14384 add_child_die (comp_unit_die, die);
14385 }
14386 }
14387 }
14388
14389 limbo_die_list = NULL;
14390
14391 /* Walk through the list of incomplete types again, trying once more to
14392 emit full debugging info for them. */
14393 retry_incomplete_types ();
14394
14395 if (flag_eliminate_unused_debug_types)
14396 prune_unused_types ();
14397
14398 /* Generate separate CUs for each of the include files we've seen.
14399 They will go into limbo_die_list. */
14400 if (flag_eliminate_dwarf2_dups)
14401 break_out_includes (comp_unit_die);
14402
14403 /* Traverse the DIE's and add add sibling attributes to those DIE's
14404 that have children. */
14405 add_sibling_attributes (comp_unit_die);
14406 for (node = limbo_die_list; node; node = node->next)
14407 add_sibling_attributes (node->die);
14408
14409 /* Output a terminator label for the .text section. */
14410 switch_to_section (text_section);
14411 targetm.asm_out.internal_label (asm_out_file, TEXT_END_LABEL, 0);
14412 if (flag_reorder_blocks_and_partition)
14413 {
14414 switch_to_section (unlikely_text_section ());
14415 targetm.asm_out.internal_label (asm_out_file, COLD_END_LABEL, 0);
14416 }
14417
14418 /* We can only use the low/high_pc attributes if all of the code was
14419 in .text. */
14420 if (!have_multiple_function_sections)
14421 {
14422 add_AT_lbl_id (comp_unit_die, DW_AT_low_pc, text_section_label);
14423 add_AT_lbl_id (comp_unit_die, DW_AT_high_pc, text_end_label);
14424 }
14425
14426 /* If it wasn't, we need to give .debug_loc and .debug_ranges an appropriate
14427 "base address". Use zero so that these addresses become absolute. */
14428 else if (have_location_lists || ranges_table_in_use)
14429 add_AT_addr (comp_unit_die, DW_AT_entry_pc, const0_rtx);
14430
14431 /* Output location list section if necessary. */
14432 if (have_location_lists)
14433 {
14434 /* Output the location lists info. */
14435 switch_to_section (debug_loc_section);
14436 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (loc_section_label,
14437 DEBUG_LOC_SECTION_LABEL, 0);
14438 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, loc_section_label);
14439 output_location_lists (die);
14440 }
14441
14442 if (debug_info_level >= DINFO_LEVEL_NORMAL)
14443 add_AT_lineptr (comp_unit_die, DW_AT_stmt_list,
14444 debug_line_section_label);
14445
14446 if (debug_info_level >= DINFO_LEVEL_VERBOSE)
14447 add_AT_macptr (comp_unit_die, DW_AT_macro_info, macinfo_section_label);
14448
14449 /* Output all of the compilation units. We put the main one last so that
14450 the offsets are available to output_pubnames. */
14451 for (node = limbo_die_list; node; node = node->next)
14452 output_comp_unit (node->die, 0);
14453
14454 output_comp_unit (comp_unit_die, 0);
14455
14456 /* Output the abbreviation table. */
14457 switch_to_section (debug_abbrev_section);
14458 output_abbrev_section ();
14459
14460 /* Output public names table if necessary. */
14461 if (!VEC_empty (pubname_entry, pubname_table))
14462 {
14463 switch_to_section (debug_pubnames_section);
14464 output_pubnames (pubname_table);
14465 }
14466
14467 #ifdef DEBUG_PUBTYPES_SECTION
14468 /* Output public types table if necessary. */
14469 if (!VEC_empty (pubname_entry, pubtype_table))
14470 {
14471 switch_to_section (debug_pubtypes_section);
14472 output_pubnames (pubtype_table);
14473 }
14474 #endif
14475
14476 /* Output the address range information. We only put functions in the arange
14477 table, so don't write it out if we don't have any. */
14478 if (fde_table_in_use)
14479 {
14480 switch_to_section (debug_aranges_section);
14481 output_aranges ();
14482 }
14483
14484 /* Output ranges section if necessary. */
14485 if (ranges_table_in_use)
14486 {
14487 switch_to_section (debug_ranges_section);
14488 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, ranges_section_label);
14489 output_ranges ();
14490 }
14491
14492 /* Output the source line correspondence table. We must do this
14493 even if there is no line information. Otherwise, on an empty
14494 translation unit, we will generate a present, but empty,
14495 .debug_info section. IRIX 6.5 `nm' will then complain when
14496 examining the file. This is done late so that any filenames
14497 used by the debug_info section are marked as 'used'. */
14498 if (! DWARF2_ASM_LINE_DEBUG_INFO)
14499 {
14500 switch_to_section (debug_line_section);
14501 output_line_info ();
14502 }
14503
14504 /* Have to end the macro section. */
14505 if (debug_info_level >= DINFO_LEVEL_VERBOSE)
14506 {
14507 switch_to_section (debug_macinfo_section);
14508 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "End compilation unit");
14509 }
14510
14511 /* If we emitted any DW_FORM_strp form attribute, output the string
14512 table too. */
14513 if (debug_str_hash)
14514 htab_traverse (debug_str_hash, output_indirect_string, NULL);
14515 }
14516 #else
14517
14518 /* This should never be used, but its address is needed for comparisons. */
14519 const struct gcc_debug_hooks dwarf2_debug_hooks;
14520
14521 #endif /* DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO */
14522
14523 #include "gt-dwarf2out.h"